1 //===--- SemaExpr.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Expressions -----------------===// 2 // 3 // The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure 4 // 5 // This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source 6 // License. See LICENSE.TXT for details. 7 // 8 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 9 // 10 // This file implements semantic analysis for expressions. 11 // 12 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 13 14 #include "TreeTransform.h" 15 #include "clang/AST/ASTConsumer.h" 16 #include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h" 17 #include "clang/AST/ASTLambda.h" 18 #include "clang/AST/ASTMutationListener.h" 19 #include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h" 20 #include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h" 21 #include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h" 22 #include "clang/AST/EvaluatedExprVisitor.h" 23 #include "clang/AST/Expr.h" 24 #include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h" 25 #include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h" 26 #include "clang/AST/ExprOpenMP.h" 27 #include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h" 28 #include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h" 29 #include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h" 30 #include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h" 31 #include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h" 32 #include "clang/Lex/LiteralSupport.h" 33 #include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h" 34 #include "clang/Sema/AnalysisBasedWarnings.h" 35 #include "clang/Sema/DeclSpec.h" 36 #include "clang/Sema/DelayedDiagnostic.h" 37 #include "clang/Sema/Designator.h" 38 #include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h" 39 #include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h" 40 #include "clang/Sema/Overload.h" 41 #include "clang/Sema/ParsedTemplate.h" 42 #include "clang/Sema/Scope.h" 43 #include "clang/Sema/ScopeInfo.h" 44 #include "clang/Sema/SemaFixItUtils.h" 45 #include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h" 46 #include "clang/Sema/Template.h" 47 #include "llvm/Support/ConvertUTF.h" 48 using namespace clang; 49 using namespace sema; 50 51 /// Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, without 52 /// emitting diagnostics. 53 bool Sema::CanUseDecl(NamedDecl *D, bool TreatUnavailableAsInvalid) { 54 // See if this is an auto-typed variable whose initializer we are parsing. 55 if (ParsingInitForAutoVars.count(D)) 56 return false; 57 58 // See if this is a deleted function. 59 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 60 if (FD->isDeleted()) 61 return false; 62 63 // If the function has a deduced return type, and we can't deduce it, 64 // then we can't use it either. 65 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && FD->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType() && 66 DeduceReturnType(FD, SourceLocation(), /*Diagnose*/ false)) 67 return false; 68 } 69 70 // See if this function is unavailable. 71 if (TreatUnavailableAsInvalid && D->getAvailability() == AR_Unavailable && 72 cast<Decl>(CurContext)->getAvailability() != AR_Unavailable) 73 return false; 74 75 return true; 76 } 77 78 static void DiagnoseUnusedOfDecl(Sema &S, NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc) { 79 // Warn if this is used but marked unused. 80 if (const auto *A = D->getAttr<UnusedAttr>()) { 81 // [[maybe_unused]] should not diagnose uses, but __attribute__((unused)) 82 // should diagnose them. 83 if (A->getSemanticSpelling() != UnusedAttr::CXX11_maybe_unused && 84 A->getSemanticSpelling() != UnusedAttr::C2x_maybe_unused) { 85 const Decl *DC = cast_or_null<Decl>(S.getCurObjCLexicalContext()); 86 if (DC && !DC->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>()) 87 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_used_but_marked_unused) << D->getDeclName(); 88 } 89 } 90 } 91 92 /// Emit a note explaining that this function is deleted. 93 void Sema::NoteDeletedFunction(FunctionDecl *Decl) { 94 assert(Decl->isDeleted()); 95 96 CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Decl); 97 98 if (Method && Method->isDeleted() && Method->isDefaulted()) { 99 // If the method was explicitly defaulted, point at that declaration. 100 if (!Method->isImplicit()) 101 Diag(Decl->getLocation(), diag::note_implicitly_deleted); 102 103 // Try to diagnose why this special member function was implicitly 104 // deleted. This might fail, if that reason no longer applies. 105 CXXSpecialMember CSM = getSpecialMember(Method); 106 if (CSM != CXXInvalid) 107 ShouldDeleteSpecialMember(Method, CSM, nullptr, /*Diagnose=*/true); 108 109 return; 110 } 111 112 auto *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Decl); 113 if (Ctor && Ctor->isInheritingConstructor()) 114 return NoteDeletedInheritingConstructor(Ctor); 115 116 Diag(Decl->getLocation(), diag::note_availability_specified_here) 117 << Decl << true; 118 } 119 120 /// Determine whether a FunctionDecl was ever declared with an 121 /// explicit storage class. 122 static bool hasAnyExplicitStorageClass(const FunctionDecl *D) { 123 for (auto I : D->redecls()) { 124 if (I->getStorageClass() != SC_None) 125 return true; 126 } 127 return false; 128 } 129 130 /// Check whether we're in an extern inline function and referring to a 131 /// variable or function with internal linkage (C11 6.7.4p3). 132 /// 133 /// This is only a warning because we used to silently accept this code, but 134 /// in many cases it will not behave correctly. This is not enabled in C++ mode 135 /// because the restriction language is a bit weaker (C++11 [basic.def.odr]p6) 136 /// and so while there may still be user mistakes, most of the time we can't 137 /// prove that there are errors. 138 static void diagnoseUseOfInternalDeclInInlineFunction(Sema &S, 139 const NamedDecl *D, 140 SourceLocation Loc) { 141 // This is disabled under C++; there are too many ways for this to fire in 142 // contexts where the warning is a false positive, or where it is technically 143 // correct but benign. 144 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 145 return; 146 147 // Check if this is an inlined function or method. 148 FunctionDecl *Current = S.getCurFunctionDecl(); 149 if (!Current) 150 return; 151 if (!Current->isInlined()) 152 return; 153 if (!Current->isExternallyVisible()) 154 return; 155 156 // Check if the decl has internal linkage. 157 if (D->getFormalLinkage() != InternalLinkage) 158 return; 159 160 // Downgrade from ExtWarn to Extension if 161 // (1) the supposedly external inline function is in the main file, 162 // and probably won't be included anywhere else. 163 // (2) the thing we're referencing is a pure function. 164 // (3) the thing we're referencing is another inline function. 165 // This last can give us false negatives, but it's better than warning on 166 // wrappers for simple C library functions. 167 const FunctionDecl *UsedFn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D); 168 bool DowngradeWarning = S.getSourceManager().isInMainFile(Loc); 169 if (!DowngradeWarning && UsedFn) 170 DowngradeWarning = UsedFn->isInlined() || UsedFn->hasAttr<ConstAttr>(); 171 172 S.Diag(Loc, DowngradeWarning ? diag::ext_internal_in_extern_inline_quiet 173 : diag::ext_internal_in_extern_inline) 174 << /*IsVar=*/!UsedFn << D; 175 176 S.MaybeSuggestAddingStaticToDecl(Current); 177 178 S.Diag(D->getCanonicalDecl()->getLocation(), diag::note_entity_declared_at) 179 << D; 180 } 181 182 void Sema::MaybeSuggestAddingStaticToDecl(const FunctionDecl *Cur) { 183 const FunctionDecl *First = Cur->getFirstDecl(); 184 185 // Suggest "static" on the function, if possible. 186 if (!hasAnyExplicitStorageClass(First)) { 187 SourceLocation DeclBegin = First->getSourceRange().getBegin(); 188 Diag(DeclBegin, diag::note_convert_inline_to_static) 189 << Cur << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(DeclBegin, "static "); 190 } 191 } 192 193 /// Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, and 194 /// emit any corresponding diagnostics. 195 /// 196 /// This routine diagnoses various problems with referencing 197 /// declarations that can occur when using a declaration. For example, 198 /// it might warn if a deprecated or unavailable declaration is being 199 /// used, or produce an error (and return true) if a C++0x deleted 200 /// function is being used. 201 /// 202 /// \returns true if there was an error (this declaration cannot be 203 /// referenced), false otherwise. 204 /// 205 bool Sema::DiagnoseUseOfDecl(NamedDecl *D, ArrayRef<SourceLocation> Locs, 206 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *UnknownObjCClass, 207 bool ObjCPropertyAccess, 208 bool AvoidPartialAvailabilityChecks) { 209 SourceLocation Loc = Locs.front(); 210 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 211 // If there were any diagnostics suppressed by template argument deduction, 212 // emit them now. 213 auto Pos = SuppressedDiagnostics.find(D->getCanonicalDecl()); 214 if (Pos != SuppressedDiagnostics.end()) { 215 for (const PartialDiagnosticAt &Suppressed : Pos->second) 216 Diag(Suppressed.first, Suppressed.second); 217 218 // Clear out the list of suppressed diagnostics, so that we don't emit 219 // them again for this specialization. However, we don't obsolete this 220 // entry from the table, because we want to avoid ever emitting these 221 // diagnostics again. 222 Pos->second.clear(); 223 } 224 225 // C++ [basic.start.main]p3: 226 // The function 'main' shall not be used within a program. 227 if (cast<FunctionDecl>(D)->isMain()) 228 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_main_used); 229 } 230 231 // See if this is an auto-typed variable whose initializer we are parsing. 232 if (ParsingInitForAutoVars.count(D)) { 233 if (isa<BindingDecl>(D)) { 234 Diag(Loc, diag::err_binding_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer) 235 << D->getDeclName(); 236 } else { 237 Diag(Loc, diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer) 238 << D->getDeclName() << cast<VarDecl>(D)->getType(); 239 } 240 return true; 241 } 242 243 // See if this is a deleted function. 244 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 245 if (FD->isDeleted()) { 246 auto *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(FD); 247 if (Ctor && Ctor->isInheritingConstructor()) 248 Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_inherited_ctor_use) 249 << Ctor->getParent() 250 << Ctor->getInheritedConstructor().getConstructor()->getParent(); 251 else 252 Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_function_use); 253 NoteDeletedFunction(FD); 254 return true; 255 } 256 257 // If the function has a deduced return type, and we can't deduce it, 258 // then we can't use it either. 259 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && FD->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType() && 260 DeduceReturnType(FD, Loc)) 261 return true; 262 263 if (getLangOpts().CUDA && !CheckCUDACall(Loc, FD)) 264 return true; 265 } 266 267 auto getReferencedObjCProp = [](const NamedDecl *D) -> 268 const ObjCPropertyDecl * { 269 if (const auto *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) 270 return MD->findPropertyDecl(); 271 return nullptr; 272 }; 273 if (const ObjCPropertyDecl *ObjCPDecl = getReferencedObjCProp(D)) { 274 if (diagnoseArgIndependentDiagnoseIfAttrs(ObjCPDecl, Loc)) 275 return true; 276 } else if (diagnoseArgIndependentDiagnoseIfAttrs(D, Loc)) { 277 return true; 278 } 279 280 // [OpenMP 4.0], 2.15 declare reduction Directive, Restrictions 281 // Only the variables omp_in and omp_out are allowed in the combiner. 282 // Only the variables omp_priv and omp_orig are allowed in the 283 // initializer-clause. 284 auto *DRD = dyn_cast<OMPDeclareReductionDecl>(CurContext); 285 if (LangOpts.OpenMP && DRD && !CurContext->containsDecl(D) && 286 isa<VarDecl>(D)) { 287 Diag(Loc, diag::err_omp_wrong_var_in_declare_reduction) 288 << getCurFunction()->HasOMPDeclareReductionCombiner; 289 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_entity_declared_at) << D; 290 return true; 291 } 292 293 DiagnoseAvailabilityOfDecl(D, Locs, UnknownObjCClass, ObjCPropertyAccess, 294 AvoidPartialAvailabilityChecks); 295 296 DiagnoseUnusedOfDecl(*this, D, Loc); 297 298 diagnoseUseOfInternalDeclInInlineFunction(*this, D, Loc); 299 300 return false; 301 } 302 303 /// Retrieve the message suffix that should be added to a 304 /// diagnostic complaining about the given function being deleted or 305 /// unavailable. 306 std::string Sema::getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(const FunctionDecl *FD) { 307 std::string Message; 308 if (FD->getAvailability(&Message)) 309 return ": " + Message; 310 311 return std::string(); 312 } 313 314 /// DiagnoseSentinelCalls - This routine checks whether a call or 315 /// message-send is to a declaration with the sentinel attribute, and 316 /// if so, it checks that the requirements of the sentinel are 317 /// satisfied. 318 void Sema::DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc, 319 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) { 320 const SentinelAttr *attr = D->getAttr<SentinelAttr>(); 321 if (!attr) 322 return; 323 324 // The number of formal parameters of the declaration. 325 unsigned numFormalParams; 326 327 // The kind of declaration. This is also an index into a %select in 328 // the diagnostic. 329 enum CalleeType { CT_Function, CT_Method, CT_Block } calleeType; 330 331 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) { 332 numFormalParams = MD->param_size(); 333 calleeType = CT_Method; 334 } else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 335 numFormalParams = FD->param_size(); 336 calleeType = CT_Function; 337 } else if (isa<VarDecl>(D)) { 338 QualType type = cast<ValueDecl>(D)->getType(); 339 const FunctionType *fn = nullptr; 340 if (const PointerType *ptr = type->getAs<PointerType>()) { 341 fn = ptr->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>(); 342 if (!fn) return; 343 calleeType = CT_Function; 344 } else if (const BlockPointerType *ptr = type->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) { 345 fn = ptr->getPointeeType()->castAs<FunctionType>(); 346 calleeType = CT_Block; 347 } else { 348 return; 349 } 350 351 if (const FunctionProtoType *proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(fn)) { 352 numFormalParams = proto->getNumParams(); 353 } else { 354 numFormalParams = 0; 355 } 356 } else { 357 return; 358 } 359 360 // "nullPos" is the number of formal parameters at the end which 361 // effectively count as part of the variadic arguments. This is 362 // useful if you would prefer to not have *any* formal parameters, 363 // but the language forces you to have at least one. 364 unsigned nullPos = attr->getNullPos(); 365 assert((nullPos == 0 || nullPos == 1) && "invalid null position on sentinel"); 366 numFormalParams = (nullPos > numFormalParams ? 0 : numFormalParams - nullPos); 367 368 // The number of arguments which should follow the sentinel. 369 unsigned numArgsAfterSentinel = attr->getSentinel(); 370 371 // If there aren't enough arguments for all the formal parameters, 372 // the sentinel, and the args after the sentinel, complain. 373 if (Args.size() < numFormalParams + numArgsAfterSentinel + 1) { 374 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName(); 375 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << int(calleeType); 376 return; 377 } 378 379 // Otherwise, find the sentinel expression. 380 Expr *sentinelExpr = Args[Args.size() - numArgsAfterSentinel - 1]; 381 if (!sentinelExpr) return; 382 if (sentinelExpr->isValueDependent()) return; 383 if (Context.isSentinelNullExpr(sentinelExpr)) return; 384 385 // Pick a reasonable string to insert. Optimistically use 'nil', 'nullptr', 386 // or 'NULL' if those are actually defined in the context. Only use 387 // 'nil' for ObjC methods, where it's much more likely that the 388 // variadic arguments form a list of object pointers. 389 SourceLocation MissingNilLoc 390 = getLocForEndOfToken(sentinelExpr->getLocEnd()); 391 std::string NullValue; 392 if (calleeType == CT_Method && PP.isMacroDefined("nil")) 393 NullValue = "nil"; 394 else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) 395 NullValue = "nullptr"; 396 else if (PP.isMacroDefined("NULL")) 397 NullValue = "NULL"; 398 else 399 NullValue = "(void*) 0"; 400 401 if (MissingNilLoc.isInvalid()) 402 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) << int(calleeType); 403 else 404 Diag(MissingNilLoc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) 405 << int(calleeType) 406 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(MissingNilLoc, ", " + NullValue); 407 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << int(calleeType); 408 } 409 410 SourceRange Sema::getExprRange(Expr *E) const { 411 return E ? E->getSourceRange() : SourceRange(); 412 } 413 414 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 415 // Standard Promotions and Conversions 416 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 417 418 /// DefaultFunctionArrayConversion (C99 6.3.2.1p3, C99 6.3.2.1p4). 419 ExprResult Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Expr *E, bool Diagnose) { 420 // Handle any placeholder expressions which made it here. 421 if (E->getType()->isPlaceholderType()) { 422 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E); 423 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 424 E = result.get(); 425 } 426 427 QualType Ty = E->getType(); 428 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayConversion - missing type"); 429 430 if (Ty->isFunctionType()) { 431 if (auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParenCasts())) 432 if (auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DRE->getDecl())) 433 if (!checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(FD, Diagnose, E->getExprLoc())) 434 return ExprError(); 435 436 E = ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty), 437 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay).get(); 438 } else if (Ty->isArrayType()) { 439 // In C90 mode, arrays only promote to pointers if the array expression is 440 // an lvalue. The relevant legalese is C90 6.2.2.1p3: "an lvalue that has 441 // type 'array of type' is converted to an expression that has type 'pointer 442 // to type'...". In C99 this was changed to: C99 6.3.2.1p3: "an expression 443 // that has type 'array of type' ...". The relevant change is "an lvalue" 444 // (C90) to "an expression" (C99). 445 // 446 // C++ 4.2p1: 447 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown bound of 448 // T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to T". 449 // 450 if (getLangOpts().C99 || getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || E->isLValue()) 451 E = ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty), 452 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay).get(); 453 } 454 return E; 455 } 456 457 static void CheckForNullPointerDereference(Sema &S, Expr *E) { 458 // Check to see if we are dereferencing a null pointer. If so, 459 // and if not volatile-qualified, this is undefined behavior that the 460 // optimizer will delete, so warn about it. People sometimes try to use this 461 // to get a deterministic trap and are surprised by clang's behavior. This 462 // only handles the pattern "*null", which is a very syntactic check. 463 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(E->IgnoreParenCasts())) 464 if (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Deref && 465 UO->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParenCasts()-> 466 isNullPointerConstant(S.Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) && 467 !UO->getType().isVolatileQualified()) { 468 S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO, 469 S.PDiag(diag::warn_indirection_through_null) 470 << UO->getSubExpr()->getSourceRange()); 471 S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO, 472 S.PDiag(diag::note_indirection_through_null)); 473 } 474 } 475 476 static void DiagnoseDirectIsaAccess(Sema &S, const ObjCIvarRefExpr *OIRE, 477 SourceLocation AssignLoc, 478 const Expr* RHS) { 479 const ObjCIvarDecl *IV = OIRE->getDecl(); 480 if (!IV) 481 return; 482 483 DeclarationName MemberName = IV->getDeclName(); 484 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo(); 485 if (!Member || !Member->isStr("isa")) 486 return; 487 488 const Expr *Base = OIRE->getBase(); 489 QualType BaseType = Base->getType(); 490 if (OIRE->isArrow()) 491 BaseType = BaseType->getPointeeType(); 492 if (const ObjCObjectType *OTy = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()) 493 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = OTy->getInterface()) { 494 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared = nullptr; 495 ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IDecl->lookupInstanceVariable(Member, ClassDeclared); 496 if (!ClassDeclared->getSuperClass() 497 && (*ClassDeclared->ivar_begin()) == IV) { 498 if (RHS) { 499 NamedDecl *ObjectSetClass = 500 S.LookupSingleName(S.TUScope, 501 &S.Context.Idents.get("object_setClass"), 502 SourceLocation(), S.LookupOrdinaryName); 503 if (ObjectSetClass) { 504 SourceLocation RHSLocEnd = S.getLocForEndOfToken(RHS->getLocEnd()); 505 S.Diag(OIRE->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_assign) << 506 FixItHint::CreateInsertion(OIRE->getLocStart(), "object_setClass(") << 507 FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(OIRE->getOpLoc(), 508 AssignLoc), ",") << 509 FixItHint::CreateInsertion(RHSLocEnd, ")"); 510 } 511 else 512 S.Diag(OIRE->getLocation(), diag::warn_objc_isa_assign); 513 } else { 514 NamedDecl *ObjectGetClass = 515 S.LookupSingleName(S.TUScope, 516 &S.Context.Idents.get("object_getClass"), 517 SourceLocation(), S.LookupOrdinaryName); 518 if (ObjectGetClass) 519 S.Diag(OIRE->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_use) << 520 FixItHint::CreateInsertion(OIRE->getLocStart(), "object_getClass(") << 521 FixItHint::CreateReplacement( 522 SourceRange(OIRE->getOpLoc(), 523 OIRE->getLocEnd()), ")"); 524 else 525 S.Diag(OIRE->getLocation(), diag::warn_objc_isa_use); 526 } 527 S.Diag(IV->getLocation(), diag::note_ivar_decl); 528 } 529 } 530 } 531 532 ExprResult Sema::DefaultLvalueConversion(Expr *E) { 533 // Handle any placeholder expressions which made it here. 534 if (E->getType()->isPlaceholderType()) { 535 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E); 536 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 537 E = result.get(); 538 } 539 540 // C++ [conv.lval]p1: 541 // A glvalue of a non-function, non-array type T can be 542 // converted to a prvalue. 543 if (!E->isGLValue()) return E; 544 545 QualType T = E->getType(); 546 assert(!T.isNull() && "r-value conversion on typeless expression?"); 547 548 // We don't want to throw lvalue-to-rvalue casts on top of 549 // expressions of certain types in C++. 550 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 551 (E->getType() == Context.OverloadTy || 552 T->isDependentType() || 553 T->isRecordType())) 554 return E; 555 556 // The C standard is actually really unclear on this point, and 557 // DR106 tells us what the result should be but not why. It's 558 // generally best to say that void types just doesn't undergo 559 // lvalue-to-rvalue at all. Note that expressions of unqualified 560 // 'void' type are never l-values, but qualified void can be. 561 if (T->isVoidType()) 562 return E; 563 564 // OpenCL usually rejects direct accesses to values of 'half' type. 565 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && !getOpenCLOptions().isEnabled("cl_khr_fp16") && 566 T->isHalfType()) { 567 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_opencl_half_load_store) 568 << 0 << T; 569 return ExprError(); 570 } 571 572 CheckForNullPointerDereference(*this, E); 573 if (const ObjCIsaExpr *OISA = dyn_cast<ObjCIsaExpr>(E->IgnoreParenCasts())) { 574 NamedDecl *ObjectGetClass = LookupSingleName(TUScope, 575 &Context.Idents.get("object_getClass"), 576 SourceLocation(), LookupOrdinaryName); 577 if (ObjectGetClass) 578 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_use) << 579 FixItHint::CreateInsertion(OISA->getLocStart(), "object_getClass(") << 580 FixItHint::CreateReplacement( 581 SourceRange(OISA->getOpLoc(), OISA->getIsaMemberLoc()), ")"); 582 else 583 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_use); 584 } 585 else if (const ObjCIvarRefExpr *OIRE = 586 dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParenCasts())) 587 DiagnoseDirectIsaAccess(*this, OIRE, SourceLocation(), /* Expr*/nullptr); 588 589 // C++ [conv.lval]p1: 590 // [...] If T is a non-class type, the type of the prvalue is the 591 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the 592 // rvalue is T. 593 // 594 // C99 6.3.2.1p2: 595 // If the lvalue has qualified type, the value has the unqualified 596 // version of the type of the lvalue; otherwise, the value has the 597 // type of the lvalue. 598 if (T.hasQualifiers()) 599 T = T.getUnqualifiedType(); 600 601 // Under the MS ABI, lock down the inheritance model now. 602 if (T->isMemberPointerType() && 603 Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft()) 604 (void)isCompleteType(E->getExprLoc(), T); 605 606 UpdateMarkingForLValueToRValue(E); 607 608 // Loading a __weak object implicitly retains the value, so we need a cleanup to 609 // balance that. 610 if (E->getType().getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Weak) 611 Cleanup.setExprNeedsCleanups(true); 612 613 ExprResult Res = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, T, CK_LValueToRValue, E, 614 nullptr, VK_RValue); 615 616 // C11 6.3.2.1p2: 617 // ... if the lvalue has atomic type, the value has the non-atomic version 618 // of the type of the lvalue ... 619 if (const AtomicType *Atomic = T->getAs<AtomicType>()) { 620 T = Atomic->getValueType().getUnqualifiedType(); 621 Res = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, T, CK_AtomicToNonAtomic, Res.get(), 622 nullptr, VK_RValue); 623 } 624 625 return Res; 626 } 627 628 ExprResult Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr *E, bool Diagnose) { 629 ExprResult Res = DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E, Diagnose); 630 if (Res.isInvalid()) 631 return ExprError(); 632 Res = DefaultLvalueConversion(Res.get()); 633 if (Res.isInvalid()) 634 return ExprError(); 635 return Res; 636 } 637 638 /// CallExprUnaryConversions - a special case of an unary conversion 639 /// performed on a function designator of a call expression. 640 ExprResult Sema::CallExprUnaryConversions(Expr *E) { 641 QualType Ty = E->getType(); 642 ExprResult Res = E; 643 // Only do implicit cast for a function type, but not for a pointer 644 // to function type. 645 if (Ty->isFunctionType()) { 646 Res = ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty), 647 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay).get(); 648 if (Res.isInvalid()) 649 return ExprError(); 650 } 651 Res = DefaultLvalueConversion(Res.get()); 652 if (Res.isInvalid()) 653 return ExprError(); 654 return Res.get(); 655 } 656 657 /// UsualUnaryConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to most 658 /// operators (C99 6.3). The conversions of array and function types are 659 /// sometimes suppressed. For example, the array->pointer conversion doesn't 660 /// apply if the array is an argument to the sizeof or address (&) operators. 661 /// In these instances, this routine should *not* be called. 662 ExprResult Sema::UsualUnaryConversions(Expr *E) { 663 // First, convert to an r-value. 664 ExprResult Res = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E); 665 if (Res.isInvalid()) 666 return ExprError(); 667 E = Res.get(); 668 669 QualType Ty = E->getType(); 670 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "UsualUnaryConversions - missing type"); 671 672 // Half FP have to be promoted to float unless it is natively supported 673 if (Ty->isHalfType() && !getLangOpts().NativeHalfType) 674 return ImpCastExprToType(Res.get(), Context.FloatTy, CK_FloatingCast); 675 676 // Try to perform integral promotions if the object has a theoretically 677 // promotable type. 678 if (Ty->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()) { 679 // C99 6.3.1.1p2: 680 // 681 // The following may be used in an expression wherever an int or 682 // unsigned int may be used: 683 // - an object or expression with an integer type whose integer 684 // conversion rank is less than or equal to the rank of int 685 // and unsigned int. 686 // - A bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int. 687 // 688 // If an int can represent all values of the original type, the 689 // value is converted to an int; otherwise, it is converted to an 690 // unsigned int. These are called the integer promotions. All 691 // other types are unchanged by the integer promotions. 692 693 QualType PTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(E); 694 if (!PTy.isNull()) { 695 E = ImpCastExprToType(E, PTy, CK_IntegralCast).get(); 696 return E; 697 } 698 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) { 699 QualType PT = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(Ty); 700 E = ImpCastExprToType(E, PT, CK_IntegralCast).get(); 701 return E; 702 } 703 } 704 return E; 705 } 706 707 /// DefaultArgumentPromotion (C99 6.5.2.2p6). Used for function calls that 708 /// do not have a prototype. Arguments that have type float or __fp16 709 /// are promoted to double. All other argument types are converted by 710 /// UsualUnaryConversions(). 711 ExprResult Sema::DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr *E) { 712 QualType Ty = E->getType(); 713 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultArgumentPromotion - missing type"); 714 715 ExprResult Res = UsualUnaryConversions(E); 716 if (Res.isInvalid()) 717 return ExprError(); 718 E = Res.get(); 719 720 // If this is a 'float' or '__fp16' (CVR qualified or typedef) 721 // promote to double. 722 // Note that default argument promotion applies only to float (and 723 // half/fp16); it does not apply to _Float16. 724 const BuiltinType *BTy = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>(); 725 if (BTy && (BTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::Half || 726 BTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float)) { 727 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && 728 !getOpenCLOptions().isEnabled("cl_khr_fp64")) { 729 if (BTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::Half) { 730 E = ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.FloatTy, CK_FloatingCast).get(); 731 } 732 } else { 733 E = ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.DoubleTy, CK_FloatingCast).get(); 734 } 735 } 736 737 // C++ performs lvalue-to-rvalue conversion as a default argument 738 // promotion, even on class types, but note: 739 // C++11 [conv.lval]p2: 740 // When an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion occurs in an unevaluated 741 // operand or a subexpression thereof the value contained in the 742 // referenced object is not accessed. Otherwise, if the glvalue 743 // has a class type, the conversion copy-initializes a temporary 744 // of type T from the glvalue and the result of the conversion 745 // is a prvalue for the temporary. 746 // FIXME: add some way to gate this entire thing for correctness in 747 // potentially potentially evaluated contexts. 748 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && E->isGLValue() && !isUnevaluatedContext()) { 749 ExprResult Temp = PerformCopyInitialization( 750 InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(E->getType()), 751 E->getExprLoc(), E); 752 if (Temp.isInvalid()) 753 return ExprError(); 754 E = Temp.get(); 755 } 756 757 return E; 758 } 759 760 /// Determine the degree of POD-ness for an expression. 761 /// Incomplete types are considered POD, since this check can be performed 762 /// when we're in an unevaluated context. 763 Sema::VarArgKind Sema::isValidVarArgType(const QualType &Ty) { 764 if (Ty->isIncompleteType()) { 765 // C++11 [expr.call]p7: 766 // After these conversions, if the argument does not have arithmetic, 767 // enumeration, pointer, pointer to member, or class type, the program 768 // is ill-formed. 769 // 770 // Since we've already performed array-to-pointer and function-to-pointer 771 // decay, the only such type in C++ is cv void. This also handles 772 // initializer lists as variadic arguments. 773 if (Ty->isVoidType()) 774 return VAK_Invalid; 775 776 if (Ty->isObjCObjectType()) 777 return VAK_Invalid; 778 return VAK_Valid; 779 } 780 781 if (Ty.isDestructedType() == QualType::DK_nontrivial_c_struct) 782 return VAK_Invalid; 783 784 if (Ty.isCXX98PODType(Context)) 785 return VAK_Valid; 786 787 // C++11 [expr.call]p7: 788 // Passing a potentially-evaluated argument of class type (Clause 9) 789 // having a non-trivial copy constructor, a non-trivial move constructor, 790 // or a non-trivial destructor, with no corresponding parameter, 791 // is conditionally-supported with implementation-defined semantics. 792 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && !Ty->isDependentType()) 793 if (CXXRecordDecl *Record = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) 794 if (!Record->hasNonTrivialCopyConstructor() && 795 !Record->hasNonTrivialMoveConstructor() && 796 !Record->hasNonTrivialDestructor()) 797 return VAK_ValidInCXX11; 798 799 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && Ty->isObjCLifetimeType()) 800 return VAK_Valid; 801 802 if (Ty->isObjCObjectType()) 803 return VAK_Invalid; 804 805 if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) 806 return VAK_MSVCUndefined; 807 808 // FIXME: In C++11, these cases are conditionally-supported, meaning we're 809 // permitted to reject them. We should consider doing so. 810 return VAK_Undefined; 811 } 812 813 void Sema::checkVariadicArgument(const Expr *E, VariadicCallType CT) { 814 // Don't allow one to pass an Objective-C interface to a vararg. 815 const QualType &Ty = E->getType(); 816 VarArgKind VAK = isValidVarArgType(Ty); 817 818 // Complain about passing non-POD types through varargs. 819 switch (VAK) { 820 case VAK_ValidInCXX11: 821 DiagRuntimeBehavior( 822 E->getLocStart(), nullptr, 823 PDiag(diag::warn_cxx98_compat_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg) 824 << Ty << CT); 825 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 826 case VAK_Valid: 827 if (Ty->isRecordType()) { 828 // This is unlikely to be what the user intended. If the class has a 829 // 'c_str' member function, the user probably meant to call that. 830 DiagRuntimeBehavior(E->getLocStart(), nullptr, 831 PDiag(diag::warn_pass_class_arg_to_vararg) 832 << Ty << CT << hasCStrMethod(E) << ".c_str()"); 833 } 834 break; 835 836 case VAK_Undefined: 837 case VAK_MSVCUndefined: 838 DiagRuntimeBehavior( 839 E->getLocStart(), nullptr, 840 PDiag(diag::warn_cannot_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg) 841 << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 << Ty << CT); 842 break; 843 844 case VAK_Invalid: 845 if (Ty.isDestructedType() == QualType::DK_nontrivial_c_struct) 846 Diag(E->getLocStart(), 847 diag::err_cannot_pass_non_trivial_c_struct_to_vararg) << Ty << CT; 848 else if (Ty->isObjCObjectType()) 849 DiagRuntimeBehavior( 850 E->getLocStart(), nullptr, 851 PDiag(diag::err_cannot_pass_objc_interface_to_vararg) 852 << Ty << CT); 853 else 854 Diag(E->getLocStart(), diag::err_cannot_pass_to_vararg) 855 << isa<InitListExpr>(E) << Ty << CT; 856 break; 857 } 858 } 859 860 /// DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion - Like DefaultArgumentPromotion, but 861 /// will create a trap if the resulting type is not a POD type. 862 ExprResult Sema::DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Expr *E, VariadicCallType CT, 863 FunctionDecl *FDecl) { 864 if (const BuiltinType *PlaceholderTy = E->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) { 865 // Strip the unbridged-cast placeholder expression off, if applicable. 866 if (PlaceholderTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast && 867 (CT == VariadicMethod || 868 (FDecl && FDecl->hasAttr<CFAuditedTransferAttr>()))) { 869 E = stripARCUnbridgedCast(E); 870 871 // Otherwise, do normal placeholder checking. 872 } else { 873 ExprResult ExprRes = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E); 874 if (ExprRes.isInvalid()) 875 return ExprError(); 876 E = ExprRes.get(); 877 } 878 } 879 880 ExprResult ExprRes = DefaultArgumentPromotion(E); 881 if (ExprRes.isInvalid()) 882 return ExprError(); 883 E = ExprRes.get(); 884 885 // Diagnostics regarding non-POD argument types are 886 // emitted along with format string checking in Sema::CheckFunctionCall(). 887 if (isValidVarArgType(E->getType()) == VAK_Undefined) { 888 // Turn this into a trap. 889 CXXScopeSpec SS; 890 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc; 891 UnqualifiedId Name; 892 Name.setIdentifier(PP.getIdentifierInfo("__builtin_trap"), 893 E->getLocStart()); 894 ExprResult TrapFn = ActOnIdExpression(TUScope, SS, TemplateKWLoc, 895 Name, true, false); 896 if (TrapFn.isInvalid()) 897 return ExprError(); 898 899 ExprResult Call = ActOnCallExpr(TUScope, TrapFn.get(), 900 E->getLocStart(), None, 901 E->getLocEnd()); 902 if (Call.isInvalid()) 903 return ExprError(); 904 905 ExprResult Comma = ActOnBinOp(TUScope, E->getLocStart(), tok::comma, 906 Call.get(), E); 907 if (Comma.isInvalid()) 908 return ExprError(); 909 return Comma.get(); 910 } 911 912 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 913 RequireCompleteType(E->getExprLoc(), E->getType(), 914 diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)) 915 return ExprError(); 916 917 return E; 918 } 919 920 /// Converts an integer to complex float type. Helper function of 921 /// UsualArithmeticConversions() 922 /// 923 /// \return false if the integer expression is an integer type and is 924 /// successfully converted to the complex type. 925 static bool handleIntegerToComplexFloatConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &IntExpr, 926 ExprResult &ComplexExpr, 927 QualType IntTy, 928 QualType ComplexTy, 929 bool SkipCast) { 930 if (IntTy->isComplexType() || IntTy->isRealFloatingType()) return true; 931 if (SkipCast) return false; 932 if (IntTy->isIntegerType()) { 933 QualType fpTy = cast<ComplexType>(ComplexTy)->getElementType(); 934 IntExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(IntExpr.get(), fpTy, CK_IntegralToFloating); 935 IntExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(IntExpr.get(), ComplexTy, 936 CK_FloatingRealToComplex); 937 } else { 938 assert(IntTy->isComplexIntegerType()); 939 IntExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(IntExpr.get(), ComplexTy, 940 CK_IntegralComplexToFloatingComplex); 941 } 942 return false; 943 } 944 945 /// Handle arithmetic conversion with complex types. Helper function of 946 /// UsualArithmeticConversions() 947 static QualType handleComplexFloatConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, 948 ExprResult &RHS, QualType LHSType, 949 QualType RHSType, 950 bool IsCompAssign) { 951 // if we have an integer operand, the result is the complex type. 952 if (!handleIntegerToComplexFloatConversion(S, RHS, LHS, RHSType, LHSType, 953 /*skipCast*/false)) 954 return LHSType; 955 if (!handleIntegerToComplexFloatConversion(S, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType, 956 /*skipCast*/IsCompAssign)) 957 return RHSType; 958 959 // This handles complex/complex, complex/float, or float/complex. 960 // When both operands are complex, the shorter operand is converted to the 961 // type of the longer, and that is the type of the result. This corresponds 962 // to what is done when combining two real floating-point operands. 963 // The fun begins when size promotion occur across type domains. 964 // From H&S 6.3.4: When one operand is complex and the other is a real 965 // floating-point type, the less precise type is converted, within it's 966 // real or complex domain, to the precision of the other type. For example, 967 // when combining a "long double" with a "double _Complex", the 968 // "double _Complex" is promoted to "long double _Complex". 969 970 // Compute the rank of the two types, regardless of whether they are complex. 971 int Order = S.Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(LHSType, RHSType); 972 973 auto *LHSComplexType = dyn_cast<ComplexType>(LHSType); 974 auto *RHSComplexType = dyn_cast<ComplexType>(RHSType); 975 QualType LHSElementType = 976 LHSComplexType ? LHSComplexType->getElementType() : LHSType; 977 QualType RHSElementType = 978 RHSComplexType ? RHSComplexType->getElementType() : RHSType; 979 980 QualType ResultType = S.Context.getComplexType(LHSElementType); 981 if (Order < 0) { 982 // Promote the precision of the LHS if not an assignment. 983 ResultType = S.Context.getComplexType(RHSElementType); 984 if (!IsCompAssign) { 985 if (LHSComplexType) 986 LHS = 987 S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), ResultType, CK_FloatingComplexCast); 988 else 989 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSElementType, CK_FloatingCast); 990 } 991 } else if (Order > 0) { 992 // Promote the precision of the RHS. 993 if (RHSComplexType) 994 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), ResultType, CK_FloatingComplexCast); 995 else 996 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSElementType, CK_FloatingCast); 997 } 998 return ResultType; 999 } 1000 1001 /// Handle arithmetic conversion from integer to float. Helper function 1002 /// of UsualArithmeticConversions() 1003 static QualType handleIntToFloatConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &FloatExpr, 1004 ExprResult &IntExpr, 1005 QualType FloatTy, QualType IntTy, 1006 bool ConvertFloat, bool ConvertInt) { 1007 if (IntTy->isIntegerType()) { 1008 if (ConvertInt) 1009 // Convert intExpr to the lhs floating point type. 1010 IntExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(IntExpr.get(), FloatTy, 1011 CK_IntegralToFloating); 1012 return FloatTy; 1013 } 1014 1015 // Convert both sides to the appropriate complex float. 1016 assert(IntTy->isComplexIntegerType()); 1017 QualType result = S.Context.getComplexType(FloatTy); 1018 1019 // _Complex int -> _Complex float 1020 if (ConvertInt) 1021 IntExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(IntExpr.get(), result, 1022 CK_IntegralComplexToFloatingComplex); 1023 1024 // float -> _Complex float 1025 if (ConvertFloat) 1026 FloatExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(FloatExpr.get(), result, 1027 CK_FloatingRealToComplex); 1028 1029 return result; 1030 } 1031 1032 /// Handle arithmethic conversion with floating point types. Helper 1033 /// function of UsualArithmeticConversions() 1034 static QualType handleFloatConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, 1035 ExprResult &RHS, QualType LHSType, 1036 QualType RHSType, bool IsCompAssign) { 1037 bool LHSFloat = LHSType->isRealFloatingType(); 1038 bool RHSFloat = RHSType->isRealFloatingType(); 1039 1040 // If we have two real floating types, convert the smaller operand 1041 // to the bigger result. 1042 if (LHSFloat && RHSFloat) { 1043 int order = S.Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(LHSType, RHSType); 1044 if (order > 0) { 1045 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_FloatingCast); 1046 return LHSType; 1047 } 1048 1049 assert(order < 0 && "illegal float comparison"); 1050 if (!IsCompAssign) 1051 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_FloatingCast); 1052 return RHSType; 1053 } 1054 1055 if (LHSFloat) { 1056 // Half FP has to be promoted to float unless it is natively supported 1057 if (LHSType->isHalfType() && !S.getLangOpts().NativeHalfType) 1058 LHSType = S.Context.FloatTy; 1059 1060 return handleIntToFloatConversion(S, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType, 1061 /*convertFloat=*/!IsCompAssign, 1062 /*convertInt=*/ true); 1063 } 1064 assert(RHSFloat); 1065 return handleIntToFloatConversion(S, RHS, LHS, RHSType, LHSType, 1066 /*convertInt=*/ true, 1067 /*convertFloat=*/!IsCompAssign); 1068 } 1069 1070 /// Diagnose attempts to convert between __float128 and long double if 1071 /// there is no support for such conversion. Helper function of 1072 /// UsualArithmeticConversions(). 1073 static bool unsupportedTypeConversion(const Sema &S, QualType LHSType, 1074 QualType RHSType) { 1075 /* No issue converting if at least one of the types is not a floating point 1076 type or the two types have the same rank. 1077 */ 1078 if (!LHSType->isFloatingType() || !RHSType->isFloatingType() || 1079 S.Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(LHSType, RHSType) == 0) 1080 return false; 1081 1082 assert(LHSType->isFloatingType() && RHSType->isFloatingType() && 1083 "The remaining types must be floating point types."); 1084 1085 auto *LHSComplex = LHSType->getAs<ComplexType>(); 1086 auto *RHSComplex = RHSType->getAs<ComplexType>(); 1087 1088 QualType LHSElemType = LHSComplex ? 1089 LHSComplex->getElementType() : LHSType; 1090 QualType RHSElemType = RHSComplex ? 1091 RHSComplex->getElementType() : RHSType; 1092 1093 // No issue if the two types have the same representation 1094 if (&S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(LHSElemType) == 1095 &S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(RHSElemType)) 1096 return false; 1097 1098 bool Float128AndLongDouble = (LHSElemType == S.Context.Float128Ty && 1099 RHSElemType == S.Context.LongDoubleTy); 1100 Float128AndLongDouble |= (LHSElemType == S.Context.LongDoubleTy && 1101 RHSElemType == S.Context.Float128Ty); 1102 1103 // We've handled the situation where __float128 and long double have the same 1104 // representation. We allow all conversions for all possible long double types 1105 // except PPC's double double. 1106 return Float128AndLongDouble && 1107 (&S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(S.Context.LongDoubleTy) == 1108 &llvm::APFloat::PPCDoubleDouble()); 1109 } 1110 1111 typedef ExprResult PerformCastFn(Sema &S, Expr *operand, QualType toType); 1112 1113 namespace { 1114 /// These helper callbacks are placed in an anonymous namespace to 1115 /// permit their use as function template parameters. 1116 ExprResult doIntegralCast(Sema &S, Expr *op, QualType toType) { 1117 return S.ImpCastExprToType(op, toType, CK_IntegralCast); 1118 } 1119 1120 ExprResult doComplexIntegralCast(Sema &S, Expr *op, QualType toType) { 1121 return S.ImpCastExprToType(op, S.Context.getComplexType(toType), 1122 CK_IntegralComplexCast); 1123 } 1124 } 1125 1126 /// Handle integer arithmetic conversions. Helper function of 1127 /// UsualArithmeticConversions() 1128 template <PerformCastFn doLHSCast, PerformCastFn doRHSCast> 1129 static QualType handleIntegerConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, 1130 ExprResult &RHS, QualType LHSType, 1131 QualType RHSType, bool IsCompAssign) { 1132 // The rules for this case are in C99 6.3.1.8 1133 int order = S.Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(LHSType, RHSType); 1134 bool LHSSigned = LHSType->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation(); 1135 bool RHSSigned = RHSType->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation(); 1136 if (LHSSigned == RHSSigned) { 1137 // Same signedness; use the higher-ranked type 1138 if (order >= 0) { 1139 RHS = (*doRHSCast)(S, RHS.get(), LHSType); 1140 return LHSType; 1141 } else if (!IsCompAssign) 1142 LHS = (*doLHSCast)(S, LHS.get(), RHSType); 1143 return RHSType; 1144 } else if (order != (LHSSigned ? 1 : -1)) { 1145 // The unsigned type has greater than or equal rank to the 1146 // signed type, so use the unsigned type 1147 if (RHSSigned) { 1148 RHS = (*doRHSCast)(S, RHS.get(), LHSType); 1149 return LHSType; 1150 } else if (!IsCompAssign) 1151 LHS = (*doLHSCast)(S, LHS.get(), RHSType); 1152 return RHSType; 1153 } else if (S.Context.getIntWidth(LHSType) != S.Context.getIntWidth(RHSType)) { 1154 // The two types are different widths; if we are here, that 1155 // means the signed type is larger than the unsigned type, so 1156 // use the signed type. 1157 if (LHSSigned) { 1158 RHS = (*doRHSCast)(S, RHS.get(), LHSType); 1159 return LHSType; 1160 } else if (!IsCompAssign) 1161 LHS = (*doLHSCast)(S, LHS.get(), RHSType); 1162 return RHSType; 1163 } else { 1164 // The signed type is higher-ranked than the unsigned type, 1165 // but isn't actually any bigger (like unsigned int and long 1166 // on most 32-bit systems). Use the unsigned type corresponding 1167 // to the signed type. 1168 QualType result = 1169 S.Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(LHSSigned ? LHSType : RHSType); 1170 RHS = (*doRHSCast)(S, RHS.get(), result); 1171 if (!IsCompAssign) 1172 LHS = (*doLHSCast)(S, LHS.get(), result); 1173 return result; 1174 } 1175 } 1176 1177 /// Handle conversions with GCC complex int extension. Helper function 1178 /// of UsualArithmeticConversions() 1179 static QualType handleComplexIntConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, 1180 ExprResult &RHS, QualType LHSType, 1181 QualType RHSType, 1182 bool IsCompAssign) { 1183 const ComplexType *LHSComplexInt = LHSType->getAsComplexIntegerType(); 1184 const ComplexType *RHSComplexInt = RHSType->getAsComplexIntegerType(); 1185 1186 if (LHSComplexInt && RHSComplexInt) { 1187 QualType LHSEltType = LHSComplexInt->getElementType(); 1188 QualType RHSEltType = RHSComplexInt->getElementType(); 1189 QualType ScalarType = 1190 handleIntegerConversion<doComplexIntegralCast, doComplexIntegralCast> 1191 (S, LHS, RHS, LHSEltType, RHSEltType, IsCompAssign); 1192 1193 return S.Context.getComplexType(ScalarType); 1194 } 1195 1196 if (LHSComplexInt) { 1197 QualType LHSEltType = LHSComplexInt->getElementType(); 1198 QualType ScalarType = 1199 handleIntegerConversion<doComplexIntegralCast, doIntegralCast> 1200 (S, LHS, RHS, LHSEltType, RHSType, IsCompAssign); 1201 QualType ComplexType = S.Context.getComplexType(ScalarType); 1202 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), ComplexType, 1203 CK_IntegralRealToComplex); 1204 1205 return ComplexType; 1206 } 1207 1208 assert(RHSComplexInt); 1209 1210 QualType RHSEltType = RHSComplexInt->getElementType(); 1211 QualType ScalarType = 1212 handleIntegerConversion<doIntegralCast, doComplexIntegralCast> 1213 (S, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSEltType, IsCompAssign); 1214 QualType ComplexType = S.Context.getComplexType(ScalarType); 1215 1216 if (!IsCompAssign) 1217 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), ComplexType, 1218 CK_IntegralRealToComplex); 1219 return ComplexType; 1220 } 1221 1222 /// UsualArithmeticConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to 1223 /// binary operators (C99 6.3.1.8). If both operands aren't arithmetic, this 1224 /// routine returns the first non-arithmetic type found. The client is 1225 /// responsible for emitting appropriate error diagnostics. 1226 QualType Sema::UsualArithmeticConversions(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 1227 bool IsCompAssign) { 1228 if (!IsCompAssign) { 1229 LHS = UsualUnaryConversions(LHS.get()); 1230 if (LHS.isInvalid()) 1231 return QualType(); 1232 } 1233 1234 RHS = UsualUnaryConversions(RHS.get()); 1235 if (RHS.isInvalid()) 1236 return QualType(); 1237 1238 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers. 1239 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent. 1240 QualType LHSType = 1241 Context.getCanonicalType(LHS.get()->getType()).getUnqualifiedType(); 1242 QualType RHSType = 1243 Context.getCanonicalType(RHS.get()->getType()).getUnqualifiedType(); 1244 1245 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any atomic qualifier on the LHS. 1246 if (const AtomicType *AtomicLHS = LHSType->getAs<AtomicType>()) 1247 LHSType = AtomicLHS->getValueType(); 1248 1249 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed. 1250 if (LHSType == RHSType) 1251 return LHSType; 1252 1253 // If either side is a non-arithmetic type (e.g. a pointer), we are done. 1254 // The caller can deal with this (e.g. pointer + int). 1255 if (!LHSType->isArithmeticType() || !RHSType->isArithmeticType()) 1256 return QualType(); 1257 1258 // Apply unary and bitfield promotions to the LHS's type. 1259 QualType LHSUnpromotedType = LHSType; 1260 if (LHSType->isPromotableIntegerType()) 1261 LHSType = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSType); 1262 QualType LHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(LHS.get()); 1263 if (!LHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull()) 1264 LHSType = LHSBitfieldPromoteTy; 1265 if (LHSType != LHSUnpromotedType && !IsCompAssign) 1266 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), LHSType, CK_IntegralCast); 1267 1268 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed. 1269 if (LHSType == RHSType) 1270 return LHSType; 1271 1272 // At this point, we have two different arithmetic types. 1273 1274 // Diagnose attempts to convert between __float128 and long double where 1275 // such conversions currently can't be handled. 1276 if (unsupportedTypeConversion(*this, LHSType, RHSType)) 1277 return QualType(); 1278 1279 // Handle complex types first (C99 6.3.1.8p1). 1280 if (LHSType->isComplexType() || RHSType->isComplexType()) 1281 return handleComplexFloatConversion(*this, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType, 1282 IsCompAssign); 1283 1284 // Now handle "real" floating types (i.e. float, double, long double). 1285 if (LHSType->isRealFloatingType() || RHSType->isRealFloatingType()) 1286 return handleFloatConversion(*this, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType, 1287 IsCompAssign); 1288 1289 // Handle GCC complex int extension. 1290 if (LHSType->isComplexIntegerType() || RHSType->isComplexIntegerType()) 1291 return handleComplexIntConversion(*this, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType, 1292 IsCompAssign); 1293 1294 // Finally, we have two differing integer types. 1295 return handleIntegerConversion<doIntegralCast, doIntegralCast> 1296 (*this, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType, IsCompAssign); 1297 } 1298 1299 1300 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 1301 // Semantic Analysis for various Expression Types 1302 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 1303 1304 1305 ExprResult 1306 Sema::ActOnGenericSelectionExpr(SourceLocation KeyLoc, 1307 SourceLocation DefaultLoc, 1308 SourceLocation RParenLoc, 1309 Expr *ControllingExpr, 1310 ArrayRef<ParsedType> ArgTypes, 1311 ArrayRef<Expr *> ArgExprs) { 1312 unsigned NumAssocs = ArgTypes.size(); 1313 assert(NumAssocs == ArgExprs.size()); 1314 1315 TypeSourceInfo **Types = new TypeSourceInfo*[NumAssocs]; 1316 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumAssocs; ++i) { 1317 if (ArgTypes[i]) 1318 (void) GetTypeFromParser(ArgTypes[i], &Types[i]); 1319 else 1320 Types[i] = nullptr; 1321 } 1322 1323 ExprResult ER = CreateGenericSelectionExpr(KeyLoc, DefaultLoc, RParenLoc, 1324 ControllingExpr, 1325 llvm::makeArrayRef(Types, NumAssocs), 1326 ArgExprs); 1327 delete [] Types; 1328 return ER; 1329 } 1330 1331 ExprResult 1332 Sema::CreateGenericSelectionExpr(SourceLocation KeyLoc, 1333 SourceLocation DefaultLoc, 1334 SourceLocation RParenLoc, 1335 Expr *ControllingExpr, 1336 ArrayRef<TypeSourceInfo *> Types, 1337 ArrayRef<Expr *> Exprs) { 1338 unsigned NumAssocs = Types.size(); 1339 assert(NumAssocs == Exprs.size()); 1340 1341 // Decay and strip qualifiers for the controlling expression type, and handle 1342 // placeholder type replacement. See committee discussion from WG14 DR423. 1343 { 1344 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated( 1345 *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated); 1346 ExprResult R = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(ControllingExpr); 1347 if (R.isInvalid()) 1348 return ExprError(); 1349 ControllingExpr = R.get(); 1350 } 1351 1352 // The controlling expression is an unevaluated operand, so side effects are 1353 // likely unintended. 1354 if (!inTemplateInstantiation() && 1355 ControllingExpr->HasSideEffects(Context, false)) 1356 Diag(ControllingExpr->getExprLoc(), 1357 diag::warn_side_effects_unevaluated_context); 1358 1359 bool TypeErrorFound = false, 1360 IsResultDependent = ControllingExpr->isTypeDependent(), 1361 ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack 1362 = ControllingExpr->containsUnexpandedParameterPack(); 1363 1364 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumAssocs; ++i) { 1365 if (Exprs[i]->containsUnexpandedParameterPack()) 1366 ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack = true; 1367 1368 if (Types[i]) { 1369 if (Types[i]->getType()->containsUnexpandedParameterPack()) 1370 ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack = true; 1371 1372 if (Types[i]->getType()->isDependentType()) { 1373 IsResultDependent = true; 1374 } else { 1375 // C11 6.5.1.1p2 "The type name in a generic association shall specify a 1376 // complete object type other than a variably modified type." 1377 unsigned D = 0; 1378 if (Types[i]->getType()->isIncompleteType()) 1379 D = diag::err_assoc_type_incomplete; 1380 else if (!Types[i]->getType()->isObjectType()) 1381 D = diag::err_assoc_type_nonobject; 1382 else if (Types[i]->getType()->isVariablyModifiedType()) 1383 D = diag::err_assoc_type_variably_modified; 1384 1385 if (D != 0) { 1386 Diag(Types[i]->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), D) 1387 << Types[i]->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange() 1388 << Types[i]->getType(); 1389 TypeErrorFound = true; 1390 } 1391 1392 // C11 6.5.1.1p2 "No two generic associations in the same generic 1393 // selection shall specify compatible types." 1394 for (unsigned j = i+1; j < NumAssocs; ++j) 1395 if (Types[j] && !Types[j]->getType()->isDependentType() && 1396 Context.typesAreCompatible(Types[i]->getType(), 1397 Types[j]->getType())) { 1398 Diag(Types[j]->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), 1399 diag::err_assoc_compatible_types) 1400 << Types[j]->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange() 1401 << Types[j]->getType() 1402 << Types[i]->getType(); 1403 Diag(Types[i]->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), 1404 diag::note_compat_assoc) 1405 << Types[i]->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange() 1406 << Types[i]->getType(); 1407 TypeErrorFound = true; 1408 } 1409 } 1410 } 1411 } 1412 if (TypeErrorFound) 1413 return ExprError(); 1414 1415 // If we determined that the generic selection is result-dependent, don't 1416 // try to compute the result expression. 1417 if (IsResultDependent) 1418 return new (Context) GenericSelectionExpr( 1419 Context, KeyLoc, ControllingExpr, Types, Exprs, DefaultLoc, RParenLoc, 1420 ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack); 1421 1422 SmallVector<unsigned, 1> CompatIndices; 1423 unsigned DefaultIndex = -1U; 1424 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumAssocs; ++i) { 1425 if (!Types[i]) 1426 DefaultIndex = i; 1427 else if (Context.typesAreCompatible(ControllingExpr->getType(), 1428 Types[i]->getType())) 1429 CompatIndices.push_back(i); 1430 } 1431 1432 // C11 6.5.1.1p2 "The controlling expression of a generic selection shall have 1433 // type compatible with at most one of the types named in its generic 1434 // association list." 1435 if (CompatIndices.size() > 1) { 1436 // We strip parens here because the controlling expression is typically 1437 // parenthesized in macro definitions. 1438 ControllingExpr = ControllingExpr->IgnoreParens(); 1439 Diag(ControllingExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_generic_sel_multi_match) 1440 << ControllingExpr->getSourceRange() << ControllingExpr->getType() 1441 << (unsigned) CompatIndices.size(); 1442 for (unsigned I : CompatIndices) { 1443 Diag(Types[I]->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), 1444 diag::note_compat_assoc) 1445 << Types[I]->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange() 1446 << Types[I]->getType(); 1447 } 1448 return ExprError(); 1449 } 1450 1451 // C11 6.5.1.1p2 "If a generic selection has no default generic association, 1452 // its controlling expression shall have type compatible with exactly one of 1453 // the types named in its generic association list." 1454 if (DefaultIndex == -1U && CompatIndices.size() == 0) { 1455 // We strip parens here because the controlling expression is typically 1456 // parenthesized in macro definitions. 1457 ControllingExpr = ControllingExpr->IgnoreParens(); 1458 Diag(ControllingExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_generic_sel_no_match) 1459 << ControllingExpr->getSourceRange() << ControllingExpr->getType(); 1460 return ExprError(); 1461 } 1462 1463 // C11 6.5.1.1p3 "If a generic selection has a generic association with a 1464 // type name that is compatible with the type of the controlling expression, 1465 // then the result expression of the generic selection is the expression 1466 // in that generic association. Otherwise, the result expression of the 1467 // generic selection is the expression in the default generic association." 1468 unsigned ResultIndex = 1469 CompatIndices.size() ? CompatIndices[0] : DefaultIndex; 1470 1471 return new (Context) GenericSelectionExpr( 1472 Context, KeyLoc, ControllingExpr, Types, Exprs, DefaultLoc, RParenLoc, 1473 ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack, ResultIndex); 1474 } 1475 1476 /// getUDSuffixLoc - Create a SourceLocation for a ud-suffix, given the 1477 /// location of the token and the offset of the ud-suffix within it. 1478 static SourceLocation getUDSuffixLoc(Sema &S, SourceLocation TokLoc, 1479 unsigned Offset) { 1480 return Lexer::AdvanceToTokenCharacter(TokLoc, Offset, S.getSourceManager(), 1481 S.getLangOpts()); 1482 } 1483 1484 /// BuildCookedLiteralOperatorCall - A user-defined literal was found. Look up 1485 /// the corresponding cooked (non-raw) literal operator, and build a call to it. 1486 static ExprResult BuildCookedLiteralOperatorCall(Sema &S, Scope *Scope, 1487 IdentifierInfo *UDSuffix, 1488 SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc, 1489 ArrayRef<Expr*> Args, 1490 SourceLocation LitEndLoc) { 1491 assert(Args.size() <= 2 && "too many arguments for literal operator"); 1492 1493 QualType ArgTy[2]; 1494 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx != Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) { 1495 ArgTy[ArgIdx] = Args[ArgIdx]->getType(); 1496 if (ArgTy[ArgIdx]->isArrayType()) 1497 ArgTy[ArgIdx] = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(ArgTy[ArgIdx]); 1498 } 1499 1500 DeclarationName OpName = 1501 S.Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXLiteralOperatorName(UDSuffix); 1502 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, UDSuffixLoc); 1503 OpNameInfo.setCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc(UDSuffixLoc); 1504 1505 LookupResult R(S, OpName, UDSuffixLoc, Sema::LookupOrdinaryName); 1506 if (S.LookupLiteralOperator(Scope, R, llvm::makeArrayRef(ArgTy, Args.size()), 1507 /*AllowRaw*/ false, /*AllowTemplate*/ false, 1508 /*AllowStringTemplate*/ false, 1509 /*DiagnoseMissing*/ true) == Sema::LOLR_Error) 1510 return ExprError(); 1511 1512 return S.BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, Args, LitEndLoc); 1513 } 1514 1515 /// ActOnStringLiteral - The specified tokens were lexed as pasted string 1516 /// fragments (e.g. "foo" "bar" L"baz"). The result string has to handle string 1517 /// concatenation ([C99 5.1.1.2, translation phase #6]), so it may come from 1518 /// multiple tokens. However, the common case is that StringToks points to one 1519 /// string. 1520 /// 1521 ExprResult 1522 Sema::ActOnStringLiteral(ArrayRef<Token> StringToks, Scope *UDLScope) { 1523 assert(!StringToks.empty() && "Must have at least one string!"); 1524 1525 StringLiteralParser Literal(StringToks, PP); 1526 if (Literal.hadError) 1527 return ExprError(); 1528 1529 SmallVector<SourceLocation, 4> StringTokLocs; 1530 for (const Token &Tok : StringToks) 1531 StringTokLocs.push_back(Tok.getLocation()); 1532 1533 QualType CharTy = Context.CharTy; 1534 StringLiteral::StringKind Kind = StringLiteral::Ascii; 1535 if (Literal.isWide()) { 1536 CharTy = Context.getWideCharType(); 1537 Kind = StringLiteral::Wide; 1538 } else if (Literal.isUTF8()) { 1539 if (getLangOpts().Char8) 1540 CharTy = Context.Char8Ty; 1541 Kind = StringLiteral::UTF8; 1542 } else if (Literal.isUTF16()) { 1543 CharTy = Context.Char16Ty; 1544 Kind = StringLiteral::UTF16; 1545 } else if (Literal.isUTF32()) { 1546 CharTy = Context.Char32Ty; 1547 Kind = StringLiteral::UTF32; 1548 } else if (Literal.isPascal()) { 1549 CharTy = Context.UnsignedCharTy; 1550 } 1551 1552 QualType CharTyConst = CharTy; 1553 // A C++ string literal has a const-qualified element type (C++ 2.13.4p1). 1554 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || getLangOpts().ConstStrings) 1555 CharTyConst.addConst(); 1556 1557 CharTyConst = Context.adjustStringLiteralBaseType(CharTyConst); 1558 1559 // Get an array type for the string, according to C99 6.4.5. This includes 1560 // the nul terminator character as well as the string length for pascal 1561 // strings. 1562 QualType StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType( 1563 CharTyConst, llvm::APInt(32, Literal.GetNumStringChars() + 1), 1564 ArrayType::Normal, 0); 1565 1566 // Pass &StringTokLocs[0], StringTokLocs.size() to factory! 1567 StringLiteral *Lit = StringLiteral::Create(Context, Literal.GetString(), 1568 Kind, Literal.Pascal, StrTy, 1569 &StringTokLocs[0], 1570 StringTokLocs.size()); 1571 if (Literal.getUDSuffix().empty()) 1572 return Lit; 1573 1574 // We're building a user-defined literal. 1575 IdentifierInfo *UDSuffix = &Context.Idents.get(Literal.getUDSuffix()); 1576 SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc = 1577 getUDSuffixLoc(*this, StringTokLocs[Literal.getUDSuffixToken()], 1578 Literal.getUDSuffixOffset()); 1579 1580 // Make sure we're allowed user-defined literals here. 1581 if (!UDLScope) 1582 return ExprError(Diag(UDSuffixLoc, diag::err_invalid_string_udl)); 1583 1584 // C++11 [lex.ext]p5: The literal L is treated as a call of the form 1585 // operator "" X (str, len) 1586 QualType SizeType = Context.getSizeType(); 1587 1588 DeclarationName OpName = 1589 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXLiteralOperatorName(UDSuffix); 1590 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, UDSuffixLoc); 1591 OpNameInfo.setCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc(UDSuffixLoc); 1592 1593 QualType ArgTy[] = { 1594 Context.getArrayDecayedType(StrTy), SizeType 1595 }; 1596 1597 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, UDSuffixLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 1598 switch (LookupLiteralOperator(UDLScope, R, ArgTy, 1599 /*AllowRaw*/ false, /*AllowTemplate*/ false, 1600 /*AllowStringTemplate*/ true, 1601 /*DiagnoseMissing*/ true)) { 1602 1603 case LOLR_Cooked: { 1604 llvm::APInt Len(Context.getIntWidth(SizeType), Literal.GetNumStringChars()); 1605 IntegerLiteral *LenArg = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Len, SizeType, 1606 StringTokLocs[0]); 1607 Expr *Args[] = { Lit, LenArg }; 1608 1609 return BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, Args, StringTokLocs.back()); 1610 } 1611 1612 case LOLR_StringTemplate: { 1613 TemplateArgumentListInfo ExplicitArgs; 1614 1615 unsigned CharBits = Context.getIntWidth(CharTy); 1616 bool CharIsUnsigned = CharTy->isUnsignedIntegerType(); 1617 llvm::APSInt Value(CharBits, CharIsUnsigned); 1618 1619 TemplateArgument TypeArg(CharTy); 1620 TemplateArgumentLocInfo TypeArgInfo(Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(CharTy)); 1621 ExplicitArgs.addArgument(TemplateArgumentLoc(TypeArg, TypeArgInfo)); 1622 1623 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Lit->getLength(); I != N; ++I) { 1624 Value = Lit->getCodeUnit(I); 1625 TemplateArgument Arg(Context, Value, CharTy); 1626 TemplateArgumentLocInfo ArgInfo; 1627 ExplicitArgs.addArgument(TemplateArgumentLoc(Arg, ArgInfo)); 1628 } 1629 return BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, None, StringTokLocs.back(), 1630 &ExplicitArgs); 1631 } 1632 case LOLR_Raw: 1633 case LOLR_Template: 1634 case LOLR_ErrorNoDiagnostic: 1635 llvm_unreachable("unexpected literal operator lookup result"); 1636 case LOLR_Error: 1637 return ExprError(); 1638 } 1639 llvm_unreachable("unexpected literal operator lookup result"); 1640 } 1641 1642 ExprResult 1643 Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, ExprValueKind VK, 1644 SourceLocation Loc, 1645 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) { 1646 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo(D->getDeclName(), Loc); 1647 return BuildDeclRefExpr(D, Ty, VK, NameInfo, SS); 1648 } 1649 1650 /// BuildDeclRefExpr - Build an expression that references a 1651 /// declaration that does not require a closure capture. 1652 ExprResult 1653 Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, ExprValueKind VK, 1654 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo, 1655 const CXXScopeSpec *SS, NamedDecl *FoundD, 1656 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) { 1657 bool RefersToCapturedVariable = 1658 isa<VarDecl>(D) && 1659 NeedToCaptureVariable(cast<VarDecl>(D), NameInfo.getLoc()); 1660 1661 DeclRefExpr *E; 1662 if (isa<VarTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D)) { 1663 VarTemplateSpecializationDecl *VarSpec = 1664 cast<VarTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D); 1665 1666 E = DeclRefExpr::Create(Context, SS ? SS->getWithLocInContext(Context) 1667 : NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), 1668 VarSpec->getTemplateKeywordLoc(), D, 1669 RefersToCapturedVariable, NameInfo.getLoc(), Ty, VK, 1670 FoundD, TemplateArgs); 1671 } else { 1672 assert(!TemplateArgs && "No template arguments for non-variable" 1673 " template specialization references"); 1674 E = DeclRefExpr::Create(Context, SS ? SS->getWithLocInContext(Context) 1675 : NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), 1676 SourceLocation(), D, RefersToCapturedVariable, 1677 NameInfo, Ty, VK, FoundD); 1678 } 1679 1680 MarkDeclRefReferenced(E); 1681 1682 if (getLangOpts().ObjCWeak && isa<VarDecl>(D) && 1683 Ty.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Weak && !isUnevaluatedContext() && 1684 !Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_arc_repeated_use_of_weak, E->getLocStart())) 1685 getCurFunction()->recordUseOfWeak(E); 1686 1687 FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(D); 1688 if (IndirectFieldDecl *IFD = dyn_cast<IndirectFieldDecl>(D)) 1689 FD = IFD->getAnonField(); 1690 if (FD) { 1691 UnusedPrivateFields.remove(FD); 1692 // Just in case we're building an illegal pointer-to-member. 1693 if (FD->isBitField()) 1694 E->setObjectKind(OK_BitField); 1695 } 1696 1697 // C++ [expr.prim]/8: The expression [...] is a bit-field if the identifier 1698 // designates a bit-field. 1699 if (auto *BD = dyn_cast<BindingDecl>(D)) 1700 if (auto *BE = BD->getBinding()) 1701 E->setObjectKind(BE->getObjectKind()); 1702 1703 return E; 1704 } 1705 1706 /// Decomposes the given name into a DeclarationNameInfo, its location, and 1707 /// possibly a list of template arguments. 1708 /// 1709 /// If this produces template arguments, it is permitted to call 1710 /// DecomposeTemplateName. 1711 /// 1712 /// This actually loses a lot of source location information for 1713 /// non-standard name kinds; we should consider preserving that in 1714 /// some way. 1715 void 1716 Sema::DecomposeUnqualifiedId(const UnqualifiedId &Id, 1717 TemplateArgumentListInfo &Buffer, 1718 DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo, 1719 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *&TemplateArgs) { 1720 if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId) { 1721 Buffer.setLAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->LAngleLoc); 1722 Buffer.setRAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->RAngleLoc); 1723 1724 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(Id.TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(), 1725 Id.TemplateId->NumArgs); 1726 translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, Buffer); 1727 1728 TemplateName TName = Id.TemplateId->Template.get(); 1729 SourceLocation TNameLoc = Id.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc; 1730 NameInfo = Context.getNameForTemplate(TName, TNameLoc); 1731 TemplateArgs = &Buffer; 1732 } else { 1733 NameInfo = GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(Id); 1734 TemplateArgs = nullptr; 1735 } 1736 } 1737 1738 static void emitEmptyLookupTypoDiagnostic( 1739 const TypoCorrection &TC, Sema &SemaRef, const CXXScopeSpec &SS, 1740 DeclarationName Typo, SourceLocation TypoLoc, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 1741 unsigned DiagnosticID, unsigned DiagnosticSuggestID) { 1742 DeclContext *Ctx = 1743 SS.isEmpty() ? nullptr : SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false); 1744 if (!TC) { 1745 // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups. 1746 // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?) 1747 if (Ctx) 1748 SemaRef.Diag(TypoLoc, diag::err_no_member) << Typo << Ctx 1749 << SS.getRange(); 1750 else 1751 SemaRef.Diag(TypoLoc, DiagnosticID) << Typo; 1752 return; 1753 } 1754 1755 std::string CorrectedStr = TC.getAsString(SemaRef.getLangOpts()); 1756 bool DroppedSpecifier = 1757 TC.WillReplaceSpecifier() && Typo.getAsString() == CorrectedStr; 1758 unsigned NoteID = TC.getCorrectionDeclAs<ImplicitParamDecl>() 1759 ? diag::note_implicit_param_decl 1760 : diag::note_previous_decl; 1761 if (!Ctx) 1762 SemaRef.diagnoseTypo(TC, SemaRef.PDiag(DiagnosticSuggestID) << Typo, 1763 SemaRef.PDiag(NoteID)); 1764 else 1765 SemaRef.diagnoseTypo(TC, SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_no_member_suggest) 1766 << Typo << Ctx << DroppedSpecifier 1767 << SS.getRange(), 1768 SemaRef.PDiag(NoteID)); 1769 } 1770 1771 /// Diagnose an empty lookup. 1772 /// 1773 /// \return false if new lookup candidates were found 1774 bool 1775 Sema::DiagnoseEmptyLookup(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R, 1776 std::unique_ptr<CorrectionCandidateCallback> CCC, 1777 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, 1778 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, TypoExpr **Out) { 1779 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName(); 1780 1781 unsigned diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_var_use; 1782 unsigned diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest; 1783 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName || 1784 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXLiteralOperatorName || 1785 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) { 1786 diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_use; 1787 diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_use_suggest; 1788 } 1789 1790 // If the original lookup was an unqualified lookup, fake an 1791 // unqualified lookup. This is useful when (for example) the 1792 // original lookup would not have found something because it was a 1793 // dependent name. 1794 DeclContext *DC = SS.isEmpty() ? CurContext : nullptr; 1795 while (DC) { 1796 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) { 1797 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC); 1798 1799 if (!R.empty()) { 1800 // Don't give errors about ambiguities in this lookup. 1801 R.suppressDiagnostics(); 1802 1803 // During a default argument instantiation the CurContext points 1804 // to a CXXMethodDecl; but we can't apply a this-> fixit inside a 1805 // function parameter list, hence add an explicit check. 1806 bool isDefaultArgument = 1807 !CodeSynthesisContexts.empty() && 1808 CodeSynthesisContexts.back().Kind == 1809 CodeSynthesisContext::DefaultFunctionArgumentInstantiation; 1810 CXXMethodDecl *CurMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext); 1811 bool isInstance = CurMethod && 1812 CurMethod->isInstance() && 1813 DC == CurMethod->getParent() && !isDefaultArgument; 1814 1815 // Give a code modification hint to insert 'this->'. 1816 // TODO: fixit for inserting 'Base<T>::' in the other cases. 1817 // Actually quite difficult! 1818 if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) 1819 diagnostic = diag::ext_found_via_dependent_bases_lookup; 1820 if (isInstance) { 1821 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name 1822 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(R.getNameLoc(), "this->"); 1823 CheckCXXThisCapture(R.getNameLoc()); 1824 } else { 1825 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name; 1826 } 1827 1828 // Do we really want to note all of these? 1829 for (NamedDecl *D : R) 1830 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_dependent_var_use); 1831 1832 // Return true if we are inside a default argument instantiation 1833 // and the found name refers to an instance member function, otherwise 1834 // the function calling DiagnoseEmptyLookup will try to create an 1835 // implicit member call and this is wrong for default argument. 1836 if (isDefaultArgument && ((*R.begin())->isCXXInstanceMember())) { 1837 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_member_call_without_object); 1838 return true; 1839 } 1840 1841 // Tell the callee to try to recover. 1842 return false; 1843 } 1844 1845 R.clear(); 1846 } 1847 1848 // In Microsoft mode, if we are performing lookup from within a friend 1849 // function definition declared at class scope then we must set 1850 // DC to the lexical parent to be able to search into the parent 1851 // class. 1852 if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && isa<FunctionDecl>(DC) && 1853 cast<FunctionDecl>(DC)->getFriendObjectKind() && 1854 DC->getLexicalParent()->isRecord()) 1855 DC = DC->getLexicalParent(); 1856 else 1857 DC = DC->getParent(); 1858 } 1859 1860 // We didn't find anything, so try to correct for a typo. 1861 TypoCorrection Corrected; 1862 if (S && Out) { 1863 SourceLocation TypoLoc = R.getNameLoc(); 1864 assert(!ExplicitTemplateArgs && 1865 "Diagnosing an empty lookup with explicit template args!"); 1866 *Out = CorrectTypoDelayed( 1867 R.getLookupNameInfo(), R.getLookupKind(), S, &SS, std::move(CCC), 1868 [=](const TypoCorrection &TC) { 1869 emitEmptyLookupTypoDiagnostic(TC, *this, SS, Name, TypoLoc, Args, 1870 diagnostic, diagnostic_suggest); 1871 }, 1872 nullptr, CTK_ErrorRecovery); 1873 if (*Out) 1874 return true; 1875 } else if (S && (Corrected = 1876 CorrectTypo(R.getLookupNameInfo(), R.getLookupKind(), S, 1877 &SS, std::move(CCC), CTK_ErrorRecovery))) { 1878 std::string CorrectedStr(Corrected.getAsString(getLangOpts())); 1879 bool DroppedSpecifier = 1880 Corrected.WillReplaceSpecifier() && Name.getAsString() == CorrectedStr; 1881 R.setLookupName(Corrected.getCorrection()); 1882 1883 bool AcceptableWithRecovery = false; 1884 bool AcceptableWithoutRecovery = false; 1885 NamedDecl *ND = Corrected.getFoundDecl(); 1886 if (ND) { 1887 if (Corrected.isOverloaded()) { 1888 OverloadCandidateSet OCS(R.getNameLoc(), 1889 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 1890 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 1891 for (NamedDecl *CD : Corrected) { 1892 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = 1893 dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(CD)) 1894 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate( 1895 FTD, DeclAccessPair::make(FTD, AS_none), ExplicitTemplateArgs, 1896 Args, OCS); 1897 else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CD)) 1898 if (!ExplicitTemplateArgs || ExplicitTemplateArgs->size() == 0) 1899 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, DeclAccessPair::make(FD, AS_none), 1900 Args, OCS); 1901 } 1902 switch (OCS.BestViableFunction(*this, R.getNameLoc(), Best)) { 1903 case OR_Success: 1904 ND = Best->FoundDecl; 1905 Corrected.setCorrectionDecl(ND); 1906 break; 1907 default: 1908 // FIXME: Arbitrarily pick the first declaration for the note. 1909 Corrected.setCorrectionDecl(ND); 1910 break; 1911 } 1912 } 1913 R.addDecl(ND); 1914 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && ND->isCXXClassMember()) { 1915 CXXRecordDecl *Record = nullptr; 1916 if (Corrected.getCorrectionSpecifier()) { 1917 const Type *Ty = Corrected.getCorrectionSpecifier()->getAsType(); 1918 Record = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl(); 1919 } 1920 if (!Record) 1921 Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>( 1922 ND->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()); 1923 R.setNamingClass(Record); 1924 } 1925 1926 auto *UnderlyingND = ND->getUnderlyingDecl(); 1927 AcceptableWithRecovery = isa<ValueDecl>(UnderlyingND) || 1928 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(UnderlyingND); 1929 // FIXME: If we ended up with a typo for a type name or 1930 // Objective-C class name, we're in trouble because the parser 1931 // is in the wrong place to recover. Suggest the typo 1932 // correction, but don't make it a fix-it since we're not going 1933 // to recover well anyway. 1934 AcceptableWithoutRecovery = 1935 isa<TypeDecl>(UnderlyingND) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(UnderlyingND); 1936 } else { 1937 // FIXME: We found a keyword. Suggest it, but don't provide a fix-it 1938 // because we aren't able to recover. 1939 AcceptableWithoutRecovery = true; 1940 } 1941 1942 if (AcceptableWithRecovery || AcceptableWithoutRecovery) { 1943 unsigned NoteID = Corrected.getCorrectionDeclAs<ImplicitParamDecl>() 1944 ? diag::note_implicit_param_decl 1945 : diag::note_previous_decl; 1946 if (SS.isEmpty()) 1947 diagnoseTypo(Corrected, PDiag(diagnostic_suggest) << Name, 1948 PDiag(NoteID), AcceptableWithRecovery); 1949 else 1950 diagnoseTypo(Corrected, PDiag(diag::err_no_member_suggest) 1951 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) 1952 << DroppedSpecifier << SS.getRange(), 1953 PDiag(NoteID), AcceptableWithRecovery); 1954 1955 // Tell the callee whether to try to recover. 1956 return !AcceptableWithRecovery; 1957 } 1958 } 1959 R.clear(); 1960 1961 // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups. 1962 // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?) 1963 if (!SS.isEmpty()) { 1964 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member) 1965 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) 1966 << SS.getRange(); 1967 return true; 1968 } 1969 1970 // Give up, we can't recover. 1971 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name; 1972 return true; 1973 } 1974 1975 /// In Microsoft mode, if we are inside a template class whose parent class has 1976 /// dependent base classes, and we can't resolve an unqualified identifier, then 1977 /// assume the identifier is a member of a dependent base class. We can only 1978 /// recover successfully in static methods, instance methods, and other contexts 1979 /// where 'this' is available. This doesn't precisely match MSVC's 1980 /// instantiation model, but it's close enough. 1981 static Expr * 1982 recoverFromMSUnqualifiedLookup(Sema &S, ASTContext &Context, 1983 DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo, 1984 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc, 1985 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) { 1986 // Only try to recover from lookup into dependent bases in static methods or 1987 // contexts where 'this' is available. 1988 QualType ThisType = S.getCurrentThisType(); 1989 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = nullptr; 1990 if (!ThisType.isNull()) 1991 RD = ThisType->getPointeeType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl(); 1992 else if (auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(S.CurContext)) 1993 RD = MD->getParent(); 1994 if (!RD || !RD->hasAnyDependentBases()) 1995 return nullptr; 1996 1997 // Diagnose this as unqualified lookup into a dependent base class. If 'this' 1998 // is available, suggest inserting 'this->' as a fixit. 1999 SourceLocation Loc = NameInfo.getLoc(); 2000 auto DB = S.Diag(Loc, diag::ext_undeclared_unqual_id_with_dependent_base); 2001 DB << NameInfo.getName() << RD; 2002 2003 if (!ThisType.isNull()) { 2004 DB << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "this->"); 2005 return CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create( 2006 Context, /*This=*/nullptr, ThisType, /*IsArrow=*/true, 2007 /*Op=*/SourceLocation(), NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), TemplateKWLoc, 2008 /*FirstQualifierInScope=*/nullptr, NameInfo, TemplateArgs); 2009 } 2010 2011 // Synthesize a fake NNS that points to the derived class. This will 2012 // perform name lookup during template instantiation. 2013 CXXScopeSpec SS; 2014 auto *NNS = 2015 NestedNameSpecifier::Create(Context, nullptr, true, RD->getTypeForDecl()); 2016 SS.MakeTrivial(Context, NNS, SourceRange(Loc, Loc)); 2017 return DependentScopeDeclRefExpr::Create( 2018 Context, SS.getWithLocInContext(Context), TemplateKWLoc, NameInfo, 2019 TemplateArgs); 2020 } 2021 2022 ExprResult 2023 Sema::ActOnIdExpression(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, 2024 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc, UnqualifiedId &Id, 2025 bool HasTrailingLParen, bool IsAddressOfOperand, 2026 std::unique_ptr<CorrectionCandidateCallback> CCC, 2027 bool IsInlineAsmIdentifier, Token *KeywordReplacement) { 2028 assert(!(IsAddressOfOperand && HasTrailingLParen) && 2029 "cannot be direct & operand and have a trailing lparen"); 2030 if (SS.isInvalid()) 2031 return ExprError(); 2032 2033 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer; 2034 2035 // Decompose the UnqualifiedId into the following data. 2036 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo; 2037 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs; 2038 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(Id, TemplateArgsBuffer, NameInfo, TemplateArgs); 2039 2040 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName(); 2041 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo(); 2042 SourceLocation NameLoc = NameInfo.getLoc(); 2043 2044 if (II && II->isEditorPlaceholder()) { 2045 // FIXME: When typed placeholders are supported we can create a typed 2046 // placeholder expression node. 2047 return ExprError(); 2048 } 2049 2050 // C++ [temp.dep.expr]p3: 2051 // An id-expression is type-dependent if it contains: 2052 // -- an identifier that was declared with a dependent type, 2053 // (note: handled after lookup) 2054 // -- a template-id that is dependent, 2055 // (note: handled in BuildTemplateIdExpr) 2056 // -- a conversion-function-id that specifies a dependent type, 2057 // -- a nested-name-specifier that contains a class-name that 2058 // names a dependent type. 2059 // Determine whether this is a member of an unknown specialization; 2060 // we need to handle these differently. 2061 bool DependentID = false; 2062 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName && 2063 Name.getCXXNameType()->isDependentType()) { 2064 DependentID = true; 2065 } else if (SS.isSet()) { 2066 if (DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false)) { 2067 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC)) 2068 return ExprError(); 2069 } else { 2070 DependentID = true; 2071 } 2072 } 2073 2074 if (DependentID) 2075 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, TemplateKWLoc, NameInfo, 2076 IsAddressOfOperand, TemplateArgs); 2077 2078 // Perform the required lookup. 2079 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, 2080 (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ImplicitSelfParam) 2081 ? LookupObjCImplicitSelfParam 2082 : LookupOrdinaryName); 2083 if (TemplateKWLoc.isValid() || TemplateArgs) { 2084 // Lookup the template name again to correctly establish the context in 2085 // which it was found. This is really unfortunate as we already did the 2086 // lookup to determine that it was a template name in the first place. If 2087 // this becomes a performance hit, we can work harder to preserve those 2088 // results until we get here but it's likely not worth it. 2089 bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization; 2090 if (LookupTemplateName(R, S, SS, QualType(), /*EnteringContext=*/false, 2091 MemberOfUnknownSpecialization, TemplateKWLoc)) 2092 return ExprError(); 2093 2094 if (MemberOfUnknownSpecialization || 2095 (R.getResultKind() == LookupResult::NotFoundInCurrentInstantiation)) 2096 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, TemplateKWLoc, NameInfo, 2097 IsAddressOfOperand, TemplateArgs); 2098 } else { 2099 bool IvarLookupFollowUp = II && !SS.isSet() && getCurMethodDecl(); 2100 LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS, !IvarLookupFollowUp); 2101 2102 // If the result might be in a dependent base class, this is a dependent 2103 // id-expression. 2104 if (R.getResultKind() == LookupResult::NotFoundInCurrentInstantiation) 2105 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, TemplateKWLoc, NameInfo, 2106 IsAddressOfOperand, TemplateArgs); 2107 2108 // If this reference is in an Objective-C method, then we need to do 2109 // some special Objective-C lookup, too. 2110 if (IvarLookupFollowUp) { 2111 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, II, true)); 2112 if (E.isInvalid()) 2113 return ExprError(); 2114 2115 if (Expr *Ex = E.getAs<Expr>()) 2116 return Ex; 2117 } 2118 } 2119 2120 if (R.isAmbiguous()) 2121 return ExprError(); 2122 2123 // This could be an implicitly declared function reference (legal in C90, 2124 // extension in C99, forbidden in C++). 2125 if (R.empty() && HasTrailingLParen && II && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 2126 NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *II, S); 2127 if (D) R.addDecl(D); 2128 } 2129 2130 // Determine whether this name might be a candidate for 2131 // argument-dependent lookup. 2132 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, R, HasTrailingLParen); 2133 2134 if (R.empty() && !ADL) { 2135 if (SS.isEmpty() && getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) { 2136 if (Expr *E = recoverFromMSUnqualifiedLookup(*this, Context, NameInfo, 2137 TemplateKWLoc, TemplateArgs)) 2138 return E; 2139 } 2140 2141 // Don't diagnose an empty lookup for inline assembly. 2142 if (IsInlineAsmIdentifier) 2143 return ExprError(); 2144 2145 // If this name wasn't predeclared and if this is not a function 2146 // call, diagnose the problem. 2147 TypoExpr *TE = nullptr; 2148 auto DefaultValidator = llvm::make_unique<CorrectionCandidateCallback>( 2149 II, SS.isValid() ? SS.getScopeRep() : nullptr); 2150 DefaultValidator->IsAddressOfOperand = IsAddressOfOperand; 2151 assert((!CCC || CCC->IsAddressOfOperand == IsAddressOfOperand) && 2152 "Typo correction callback misconfigured"); 2153 if (CCC) { 2154 // Make sure the callback knows what the typo being diagnosed is. 2155 CCC->setTypoName(II); 2156 if (SS.isValid()) 2157 CCC->setTypoNNS(SS.getScopeRep()); 2158 } 2159 // FIXME: DiagnoseEmptyLookup produces bad diagnostics if we're looking for 2160 // a template name, but we happen to have always already looked up the name 2161 // before we get here if it must be a template name. 2162 if (DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, 2163 CCC ? std::move(CCC) : std::move(DefaultValidator), 2164 nullptr, None, &TE)) { 2165 if (TE && KeywordReplacement) { 2166 auto &State = getTypoExprState(TE); 2167 auto BestTC = State.Consumer->getNextCorrection(); 2168 if (BestTC.isKeyword()) { 2169 auto *II = BestTC.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo(); 2170 if (State.DiagHandler) 2171 State.DiagHandler(BestTC); 2172 KeywordReplacement->startToken(); 2173 KeywordReplacement->setKind(II->getTokenID()); 2174 KeywordReplacement->setIdentifierInfo(II); 2175 KeywordReplacement->setLocation(BestTC.getCorrectionRange().getBegin()); 2176 // Clean up the state associated with the TypoExpr, since it has 2177 // now been diagnosed (without a call to CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr). 2178 clearDelayedTypo(TE); 2179 // Signal that a correction to a keyword was performed by returning a 2180 // valid-but-null ExprResult. 2181 return (Expr*)nullptr; 2182 } 2183 State.Consumer->resetCorrectionStream(); 2184 } 2185 return TE ? TE : ExprError(); 2186 } 2187 2188 assert(!R.empty() && 2189 "DiagnoseEmptyLookup returned false but added no results"); 2190 2191 // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let 2192 // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to 2193 // reference the ivar. 2194 if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = R.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) { 2195 R.clear(); 2196 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, Ivar->getIdentifier())); 2197 // In a hopelessly buggy code, Objective-C instance variable 2198 // lookup fails and no expression will be built to reference it. 2199 if (!E.isInvalid() && !E.get()) 2200 return ExprError(); 2201 return E; 2202 } 2203 } 2204 2205 // This is guaranteed from this point on. 2206 assert(!R.empty() || ADL); 2207 2208 // Check whether this might be a C++ implicit instance member access. 2209 // C++ [class.mfct.non-static]p3: 2210 // When an id-expression that is not part of a class member access 2211 // syntax and not used to form a pointer to member is used in the 2212 // body of a non-static member function of class X, if name lookup 2213 // resolves the name in the id-expression to a non-static non-type 2214 // member of some class C, the id-expression is transformed into a 2215 // class member access expression using (*this) as the 2216 // postfix-expression to the left of the . operator. 2217 // 2218 // But we don't actually need to do this for '&' operands if R 2219 // resolved to a function or overloaded function set, because the 2220 // expression is ill-formed if it actually works out to be a 2221 // non-static member function: 2222 // 2223 // C++ [expr.ref]p4: 2224 // Otherwise, if E1.E2 refers to a non-static member function. . . 2225 // [t]he expression can be used only as the left-hand operand of a 2226 // member function call. 2227 // 2228 // There are other safeguards against such uses, but it's important 2229 // to get this right here so that we don't end up making a 2230 // spuriously dependent expression if we're inside a dependent 2231 // instance method. 2232 if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) { 2233 bool MightBeImplicitMember; 2234 if (!IsAddressOfOperand) 2235 MightBeImplicitMember = true; 2236 else if (!SS.isEmpty()) 2237 MightBeImplicitMember = false; 2238 else if (R.isOverloadedResult()) 2239 MightBeImplicitMember = false; 2240 else if (R.isUnresolvableResult()) 2241 MightBeImplicitMember = true; 2242 else 2243 MightBeImplicitMember = isa<FieldDecl>(R.getFoundDecl()) || 2244 isa<IndirectFieldDecl>(R.getFoundDecl()) || 2245 isa<MSPropertyDecl>(R.getFoundDecl()); 2246 2247 if (MightBeImplicitMember) 2248 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc, 2249 R, TemplateArgs, S); 2250 } 2251 2252 if (TemplateArgs || TemplateKWLoc.isValid()) { 2253 2254 // In C++1y, if this is a variable template id, then check it 2255 // in BuildTemplateIdExpr(). 2256 // The single lookup result must be a variable template declaration. 2257 if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId && Id.TemplateId && 2258 Id.TemplateId->Kind == TNK_Var_template) { 2259 assert(R.getAsSingle<VarTemplateDecl>() && 2260 "There should only be one declaration found."); 2261 } 2262 2263 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc, R, ADL, TemplateArgs); 2264 } 2265 2266 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, ADL); 2267 } 2268 2269 /// BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr - Build a C++ qualified 2270 /// declaration name, generally during template instantiation. 2271 /// There's a large number of things which don't need to be done along 2272 /// this path. 2273 ExprResult Sema::BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr( 2274 CXXScopeSpec &SS, const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo, 2275 bool IsAddressOfOperand, const Scope *S, TypeSourceInfo **RecoveryTSI) { 2276 DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false); 2277 if (!DC) 2278 return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(), 2279 NameInfo, /*TemplateArgs=*/nullptr); 2280 2281 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC)) 2282 return ExprError(); 2283 2284 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName); 2285 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC); 2286 2287 if (R.isAmbiguous()) 2288 return ExprError(); 2289 2290 if (R.getResultKind() == LookupResult::NotFoundInCurrentInstantiation) 2291 return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(), 2292 NameInfo, /*TemplateArgs=*/nullptr); 2293 2294 if (R.empty()) { 2295 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_no_member) 2296 << NameInfo.getName() << DC << SS.getRange(); 2297 return ExprError(); 2298 } 2299 2300 if (const TypeDecl *TD = R.getAsSingle<TypeDecl>()) { 2301 // Diagnose a missing typename if this resolved unambiguously to a type in 2302 // a dependent context. If we can recover with a type, downgrade this to 2303 // a warning in Microsoft compatibility mode. 2304 unsigned DiagID = diag::err_typename_missing; 2305 if (RecoveryTSI && getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) 2306 DiagID = diag::ext_typename_missing; 2307 SourceLocation Loc = SS.getBeginLoc(); 2308 auto D = Diag(Loc, DiagID); 2309 D << SS.getScopeRep() << NameInfo.getName().getAsString() 2310 << SourceRange(Loc, NameInfo.getEndLoc()); 2311 2312 // Don't recover if the caller isn't expecting us to or if we're in a SFINAE 2313 // context. 2314 if (!RecoveryTSI) 2315 return ExprError(); 2316 2317 // Only issue the fixit if we're prepared to recover. 2318 D << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "typename "); 2319 2320 // Recover by pretending this was an elaborated type. 2321 QualType Ty = Context.getTypeDeclType(TD); 2322 TypeLocBuilder TLB; 2323 TLB.pushTypeSpec(Ty).setNameLoc(NameInfo.getLoc()); 2324 2325 QualType ET = getElaboratedType(ETK_None, SS, Ty); 2326 ElaboratedTypeLoc QTL = TLB.push<ElaboratedTypeLoc>(ET); 2327 QTL.setElaboratedKeywordLoc(SourceLocation()); 2328 QTL.setQualifierLoc(SS.getWithLocInContext(Context)); 2329 2330 *RecoveryTSI = TLB.getTypeSourceInfo(Context, ET); 2331 2332 return ExprEmpty(); 2333 } 2334 2335 // Defend against this resolving to an implicit member access. We usually 2336 // won't get here if this might be a legitimate a class member (we end up in 2337 // BuildMemberReferenceExpr instead), but this can be valid if we're forming 2338 // a pointer-to-member or in an unevaluated context in C++11. 2339 if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember() && !IsAddressOfOperand) 2340 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, 2341 /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(), 2342 R, /*TemplateArgs=*/nullptr, S); 2343 2344 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, /* ADL */ false); 2345 } 2346 2347 /// LookupInObjCMethod - The parser has read a name in, and Sema has 2348 /// detected that we're currently inside an ObjC method. Perform some 2349 /// additional lookup. 2350 /// 2351 /// Ideally, most of this would be done by lookup, but there's 2352 /// actually quite a lot of extra work involved. 2353 /// 2354 /// Returns a null sentinel to indicate trivial success. 2355 ExprResult 2356 Sema::LookupInObjCMethod(LookupResult &Lookup, Scope *S, 2357 IdentifierInfo *II, bool AllowBuiltinCreation) { 2358 SourceLocation Loc = Lookup.getNameLoc(); 2359 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl(); 2360 2361 // Check for error condition which is already reported. 2362 if (!CurMethod) 2363 return ExprError(); 2364 2365 // There are two cases to handle here. 1) scoped lookup could have failed, 2366 // in which case we should look for an ivar. 2) scoped lookup could have 2367 // found a decl, but that decl is outside the current instance method (i.e. 2368 // a global variable). In these two cases, we do a lookup for an ivar with 2369 // this name, if the lookup sucedes, we replace it our current decl. 2370 2371 // If we're in a class method, we don't normally want to look for 2372 // ivars. But if we don't find anything else, and there's an 2373 // ivar, that's an error. 2374 bool IsClassMethod = CurMethod->isClassMethod(); 2375 2376 bool LookForIvars; 2377 if (Lookup.empty()) 2378 LookForIvars = true; 2379 else if (IsClassMethod) 2380 LookForIvars = false; 2381 else 2382 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() && 2383 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod()); 2384 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = nullptr; 2385 if (LookForIvars) { 2386 IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface(); 2387 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared; 2388 ObjCIvarDecl *IV = nullptr; 2389 if (IFace && (IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared))) { 2390 // Diagnose using an ivar in a class method. 2391 if (IsClassMethod) 2392 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::err_ivar_use_in_class_method) 2393 << IV->getDeclName()); 2394 2395 // If we're referencing an invalid decl, just return this as a silent 2396 // error node. The error diagnostic was already emitted on the decl. 2397 if (IV->isInvalidDecl()) 2398 return ExprError(); 2399 2400 // Check if referencing a field with __attribute__((deprecated)). 2401 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, Loc)) 2402 return ExprError(); 2403 2404 // Diagnose the use of an ivar outside of the declaring class. 2405 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private && 2406 !declaresSameEntity(ClassDeclared, IFace) && 2407 !getLangOpts().DebuggerSupport) 2408 Diag(Loc, diag::err_private_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName(); 2409 2410 // FIXME: This should use a new expr for a direct reference, don't 2411 // turn this into Self->ivar, just return a BareIVarExpr or something. 2412 IdentifierInfo &II = Context.Idents.get("self"); 2413 UnqualifiedId SelfName; 2414 SelfName.setIdentifier(&II, SourceLocation()); 2415 SelfName.setKind(UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ImplicitSelfParam); 2416 CXXScopeSpec SelfScopeSpec; 2417 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc; 2418 ExprResult SelfExpr = ActOnIdExpression(S, SelfScopeSpec, TemplateKWLoc, 2419 SelfName, false, false); 2420 if (SelfExpr.isInvalid()) 2421 return ExprError(); 2422 2423 SelfExpr = DefaultLvalueConversion(SelfExpr.get()); 2424 if (SelfExpr.isInvalid()) 2425 return ExprError(); 2426 2427 MarkAnyDeclReferenced(Loc, IV, true); 2428 2429 ObjCMethodFamily MF = CurMethod->getMethodFamily(); 2430 if (MF != OMF_init && MF != OMF_dealloc && MF != OMF_finalize && 2431 !IvarBacksCurrentMethodAccessor(IFace, CurMethod, IV)) 2432 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_direct_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName(); 2433 2434 ObjCIvarRefExpr *Result = new (Context) 2435 ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getUsageType(SelfExpr.get()->getType()), Loc, 2436 IV->getLocation(), SelfExpr.get(), true, true); 2437 2438 if (IV->getType().getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Weak) { 2439 if (!isUnevaluatedContext() && 2440 !Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_arc_repeated_use_of_weak, Loc)) 2441 getCurFunction()->recordUseOfWeak(Result); 2442 } 2443 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) { 2444 if (CurContext->isClosure()) 2445 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_implicitly_retains_self) 2446 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "self->"); 2447 } 2448 2449 return Result; 2450 } 2451 } else if (CurMethod->isInstanceMethod()) { 2452 // We should warn if a local variable hides an ivar. 2453 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface()) { 2454 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared; 2455 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) { 2456 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Private || 2457 declaresSameEntity(IFace, ClassDeclared)) 2458 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivar_use_hidden) << IV->getDeclName(); 2459 } 2460 } 2461 } else if (Lookup.isSingleResult() && 2462 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod()) { 2463 // If accessing a stand-alone ivar in a class method, this is an error. 2464 if (const ObjCIvarDecl *IV = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarDecl>(Lookup.getFoundDecl())) 2465 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::err_ivar_use_in_class_method) 2466 << IV->getDeclName()); 2467 } 2468 2469 if (Lookup.empty() && II && AllowBuiltinCreation) { 2470 // FIXME. Consolidate this with similar code in LookupName. 2471 if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) { 2472 if (!(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 2473 Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID))) { 2474 NamedDecl *D = LazilyCreateBuiltin((IdentifierInfo *)II, BuiltinID, 2475 S, Lookup.isForRedeclaration(), 2476 Lookup.getNameLoc()); 2477 if (D) Lookup.addDecl(D); 2478 } 2479 } 2480 } 2481 // Sentinel value saying that we didn't do anything special. 2482 return ExprResult((Expr *)nullptr); 2483 } 2484 2485 /// Cast a base object to a member's actual type. 2486 /// 2487 /// Logically this happens in three phases: 2488 /// 2489 /// * First we cast from the base type to the naming class. 2490 /// The naming class is the class into which we were looking 2491 /// when we found the member; it's the qualifier type if a 2492 /// qualifier was provided, and otherwise it's the base type. 2493 /// 2494 /// * Next we cast from the naming class to the declaring class. 2495 /// If the member we found was brought into a class's scope by 2496 /// a using declaration, this is that class; otherwise it's 2497 /// the class declaring the member. 2498 /// 2499 /// * Finally we cast from the declaring class to the "true" 2500 /// declaring class of the member. This conversion does not 2501 /// obey access control. 2502 ExprResult 2503 Sema::PerformObjectMemberConversion(Expr *From, 2504 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier, 2505 NamedDecl *FoundDecl, 2506 NamedDecl *Member) { 2507 CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Member->getDeclContext()); 2508 if (!RD) 2509 return From; 2510 2511 QualType DestRecordType; 2512 QualType DestType; 2513 QualType FromRecordType; 2514 QualType FromType = From->getType(); 2515 bool PointerConversions = false; 2516 if (isa<FieldDecl>(Member)) { 2517 DestRecordType = Context.getCanonicalType(Context.getTypeDeclType(RD)); 2518 2519 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 2520 DestType = Context.getPointerType(DestRecordType); 2521 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType(); 2522 PointerConversions = true; 2523 } else { 2524 DestType = DestRecordType; 2525 FromRecordType = FromType; 2526 } 2527 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Member)) { 2528 if (Method->isStatic()) 2529 return From; 2530 2531 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context); 2532 DestRecordType = DestType->getPointeeType(); 2533 2534 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 2535 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType(); 2536 PointerConversions = true; 2537 } else { 2538 FromRecordType = FromType; 2539 DestType = DestRecordType; 2540 } 2541 } else { 2542 // No conversion necessary. 2543 return From; 2544 } 2545 2546 if (DestType->isDependentType() || FromType->isDependentType()) 2547 return From; 2548 2549 // If the unqualified types are the same, no conversion is necessary. 2550 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType)) 2551 return From; 2552 2553 SourceRange FromRange = From->getSourceRange(); 2554 SourceLocation FromLoc = FromRange.getBegin(); 2555 2556 ExprValueKind VK = From->getValueKind(); 2557 2558 // C++ [class.member.lookup]p8: 2559 // [...] Ambiguities can often be resolved by qualifying a name with its 2560 // class name. 2561 // 2562 // If the member was a qualified name and the qualified referred to a 2563 // specific base subobject type, we'll cast to that intermediate type 2564 // first and then to the object in which the member is declared. That allows 2565 // one to resolve ambiguities in, e.g., a diamond-shaped hierarchy such as: 2566 // 2567 // class Base { public: int x; }; 2568 // class Derived1 : public Base { }; 2569 // class Derived2 : public Base { }; 2570 // class VeryDerived : public Derived1, public Derived2 { void f(); }; 2571 // 2572 // void VeryDerived::f() { 2573 // x = 17; // error: ambiguous base subobjects 2574 // Derived1::x = 17; // okay, pick the Base subobject of Derived1 2575 // } 2576 if (Qualifier && Qualifier->getAsType()) { 2577 QualType QType = QualType(Qualifier->getAsType(), 0); 2578 assert(QType->isRecordType() && "lookup done with non-record type"); 2579 2580 QualType QRecordType = QualType(QType->getAs<RecordType>(), 0); 2581 2582 // In C++98, the qualifier type doesn't actually have to be a base 2583 // type of the object type, in which case we just ignore it. 2584 // Otherwise build the appropriate casts. 2585 if (IsDerivedFrom(FromLoc, FromRecordType, QRecordType)) { 2586 CXXCastPath BasePath; 2587 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, QRecordType, 2588 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath)) 2589 return ExprError(); 2590 2591 if (PointerConversions) 2592 QType = Context.getPointerType(QType); 2593 From = ImpCastExprToType(From, QType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase, 2594 VK, &BasePath).get(); 2595 2596 FromType = QType; 2597 FromRecordType = QRecordType; 2598 2599 // If the qualifier type was the same as the destination type, 2600 // we're done. 2601 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType)) 2602 return From; 2603 } 2604 } 2605 2606 bool IgnoreAccess = false; 2607 2608 // If we actually found the member through a using declaration, cast 2609 // down to the using declaration's type. 2610 // 2611 // Pointer equality is fine here because only one declaration of a 2612 // class ever has member declarations. 2613 if (FoundDecl->getDeclContext() != Member->getDeclContext()) { 2614 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl)); 2615 QualType URecordType = Context.getTypeDeclType( 2616 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FoundDecl->getDeclContext())); 2617 2618 // We only need to do this if the naming-class to declaring-class 2619 // conversion is non-trivial. 2620 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, URecordType)) { 2621 assert(IsDerivedFrom(FromLoc, FromRecordType, URecordType)); 2622 CXXCastPath BasePath; 2623 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, URecordType, 2624 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath)) 2625 return ExprError(); 2626 2627 QualType UType = URecordType; 2628 if (PointerConversions) 2629 UType = Context.getPointerType(UType); 2630 From = ImpCastExprToType(From, UType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase, 2631 VK, &BasePath).get(); 2632 FromType = UType; 2633 FromRecordType = URecordType; 2634 } 2635 2636 // We don't do access control for the conversion from the 2637 // declaring class to the true declaring class. 2638 IgnoreAccess = true; 2639 } 2640 2641 CXXCastPath BasePath; 2642 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, DestRecordType, 2643 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath, 2644 IgnoreAccess)) 2645 return ExprError(); 2646 2647 return ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase, 2648 VK, &BasePath); 2649 } 2650 2651 bool Sema::UseArgumentDependentLookup(const CXXScopeSpec &SS, 2652 const LookupResult &R, 2653 bool HasTrailingLParen) { 2654 // Only when used directly as the postfix-expression of a call. 2655 if (!HasTrailingLParen) 2656 return false; 2657 2658 // Never if a scope specifier was provided. 2659 if (SS.isSet()) 2660 return false; 2661 2662 // Only in C++ or ObjC++. 2663 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 2664 return false; 2665 2666 // Turn off ADL when we find certain kinds of declarations during 2667 // normal lookup: 2668 for (NamedDecl *D : R) { 2669 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3: 2670 // -- a declaration of a class member 2671 // Since using decls preserve this property, we check this on the 2672 // original decl. 2673 if (D->isCXXClassMember()) 2674 return false; 2675 2676 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3: 2677 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a 2678 // using-declaration 2679 // NOTE: we also trigger this for function templates (in fact, we 2680 // don't check the decl type at all, since all other decl types 2681 // turn off ADL anyway). 2682 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 2683 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 2684 else if (D->getLexicalDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod()) 2685 return false; 2686 2687 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3: 2688 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function 2689 // template 2690 // And also for builtin functions. 2691 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 2692 FunctionDecl *FDecl = cast<FunctionDecl>(D); 2693 2694 // But also builtin functions. 2695 if (FDecl->getBuiltinID() && FDecl->isImplicit()) 2696 return false; 2697 } else if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)) 2698 return false; 2699 } 2700 2701 return true; 2702 } 2703 2704 2705 /// Diagnoses obvious problems with the use of the given declaration 2706 /// as an expression. This is only actually called for lookups that 2707 /// were not overloaded, and it doesn't promise that the declaration 2708 /// will in fact be used. 2709 static bool CheckDeclInExpr(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) { 2710 if (D->isInvalidDecl()) 2711 return true; 2712 2713 if (isa<TypedefNameDecl>(D)) { 2714 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_typedef) << D->getDeclName(); 2715 return true; 2716 } 2717 2718 if (isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) { 2719 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_interface) << D->getDeclName(); 2720 return true; 2721 } 2722 2723 if (isa<NamespaceDecl>(D)) { 2724 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_namespace) << D->getDeclName(); 2725 return true; 2726 } 2727 2728 return false; 2729 } 2730 2731 // Certain multiversion types should be treated as overloaded even when there is 2732 // only one result. 2733 static bool ShouldLookupResultBeMultiVersionOverload(const LookupResult &R) { 2734 assert(R.isSingleResult() && "Expected only a single result"); 2735 const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(R.getFoundDecl()); 2736 return FD && 2737 (FD->isCPUDispatchMultiVersion() || FD->isCPUSpecificMultiVersion()); 2738 } 2739 2740 ExprResult Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS, 2741 LookupResult &R, bool NeedsADL, 2742 bool AcceptInvalidDecl) { 2743 // If this is a single, fully-resolved result and we don't need ADL, 2744 // just build an ordinary singleton decl ref. 2745 if (!NeedsADL && R.isSingleResult() && 2746 !R.getAsSingle<FunctionTemplateDecl>() && 2747 !ShouldLookupResultBeMultiVersionOverload(R)) 2748 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(), R.getFoundDecl(), 2749 R.getRepresentativeDecl(), nullptr, 2750 AcceptInvalidDecl); 2751 2752 // We only need to check the declaration if there's exactly one 2753 // result, because in the overloaded case the results can only be 2754 // functions and function templates. 2755 if (R.isSingleResult() && !ShouldLookupResultBeMultiVersionOverload(R) && 2756 CheckDeclInExpr(*this, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl())) 2757 return ExprError(); 2758 2759 // Otherwise, just build an unresolved lookup expression. Suppress 2760 // any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll hash these out later, when 2761 // we've picked a target. 2762 R.suppressDiagnostics(); 2763 2764 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE 2765 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, R.getNamingClass(), 2766 SS.getWithLocInContext(Context), 2767 R.getLookupNameInfo(), 2768 NeedsADL, R.isOverloadedResult(), 2769 R.begin(), R.end()); 2770 2771 return ULE; 2772 } 2773 2774 static void 2775 diagnoseUncapturableValueReference(Sema &S, SourceLocation loc, 2776 ValueDecl *var, DeclContext *DC); 2777 2778 /// Complete semantic analysis for a reference to the given declaration. 2779 ExprResult Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr( 2780 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo, NamedDecl *D, 2781 NamedDecl *FoundD, const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs, 2782 bool AcceptInvalidDecl) { 2783 assert(D && "Cannot refer to a NULL declaration"); 2784 assert(!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) && 2785 "Cannot refer unambiguously to a function template"); 2786 2787 SourceLocation Loc = NameInfo.getLoc(); 2788 if (CheckDeclInExpr(*this, Loc, D)) 2789 return ExprError(); 2790 2791 if (TemplateDecl *Template = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) { 2792 // Specifically diagnose references to class templates that are missing 2793 // a template argument list. 2794 diagnoseMissingTemplateArguments(TemplateName(Template), Loc); 2795 return ExprError(); 2796 } 2797 2798 // Make sure that we're referring to a value. 2799 ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D); 2800 if (!VD) { 2801 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_non_value) 2802 << D << SS.getRange(); 2803 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at); 2804 return ExprError(); 2805 } 2806 2807 // Check whether this declaration can be used. Note that we suppress 2808 // this check when we're going to perform argument-dependent lookup 2809 // on this function name, because this might not be the function 2810 // that overload resolution actually selects. 2811 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(VD, Loc)) 2812 return ExprError(); 2813 2814 // Only create DeclRefExpr's for valid Decl's. 2815 if (VD->isInvalidDecl() && !AcceptInvalidDecl) 2816 return ExprError(); 2817 2818 // Handle members of anonymous structs and unions. If we got here, 2819 // and the reference is to a class member indirect field, then this 2820 // must be the subject of a pointer-to-member expression. 2821 if (IndirectFieldDecl *indirectField = dyn_cast<IndirectFieldDecl>(VD)) 2822 if (!indirectField->isCXXClassMember()) 2823 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(SS, NameInfo.getLoc(), 2824 indirectField); 2825 2826 { 2827 QualType type = VD->getType(); 2828 if (type.isNull()) 2829 return ExprError(); 2830 if (auto *FPT = type->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) { 2831 // C++ [except.spec]p17: 2832 // An exception-specification is considered to be needed when: 2833 // - in an expression, the function is the unique lookup result or 2834 // the selected member of a set of overloaded functions. 2835 ResolveExceptionSpec(Loc, FPT); 2836 type = VD->getType(); 2837 } 2838 ExprValueKind valueKind = VK_RValue; 2839 2840 switch (D->getKind()) { 2841 // Ignore all the non-ValueDecl kinds. 2842 #define ABSTRACT_DECL(kind) 2843 #define VALUE(type, base) 2844 #define DECL(type, base) \ 2845 case Decl::type: 2846 #include "clang/AST/DeclNodes.inc" 2847 llvm_unreachable("invalid value decl kind"); 2848 2849 // These shouldn't make it here. 2850 case Decl::ObjCAtDefsField: 2851 case Decl::ObjCIvar: 2852 llvm_unreachable("forming non-member reference to ivar?"); 2853 2854 // Enum constants are always r-values and never references. 2855 // Unresolved using declarations are dependent. 2856 case Decl::EnumConstant: 2857 case Decl::UnresolvedUsingValue: 2858 case Decl::OMPDeclareReduction: 2859 valueKind = VK_RValue; 2860 break; 2861 2862 // Fields and indirect fields that got here must be for 2863 // pointer-to-member expressions; we just call them l-values for 2864 // internal consistency, because this subexpression doesn't really 2865 // exist in the high-level semantics. 2866 case Decl::Field: 2867 case Decl::IndirectField: 2868 assert(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 2869 "building reference to field in C?"); 2870 2871 // These can't have reference type in well-formed programs, but 2872 // for internal consistency we do this anyway. 2873 type = type.getNonReferenceType(); 2874 valueKind = VK_LValue; 2875 break; 2876 2877 // Non-type template parameters are either l-values or r-values 2878 // depending on the type. 2879 case Decl::NonTypeTemplateParm: { 2880 if (const ReferenceType *reftype = type->getAs<ReferenceType>()) { 2881 type = reftype->getPointeeType(); 2882 valueKind = VK_LValue; // even if the parameter is an r-value reference 2883 break; 2884 } 2885 2886 // For non-references, we need to strip qualifiers just in case 2887 // the template parameter was declared as 'const int' or whatever. 2888 valueKind = VK_RValue; 2889 type = type.getUnqualifiedType(); 2890 break; 2891 } 2892 2893 case Decl::Var: 2894 case Decl::VarTemplateSpecialization: 2895 case Decl::VarTemplatePartialSpecialization: 2896 case Decl::Decomposition: 2897 case Decl::OMPCapturedExpr: 2898 // In C, "extern void blah;" is valid and is an r-value. 2899 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 2900 !type.hasQualifiers() && 2901 type->isVoidType()) { 2902 valueKind = VK_RValue; 2903 break; 2904 } 2905 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 2906 2907 case Decl::ImplicitParam: 2908 case Decl::ParmVar: { 2909 // These are always l-values. 2910 valueKind = VK_LValue; 2911 type = type.getNonReferenceType(); 2912 2913 // FIXME: Does the addition of const really only apply in 2914 // potentially-evaluated contexts? Since the variable isn't actually 2915 // captured in an unevaluated context, it seems that the answer is no. 2916 if (!isUnevaluatedContext()) { 2917 QualType CapturedType = getCapturedDeclRefType(cast<VarDecl>(VD), Loc); 2918 if (!CapturedType.isNull()) 2919 type = CapturedType; 2920 } 2921 2922 break; 2923 } 2924 2925 case Decl::Binding: { 2926 // These are always lvalues. 2927 valueKind = VK_LValue; 2928 type = type.getNonReferenceType(); 2929 // FIXME: Support lambda-capture of BindingDecls, once CWG actually 2930 // decides how that's supposed to work. 2931 auto *BD = cast<BindingDecl>(VD); 2932 if (BD->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod() && 2933 BD->getDeclContext() != CurContext) 2934 diagnoseUncapturableValueReference(*this, Loc, BD, CurContext); 2935 break; 2936 } 2937 2938 case Decl::Function: { 2939 if (unsigned BID = cast<FunctionDecl>(VD)->getBuiltinID()) { 2940 if (!Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BID)) { 2941 type = Context.BuiltinFnTy; 2942 valueKind = VK_RValue; 2943 break; 2944 } 2945 } 2946 2947 const FunctionType *fty = type->castAs<FunctionType>(); 2948 2949 // If we're referring to a function with an __unknown_anytype 2950 // result type, make the entire expression __unknown_anytype. 2951 if (fty->getReturnType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) { 2952 type = Context.UnknownAnyTy; 2953 valueKind = VK_RValue; 2954 break; 2955 } 2956 2957 // Functions are l-values in C++. 2958 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 2959 valueKind = VK_LValue; 2960 break; 2961 } 2962 2963 // C99 DR 316 says that, if a function type comes from a 2964 // function definition (without a prototype), that type is only 2965 // used for checking compatibility. Therefore, when referencing 2966 // the function, we pretend that we don't have the full function 2967 // type. 2968 if (!cast<FunctionDecl>(VD)->hasPrototype() && 2969 isa<FunctionProtoType>(fty)) 2970 type = Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(fty->getReturnType(), 2971 fty->getExtInfo()); 2972 2973 // Functions are r-values in C. 2974 valueKind = VK_RValue; 2975 break; 2976 } 2977 2978 case Decl::CXXDeductionGuide: 2979 llvm_unreachable("building reference to deduction guide"); 2980 2981 case Decl::MSProperty: 2982 valueKind = VK_LValue; 2983 break; 2984 2985 case Decl::CXXMethod: 2986 // If we're referring to a method with an __unknown_anytype 2987 // result type, make the entire expression __unknown_anytype. 2988 // This should only be possible with a type written directly. 2989 if (const FunctionProtoType *proto 2990 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(VD->getType())) 2991 if (proto->getReturnType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) { 2992 type = Context.UnknownAnyTy; 2993 valueKind = VK_RValue; 2994 break; 2995 } 2996 2997 // C++ methods are l-values if static, r-values if non-static. 2998 if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(VD)->isStatic()) { 2999 valueKind = VK_LValue; 3000 break; 3001 } 3002 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 3003 3004 case Decl::CXXConversion: 3005 case Decl::CXXDestructor: 3006 case Decl::CXXConstructor: 3007 valueKind = VK_RValue; 3008 break; 3009 } 3010 3011 return BuildDeclRefExpr(VD, type, valueKind, NameInfo, &SS, FoundD, 3012 TemplateArgs); 3013 } 3014 } 3015 3016 static void ConvertUTF8ToWideString(unsigned CharByteWidth, StringRef Source, 3017 SmallString<32> &Target) { 3018 Target.resize(CharByteWidth * (Source.size() + 1)); 3019 char *ResultPtr = &Target[0]; 3020 const llvm::UTF8 *ErrorPtr; 3021 bool success = 3022 llvm::ConvertUTF8toWide(CharByteWidth, Source, ResultPtr, ErrorPtr); 3023 (void)success; 3024 assert(success); 3025 Target.resize(ResultPtr - &Target[0]); 3026 } 3027 3028 ExprResult Sema::BuildPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc, 3029 PredefinedExpr::IdentType IT) { 3030 // Pick the current block, lambda, captured statement or function. 3031 Decl *currentDecl = nullptr; 3032 if (const BlockScopeInfo *BSI = getCurBlock()) 3033 currentDecl = BSI->TheDecl; 3034 else if (const LambdaScopeInfo *LSI = getCurLambda()) 3035 currentDecl = LSI->CallOperator; 3036 else if (const CapturedRegionScopeInfo *CSI = getCurCapturedRegion()) 3037 currentDecl = CSI->TheCapturedDecl; 3038 else 3039 currentDecl = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl(); 3040 3041 if (!currentDecl) { 3042 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_predef_outside_function); 3043 currentDecl = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl(); 3044 } 3045 3046 QualType ResTy; 3047 StringLiteral *SL = nullptr; 3048 if (cast<DeclContext>(currentDecl)->isDependentContext()) 3049 ResTy = Context.DependentTy; 3050 else { 3051 // Pre-defined identifiers are of type char[x], where x is the length of 3052 // the string. 3053 auto Str = PredefinedExpr::ComputeName(IT, currentDecl); 3054 unsigned Length = Str.length(); 3055 3056 llvm::APInt LengthI(32, Length + 1); 3057 if (IT == PredefinedExpr::LFunction || IT == PredefinedExpr::LFuncSig) { 3058 ResTy = 3059 Context.adjustStringLiteralBaseType(Context.WideCharTy.withConst()); 3060 SmallString<32> RawChars; 3061 ConvertUTF8ToWideString(Context.getTypeSizeInChars(ResTy).getQuantity(), 3062 Str, RawChars); 3063 ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal, 3064 /*IndexTypeQuals*/ 0); 3065 SL = StringLiteral::Create(Context, RawChars, StringLiteral::Wide, 3066 /*Pascal*/ false, ResTy, Loc); 3067 } else { 3068 ResTy = Context.adjustStringLiteralBaseType(Context.CharTy.withConst()); 3069 ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal, 3070 /*IndexTypeQuals*/ 0); 3071 SL = StringLiteral::Create(Context, Str, StringLiteral::Ascii, 3072 /*Pascal*/ false, ResTy, Loc); 3073 } 3074 } 3075 3076 return new (Context) PredefinedExpr(Loc, ResTy, IT, SL); 3077 } 3078 3079 ExprResult Sema::ActOnPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc, tok::TokenKind Kind) { 3080 PredefinedExpr::IdentType IT; 3081 3082 switch (Kind) { 3083 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown simple primary expr!"); 3084 case tok::kw___func__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Func; break; // [C99 6.4.2.2] 3085 case tok::kw___FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Function; break; 3086 case tok::kw___FUNCDNAME__: IT = PredefinedExpr::FuncDName; break; // [MS] 3087 case tok::kw___FUNCSIG__: IT = PredefinedExpr::FuncSig; break; // [MS] 3088 case tok::kw_L__FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::LFunction; break; // [MS] 3089 case tok::kw_L__FUNCSIG__: IT = PredefinedExpr::LFuncSig; break; // [MS] 3090 case tok::kw___PRETTY_FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::PrettyFunction; break; 3091 } 3092 3093 return BuildPredefinedExpr(Loc, IT); 3094 } 3095 3096 ExprResult Sema::ActOnCharacterConstant(const Token &Tok, Scope *UDLScope) { 3097 SmallString<16> CharBuffer; 3098 bool Invalid = false; 3099 StringRef ThisTok = PP.getSpelling(Tok, CharBuffer, &Invalid); 3100 if (Invalid) 3101 return ExprError(); 3102 3103 CharLiteralParser Literal(ThisTok.begin(), ThisTok.end(), Tok.getLocation(), 3104 PP, Tok.getKind()); 3105 if (Literal.hadError()) 3106 return ExprError(); 3107 3108 QualType Ty; 3109 if (Literal.isWide()) 3110 Ty = Context.WideCharTy; // L'x' -> wchar_t in C and C++. 3111 else if (Literal.isUTF8() && getLangOpts().Char8) 3112 Ty = Context.Char8Ty; // u8'x' -> char8_t when it exists. 3113 else if (Literal.isUTF16()) 3114 Ty = Context.Char16Ty; // u'x' -> char16_t in C11 and C++11. 3115 else if (Literal.isUTF32()) 3116 Ty = Context.Char32Ty; // U'x' -> char32_t in C11 and C++11. 3117 else if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || Literal.isMultiChar()) 3118 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'x' -> int in C, 'wxyz' -> int in C++. 3119 else 3120 Ty = Context.CharTy; // 'x' -> char in C++ 3121 3122 CharacterLiteral::CharacterKind Kind = CharacterLiteral::Ascii; 3123 if (Literal.isWide()) 3124 Kind = CharacterLiteral::Wide; 3125 else if (Literal.isUTF16()) 3126 Kind = CharacterLiteral::UTF16; 3127 else if (Literal.isUTF32()) 3128 Kind = CharacterLiteral::UTF32; 3129 else if (Literal.isUTF8()) 3130 Kind = CharacterLiteral::UTF8; 3131 3132 Expr *Lit = new (Context) CharacterLiteral(Literal.getValue(), Kind, Ty, 3133 Tok.getLocation()); 3134 3135 if (Literal.getUDSuffix().empty()) 3136 return Lit; 3137 3138 // We're building a user-defined literal. 3139 IdentifierInfo *UDSuffix = &Context.Idents.get(Literal.getUDSuffix()); 3140 SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc = 3141 getUDSuffixLoc(*this, Tok.getLocation(), Literal.getUDSuffixOffset()); 3142 3143 // Make sure we're allowed user-defined literals here. 3144 if (!UDLScope) 3145 return ExprError(Diag(UDSuffixLoc, diag::err_invalid_character_udl)); 3146 3147 // C++11 [lex.ext]p6: The literal L is treated as a call of the form 3148 // operator "" X (ch) 3149 return BuildCookedLiteralOperatorCall(*this, UDLScope, UDSuffix, UDSuffixLoc, 3150 Lit, Tok.getLocation()); 3151 } 3152 3153 ExprResult Sema::ActOnIntegerConstant(SourceLocation Loc, uint64_t Val) { 3154 unsigned IntSize = Context.getTargetInfo().getIntWidth(); 3155 return IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, llvm::APInt(IntSize, Val), 3156 Context.IntTy, Loc); 3157 } 3158 3159 static Expr *BuildFloatingLiteral(Sema &S, NumericLiteralParser &Literal, 3160 QualType Ty, SourceLocation Loc) { 3161 const llvm::fltSemantics &Format = S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(Ty); 3162 3163 using llvm::APFloat; 3164 APFloat Val(Format); 3165 3166 APFloat::opStatus result = Literal.GetFloatValue(Val); 3167 3168 // Overflow is always an error, but underflow is only an error if 3169 // we underflowed to zero (APFloat reports denormals as underflow). 3170 if ((result & APFloat::opOverflow) || 3171 ((result & APFloat::opUnderflow) && Val.isZero())) { 3172 unsigned diagnostic; 3173 SmallString<20> buffer; 3174 if (result & APFloat::opOverflow) { 3175 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_overflow; 3176 APFloat::getLargest(Format).toString(buffer); 3177 } else { 3178 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_underflow; 3179 APFloat::getSmallest(Format).toString(buffer); 3180 } 3181 3182 S.Diag(Loc, diagnostic) 3183 << Ty 3184 << StringRef(buffer.data(), buffer.size()); 3185 } 3186 3187 bool isExact = (result == APFloat::opOK); 3188 return FloatingLiteral::Create(S.Context, Val, isExact, Ty, Loc); 3189 } 3190 3191 bool Sema::CheckLoopHintExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc) { 3192 assert(E && "Invalid expression"); 3193 3194 if (E->isValueDependent()) 3195 return false; 3196 3197 QualType QT = E->getType(); 3198 if (!QT->isIntegerType() || QT->isBooleanType() || QT->isCharType()) { 3199 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_pragma_loop_invalid_argument_type) << QT; 3200 return true; 3201 } 3202 3203 llvm::APSInt ValueAPS; 3204 ExprResult R = VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(E, &ValueAPS); 3205 3206 if (R.isInvalid()) 3207 return true; 3208 3209 bool ValueIsPositive = ValueAPS.isStrictlyPositive(); 3210 if (!ValueIsPositive || ValueAPS.getActiveBits() > 31) { 3211 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_pragma_loop_invalid_argument_value) 3212 << ValueAPS.toString(10) << ValueIsPositive; 3213 return true; 3214 } 3215 3216 return false; 3217 } 3218 3219 ExprResult Sema::ActOnNumericConstant(const Token &Tok, Scope *UDLScope) { 3220 // Fast path for a single digit (which is quite common). A single digit 3221 // cannot have a trigraph, escaped newline, radix prefix, or suffix. 3222 if (Tok.getLength() == 1) { 3223 const char Val = PP.getSpellingOfSingleCharacterNumericConstant(Tok); 3224 return ActOnIntegerConstant(Tok.getLocation(), Val-'0'); 3225 } 3226 3227 SmallString<128> SpellingBuffer; 3228 // NumericLiteralParser wants to overread by one character. Add padding to 3229 // the buffer in case the token is copied to the buffer. If getSpelling() 3230 // returns a StringRef to the memory buffer, it should have a null char at 3231 // the EOF, so it is also safe. 3232 SpellingBuffer.resize(Tok.getLength() + 1); 3233 3234 // Get the spelling of the token, which eliminates trigraphs, etc. 3235 bool Invalid = false; 3236 StringRef TokSpelling = PP.getSpelling(Tok, SpellingBuffer, &Invalid); 3237 if (Invalid) 3238 return ExprError(); 3239 3240 NumericLiteralParser Literal(TokSpelling, Tok.getLocation(), PP); 3241 if (Literal.hadError) 3242 return ExprError(); 3243 3244 if (Literal.hasUDSuffix()) { 3245 // We're building a user-defined literal. 3246 IdentifierInfo *UDSuffix = &Context.Idents.get(Literal.getUDSuffix()); 3247 SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc = 3248 getUDSuffixLoc(*this, Tok.getLocation(), Literal.getUDSuffixOffset()); 3249 3250 // Make sure we're allowed user-defined literals here. 3251 if (!UDLScope) 3252 return ExprError(Diag(UDSuffixLoc, diag::err_invalid_numeric_udl)); 3253 3254 QualType CookedTy; 3255 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) { 3256 // C++11 [lex.ext]p4: If S contains a literal operator with parameter type 3257 // long double, the literal is treated as a call of the form 3258 // operator "" X (f L) 3259 CookedTy = Context.LongDoubleTy; 3260 } else { 3261 // C++11 [lex.ext]p3: If S contains a literal operator with parameter type 3262 // unsigned long long, the literal is treated as a call of the form 3263 // operator "" X (n ULL) 3264 CookedTy = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy; 3265 } 3266 3267 DeclarationName OpName = 3268 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXLiteralOperatorName(UDSuffix); 3269 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, UDSuffixLoc); 3270 OpNameInfo.setCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc(UDSuffixLoc); 3271 3272 SourceLocation TokLoc = Tok.getLocation(); 3273 3274 // Perform literal operator lookup to determine if we're building a raw 3275 // literal or a cooked one. 3276 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, UDSuffixLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 3277 switch (LookupLiteralOperator(UDLScope, R, CookedTy, 3278 /*AllowRaw*/ true, /*AllowTemplate*/ true, 3279 /*AllowStringTemplate*/ false, 3280 /*DiagnoseMissing*/ !Literal.isImaginary)) { 3281 case LOLR_ErrorNoDiagnostic: 3282 // Lookup failure for imaginary constants isn't fatal, there's still the 3283 // GNU extension producing _Complex types. 3284 break; 3285 case LOLR_Error: 3286 return ExprError(); 3287 case LOLR_Cooked: { 3288 Expr *Lit; 3289 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) { 3290 Lit = BuildFloatingLiteral(*this, Literal, CookedTy, Tok.getLocation()); 3291 } else { 3292 llvm::APInt ResultVal(Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth(), 0); 3293 if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) 3294 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::err_integer_literal_too_large) 3295 << /* Unsigned */ 1; 3296 Lit = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, ResultVal, CookedTy, 3297 Tok.getLocation()); 3298 } 3299 return BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, Lit, TokLoc); 3300 } 3301 3302 case LOLR_Raw: { 3303 // C++11 [lit.ext]p3, p4: If S contains a raw literal operator, the 3304 // literal is treated as a call of the form 3305 // operator "" X ("n") 3306 unsigned Length = Literal.getUDSuffixOffset(); 3307 QualType StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType( 3308 Context.adjustStringLiteralBaseType(Context.CharTy.withConst()), 3309 llvm::APInt(32, Length + 1), ArrayType::Normal, 0); 3310 Expr *Lit = StringLiteral::Create( 3311 Context, StringRef(TokSpelling.data(), Length), StringLiteral::Ascii, 3312 /*Pascal*/false, StrTy, &TokLoc, 1); 3313 return BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, Lit, TokLoc); 3314 } 3315 3316 case LOLR_Template: { 3317 // C++11 [lit.ext]p3, p4: Otherwise (S contains a literal operator 3318 // template), L is treated as a call fo the form 3319 // operator "" X <'c1', 'c2', ... 'ck'>() 3320 // where n is the source character sequence c1 c2 ... ck. 3321 TemplateArgumentListInfo ExplicitArgs; 3322 unsigned CharBits = Context.getIntWidth(Context.CharTy); 3323 bool CharIsUnsigned = Context.CharTy->isUnsignedIntegerType(); 3324 llvm::APSInt Value(CharBits, CharIsUnsigned); 3325 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Literal.getUDSuffixOffset(); I != N; ++I) { 3326 Value = TokSpelling[I]; 3327 TemplateArgument Arg(Context, Value, Context.CharTy); 3328 TemplateArgumentLocInfo ArgInfo; 3329 ExplicitArgs.addArgument(TemplateArgumentLoc(Arg, ArgInfo)); 3330 } 3331 return BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, None, TokLoc, 3332 &ExplicitArgs); 3333 } 3334 case LOLR_StringTemplate: 3335 llvm_unreachable("unexpected literal operator lookup result"); 3336 } 3337 } 3338 3339 Expr *Res; 3340 3341 if (Literal.isFixedPointLiteral()) { 3342 QualType Ty; 3343 3344 if (Literal.isAccum) { 3345 if (Literal.isHalf) { 3346 Ty = Context.ShortAccumTy; 3347 } else if (Literal.isLong) { 3348 Ty = Context.LongAccumTy; 3349 } else { 3350 Ty = Context.AccumTy; 3351 } 3352 } else if (Literal.isFract) { 3353 if (Literal.isHalf) { 3354 Ty = Context.ShortFractTy; 3355 } else if (Literal.isLong) { 3356 Ty = Context.LongFractTy; 3357 } else { 3358 Ty = Context.FractTy; 3359 } 3360 } 3361 3362 if (Literal.isUnsigned) Ty = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(Ty); 3363 3364 bool isSigned = !Literal.isUnsigned; 3365 unsigned scale = Context.getFixedPointScale(Ty); 3366 unsigned ibits = Context.getFixedPointIBits(Ty); 3367 unsigned bit_width = Context.getTypeInfo(Ty).Width; 3368 3369 llvm::APInt Val(bit_width, 0, isSigned); 3370 bool Overflowed = Literal.GetFixedPointValue(Val, scale); 3371 3372 // Do not use bit_width since some types may have padding like _Fract or 3373 // unsigned _Accums if PaddingOnUnsignedFixedPoint is set. 3374 auto MaxVal = llvm::APInt::getMaxValue(ibits + scale).zextOrSelf(bit_width); 3375 if (Literal.isFract && Val == MaxVal + 1) 3376 // Clause 6.4.4 - The value of a constant shall be in the range of 3377 // representable values for its type, with exception for constants of a 3378 // fract type with a value of exactly 1; such a constant shall denote 3379 // the maximal value for the type. 3380 --Val; 3381 else if (Val.ugt(MaxVal) || Overflowed) 3382 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::err_too_large_for_fixed_point); 3383 3384 Res = FixedPointLiteral::CreateFromRawInt(Context, Val, Ty, 3385 Tok.getLocation(), scale); 3386 } else if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) { 3387 QualType Ty; 3388 if (Literal.isHalf){ 3389 if (getOpenCLOptions().isEnabled("cl_khr_fp16")) 3390 Ty = Context.HalfTy; 3391 else { 3392 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::err_half_const_requires_fp16); 3393 return ExprError(); 3394 } 3395 } else if (Literal.isFloat) 3396 Ty = Context.FloatTy; 3397 else if (Literal.isLong) 3398 Ty = Context.LongDoubleTy; 3399 else if (Literal.isFloat16) 3400 Ty = Context.Float16Ty; 3401 else if (Literal.isFloat128) 3402 Ty = Context.Float128Ty; 3403 else 3404 Ty = Context.DoubleTy; 3405 3406 Res = BuildFloatingLiteral(*this, Literal, Ty, Tok.getLocation()); 3407 3408 if (Ty == Context.DoubleTy) { 3409 if (getLangOpts().SinglePrecisionConstants) { 3410 const BuiltinType *BTy = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>(); 3411 if (BTy->getKind() != BuiltinType::Float) { 3412 Res = ImpCastExprToType(Res, Context.FloatTy, CK_FloatingCast).get(); 3413 } 3414 } else if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && 3415 !getOpenCLOptions().isEnabled("cl_khr_fp64")) { 3416 // Impose single-precision float type when cl_khr_fp64 is not enabled. 3417 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_double_const_requires_fp64); 3418 Res = ImpCastExprToType(Res, Context.FloatTy, CK_FloatingCast).get(); 3419 } 3420 } 3421 } else if (!Literal.isIntegerLiteral()) { 3422 return ExprError(); 3423 } else { 3424 QualType Ty; 3425 3426 // 'long long' is a C99 or C++11 feature. 3427 if (!getLangOpts().C99 && Literal.isLongLong) { 3428 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 3429 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), 3430 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 ? 3431 diag::warn_cxx98_compat_longlong : diag::ext_cxx11_longlong); 3432 else 3433 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_c99_longlong); 3434 } 3435 3436 // Get the value in the widest-possible width. 3437 unsigned MaxWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getIntMaxTWidth(); 3438 llvm::APInt ResultVal(MaxWidth, 0); 3439 3440 if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) { 3441 // If this value didn't fit into uintmax_t, error and force to ull. 3442 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::err_integer_literal_too_large) 3443 << /* Unsigned */ 1; 3444 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy; 3445 assert(Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == ResultVal.getBitWidth() && 3446 "long long is not intmax_t?"); 3447 } else { 3448 // If this value fits into a ULL, try to figure out what else it fits into 3449 // according to the rules of C99 6.4.4.1p5. 3450 3451 // Octal, Hexadecimal, and integers with a U suffix are allowed to 3452 // be an unsigned int. 3453 bool AllowUnsigned = Literal.isUnsigned || Literal.getRadix() != 10; 3454 3455 // Check from smallest to largest, picking the smallest type we can. 3456 unsigned Width = 0; 3457 3458 // Microsoft specific integer suffixes are explicitly sized. 3459 if (Literal.MicrosoftInteger) { 3460 if (Literal.MicrosoftInteger == 8 && !Literal.isUnsigned) { 3461 Width = 8; 3462 Ty = Context.CharTy; 3463 } else { 3464 Width = Literal.MicrosoftInteger; 3465 Ty = Context.getIntTypeForBitwidth(Width, 3466 /*Signed=*/!Literal.isUnsigned); 3467 } 3468 } 3469 3470 if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLong && !Literal.isLongLong) { 3471 // Are int/unsigned possibilities? 3472 unsigned IntSize = Context.getTargetInfo().getIntWidth(); 3473 3474 // Does it fit in a unsigned int? 3475 if (ResultVal.isIntN(IntSize)) { 3476 // Does it fit in a signed int? 3477 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[IntSize-1] == 0) 3478 Ty = Context.IntTy; 3479 else if (AllowUnsigned) 3480 Ty = Context.UnsignedIntTy; 3481 Width = IntSize; 3482 } 3483 } 3484 3485 // Are long/unsigned long possibilities? 3486 if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLongLong) { 3487 unsigned LongSize = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongWidth(); 3488 3489 // Does it fit in a unsigned long? 3490 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongSize)) { 3491 // Does it fit in a signed long? 3492 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongSize-1] == 0) 3493 Ty = Context.LongTy; 3494 else if (AllowUnsigned) 3495 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy; 3496 // Check according to the rules of C90 6.1.3.2p5. C++03 [lex.icon]p2 3497 // is compatible. 3498 else if (!getLangOpts().C99 && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) { 3499 const unsigned LongLongSize = 3500 Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth(); 3501 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), 3502 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 3503 ? Literal.isLong 3504 ? diag::warn_old_implicitly_unsigned_long_cxx 3505 : /*C++98 UB*/ diag:: 3506 ext_old_implicitly_unsigned_long_cxx 3507 : diag::warn_old_implicitly_unsigned_long) 3508 << (LongLongSize > LongSize ? /*will have type 'long long'*/ 0 3509 : /*will be ill-formed*/ 1); 3510 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy; 3511 } 3512 Width = LongSize; 3513 } 3514 } 3515 3516 // Check long long if needed. 3517 if (Ty.isNull()) { 3518 unsigned LongLongSize = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth(); 3519 3520 // Does it fit in a unsigned long long? 3521 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongLongSize)) { 3522 // Does it fit in a signed long long? 3523 // To be compatible with MSVC, hex integer literals ending with the 3524 // LL or i64 suffix are always signed in Microsoft mode. 3525 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && (ResultVal[LongLongSize-1] == 0 || 3526 (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && Literal.isLongLong))) 3527 Ty = Context.LongLongTy; 3528 else if (AllowUnsigned) 3529 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy; 3530 Width = LongLongSize; 3531 } 3532 } 3533 3534 // If we still couldn't decide a type, we probably have something that 3535 // does not fit in a signed long long, but has no U suffix. 3536 if (Ty.isNull()) { 3537 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_integer_literal_too_large_for_signed); 3538 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy; 3539 Width = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth(); 3540 } 3541 3542 if (ResultVal.getBitWidth() != Width) 3543 ResultVal = ResultVal.trunc(Width); 3544 } 3545 Res = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, ResultVal, Ty, Tok.getLocation()); 3546 } 3547 3548 // If this is an imaginary literal, create the ImaginaryLiteral wrapper. 3549 if (Literal.isImaginary) { 3550 Res = new (Context) ImaginaryLiteral(Res, 3551 Context.getComplexType(Res->getType())); 3552 3553 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_imaginary_constant); 3554 } 3555 return Res; 3556 } 3557 3558 ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenExpr(SourceLocation L, SourceLocation R, Expr *E) { 3559 assert(E && "ActOnParenExpr() missing expr"); 3560 return new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, E); 3561 } 3562 3563 static bool CheckVecStepTraitOperandType(Sema &S, QualType T, 3564 SourceLocation Loc, 3565 SourceRange ArgRange) { 3566 // [OpenCL 1.1 6.11.12] "The vec_step built-in function takes a built-in 3567 // scalar or vector data type argument..." 3568 // Every built-in scalar type (OpenCL 1.1 6.1.1) is either an arithmetic 3569 // type (C99 6.2.5p18) or void. 3570 if (!(T->isArithmeticType() || T->isVoidType() || T->isVectorType())) { 3571 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_vecstep_non_scalar_vector_type) 3572 << T << ArgRange; 3573 return true; 3574 } 3575 3576 assert((T->isVoidType() || !T->isIncompleteType()) && 3577 "Scalar types should always be complete"); 3578 return false; 3579 } 3580 3581 static bool CheckExtensionTraitOperandType(Sema &S, QualType T, 3582 SourceLocation Loc, 3583 SourceRange ArgRange, 3584 UnaryExprOrTypeTrait TraitKind) { 3585 // Invalid types must be hard errors for SFINAE in C++. 3586 if (S.LangOpts.CPlusPlus) 3587 return true; 3588 3589 // C99 6.5.3.4p1: 3590 if (T->isFunctionType() && 3591 (TraitKind == UETT_SizeOf || TraitKind == UETT_AlignOf)) { 3592 // sizeof(function)/alignof(function) is allowed as an extension. 3593 S.Diag(Loc, diag::ext_sizeof_alignof_function_type) 3594 << TraitKind << ArgRange; 3595 return false; 3596 } 3597 3598 // Allow sizeof(void)/alignof(void) as an extension, unless in OpenCL where 3599 // this is an error (OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.k) 3600 if (T->isVoidType()) { 3601 unsigned DiagID = S.LangOpts.OpenCL ? diag::err_opencl_sizeof_alignof_type 3602 : diag::ext_sizeof_alignof_void_type; 3603 S.Diag(Loc, DiagID) << TraitKind << ArgRange; 3604 return false; 3605 } 3606 3607 return true; 3608 } 3609 3610 static bool CheckObjCTraitOperandConstraints(Sema &S, QualType T, 3611 SourceLocation Loc, 3612 SourceRange ArgRange, 3613 UnaryExprOrTypeTrait TraitKind) { 3614 // Reject sizeof(interface) and sizeof(interface<proto>) if the 3615 // runtime doesn't allow it. 3616 if (!S.LangOpts.ObjCRuntime.allowsSizeofAlignof() && T->isObjCObjectType()) { 3617 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_sizeof_nonfragile_interface) 3618 << T << (TraitKind == UETT_SizeOf) 3619 << ArgRange; 3620 return true; 3621 } 3622 3623 return false; 3624 } 3625 3626 /// Check whether E is a pointer from a decayed array type (the decayed 3627 /// pointer type is equal to T) and emit a warning if it is. 3628 static void warnOnSizeofOnArrayDecay(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T, 3629 Expr *E) { 3630 // Don't warn if the operation changed the type. 3631 if (T != E->getType()) 3632 return; 3633 3634 // Now look for array decays. 3635 ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E); 3636 if (!ICE || ICE->getCastKind() != CK_ArrayToPointerDecay) 3637 return; 3638 3639 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_sizeof_array_decay) << ICE->getSourceRange() 3640 << ICE->getType() 3641 << ICE->getSubExpr()->getType(); 3642 } 3643 3644 /// Check the constraints on expression operands to unary type expression 3645 /// and type traits. 3646 /// 3647 /// Completes any types necessary and validates the constraints on the operand 3648 /// expression. The logic mostly mirrors the type-based overload, but may modify 3649 /// the expression as it completes the type for that expression through template 3650 /// instantiation, etc. 3651 bool Sema::CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(Expr *E, 3652 UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind) { 3653 QualType ExprTy = E->getType(); 3654 assert(!ExprTy->isReferenceType()); 3655 3656 if (ExprKind == UETT_VecStep) 3657 return CheckVecStepTraitOperandType(*this, ExprTy, E->getExprLoc(), 3658 E->getSourceRange()); 3659 3660 // Whitelist some types as extensions 3661 if (!CheckExtensionTraitOperandType(*this, ExprTy, E->getExprLoc(), 3662 E->getSourceRange(), ExprKind)) 3663 return false; 3664 3665 // 'alignof' applied to an expression only requires the base element type of 3666 // the expression to be complete. 'sizeof' requires the expression's type to 3667 // be complete (and will attempt to complete it if it's an array of unknown 3668 // bound). 3669 if (ExprKind == UETT_AlignOf) { 3670 if (RequireCompleteType(E->getExprLoc(), 3671 Context.getBaseElementType(E->getType()), 3672 diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type, ExprKind, 3673 E->getSourceRange())) 3674 return true; 3675 } else { 3676 if (RequireCompleteExprType(E, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type, 3677 ExprKind, E->getSourceRange())) 3678 return true; 3679 } 3680 3681 // Completing the expression's type may have changed it. 3682 ExprTy = E->getType(); 3683 assert(!ExprTy->isReferenceType()); 3684 3685 if (ExprTy->isFunctionType()) { 3686 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_sizeof_alignof_function_type) 3687 << ExprKind << E->getSourceRange(); 3688 return true; 3689 } 3690 3691 // The operand for sizeof and alignof is in an unevaluated expression context, 3692 // so side effects could result in unintended consequences. 3693 if ((ExprKind == UETT_SizeOf || ExprKind == UETT_AlignOf) && 3694 !inTemplateInstantiation() && E->HasSideEffects(Context, false)) 3695 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_side_effects_unevaluated_context); 3696 3697 if (CheckObjCTraitOperandConstraints(*this, ExprTy, E->getExprLoc(), 3698 E->getSourceRange(), ExprKind)) 3699 return true; 3700 3701 if (ExprKind == UETT_SizeOf) { 3702 if (DeclRefExpr *DeclRef = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParens())) { 3703 if (ParmVarDecl *PVD = dyn_cast<ParmVarDecl>(DeclRef->getFoundDecl())) { 3704 QualType OType = PVD->getOriginalType(); 3705 QualType Type = PVD->getType(); 3706 if (Type->isPointerType() && OType->isArrayType()) { 3707 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_sizeof_array_param) 3708 << Type << OType; 3709 Diag(PVD->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at); 3710 } 3711 } 3712 } 3713 3714 // Warn on "sizeof(array op x)" and "sizeof(x op array)", where the array 3715 // decays into a pointer and returns an unintended result. This is most 3716 // likely a typo for "sizeof(array) op x". 3717 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E->IgnoreParens())) { 3718 warnOnSizeofOnArrayDecay(*this, BO->getOperatorLoc(), BO->getType(), 3719 BO->getLHS()); 3720 warnOnSizeofOnArrayDecay(*this, BO->getOperatorLoc(), BO->getType(), 3721 BO->getRHS()); 3722 } 3723 } 3724 3725 return false; 3726 } 3727 3728 /// Check the constraints on operands to unary expression and type 3729 /// traits. 3730 /// 3731 /// This will complete any types necessary, and validate the various constraints 3732 /// on those operands. 3733 /// 3734 /// The UsualUnaryConversions() function is *not* called by this routine. 3735 /// C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4] all state: 3736 /// Except when it is the operand of the sizeof operator ... 3737 /// 3738 /// C++ [expr.sizeof]p4 3739 /// The lvalue-to-rvalue, array-to-pointer, and function-to-pointer 3740 /// standard conversions are not applied to the operand of sizeof. 3741 /// 3742 /// This policy is followed for all of the unary trait expressions. 3743 bool Sema::CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(QualType ExprType, 3744 SourceLocation OpLoc, 3745 SourceRange ExprRange, 3746 UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind) { 3747 if (ExprType->isDependentType()) 3748 return false; 3749 3750 // C++ [expr.sizeof]p2: 3751 // When applied to a reference or a reference type, the result 3752 // is the size of the referenced type. 3753 // C++11 [expr.alignof]p3: 3754 // When alignof is applied to a reference type, the result 3755 // shall be the alignment of the referenced type. 3756 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = ExprType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 3757 ExprType = Ref->getPointeeType(); 3758 3759 // C11 6.5.3.4/3, C++11 [expr.alignof]p3: 3760 // When alignof or _Alignof is applied to an array type, the result 3761 // is the alignment of the element type. 3762 if (ExprKind == UETT_AlignOf || ExprKind == UETT_OpenMPRequiredSimdAlign) 3763 ExprType = Context.getBaseElementType(ExprType); 3764 3765 if (ExprKind == UETT_VecStep) 3766 return CheckVecStepTraitOperandType(*this, ExprType, OpLoc, ExprRange); 3767 3768 // Whitelist some types as extensions 3769 if (!CheckExtensionTraitOperandType(*this, ExprType, OpLoc, ExprRange, 3770 ExprKind)) 3771 return false; 3772 3773 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, ExprType, 3774 diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type, 3775 ExprKind, ExprRange)) 3776 return true; 3777 3778 if (ExprType->isFunctionType()) { 3779 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_function_type) 3780 << ExprKind << ExprRange; 3781 return true; 3782 } 3783 3784 if (CheckObjCTraitOperandConstraints(*this, ExprType, OpLoc, ExprRange, 3785 ExprKind)) 3786 return true; 3787 3788 return false; 3789 } 3790 3791 static bool CheckAlignOfExpr(Sema &S, Expr *E) { 3792 E = E->IgnoreParens(); 3793 3794 // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent. 3795 if (E->isTypeDependent()) 3796 return false; 3797 3798 if (E->getObjectKind() == OK_BitField) { 3799 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_sizeof_alignof_typeof_bitfield) 3800 << 1 << E->getSourceRange(); 3801 return true; 3802 } 3803 3804 ValueDecl *D = nullptr; 3805 if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) { 3806 D = DRE->getDecl(); 3807 } else if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E)) { 3808 D = ME->getMemberDecl(); 3809 } 3810 3811 // If it's a field, require the containing struct to have a 3812 // complete definition so that we can compute the layout. 3813 // 3814 // This can happen in C++11 onwards, either by naming the member 3815 // in a way that is not transformed into a member access expression 3816 // (in an unevaluated operand, for instance), or by naming the member 3817 // in a trailing-return-type. 3818 // 3819 // For the record, since __alignof__ on expressions is a GCC 3820 // extension, GCC seems to permit this but always gives the 3821 // nonsensical answer 0. 3822 // 3823 // We don't really need the layout here --- we could instead just 3824 // directly check for all the appropriate alignment-lowing 3825 // attributes --- but that would require duplicating a lot of 3826 // logic that just isn't worth duplicating for such a marginal 3827 // use-case. 3828 if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FieldDecl>(D)) { 3829 // Fast path this check, since we at least know the record has a 3830 // definition if we can find a member of it. 3831 if (!FD->getParent()->isCompleteDefinition()) { 3832 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_alignof_member_of_incomplete_type) 3833 << E->getSourceRange(); 3834 return true; 3835 } 3836 3837 // Otherwise, if it's a field, and the field doesn't have 3838 // reference type, then it must have a complete type (or be a 3839 // flexible array member, which we explicitly want to 3840 // white-list anyway), which makes the following checks trivial. 3841 if (!FD->getType()->isReferenceType()) 3842 return false; 3843 } 3844 3845 return S.CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(E, UETT_AlignOf); 3846 } 3847 3848 bool Sema::CheckVecStepExpr(Expr *E) { 3849 E = E->IgnoreParens(); 3850 3851 // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent. 3852 if (E->isTypeDependent()) 3853 return false; 3854 3855 return CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(E, UETT_VecStep); 3856 } 3857 3858 static void captureVariablyModifiedType(ASTContext &Context, QualType T, 3859 CapturingScopeInfo *CSI) { 3860 assert(T->isVariablyModifiedType()); 3861 assert(CSI != nullptr); 3862 3863 // We're going to walk down into the type and look for VLA expressions. 3864 do { 3865 const Type *Ty = T.getTypePtr(); 3866 switch (Ty->getTypeClass()) { 3867 #define TYPE(Class, Base) 3868 #define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base) 3869 #define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base) 3870 #define DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class: 3871 #define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) 3872 #include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def" 3873 T = QualType(); 3874 break; 3875 // These types are never variably-modified. 3876 case Type::Builtin: 3877 case Type::Complex: 3878 case Type::Vector: 3879 case Type::ExtVector: 3880 case Type::Record: 3881 case Type::Enum: 3882 case Type::Elaborated: 3883 case Type::TemplateSpecialization: 3884 case Type::ObjCObject: 3885 case Type::ObjCInterface: 3886 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer: 3887 case Type::ObjCTypeParam: 3888 case Type::Pipe: 3889 llvm_unreachable("type class is never variably-modified!"); 3890 case Type::Adjusted: 3891 T = cast<AdjustedType>(Ty)->getOriginalType(); 3892 break; 3893 case Type::Decayed: 3894 T = cast<DecayedType>(Ty)->getPointeeType(); 3895 break; 3896 case Type::Pointer: 3897 T = cast<PointerType>(Ty)->getPointeeType(); 3898 break; 3899 case Type::BlockPointer: 3900 T = cast<BlockPointerType>(Ty)->getPointeeType(); 3901 break; 3902 case Type::LValueReference: 3903 case Type::RValueReference: 3904 T = cast<ReferenceType>(Ty)->getPointeeType(); 3905 break; 3906 case Type::MemberPointer: 3907 T = cast<MemberPointerType>(Ty)->getPointeeType(); 3908 break; 3909 case Type::ConstantArray: 3910 case Type::IncompleteArray: 3911 // Losing element qualification here is fine. 3912 T = cast<ArrayType>(Ty)->getElementType(); 3913 break; 3914 case Type::VariableArray: { 3915 // Losing element qualification here is fine. 3916 const VariableArrayType *VAT = cast<VariableArrayType>(Ty); 3917 3918 // Unknown size indication requires no size computation. 3919 // Otherwise, evaluate and record it. 3920 if (auto Size = VAT->getSizeExpr()) { 3921 if (!CSI->isVLATypeCaptured(VAT)) { 3922 RecordDecl *CapRecord = nullptr; 3923 if (auto LSI = dyn_cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI)) { 3924 CapRecord = LSI->Lambda; 3925 } else if (auto CRSI = dyn_cast<CapturedRegionScopeInfo>(CSI)) { 3926 CapRecord = CRSI->TheRecordDecl; 3927 } 3928 if (CapRecord) { 3929 auto ExprLoc = Size->getExprLoc(); 3930 auto SizeType = Context.getSizeType(); 3931 // Build the non-static data member. 3932 auto Field = 3933 FieldDecl::Create(Context, CapRecord, ExprLoc, ExprLoc, 3934 /*Id*/ nullptr, SizeType, /*TInfo*/ nullptr, 3935 /*BW*/ nullptr, /*Mutable*/ false, 3936 /*InitStyle*/ ICIS_NoInit); 3937 Field->setImplicit(true); 3938 Field->setAccess(AS_private); 3939 Field->setCapturedVLAType(VAT); 3940 CapRecord->addDecl(Field); 3941 3942 CSI->addVLATypeCapture(ExprLoc, SizeType); 3943 } 3944 } 3945 } 3946 T = VAT->getElementType(); 3947 break; 3948 } 3949 case Type::FunctionProto: 3950 case Type::FunctionNoProto: 3951 T = cast<FunctionType>(Ty)->getReturnType(); 3952 break; 3953 case Type::Paren: 3954 case Type::TypeOf: 3955 case Type::UnaryTransform: 3956 case Type::Attributed: 3957 case Type::SubstTemplateTypeParm: 3958 case Type::PackExpansion: 3959 // Keep walking after single level desugaring. 3960 T = T.getSingleStepDesugaredType(Context); 3961 break; 3962 case Type::Typedef: 3963 T = cast<TypedefType>(Ty)->desugar(); 3964 break; 3965 case Type::Decltype: 3966 T = cast<DecltypeType>(Ty)->desugar(); 3967 break; 3968 case Type::Auto: 3969 case Type::DeducedTemplateSpecialization: 3970 T = cast<DeducedType>(Ty)->getDeducedType(); 3971 break; 3972 case Type::TypeOfExpr: 3973 T = cast<TypeOfExprType>(Ty)->getUnderlyingExpr()->getType(); 3974 break; 3975 case Type::Atomic: 3976 T = cast<AtomicType>(Ty)->getValueType(); 3977 break; 3978 } 3979 } while (!T.isNull() && T->isVariablyModifiedType()); 3980 } 3981 3982 /// Build a sizeof or alignof expression given a type operand. 3983 ExprResult 3984 Sema::CreateUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, 3985 SourceLocation OpLoc, 3986 UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind, 3987 SourceRange R) { 3988 if (!TInfo) 3989 return ExprError(); 3990 3991 QualType T = TInfo->getType(); 3992 3993 if (!T->isDependentType() && 3994 CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(T, OpLoc, R, ExprKind)) 3995 return ExprError(); 3996 3997 if (T->isVariablyModifiedType() && FunctionScopes.size() > 1) { 3998 if (auto *TT = T->getAs<TypedefType>()) { 3999 for (auto I = FunctionScopes.rbegin(), 4000 E = std::prev(FunctionScopes.rend()); 4001 I != E; ++I) { 4002 auto *CSI = dyn_cast<CapturingScopeInfo>(*I); 4003 if (CSI == nullptr) 4004 break; 4005 DeclContext *DC = nullptr; 4006 if (auto *LSI = dyn_cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI)) 4007 DC = LSI->CallOperator; 4008 else if (auto *CRSI = dyn_cast<CapturedRegionScopeInfo>(CSI)) 4009 DC = CRSI->TheCapturedDecl; 4010 else if (auto *BSI = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(CSI)) 4011 DC = BSI->TheDecl; 4012 if (DC) { 4013 if (DC->containsDecl(TT->getDecl())) 4014 break; 4015 captureVariablyModifiedType(Context, T, CSI); 4016 } 4017 } 4018 } 4019 } 4020 4021 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t. 4022 return new (Context) UnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr( 4023 ExprKind, TInfo, Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc, R.getEnd()); 4024 } 4025 4026 /// Build a sizeof or alignof expression given an expression 4027 /// operand. 4028 ExprResult 4029 Sema::CreateUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc, 4030 UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind) { 4031 ExprResult PE = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E); 4032 if (PE.isInvalid()) 4033 return ExprError(); 4034 4035 E = PE.get(); 4036 4037 // Verify that the operand is valid. 4038 bool isInvalid = false; 4039 if (E->isTypeDependent()) { 4040 // Delay type-checking for type-dependent expressions. 4041 } else if (ExprKind == UETT_AlignOf) { 4042 isInvalid = CheckAlignOfExpr(*this, E); 4043 } else if (ExprKind == UETT_VecStep) { 4044 isInvalid = CheckVecStepExpr(E); 4045 } else if (ExprKind == UETT_OpenMPRequiredSimdAlign) { 4046 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_openmp_default_simd_align_expr); 4047 isInvalid = true; 4048 } else if (E->refersToBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.4p1. 4049 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_sizeof_alignof_typeof_bitfield) << 0; 4050 isInvalid = true; 4051 } else { 4052 isInvalid = CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(E, UETT_SizeOf); 4053 } 4054 4055 if (isInvalid) 4056 return ExprError(); 4057 4058 if (ExprKind == UETT_SizeOf && E->getType()->isVariableArrayType()) { 4059 PE = TransformToPotentiallyEvaluated(E); 4060 if (PE.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 4061 E = PE.get(); 4062 } 4063 4064 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t. 4065 return new (Context) UnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr( 4066 ExprKind, E, Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc, E->getSourceRange().getEnd()); 4067 } 4068 4069 /// ActOnUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr - Handle @c sizeof(type) and @c sizeof @c 4070 /// expr and the same for @c alignof and @c __alignof 4071 /// Note that the ArgRange is invalid if isType is false. 4072 ExprResult 4073 Sema::ActOnUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(SourceLocation OpLoc, 4074 UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind, bool IsType, 4075 void *TyOrEx, SourceRange ArgRange) { 4076 // If error parsing type, ignore. 4077 if (!TyOrEx) return ExprError(); 4078 4079 if (IsType) { 4080 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo; 4081 (void) GetTypeFromParser(ParsedType::getFromOpaquePtr(TyOrEx), &TInfo); 4082 return CreateUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(TInfo, OpLoc, ExprKind, ArgRange); 4083 } 4084 4085 Expr *ArgEx = (Expr *)TyOrEx; 4086 ExprResult Result = CreateUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(ArgEx, OpLoc, ExprKind); 4087 return Result; 4088 } 4089 4090 static QualType CheckRealImagOperand(Sema &S, ExprResult &V, SourceLocation Loc, 4091 bool IsReal) { 4092 if (V.get()->isTypeDependent()) 4093 return S.Context.DependentTy; 4094 4095 // _Real and _Imag are only l-values for normal l-values. 4096 if (V.get()->getObjectKind() != OK_Ordinary) { 4097 V = S.DefaultLvalueConversion(V.get()); 4098 if (V.isInvalid()) 4099 return QualType(); 4100 } 4101 4102 // These operators return the element type of a complex type. 4103 if (const ComplexType *CT = V.get()->getType()->getAs<ComplexType>()) 4104 return CT->getElementType(); 4105 4106 // Otherwise they pass through real integer and floating point types here. 4107 if (V.get()->getType()->isArithmeticType()) 4108 return V.get()->getType(); 4109 4110 // Test for placeholders. 4111 ExprResult PR = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(V.get()); 4112 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType(); 4113 if (PR.get() != V.get()) { 4114 V = PR; 4115 return CheckRealImagOperand(S, V, Loc, IsReal); 4116 } 4117 4118 // Reject anything else. 4119 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_realimag_invalid_type) << V.get()->getType() 4120 << (IsReal ? "__real" : "__imag"); 4121 return QualType(); 4122 } 4123 4124 4125 4126 ExprResult 4127 Sema::ActOnPostfixUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc, 4128 tok::TokenKind Kind, Expr *Input) { 4129 UnaryOperatorKind Opc; 4130 switch (Kind) { 4131 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown unary op!"); 4132 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PostInc; break; 4133 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PostDec; break; 4134 } 4135 4136 // Since this might is a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs. 4137 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Input); 4138 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 4139 Input = Result.get(); 4140 4141 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, Opc, Input); 4142 } 4143 4144 /// Diagnose if arithmetic on the given ObjC pointer is illegal. 4145 /// 4146 /// \return true on error 4147 static bool checkArithmeticOnObjCPointer(Sema &S, 4148 SourceLocation opLoc, 4149 Expr *op) { 4150 assert(op->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()); 4151 if (S.LangOpts.ObjCRuntime.allowsPointerArithmetic() && 4152 !S.LangOpts.ObjCSubscriptingLegacyRuntime) 4153 return false; 4154 4155 S.Diag(opLoc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface) 4156 << op->getType()->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType() 4157 << op->getSourceRange(); 4158 return true; 4159 } 4160 4161 static bool isMSPropertySubscriptExpr(Sema &S, Expr *Base) { 4162 auto *BaseNoParens = Base->IgnoreParens(); 4163 if (auto *MSProp = dyn_cast<MSPropertyRefExpr>(BaseNoParens)) 4164 return MSProp->getPropertyDecl()->getType()->isArrayType(); 4165 return isa<MSPropertySubscriptExpr>(BaseNoParens); 4166 } 4167 4168 ExprResult 4169 Sema::ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(Scope *S, Expr *base, SourceLocation lbLoc, 4170 Expr *idx, SourceLocation rbLoc) { 4171 if (base && !base->getType().isNull() && 4172 base->getType()->isSpecificPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::OMPArraySection)) 4173 return ActOnOMPArraySectionExpr(base, lbLoc, idx, SourceLocation(), 4174 /*Length=*/nullptr, rbLoc); 4175 4176 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs. 4177 if (isa<ParenListExpr>(base)) { 4178 ExprResult result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, base); 4179 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 4180 base = result.get(); 4181 } 4182 4183 // Handle any non-overload placeholder types in the base and index 4184 // expressions. We can't handle overloads here because the other 4185 // operand might be an overloadable type, in which case the overload 4186 // resolution for the operator overload should get the first crack 4187 // at the overload. 4188 bool IsMSPropertySubscript = false; 4189 if (base->getType()->isNonOverloadPlaceholderType()) { 4190 IsMSPropertySubscript = isMSPropertySubscriptExpr(*this, base); 4191 if (!IsMSPropertySubscript) { 4192 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(base); 4193 if (result.isInvalid()) 4194 return ExprError(); 4195 base = result.get(); 4196 } 4197 } 4198 if (idx->getType()->isNonOverloadPlaceholderType()) { 4199 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(idx); 4200 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 4201 idx = result.get(); 4202 } 4203 4204 // Build an unanalyzed expression if either operand is type-dependent. 4205 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 4206 (base->isTypeDependent() || idx->isTypeDependent())) { 4207 return new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(base, idx, Context.DependentTy, 4208 VK_LValue, OK_Ordinary, rbLoc); 4209 } 4210 4211 // MSDN, property (C++) 4212 // https://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/yhfk0thd(v=vs.120).aspx 4213 // This attribute can also be used in the declaration of an empty array in a 4214 // class or structure definition. For example: 4215 // __declspec(property(get=GetX, put=PutX)) int x[]; 4216 // The above statement indicates that x[] can be used with one or more array 4217 // indices. In this case, i=p->x[a][b] will be turned into i=p->GetX(a, b), 4218 // and p->x[a][b] = i will be turned into p->PutX(a, b, i); 4219 if (IsMSPropertySubscript) { 4220 // Build MS property subscript expression if base is MS property reference 4221 // or MS property subscript. 4222 return new (Context) MSPropertySubscriptExpr( 4223 base, idx, Context.PseudoObjectTy, VK_LValue, OK_Ordinary, rbLoc); 4224 } 4225 4226 // Use C++ overloaded-operator rules if either operand has record 4227 // type. The spec says to do this if either type is *overloadable*, 4228 // but enum types can't declare subscript operators or conversion 4229 // operators, so there's nothing interesting for overload resolution 4230 // to do if there aren't any record types involved. 4231 // 4232 // ObjC pointers have their own subscripting logic that is not tied 4233 // to overload resolution and so should not take this path. 4234 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 4235 (base->getType()->isRecordType() || 4236 (!base->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() && 4237 idx->getType()->isRecordType()))) { 4238 return CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(lbLoc, rbLoc, base, idx); 4239 } 4240 4241 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(base, lbLoc, idx, rbLoc); 4242 } 4243 4244 ExprResult Sema::ActOnOMPArraySectionExpr(Expr *Base, SourceLocation LBLoc, 4245 Expr *LowerBound, 4246 SourceLocation ColonLoc, Expr *Length, 4247 SourceLocation RBLoc) { 4248 if (Base->getType()->isPlaceholderType() && 4249 !Base->getType()->isSpecificPlaceholderType( 4250 BuiltinType::OMPArraySection)) { 4251 ExprResult Result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Base); 4252 if (Result.isInvalid()) 4253 return ExprError(); 4254 Base = Result.get(); 4255 } 4256 if (LowerBound && LowerBound->getType()->isNonOverloadPlaceholderType()) { 4257 ExprResult Result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(LowerBound); 4258 if (Result.isInvalid()) 4259 return ExprError(); 4260 Result = DefaultLvalueConversion(Result.get()); 4261 if (Result.isInvalid()) 4262 return ExprError(); 4263 LowerBound = Result.get(); 4264 } 4265 if (Length && Length->getType()->isNonOverloadPlaceholderType()) { 4266 ExprResult Result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Length); 4267 if (Result.isInvalid()) 4268 return ExprError(); 4269 Result = DefaultLvalueConversion(Result.get()); 4270 if (Result.isInvalid()) 4271 return ExprError(); 4272 Length = Result.get(); 4273 } 4274 4275 // Build an unanalyzed expression if either operand is type-dependent. 4276 if (Base->isTypeDependent() || 4277 (LowerBound && 4278 (LowerBound->isTypeDependent() || LowerBound->isValueDependent())) || 4279 (Length && (Length->isTypeDependent() || Length->isValueDependent()))) { 4280 return new (Context) 4281 OMPArraySectionExpr(Base, LowerBound, Length, Context.DependentTy, 4282 VK_LValue, OK_Ordinary, ColonLoc, RBLoc); 4283 } 4284 4285 // Perform default conversions. 4286 QualType OriginalTy = OMPArraySectionExpr::getBaseOriginalType(Base); 4287 QualType ResultTy; 4288 if (OriginalTy->isAnyPointerType()) { 4289 ResultTy = OriginalTy->getPointeeType(); 4290 } else if (OriginalTy->isArrayType()) { 4291 ResultTy = OriginalTy->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe()->getElementType(); 4292 } else { 4293 return ExprError( 4294 Diag(Base->getExprLoc(), diag::err_omp_typecheck_section_value) 4295 << Base->getSourceRange()); 4296 } 4297 // C99 6.5.2.1p1 4298 if (LowerBound) { 4299 auto Res = PerformOpenMPImplicitIntegerConversion(LowerBound->getExprLoc(), 4300 LowerBound); 4301 if (Res.isInvalid()) 4302 return ExprError(Diag(LowerBound->getExprLoc(), 4303 diag::err_omp_typecheck_section_not_integer) 4304 << 0 << LowerBound->getSourceRange()); 4305 LowerBound = Res.get(); 4306 4307 if (LowerBound->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) || 4308 LowerBound->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U)) 4309 Diag(LowerBound->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_omp_section_is_char) 4310 << 0 << LowerBound->getSourceRange(); 4311 } 4312 if (Length) { 4313 auto Res = 4314 PerformOpenMPImplicitIntegerConversion(Length->getExprLoc(), Length); 4315 if (Res.isInvalid()) 4316 return ExprError(Diag(Length->getExprLoc(), 4317 diag::err_omp_typecheck_section_not_integer) 4318 << 1 << Length->getSourceRange()); 4319 Length = Res.get(); 4320 4321 if (Length->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) || 4322 Length->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U)) 4323 Diag(Length->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_omp_section_is_char) 4324 << 1 << Length->getSourceRange(); 4325 } 4326 4327 // C99 6.5.2.1p1: "shall have type "pointer to *object* type". Similarly, 4328 // C++ [expr.sub]p1: The type "T" shall be a completely-defined object 4329 // type. Note that functions are not objects, and that (in C99 parlance) 4330 // incomplete types are not object types. 4331 if (ResultTy->isFunctionType()) { 4332 Diag(Base->getExprLoc(), diag::err_omp_section_function_type) 4333 << ResultTy << Base->getSourceRange(); 4334 return ExprError(); 4335 } 4336 4337 if (RequireCompleteType(Base->getExprLoc(), ResultTy, 4338 diag::err_omp_section_incomplete_type, Base)) 4339 return ExprError(); 4340 4341 if (LowerBound && !OriginalTy->isAnyPointerType()) { 4342 llvm::APSInt LowerBoundValue; 4343 if (LowerBound->EvaluateAsInt(LowerBoundValue, Context)) { 4344 // OpenMP 4.5, [2.4 Array Sections] 4345 // The array section must be a subset of the original array. 4346 if (LowerBoundValue.isNegative()) { 4347 Diag(LowerBound->getExprLoc(), diag::err_omp_section_not_subset_of_array) 4348 << LowerBound->getSourceRange(); 4349 return ExprError(); 4350 } 4351 } 4352 } 4353 4354 if (Length) { 4355 llvm::APSInt LengthValue; 4356 if (Length->EvaluateAsInt(LengthValue, Context)) { 4357 // OpenMP 4.5, [2.4 Array Sections] 4358 // The length must evaluate to non-negative integers. 4359 if (LengthValue.isNegative()) { 4360 Diag(Length->getExprLoc(), diag::err_omp_section_length_negative) 4361 << LengthValue.toString(/*Radix=*/10, /*Signed=*/true) 4362 << Length->getSourceRange(); 4363 return ExprError(); 4364 } 4365 } 4366 } else if (ColonLoc.isValid() && 4367 (OriginalTy.isNull() || (!OriginalTy->isConstantArrayType() && 4368 !OriginalTy->isVariableArrayType()))) { 4369 // OpenMP 4.5, [2.4 Array Sections] 4370 // When the size of the array dimension is not known, the length must be 4371 // specified explicitly. 4372 Diag(ColonLoc, diag::err_omp_section_length_undefined) 4373 << (!OriginalTy.isNull() && OriginalTy->isArrayType()); 4374 return ExprError(); 4375 } 4376 4377 if (!Base->getType()->isSpecificPlaceholderType( 4378 BuiltinType::OMPArraySection)) { 4379 ExprResult Result = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Base); 4380 if (Result.isInvalid()) 4381 return ExprError(); 4382 Base = Result.get(); 4383 } 4384 return new (Context) 4385 OMPArraySectionExpr(Base, LowerBound, Length, Context.OMPArraySectionTy, 4386 VK_LValue, OK_Ordinary, ColonLoc, RBLoc); 4387 } 4388 4389 ExprResult 4390 Sema::CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc, 4391 Expr *Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) { 4392 Expr *LHSExp = Base; 4393 Expr *RHSExp = Idx; 4394 4395 ExprValueKind VK = VK_LValue; 4396 ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary; 4397 4398 // Per C++ core issue 1213, the result is an xvalue if either operand is 4399 // a non-lvalue array, and an lvalue otherwise. 4400 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) { 4401 for (auto *Op : {LHSExp, RHSExp}) { 4402 Op = Op->IgnoreImplicit(); 4403 if (Op->getType()->isArrayType() && !Op->isLValue()) 4404 VK = VK_XValue; 4405 } 4406 } 4407 4408 // Perform default conversions. 4409 if (!LHSExp->getType()->getAs<VectorType>()) { 4410 ExprResult Result = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHSExp); 4411 if (Result.isInvalid()) 4412 return ExprError(); 4413 LHSExp = Result.get(); 4414 } 4415 ExprResult Result = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHSExp); 4416 if (Result.isInvalid()) 4417 return ExprError(); 4418 RHSExp = Result.get(); 4419 4420 QualType LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExp->getType(); 4421 4422 // C99 6.5.2.1p2: the expression e1[e2] is by definition precisely equivalent 4423 // to the expression *((e1)+(e2)). This means the array "Base" may actually be 4424 // in the subscript position. As a result, we need to derive the array base 4425 // and index from the expression types. 4426 Expr *BaseExpr, *IndexExpr; 4427 QualType ResultType; 4428 if (LHSTy->isDependentType() || RHSTy->isDependentType()) { 4429 BaseExpr = LHSExp; 4430 IndexExpr = RHSExp; 4431 ResultType = Context.DependentTy; 4432 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) { 4433 BaseExpr = LHSExp; 4434 IndexExpr = RHSExp; 4435 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType(); 4436 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy = 4437 LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { 4438 BaseExpr = LHSExp; 4439 IndexExpr = RHSExp; 4440 4441 // Use custom logic if this should be the pseudo-object subscript 4442 // expression. 4443 if (!LangOpts.isSubscriptPointerArithmetic()) 4444 return BuildObjCSubscriptExpression(RLoc, BaseExpr, IndexExpr, nullptr, 4445 nullptr); 4446 4447 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType(); 4448 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) { 4449 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]". 4450 BaseExpr = RHSExp; 4451 IndexExpr = LHSExp; 4452 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType(); 4453 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy = 4454 RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { 4455 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]". 4456 BaseExpr = RHSExp; 4457 IndexExpr = LHSExp; 4458 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType(); 4459 if (!LangOpts.isSubscriptPointerArithmetic()) { 4460 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_subscript_nonfragile_interface) 4461 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange(); 4462 return ExprError(); 4463 } 4464 } else if (const VectorType *VTy = LHSTy->getAs<VectorType>()) { 4465 BaseExpr = LHSExp; // vectors: V[123] 4466 IndexExpr = RHSExp; 4467 // We apply C++ DR1213 to vector subscripting too. 4468 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && LHSExp->getValueKind() == VK_RValue) { 4469 ExprResult Materialized = TemporaryMaterializationConversion(LHSExp); 4470 if (Materialized.isInvalid()) 4471 return ExprError(); 4472 LHSExp = Materialized.get(); 4473 } 4474 VK = LHSExp->getValueKind(); 4475 if (VK != VK_RValue) 4476 OK = OK_VectorComponent; 4477 4478 ResultType = VTy->getElementType(); 4479 QualType BaseType = BaseExpr->getType(); 4480 Qualifiers BaseQuals = BaseType.getQualifiers(); 4481 Qualifiers MemberQuals = ResultType.getQualifiers(); 4482 Qualifiers Combined = BaseQuals + MemberQuals; 4483 if (Combined != MemberQuals) 4484 ResultType = Context.getQualifiedType(ResultType, Combined); 4485 } else if (LHSTy->isArrayType()) { 4486 // If we see an array that wasn't promoted by 4487 // DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion, it must be an array that 4488 // wasn't promoted because of the C90 rule that doesn't 4489 // allow promoting non-lvalue arrays. Warn, then 4490 // force the promotion here. 4491 Diag(LHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) << 4492 LHSExp->getSourceRange(); 4493 LHSExp = ImpCastExprToType(LHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(LHSTy), 4494 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay).get(); 4495 LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(); 4496 4497 BaseExpr = LHSExp; 4498 IndexExpr = RHSExp; 4499 ResultType = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 4500 } else if (RHSTy->isArrayType()) { 4501 // Same as previous, except for 123[f().a] case 4502 Diag(RHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) << 4503 RHSExp->getSourceRange(); 4504 RHSExp = ImpCastExprToType(RHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(RHSTy), 4505 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay).get(); 4506 RHSTy = RHSExp->getType(); 4507 4508 BaseExpr = RHSExp; 4509 IndexExpr = LHSExp; 4510 ResultType = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 4511 } else { 4512 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_value) 4513 << LHSExp->getSourceRange() << RHSExp->getSourceRange()); 4514 } 4515 // C99 6.5.2.1p1 4516 if (!IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent()) 4517 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer) 4518 << IndexExpr->getSourceRange()); 4519 4520 if ((IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) || 4521 IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U)) 4522 && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent()) 4523 Diag(LLoc, diag::warn_subscript_is_char) << IndexExpr->getSourceRange(); 4524 4525 // C99 6.5.2.1p1: "shall have type "pointer to *object* type". Similarly, 4526 // C++ [expr.sub]p1: The type "T" shall be a completely-defined object 4527 // type. Note that Functions are not objects, and that (in C99 parlance) 4528 // incomplete types are not object types. 4529 if (ResultType->isFunctionType()) { 4530 Diag(BaseExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_subscript_function_type) 4531 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange(); 4532 return ExprError(); 4533 } 4534 4535 if (ResultType->isVoidType() && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 4536 // GNU extension: subscripting on pointer to void 4537 Diag(LLoc, diag::ext_gnu_subscript_void_type) 4538 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange(); 4539 4540 // C forbids expressions of unqualified void type from being l-values. 4541 // See IsCForbiddenLValueType. 4542 if (!ResultType.hasQualifiers()) VK = VK_RValue; 4543 } else if (!ResultType->isDependentType() && 4544 RequireCompleteType(LLoc, ResultType, 4545 diag::err_subscript_incomplete_type, BaseExpr)) 4546 return ExprError(); 4547 4548 assert(VK == VK_RValue || LangOpts.CPlusPlus || 4549 !ResultType.isCForbiddenLValueType()); 4550 4551 return new (Context) 4552 ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp, ResultType, VK, OK, RLoc); 4553 } 4554 4555 bool Sema::CheckCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc, FunctionDecl *FD, 4556 ParmVarDecl *Param) { 4557 if (Param->hasUnparsedDefaultArg()) { 4558 Diag(CallLoc, 4559 diag::err_use_of_default_argument_to_function_declared_later) << 4560 FD << cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getDeclName(); 4561 Diag(UnparsedDefaultArgLocs[Param], 4562 diag::note_default_argument_declared_here); 4563 return true; 4564 } 4565 4566 if (Param->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg()) { 4567 Expr *UninstExpr = Param->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg(); 4568 4569 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext EvalContext( 4570 *this, ExpressionEvaluationContext::PotentiallyEvaluated, Param); 4571 4572 // Instantiate the expression. 4573 // 4574 // FIXME: Pass in a correct Pattern argument, otherwise 4575 // getTemplateInstantiationArgs uses the lexical context of FD, e.g. 4576 // 4577 // template<typename T> 4578 // struct A { 4579 // static int FooImpl(); 4580 // 4581 // template<typename Tp> 4582 // // bug: default argument A<T>::FooImpl() is evaluated with 2-level 4583 // // template argument list [[T], [Tp]], should be [[Tp]]. 4584 // friend A<Tp> Foo(int a); 4585 // }; 4586 // 4587 // template<typename T> 4588 // A<T> Foo(int a = A<T>::FooImpl()); 4589 MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList MutiLevelArgList 4590 = getTemplateInstantiationArgs(FD, nullptr, /*RelativeToPrimary=*/true); 4591 4592 InstantiatingTemplate Inst(*this, CallLoc, Param, 4593 MutiLevelArgList.getInnermost()); 4594 if (Inst.isInvalid()) 4595 return true; 4596 if (Inst.isAlreadyInstantiating()) { 4597 Diag(Param->getLocStart(), diag::err_recursive_default_argument) << FD; 4598 Param->setInvalidDecl(); 4599 return true; 4600 } 4601 4602 ExprResult Result; 4603 { 4604 // C++ [dcl.fct.default]p5: 4605 // The names in the [default argument] expression are bound, and 4606 // the semantic constraints are checked, at the point where the 4607 // default argument expression appears. 4608 ContextRAII SavedContext(*this, FD); 4609 LocalInstantiationScope Local(*this); 4610 Result = SubstInitializer(UninstExpr, MutiLevelArgList, 4611 /*DirectInit*/false); 4612 } 4613 if (Result.isInvalid()) 4614 return true; 4615 4616 // Check the expression as an initializer for the parameter. 4617 InitializedEntity Entity 4618 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, Param); 4619 InitializationKind Kind 4620 = InitializationKind::CreateCopy(Param->getLocation(), 4621 /*FIXME:EqualLoc*/UninstExpr->getLocStart()); 4622 Expr *ResultE = Result.getAs<Expr>(); 4623 4624 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, ResultE); 4625 Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind, ResultE); 4626 if (Result.isInvalid()) 4627 return true; 4628 4629 Result = ActOnFinishFullExpr(Result.getAs<Expr>(), 4630 Param->getOuterLocStart()); 4631 if (Result.isInvalid()) 4632 return true; 4633 4634 // Remember the instantiated default argument. 4635 Param->setDefaultArg(Result.getAs<Expr>()); 4636 if (ASTMutationListener *L = getASTMutationListener()) { 4637 L->DefaultArgumentInstantiated(Param); 4638 } 4639 } 4640 4641 // If the default argument expression is not set yet, we are building it now. 4642 if (!Param->hasInit()) { 4643 Diag(Param->getLocStart(), diag::err_recursive_default_argument) << FD; 4644 Param->setInvalidDecl(); 4645 return true; 4646 } 4647 4648 // If the default expression creates temporaries, we need to 4649 // push them to the current stack of expression temporaries so they'll 4650 // be properly destroyed. 4651 // FIXME: We should really be rebuilding the default argument with new 4652 // bound temporaries; see the comment in PR5810. 4653 // We don't need to do that with block decls, though, because 4654 // blocks in default argument expression can never capture anything. 4655 if (auto Init = dyn_cast<ExprWithCleanups>(Param->getInit())) { 4656 // Set the "needs cleanups" bit regardless of whether there are 4657 // any explicit objects. 4658 Cleanup.setExprNeedsCleanups(Init->cleanupsHaveSideEffects()); 4659 4660 // Append all the objects to the cleanup list. Right now, this 4661 // should always be a no-op, because blocks in default argument 4662 // expressions should never be able to capture anything. 4663 assert(!Init->getNumObjects() && 4664 "default argument expression has capturing blocks?"); 4665 } 4666 4667 // We already type-checked the argument, so we know it works. 4668 // Just mark all of the declarations in this potentially-evaluated expression 4669 // as being "referenced". 4670 MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Param->getDefaultArg(), 4671 /*SkipLocalVariables=*/true); 4672 return false; 4673 } 4674 4675 ExprResult Sema::BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc, 4676 FunctionDecl *FD, ParmVarDecl *Param) { 4677 if (CheckCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, FD, Param)) 4678 return ExprError(); 4679 return CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param); 4680 } 4681 4682 Sema::VariadicCallType 4683 Sema::getVariadicCallType(FunctionDecl *FDecl, const FunctionProtoType *Proto, 4684 Expr *Fn) { 4685 if (Proto && Proto->isVariadic()) { 4686 if (dyn_cast_or_null<CXXConstructorDecl>(FDecl)) 4687 return VariadicConstructor; 4688 else if (Fn && Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()) 4689 return VariadicBlock; 4690 else if (FDecl) { 4691 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl)) 4692 if (Method->isInstance()) 4693 return VariadicMethod; 4694 } else if (Fn && Fn->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy) 4695 return VariadicMethod; 4696 return VariadicFunction; 4697 } 4698 return VariadicDoesNotApply; 4699 } 4700 4701 namespace { 4702 class FunctionCallCCC : public FunctionCallFilterCCC { 4703 public: 4704 FunctionCallCCC(Sema &SemaRef, const IdentifierInfo *FuncName, 4705 unsigned NumArgs, MemberExpr *ME) 4706 : FunctionCallFilterCCC(SemaRef, NumArgs, false, ME), 4707 FunctionName(FuncName) {} 4708 4709 bool ValidateCandidate(const TypoCorrection &candidate) override { 4710 if (!candidate.getCorrectionSpecifier() || 4711 candidate.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo() != FunctionName) { 4712 return false; 4713 } 4714 4715 return FunctionCallFilterCCC::ValidateCandidate(candidate); 4716 } 4717 4718 private: 4719 const IdentifierInfo *const FunctionName; 4720 }; 4721 } 4722 4723 static TypoCorrection TryTypoCorrectionForCall(Sema &S, Expr *Fn, 4724 FunctionDecl *FDecl, 4725 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) { 4726 MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(Fn); 4727 DeclarationName FuncName = FDecl->getDeclName(); 4728 SourceLocation NameLoc = ME ? ME->getMemberLoc() : Fn->getLocStart(); 4729 4730 if (TypoCorrection Corrected = S.CorrectTypo( 4731 DeclarationNameInfo(FuncName, NameLoc), Sema::LookupOrdinaryName, 4732 S.getScopeForContext(S.CurContext), nullptr, 4733 llvm::make_unique<FunctionCallCCC>(S, FuncName.getAsIdentifierInfo(), 4734 Args.size(), ME), 4735 Sema::CTK_ErrorRecovery)) { 4736 if (NamedDecl *ND = Corrected.getFoundDecl()) { 4737 if (Corrected.isOverloaded()) { 4738 OverloadCandidateSet OCS(NameLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 4739 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 4740 for (NamedDecl *CD : Corrected) { 4741 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CD)) 4742 S.AddOverloadCandidate(FD, DeclAccessPair::make(FD, AS_none), Args, 4743 OCS); 4744 } 4745 switch (OCS.BestViableFunction(S, NameLoc, Best)) { 4746 case OR_Success: 4747 ND = Best->FoundDecl; 4748 Corrected.setCorrectionDecl(ND); 4749 break; 4750 default: 4751 break; 4752 } 4753 } 4754 ND = ND->getUnderlyingDecl(); 4755 if (isa<ValueDecl>(ND) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(ND)) 4756 return Corrected; 4757 } 4758 } 4759 return TypoCorrection(); 4760 } 4761 4762 /// ConvertArgumentsForCall - Converts the arguments specified in 4763 /// Args/NumArgs to the parameter types of the function FDecl with 4764 /// function prototype Proto. Call is the call expression itself, and 4765 /// Fn is the function expression. For a C++ member function, this 4766 /// routine does not attempt to convert the object argument. Returns 4767 /// true if the call is ill-formed. 4768 bool 4769 Sema::ConvertArgumentsForCall(CallExpr *Call, Expr *Fn, 4770 FunctionDecl *FDecl, 4771 const FunctionProtoType *Proto, 4772 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 4773 SourceLocation RParenLoc, 4774 bool IsExecConfig) { 4775 // Bail out early if calling a builtin with custom typechecking. 4776 if (FDecl) 4777 if (unsigned ID = FDecl->getBuiltinID()) 4778 if (Context.BuiltinInfo.hasCustomTypechecking(ID)) 4779 return false; 4780 4781 // C99 6.5.2.2p7 - the arguments are implicitly converted, as if by 4782 // assignment, to the types of the corresponding parameter, ... 4783 unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams(); 4784 bool Invalid = false; 4785 unsigned MinArgs = FDecl ? FDecl->getMinRequiredArguments() : NumParams; 4786 unsigned FnKind = Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType() 4787 ? 1 /* block */ 4788 : (IsExecConfig ? 3 /* kernel function (exec config) */ 4789 : 0 /* function */); 4790 4791 // If too few arguments are available (and we don't have default 4792 // arguments for the remaining parameters), don't make the call. 4793 if (Args.size() < NumParams) { 4794 if (Args.size() < MinArgs) { 4795 TypoCorrection TC; 4796 if (FDecl && (TC = TryTypoCorrectionForCall(*this, Fn, FDecl, Args))) { 4797 unsigned diag_id = 4798 MinArgs == NumParams && !Proto->isVariadic() 4799 ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args_suggest 4800 : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args_at_least_suggest; 4801 diagnoseTypo(TC, PDiag(diag_id) << FnKind << MinArgs 4802 << static_cast<unsigned>(Args.size()) 4803 << TC.getCorrectionRange()); 4804 } else if (MinArgs == 1 && FDecl && FDecl->getParamDecl(0)->getDeclName()) 4805 Diag(RParenLoc, 4806 MinArgs == NumParams && !Proto->isVariadic() 4807 ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args_one 4808 : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args_at_least_one) 4809 << FnKind << FDecl->getParamDecl(0) << Fn->getSourceRange(); 4810 else 4811 Diag(RParenLoc, MinArgs == NumParams && !Proto->isVariadic() 4812 ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args 4813 : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args_at_least) 4814 << FnKind << MinArgs << static_cast<unsigned>(Args.size()) 4815 << Fn->getSourceRange(); 4816 4817 // Emit the location of the prototype. 4818 if (!TC && FDecl && !FDecl->getBuiltinID() && !IsExecConfig) 4819 Diag(FDecl->getLocStart(), diag::note_callee_decl) 4820 << FDecl; 4821 4822 return true; 4823 } 4824 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumParams); 4825 } 4826 4827 // If too many are passed and not variadic, error on the extras and drop 4828 // them. 4829 if (Args.size() > NumParams) { 4830 if (!Proto->isVariadic()) { 4831 TypoCorrection TC; 4832 if (FDecl && (TC = TryTypoCorrectionForCall(*this, Fn, FDecl, Args))) { 4833 unsigned diag_id = 4834 MinArgs == NumParams && !Proto->isVariadic() 4835 ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args_suggest 4836 : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args_at_most_suggest; 4837 diagnoseTypo(TC, PDiag(diag_id) << FnKind << NumParams 4838 << static_cast<unsigned>(Args.size()) 4839 << TC.getCorrectionRange()); 4840 } else if (NumParams == 1 && FDecl && 4841 FDecl->getParamDecl(0)->getDeclName()) 4842 Diag(Args[NumParams]->getLocStart(), 4843 MinArgs == NumParams 4844 ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args_one 4845 : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args_at_most_one) 4846 << FnKind << FDecl->getParamDecl(0) 4847 << static_cast<unsigned>(Args.size()) << Fn->getSourceRange() 4848 << SourceRange(Args[NumParams]->getLocStart(), 4849 Args.back()->getLocEnd()); 4850 else 4851 Diag(Args[NumParams]->getLocStart(), 4852 MinArgs == NumParams 4853 ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args 4854 : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args_at_most) 4855 << FnKind << NumParams << static_cast<unsigned>(Args.size()) 4856 << Fn->getSourceRange() 4857 << SourceRange(Args[NumParams]->getLocStart(), 4858 Args.back()->getLocEnd()); 4859 4860 // Emit the location of the prototype. 4861 if (!TC && FDecl && !FDecl->getBuiltinID() && !IsExecConfig) 4862 Diag(FDecl->getLocStart(), diag::note_callee_decl) 4863 << FDecl; 4864 4865 // This deletes the extra arguments. 4866 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumParams); 4867 return true; 4868 } 4869 } 4870 SmallVector<Expr *, 8> AllArgs; 4871 VariadicCallType CallType = getVariadicCallType(FDecl, Proto, Fn); 4872 4873 Invalid = GatherArgumentsForCall(Call->getLocStart(), FDecl, 4874 Proto, 0, Args, AllArgs, CallType); 4875 if (Invalid) 4876 return true; 4877 unsigned TotalNumArgs = AllArgs.size(); 4878 for (unsigned i = 0; i < TotalNumArgs; ++i) 4879 Call->setArg(i, AllArgs[i]); 4880 4881 return false; 4882 } 4883 4884 bool Sema::GatherArgumentsForCall(SourceLocation CallLoc, FunctionDecl *FDecl, 4885 const FunctionProtoType *Proto, 4886 unsigned FirstParam, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 4887 SmallVectorImpl<Expr *> &AllArgs, 4888 VariadicCallType CallType, bool AllowExplicit, 4889 bool IsListInitialization) { 4890 unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams(); 4891 bool Invalid = false; 4892 size_t ArgIx = 0; 4893 // Continue to check argument types (even if we have too few/many args). 4894 for (unsigned i = FirstParam; i < NumParams; i++) { 4895 QualType ProtoArgType = Proto->getParamType(i); 4896 4897 Expr *Arg; 4898 ParmVarDecl *Param = FDecl ? FDecl->getParamDecl(i) : nullptr; 4899 if (ArgIx < Args.size()) { 4900 Arg = Args[ArgIx++]; 4901 4902 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getLocStart(), 4903 ProtoArgType, 4904 diag::err_call_incomplete_argument, Arg)) 4905 return true; 4906 4907 // Strip the unbridged-cast placeholder expression off, if applicable. 4908 bool CFAudited = false; 4909 if (Arg->getType() == Context.ARCUnbridgedCastTy && 4910 FDecl && FDecl->hasAttr<CFAuditedTransferAttr>() && 4911 (!Param || !Param->hasAttr<CFConsumedAttr>())) 4912 Arg = stripARCUnbridgedCast(Arg); 4913 else if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && 4914 FDecl && FDecl->hasAttr<CFAuditedTransferAttr>() && 4915 (!Param || !Param->hasAttr<CFConsumedAttr>())) 4916 CFAudited = true; 4917 4918 if (Proto->getExtParameterInfo(i).isNoEscape()) 4919 if (auto *BE = dyn_cast<BlockExpr>(Arg->IgnoreParenNoopCasts(Context))) 4920 BE->getBlockDecl()->setDoesNotEscape(); 4921 4922 InitializedEntity Entity = 4923 Param ? InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, Param, 4924 ProtoArgType) 4925 : InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter( 4926 Context, ProtoArgType, Proto->isParamConsumed(i)); 4927 4928 // Remember that parameter belongs to a CF audited API. 4929 if (CFAudited) 4930 Entity.setParameterCFAudited(); 4931 4932 ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization( 4933 Entity, SourceLocation(), Arg, IsListInitialization, AllowExplicit); 4934 if (ArgE.isInvalid()) 4935 return true; 4936 4937 Arg = ArgE.getAs<Expr>(); 4938 } else { 4939 assert(Param && "can't use default arguments without a known callee"); 4940 4941 ExprResult ArgExpr = 4942 BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, FDecl, Param); 4943 if (ArgExpr.isInvalid()) 4944 return true; 4945 4946 Arg = ArgExpr.getAs<Expr>(); 4947 } 4948 4949 // Check for array bounds violations for each argument to the call. This 4950 // check only triggers warnings when the argument isn't a more complex Expr 4951 // with its own checking, such as a BinaryOperator. 4952 CheckArrayAccess(Arg); 4953 4954 // Check for violations of C99 static array rules (C99 6.7.5.3p7). 4955 CheckStaticArrayArgument(CallLoc, Param, Arg); 4956 4957 AllArgs.push_back(Arg); 4958 } 4959 4960 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...". 4961 if (CallType != VariadicDoesNotApply) { 4962 // Assume that extern "C" functions with variadic arguments that 4963 // return __unknown_anytype aren't *really* variadic. 4964 if (Proto->getReturnType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy && FDecl && 4965 FDecl->isExternC()) { 4966 for (Expr *A : Args.slice(ArgIx)) { 4967 QualType paramType; // ignored 4968 ExprResult arg = checkUnknownAnyArg(CallLoc, A, paramType); 4969 Invalid |= arg.isInvalid(); 4970 AllArgs.push_back(arg.get()); 4971 } 4972 4973 // Otherwise do argument promotion, (C99 6.5.2.2p7). 4974 } else { 4975 for (Expr *A : Args.slice(ArgIx)) { 4976 ExprResult Arg = DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(A, CallType, FDecl); 4977 Invalid |= Arg.isInvalid(); 4978 AllArgs.push_back(Arg.get()); 4979 } 4980 } 4981 4982 // Check for array bounds violations. 4983 for (Expr *A : Args.slice(ArgIx)) 4984 CheckArrayAccess(A); 4985 } 4986 return Invalid; 4987 } 4988 4989 static void DiagnoseCalleeStaticArrayParam(Sema &S, ParmVarDecl *PVD) { 4990 TypeLoc TL = PVD->getTypeSourceInfo()->getTypeLoc(); 4991 if (DecayedTypeLoc DTL = TL.getAs<DecayedTypeLoc>()) 4992 TL = DTL.getOriginalLoc(); 4993 if (ArrayTypeLoc ATL = TL.getAs<ArrayTypeLoc>()) 4994 S.Diag(PVD->getLocation(), diag::note_callee_static_array) 4995 << ATL.getLocalSourceRange(); 4996 } 4997 4998 /// CheckStaticArrayArgument - If the given argument corresponds to a static 4999 /// array parameter, check that it is non-null, and that if it is formed by 5000 /// array-to-pointer decay, the underlying array is sufficiently large. 5001 /// 5002 /// C99 6.7.5.3p7: If the keyword static also appears within the [ and ] of the 5003 /// array type derivation, then for each call to the function, the value of the 5004 /// corresponding actual argument shall provide access to the first element of 5005 /// an array with at least as many elements as specified by the size expression. 5006 void 5007 Sema::CheckStaticArrayArgument(SourceLocation CallLoc, 5008 ParmVarDecl *Param, 5009 const Expr *ArgExpr) { 5010 // Static array parameters are not supported in C++. 5011 if (!Param || getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 5012 return; 5013 5014 QualType OrigTy = Param->getOriginalType(); 5015 5016 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(OrigTy); 5017 if (!AT || AT->getSizeModifier() != ArrayType::Static) 5018 return; 5019 5020 if (ArgExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 5021 Expr::NPC_NeverValueDependent)) { 5022 Diag(CallLoc, diag::warn_null_arg) << ArgExpr->getSourceRange(); 5023 DiagnoseCalleeStaticArrayParam(*this, Param); 5024 return; 5025 } 5026 5027 const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT); 5028 if (!CAT) 5029 return; 5030 5031 const ConstantArrayType *ArgCAT = 5032 Context.getAsConstantArrayType(ArgExpr->IgnoreParenImpCasts()->getType()); 5033 if (!ArgCAT) 5034 return; 5035 5036 if (ArgCAT->getSize().ult(CAT->getSize())) { 5037 Diag(CallLoc, diag::warn_static_array_too_small) 5038 << ArgExpr->getSourceRange() 5039 << (unsigned) ArgCAT->getSize().getZExtValue() 5040 << (unsigned) CAT->getSize().getZExtValue(); 5041 DiagnoseCalleeStaticArrayParam(*this, Param); 5042 } 5043 } 5044 5045 /// Given a function expression of unknown-any type, try to rebuild it 5046 /// to have a function type. 5047 static ExprResult rebuildUnknownAnyFunction(Sema &S, Expr *fn); 5048 5049 /// Is the given type a placeholder that we need to lower out 5050 /// immediately during argument processing? 5051 static bool isPlaceholderToRemoveAsArg(QualType type) { 5052 // Placeholders are never sugared. 5053 const BuiltinType *placeholder = dyn_cast<BuiltinType>(type); 5054 if (!placeholder) return false; 5055 5056 switch (placeholder->getKind()) { 5057 // Ignore all the non-placeholder types. 5058 #define IMAGE_TYPE(ImgType, Id, SingletonId, Access, Suffix) \ 5059 case BuiltinType::Id: 5060 #include "clang/Basic/OpenCLImageTypes.def" 5061 #define PLACEHOLDER_TYPE(ID, SINGLETON_ID) 5062 #define BUILTIN_TYPE(ID, SINGLETON_ID) case BuiltinType::ID: 5063 #include "clang/AST/BuiltinTypes.def" 5064 return false; 5065 5066 // We cannot lower out overload sets; they might validly be resolved 5067 // by the call machinery. 5068 case BuiltinType::Overload: 5069 return false; 5070 5071 // Unbridged casts in ARC can be handled in some call positions and 5072 // should be left in place. 5073 case BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast: 5074 return false; 5075 5076 // Pseudo-objects should be converted as soon as possible. 5077 case BuiltinType::PseudoObject: 5078 return true; 5079 5080 // The debugger mode could theoretically but currently does not try 5081 // to resolve unknown-typed arguments based on known parameter types. 5082 case BuiltinType::UnknownAny: 5083 return true; 5084 5085 // These are always invalid as call arguments and should be reported. 5086 case BuiltinType::BoundMember: 5087 case BuiltinType::BuiltinFn: 5088 case BuiltinType::OMPArraySection: 5089 return true; 5090 5091 } 5092 llvm_unreachable("bad builtin type kind"); 5093 } 5094 5095 /// Check an argument list for placeholders that we won't try to 5096 /// handle later. 5097 static bool checkArgsForPlaceholders(Sema &S, MultiExprArg args) { 5098 // Apply this processing to all the arguments at once instead of 5099 // dying at the first failure. 5100 bool hasInvalid = false; 5101 for (size_t i = 0, e = args.size(); i != e; i++) { 5102 if (isPlaceholderToRemoveAsArg(args[i]->getType())) { 5103 ExprResult result = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(args[i]); 5104 if (result.isInvalid()) hasInvalid = true; 5105 else args[i] = result.get(); 5106 } else if (hasInvalid) { 5107 (void)S.CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(args[i]); 5108 } 5109 } 5110 return hasInvalid; 5111 } 5112 5113 /// If a builtin function has a pointer argument with no explicit address 5114 /// space, then it should be able to accept a pointer to any address 5115 /// space as input. In order to do this, we need to replace the 5116 /// standard builtin declaration with one that uses the same address space 5117 /// as the call. 5118 /// 5119 /// \returns nullptr If this builtin is not a candidate for a rewrite i.e. 5120 /// it does not contain any pointer arguments without 5121 /// an address space qualifer. Otherwise the rewritten 5122 /// FunctionDecl is returned. 5123 /// TODO: Handle pointer return types. 5124 static FunctionDecl *rewriteBuiltinFunctionDecl(Sema *Sema, ASTContext &Context, 5125 const FunctionDecl *FDecl, 5126 MultiExprArg ArgExprs) { 5127 5128 QualType DeclType = FDecl->getType(); 5129 const FunctionProtoType *FT = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(DeclType); 5130 5131 if (!Context.BuiltinInfo.hasPtrArgsOrResult(FDecl->getBuiltinID()) || 5132 !FT || FT->isVariadic() || ArgExprs.size() != FT->getNumParams()) 5133 return nullptr; 5134 5135 bool NeedsNewDecl = false; 5136 unsigned i = 0; 5137 SmallVector<QualType, 8> OverloadParams; 5138 5139 for (QualType ParamType : FT->param_types()) { 5140 5141 // Convert array arguments to pointer to simplify type lookup. 5142 ExprResult ArgRes = 5143 Sema->DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(ArgExprs[i++]); 5144 if (ArgRes.isInvalid()) 5145 return nullptr; 5146 Expr *Arg = ArgRes.get(); 5147 QualType ArgType = Arg->getType(); 5148 if (!ParamType->isPointerType() || 5149 ParamType.getQualifiers().hasAddressSpace() || 5150 !ArgType->isPointerType() || 5151 !ArgType->getPointeeType().getQualifiers().hasAddressSpace()) { 5152 OverloadParams.push_back(ParamType); 5153 continue; 5154 } 5155 5156 NeedsNewDecl = true; 5157 LangAS AS = ArgType->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace(); 5158 5159 QualType PointeeType = ParamType->getPointeeType(); 5160 PointeeType = Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(PointeeType, AS); 5161 OverloadParams.push_back(Context.getPointerType(PointeeType)); 5162 } 5163 5164 if (!NeedsNewDecl) 5165 return nullptr; 5166 5167 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI; 5168 QualType OverloadTy = Context.getFunctionType(FT->getReturnType(), 5169 OverloadParams, EPI); 5170 DeclContext *Parent = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl(); 5171 FunctionDecl *OverloadDecl = FunctionDecl::Create(Context, Parent, 5172 FDecl->getLocation(), 5173 FDecl->getLocation(), 5174 FDecl->getIdentifier(), 5175 OverloadTy, 5176 /*TInfo=*/nullptr, 5177 SC_Extern, false, 5178 /*hasPrototype=*/true); 5179 SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 16> Params; 5180 FT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(OverloadTy); 5181 for (unsigned i = 0, e = FT->getNumParams(); i != e; ++i) { 5182 QualType ParamType = FT->getParamType(i); 5183 ParmVarDecl *Parm = 5184 ParmVarDecl::Create(Context, OverloadDecl, SourceLocation(), 5185 SourceLocation(), nullptr, ParamType, 5186 /*TInfo=*/nullptr, SC_None, nullptr); 5187 Parm->setScopeInfo(0, i); 5188 Params.push_back(Parm); 5189 } 5190 OverloadDecl->setParams(Params); 5191 return OverloadDecl; 5192 } 5193 5194 static void checkDirectCallValidity(Sema &S, const Expr *Fn, 5195 FunctionDecl *Callee, 5196 MultiExprArg ArgExprs) { 5197 // `Callee` (when called with ArgExprs) may be ill-formed. enable_if (and 5198 // similar attributes) really don't like it when functions are called with an 5199 // invalid number of args. 5200 if (S.TooManyArguments(Callee->getNumParams(), ArgExprs.size(), 5201 /*PartialOverloading=*/false) && 5202 !Callee->isVariadic()) 5203 return; 5204 if (Callee->getMinRequiredArguments() > ArgExprs.size()) 5205 return; 5206 5207 if (const EnableIfAttr *Attr = S.CheckEnableIf(Callee, ArgExprs, true)) { 5208 S.Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), 5209 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Callee) 5210 ? diag::err_ovl_no_viable_member_function_in_call 5211 : diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call) 5212 << Callee << Callee->getSourceRange(); 5213 S.Diag(Callee->getLocation(), 5214 diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_function_cond_attr) 5215 << Attr->getCond()->getSourceRange() << Attr->getMessage(); 5216 return; 5217 } 5218 } 5219 5220 static bool enclosingClassIsRelatedToClassInWhichMembersWereFound( 5221 const UnresolvedMemberExpr *const UME, Sema &S) { 5222 5223 const auto GetFunctionLevelDCIfCXXClass = 5224 [](Sema &S) -> const CXXRecordDecl * { 5225 const DeclContext *const DC = S.getFunctionLevelDeclContext(); 5226 if (!DC || !DC->getParent()) 5227 return nullptr; 5228 5229 // If the call to some member function was made from within a member 5230 // function body 'M' return return 'M's parent. 5231 if (const auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)) 5232 return MD->getParent()->getCanonicalDecl(); 5233 // else the call was made from within a default member initializer of a 5234 // class, so return the class. 5235 if (const auto *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) 5236 return RD->getCanonicalDecl(); 5237 return nullptr; 5238 }; 5239 // If our DeclContext is neither a member function nor a class (in the 5240 // case of a lambda in a default member initializer), we can't have an 5241 // enclosing 'this'. 5242 5243 const CXXRecordDecl *const CurParentClass = GetFunctionLevelDCIfCXXClass(S); 5244 if (!CurParentClass) 5245 return false; 5246 5247 // The naming class for implicit member functions call is the class in which 5248 // name lookup starts. 5249 const CXXRecordDecl *const NamingClass = 5250 UME->getNamingClass()->getCanonicalDecl(); 5251 assert(NamingClass && "Must have naming class even for implicit access"); 5252 5253 // If the unresolved member functions were found in a 'naming class' that is 5254 // related (either the same or derived from) to the class that contains the 5255 // member function that itself contained the implicit member access. 5256 5257 return CurParentClass == NamingClass || 5258 CurParentClass->isDerivedFrom(NamingClass); 5259 } 5260 5261 static void 5262 tryImplicitlyCaptureThisIfImplicitMemberFunctionAccessWithDependentArgs( 5263 Sema &S, const UnresolvedMemberExpr *const UME, SourceLocation CallLoc) { 5264 5265 if (!UME) 5266 return; 5267 5268 LambdaScopeInfo *const CurLSI = S.getCurLambda(); 5269 // Only try and implicitly capture 'this' within a C++ Lambda if it hasn't 5270 // already been captured, or if this is an implicit member function call (if 5271 // it isn't, an attempt to capture 'this' should already have been made). 5272 if (!CurLSI || CurLSI->ImpCaptureStyle == CurLSI->ImpCap_None || 5273 !UME->isImplicitAccess() || CurLSI->isCXXThisCaptured()) 5274 return; 5275 5276 // Check if the naming class in which the unresolved members were found is 5277 // related (same as or is a base of) to the enclosing class. 5278 5279 if (!enclosingClassIsRelatedToClassInWhichMembersWereFound(UME, S)) 5280 return; 5281 5282 5283 DeclContext *EnclosingFunctionCtx = S.CurContext->getParent()->getParent(); 5284 // If the enclosing function is not dependent, then this lambda is 5285 // capture ready, so if we can capture this, do so. 5286 if (!EnclosingFunctionCtx->isDependentContext()) { 5287 // If the current lambda and all enclosing lambdas can capture 'this' - 5288 // then go ahead and capture 'this' (since our unresolved overload set 5289 // contains at least one non-static member function). 5290 if (!S.CheckCXXThisCapture(CallLoc, /*Explcit*/ false, /*Diagnose*/ false)) 5291 S.CheckCXXThisCapture(CallLoc); 5292 } else if (S.CurContext->isDependentContext()) { 5293 // ... since this is an implicit member reference, that might potentially 5294 // involve a 'this' capture, mark 'this' for potential capture in 5295 // enclosing lambdas. 5296 if (CurLSI->ImpCaptureStyle != CurLSI->ImpCap_None) 5297 CurLSI->addPotentialThisCapture(CallLoc); 5298 } 5299 } 5300 5301 /// ActOnCallExpr - Handle a call to Fn with the specified array of arguments. 5302 /// This provides the location of the left/right parens and a list of comma 5303 /// locations. 5304 ExprResult Sema::ActOnCallExpr(Scope *Scope, Expr *Fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc, 5305 MultiExprArg ArgExprs, SourceLocation RParenLoc, 5306 Expr *ExecConfig, bool IsExecConfig) { 5307 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs. 5308 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope, Fn); 5309 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 5310 Fn = Result.get(); 5311 5312 if (checkArgsForPlaceholders(*this, ArgExprs)) 5313 return ExprError(); 5314 5315 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 5316 // If this is a pseudo-destructor expression, build the call immediately. 5317 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(Fn)) { 5318 if (!ArgExprs.empty()) { 5319 // Pseudo-destructor calls should not have any arguments. 5320 Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_pseudo_dtor_call_with_args) 5321 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval( 5322 SourceRange(ArgExprs.front()->getLocStart(), 5323 ArgExprs.back()->getLocEnd())); 5324 } 5325 5326 return new (Context) 5327 CallExpr(Context, Fn, None, Context.VoidTy, VK_RValue, RParenLoc); 5328 } 5329 if (Fn->getType() == Context.PseudoObjectTy) { 5330 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Fn); 5331 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 5332 Fn = result.get(); 5333 } 5334 5335 // Determine whether this is a dependent call inside a C++ template, 5336 // in which case we won't do any semantic analysis now. 5337 bool Dependent = false; 5338 if (Fn->isTypeDependent()) 5339 Dependent = true; 5340 else if (Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(ArgExprs)) 5341 Dependent = true; 5342 5343 if (Dependent) { 5344 if (ExecConfig) { 5345 return new (Context) CUDAKernelCallExpr( 5346 Context, Fn, cast<CallExpr>(ExecConfig), ArgExprs, 5347 Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, RParenLoc); 5348 } else { 5349 5350 tryImplicitlyCaptureThisIfImplicitMemberFunctionAccessWithDependentArgs( 5351 *this, dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(Fn->IgnoreParens()), 5352 Fn->getLocStart()); 5353 5354 return new (Context) CallExpr( 5355 Context, Fn, ArgExprs, Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, RParenLoc); 5356 } 5357 } 5358 5359 // Determine whether this is a call to an object (C++ [over.call.object]). 5360 if (Fn->getType()->isRecordType()) 5361 return BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(Scope, Fn, LParenLoc, ArgExprs, 5362 RParenLoc); 5363 5364 if (Fn->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) { 5365 ExprResult result = rebuildUnknownAnyFunction(*this, Fn); 5366 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 5367 Fn = result.get(); 5368 } 5369 5370 if (Fn->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy) { 5371 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(Scope, Fn, LParenLoc, ArgExprs, 5372 RParenLoc); 5373 } 5374 } 5375 5376 // Check for overloaded calls. This can happen even in C due to extensions. 5377 if (Fn->getType() == Context.OverloadTy) { 5378 OverloadExpr::FindResult find = OverloadExpr::find(Fn); 5379 5380 // We aren't supposed to apply this logic if there's an '&' involved. 5381 if (!find.HasFormOfMemberPointer) { 5382 if (Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(ArgExprs)) 5383 return new (Context) CallExpr( 5384 Context, Fn, ArgExprs, Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, RParenLoc); 5385 OverloadExpr *ovl = find.Expression; 5386 if (UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(ovl)) 5387 return BuildOverloadedCallExpr( 5388 Scope, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, ArgExprs, RParenLoc, ExecConfig, 5389 /*AllowTypoCorrection=*/true, find.IsAddressOfOperand); 5390 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(Scope, Fn, LParenLoc, ArgExprs, 5391 RParenLoc); 5392 } 5393 } 5394 5395 // If we're directly calling a function, get the appropriate declaration. 5396 if (Fn->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) { 5397 ExprResult result = rebuildUnknownAnyFunction(*this, Fn); 5398 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 5399 Fn = result.get(); 5400 } 5401 5402 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens(); 5403 5404 bool CallingNDeclIndirectly = false; 5405 NamedDecl *NDecl = nullptr; 5406 if (UnaryOperator *UnOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(NakedFn)) { 5407 if (UnOp->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf) { 5408 CallingNDeclIndirectly = true; 5409 NakedFn = UnOp->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens(); 5410 } 5411 } 5412 5413 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)) { 5414 NDecl = cast<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)->getDecl(); 5415 5416 FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(NDecl); 5417 if (FDecl && FDecl->getBuiltinID()) { 5418 // Rewrite the function decl for this builtin by replacing parameters 5419 // with no explicit address space with the address space of the arguments 5420 // in ArgExprs. 5421 if ((FDecl = 5422 rewriteBuiltinFunctionDecl(this, Context, FDecl, ArgExprs))) { 5423 NDecl = FDecl; 5424 Fn = DeclRefExpr::Create( 5425 Context, FDecl->getQualifierLoc(), SourceLocation(), FDecl, false, 5426 SourceLocation(), FDecl->getType(), Fn->getValueKind(), FDecl); 5427 } 5428 } 5429 } else if (isa<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)) 5430 NDecl = cast<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)->getMemberDecl(); 5431 5432 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl)) { 5433 if (CallingNDeclIndirectly && 5434 !checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(FD, /*Complain=*/true, 5435 Fn->getLocStart())) 5436 return ExprError(); 5437 5438 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && checkOpenCLDisabledDecl(*FD, *Fn)) 5439 return ExprError(); 5440 5441 checkDirectCallValidity(*this, Fn, FD, ArgExprs); 5442 } 5443 5444 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, NDecl, LParenLoc, ArgExprs, RParenLoc, 5445 ExecConfig, IsExecConfig); 5446 } 5447 5448 /// ActOnAsTypeExpr - create a new asType (bitcast) from the arguments. 5449 /// 5450 /// __builtin_astype( value, dst type ) 5451 /// 5452 ExprResult Sema::ActOnAsTypeExpr(Expr *E, ParsedType ParsedDestTy, 5453 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc, 5454 SourceLocation RParenLoc) { 5455 ExprValueKind VK = VK_RValue; 5456 ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary; 5457 QualType DstTy = GetTypeFromParser(ParsedDestTy); 5458 QualType SrcTy = E->getType(); 5459 if (Context.getTypeSize(DstTy) != Context.getTypeSize(SrcTy)) 5460 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, 5461 diag::err_invalid_astype_of_different_size) 5462 << DstTy 5463 << SrcTy 5464 << E->getSourceRange()); 5465 return new (Context) AsTypeExpr(E, DstTy, VK, OK, BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc); 5466 } 5467 5468 /// ActOnConvertVectorExpr - create a new convert-vector expression from the 5469 /// provided arguments. 5470 /// 5471 /// __builtin_convertvector( value, dst type ) 5472 /// 5473 ExprResult Sema::ActOnConvertVectorExpr(Expr *E, ParsedType ParsedDestTy, 5474 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc, 5475 SourceLocation RParenLoc) { 5476 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo; 5477 GetTypeFromParser(ParsedDestTy, &TInfo); 5478 return SemaConvertVectorExpr(E, TInfo, BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc); 5479 } 5480 5481 /// BuildResolvedCallExpr - Build a call to a resolved expression, 5482 /// i.e. an expression not of \p OverloadTy. The expression should 5483 /// unary-convert to an expression of function-pointer or 5484 /// block-pointer type. 5485 /// 5486 /// \param NDecl the declaration being called, if available 5487 ExprResult 5488 Sema::BuildResolvedCallExpr(Expr *Fn, NamedDecl *NDecl, 5489 SourceLocation LParenLoc, 5490 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 5491 SourceLocation RParenLoc, 5492 Expr *Config, bool IsExecConfig) { 5493 FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl); 5494 unsigned BuiltinID = (FDecl ? FDecl->getBuiltinID() : 0); 5495 5496 // Functions with 'interrupt' attribute cannot be called directly. 5497 if (FDecl && FDecl->hasAttr<AnyX86InterruptAttr>()) { 5498 Diag(Fn->getExprLoc(), diag::err_anyx86_interrupt_called); 5499 return ExprError(); 5500 } 5501 5502 // Interrupt handlers don't save off the VFP regs automatically on ARM, 5503 // so there's some risk when calling out to non-interrupt handler functions 5504 // that the callee might not preserve them. This is easy to diagnose here, 5505 // but can be very challenging to debug. 5506 if (auto *Caller = getCurFunctionDecl()) 5507 if (Caller->hasAttr<ARMInterruptAttr>()) { 5508 bool VFP = Context.getTargetInfo().hasFeature("vfp"); 5509 if (VFP && (!FDecl || !FDecl->hasAttr<ARMInterruptAttr>())) 5510 Diag(Fn->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_arm_interrupt_calling_convention); 5511 } 5512 5513 // Promote the function operand. 5514 // We special-case function promotion here because we only allow promoting 5515 // builtin functions to function pointers in the callee of a call. 5516 ExprResult Result; 5517 if (BuiltinID && 5518 Fn->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::BuiltinFn)) { 5519 Result = ImpCastExprToType(Fn, Context.getPointerType(FDecl->getType()), 5520 CK_BuiltinFnToFnPtr).get(); 5521 } else { 5522 Result = CallExprUnaryConversions(Fn); 5523 } 5524 if (Result.isInvalid()) 5525 return ExprError(); 5526 Fn = Result.get(); 5527 5528 // Make the call expr early, before semantic checks. This guarantees cleanup 5529 // of arguments and function on error. 5530 CallExpr *TheCall; 5531 if (Config) 5532 TheCall = new (Context) CUDAKernelCallExpr(Context, Fn, 5533 cast<CallExpr>(Config), Args, 5534 Context.BoolTy, VK_RValue, 5535 RParenLoc); 5536 else 5537 TheCall = new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args, Context.BoolTy, 5538 VK_RValue, RParenLoc); 5539 5540 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 5541 // C cannot always handle TypoExpr nodes in builtin calls and direct 5542 // function calls as their argument checking don't necessarily handle 5543 // dependent types properly, so make sure any TypoExprs have been 5544 // dealt with. 5545 ExprResult Result = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(TheCall); 5546 if (!Result.isUsable()) return ExprError(); 5547 TheCall = dyn_cast<CallExpr>(Result.get()); 5548 if (!TheCall) return Result; 5549 Args = llvm::makeArrayRef(TheCall->getArgs(), TheCall->getNumArgs()); 5550 } 5551 5552 // Bail out early if calling a builtin with custom typechecking. 5553 if (BuiltinID && Context.BuiltinInfo.hasCustomTypechecking(BuiltinID)) 5554 return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(FDecl, BuiltinID, TheCall); 5555 5556 retry: 5557 const FunctionType *FuncT; 5558 if (const PointerType *PT = Fn->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) { 5559 // C99 6.5.2.2p1 - "The expression that denotes the called function shall 5560 // have type pointer to function". 5561 FuncT = PT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>(); 5562 if (!FuncT) 5563 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function) 5564 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange()); 5565 } else if (const BlockPointerType *BPT = 5566 Fn->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) { 5567 FuncT = BPT->getPointeeType()->castAs<FunctionType>(); 5568 } else { 5569 // Handle calls to expressions of unknown-any type. 5570 if (Fn->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) { 5571 ExprResult rewrite = rebuildUnknownAnyFunction(*this, Fn); 5572 if (rewrite.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 5573 Fn = rewrite.get(); 5574 TheCall->setCallee(Fn); 5575 goto retry; 5576 } 5577 5578 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function) 5579 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange()); 5580 } 5581 5582 if (getLangOpts().CUDA) { 5583 if (Config) { 5584 // CUDA: Kernel calls must be to global functions 5585 if (FDecl && !FDecl->hasAttr<CUDAGlobalAttr>()) 5586 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc,diag::err_kern_call_not_global_function) 5587 << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange()); 5588 5589 // CUDA: Kernel function must have 'void' return type 5590 if (!FuncT->getReturnType()->isVoidType()) 5591 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_kern_type_not_void_return) 5592 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange()); 5593 } else { 5594 // CUDA: Calls to global functions must be configured 5595 if (FDecl && FDecl->hasAttr<CUDAGlobalAttr>()) 5596 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_global_call_not_config) 5597 << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange()); 5598 } 5599 } 5600 5601 // Check for a valid return type 5602 if (CheckCallReturnType(FuncT->getReturnType(), Fn->getLocStart(), TheCall, 5603 FDecl)) 5604 return ExprError(); 5605 5606 // We know the result type of the call, set it. 5607 TheCall->setType(FuncT->getCallResultType(Context)); 5608 TheCall->setValueKind(Expr::getValueKindForType(FuncT->getReturnType())); 5609 5610 const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FuncT); 5611 if (Proto) { 5612 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, Fn, FDecl, Proto, Args, RParenLoc, 5613 IsExecConfig)) 5614 return ExprError(); 5615 } else { 5616 assert(isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FuncT) && "Unknown FunctionType!"); 5617 5618 if (FDecl) { 5619 // Check if we have too few/too many template arguments, based 5620 // on our knowledge of the function definition. 5621 const FunctionDecl *Def = nullptr; 5622 if (FDecl->hasBody(Def) && Args.size() != Def->param_size()) { 5623 Proto = Def->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 5624 if (!Proto || !(Proto->isVariadic() && Args.size() >= Def->param_size())) 5625 Diag(RParenLoc, diag::warn_call_wrong_number_of_arguments) 5626 << (Args.size() > Def->param_size()) << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange(); 5627 } 5628 5629 // If the function we're calling isn't a function prototype, but we have 5630 // a function prototype from a prior declaratiom, use that prototype. 5631 if (!FDecl->hasPrototype()) 5632 Proto = FDecl->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 5633 } 5634 5635 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p6). 5636 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Args.size(); i != e; i++) { 5637 Expr *Arg = Args[i]; 5638 5639 if (Proto && i < Proto->getNumParams()) { 5640 InitializedEntity Entity = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter( 5641 Context, Proto->getParamType(i), Proto->isParamConsumed(i)); 5642 ExprResult ArgE = 5643 PerformCopyInitialization(Entity, SourceLocation(), Arg); 5644 if (ArgE.isInvalid()) 5645 return true; 5646 5647 Arg = ArgE.getAs<Expr>(); 5648 5649 } else { 5650 ExprResult ArgE = DefaultArgumentPromotion(Arg); 5651 5652 if (ArgE.isInvalid()) 5653 return true; 5654 5655 Arg = ArgE.getAs<Expr>(); 5656 } 5657 5658 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getLocStart(), 5659 Arg->getType(), 5660 diag::err_call_incomplete_argument, Arg)) 5661 return ExprError(); 5662 5663 TheCall->setArg(i, Arg); 5664 } 5665 } 5666 5667 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl)) 5668 if (!Method->isStatic()) 5669 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_member_call_without_object) 5670 << Fn->getSourceRange()); 5671 5672 // Check for sentinels 5673 if (NDecl) 5674 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NDecl, LParenLoc, Args); 5675 5676 // Do special checking on direct calls to functions. 5677 if (FDecl) { 5678 if (CheckFunctionCall(FDecl, TheCall, Proto)) 5679 return ExprError(); 5680 5681 if (BuiltinID) 5682 return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(FDecl, BuiltinID, TheCall); 5683 } else if (NDecl) { 5684 if (CheckPointerCall(NDecl, TheCall, Proto)) 5685 return ExprError(); 5686 } else { 5687 if (CheckOtherCall(TheCall, Proto)) 5688 return ExprError(); 5689 } 5690 5691 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall); 5692 } 5693 5694 ExprResult 5695 Sema::ActOnCompoundLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, ParsedType Ty, 5696 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *InitExpr) { 5697 assert(Ty && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing type"); 5698 assert(InitExpr && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing expression"); 5699 5700 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo; 5701 QualType literalType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo); 5702 if (!TInfo) 5703 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(literalType); 5704 5705 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, InitExpr); 5706 } 5707 5708 ExprResult 5709 Sema::BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, 5710 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *LiteralExpr) { 5711 QualType literalType = TInfo->getType(); 5712 5713 if (literalType->isArrayType()) { 5714 if (RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, Context.getBaseElementType(literalType), 5715 diag::err_illegal_decl_array_incomplete_type, 5716 SourceRange(LParenLoc, 5717 LiteralExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()))) 5718 return ExprError(); 5719 if (literalType->isVariableArrayType()) 5720 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_variable_object_no_init) 5721 << SourceRange(LParenLoc, LiteralExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())); 5722 } else if (!literalType->isDependentType() && 5723 RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, literalType, 5724 diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type, 5725 SourceRange(LParenLoc, LiteralExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()))) 5726 return ExprError(); 5727 5728 InitializedEntity Entity 5729 = InitializedEntity::InitializeCompoundLiteralInit(TInfo); 5730 InitializationKind Kind 5731 = InitializationKind::CreateCStyleCast(LParenLoc, 5732 SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc), 5733 /*InitList=*/true); 5734 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, LiteralExpr); 5735 ExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind, LiteralExpr, 5736 &literalType); 5737 if (Result.isInvalid()) 5738 return ExprError(); 5739 LiteralExpr = Result.get(); 5740 5741 bool isFileScope = !CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod(); 5742 if (isFileScope && 5743 !LiteralExpr->isTypeDependent() && 5744 !LiteralExpr->isValueDependent() && 5745 !literalType->isDependentType()) { // 6.5.2.5p3 5746 if (CheckForConstantInitializer(LiteralExpr, literalType)) 5747 return ExprError(); 5748 } 5749 5750 // In C, compound literals are l-values for some reason. 5751 // For GCC compatibility, in C++, file-scope array compound literals with 5752 // constant initializers are also l-values, and compound literals are 5753 // otherwise prvalues. 5754 // 5755 // (GCC also treats C++ list-initialized file-scope array prvalues with 5756 // constant initializers as l-values, but that's non-conforming, so we don't 5757 // follow it there.) 5758 // 5759 // FIXME: It would be better to handle the lvalue cases as materializing and 5760 // lifetime-extending a temporary object, but our materialized temporaries 5761 // representation only supports lifetime extension from a variable, not "out 5762 // of thin air". 5763 // FIXME: For C++, we might want to instead lifetime-extend only if a pointer 5764 // is bound to the result of applying array-to-pointer decay to the compound 5765 // literal. 5766 // FIXME: GCC supports compound literals of reference type, which should 5767 // obviously have a value kind derived from the kind of reference involved. 5768 ExprValueKind VK = 5769 (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !(isFileScope && literalType->isArrayType())) 5770 ? VK_RValue 5771 : VK_LValue; 5772 5773 return MaybeBindToTemporary( 5774 new (Context) CompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, literalType, 5775 VK, LiteralExpr, isFileScope)); 5776 } 5777 5778 ExprResult 5779 Sema::ActOnInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg InitArgList, 5780 SourceLocation RBraceLoc) { 5781 // Immediately handle non-overload placeholders. Overloads can be 5782 // resolved contextually, but everything else here can't. 5783 for (unsigned I = 0, E = InitArgList.size(); I != E; ++I) { 5784 if (InitArgList[I]->getType()->isNonOverloadPlaceholderType()) { 5785 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(InitArgList[I]); 5786 5787 // Ignore failures; dropping the entire initializer list because 5788 // of one failure would be terrible for indexing/etc. 5789 if (result.isInvalid()) continue; 5790 5791 InitArgList[I] = result.get(); 5792 } 5793 } 5794 5795 // Semantic analysis for initializers is done by ActOnDeclarator() and 5796 // CheckInitializer() - it requires knowledge of the object being initialized. 5797 5798 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LBraceLoc, InitArgList, 5799 RBraceLoc); 5800 E->setType(Context.VoidTy); // FIXME: just a place holder for now. 5801 return E; 5802 } 5803 5804 /// Do an explicit extend of the given block pointer if we're in ARC. 5805 void Sema::maybeExtendBlockObject(ExprResult &E) { 5806 assert(E.get()->getType()->isBlockPointerType()); 5807 assert(E.get()->isRValue()); 5808 5809 // Only do this in an r-value context. 5810 if (!getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) return; 5811 5812 E = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, E.get()->getType(), 5813 CK_ARCExtendBlockObject, E.get(), 5814 /*base path*/ nullptr, VK_RValue); 5815 Cleanup.setExprNeedsCleanups(true); 5816 } 5817 5818 /// Prepare a conversion of the given expression to an ObjC object 5819 /// pointer type. 5820 CastKind Sema::PrepareCastToObjCObjectPointer(ExprResult &E) { 5821 QualType type = E.get()->getType(); 5822 if (type->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 5823 return CK_BitCast; 5824 } else if (type->isBlockPointerType()) { 5825 maybeExtendBlockObject(E); 5826 return CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast; 5827 } else { 5828 assert(type->isPointerType()); 5829 return CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast; 5830 } 5831 } 5832 5833 /// Prepares for a scalar cast, performing all the necessary stages 5834 /// except the final cast and returning the kind required. 5835 CastKind Sema::PrepareScalarCast(ExprResult &Src, QualType DestTy) { 5836 // Both Src and Dest are scalar types, i.e. arithmetic or pointer. 5837 // Also, callers should have filtered out the invalid cases with 5838 // pointers. Everything else should be possible. 5839 5840 QualType SrcTy = Src.get()->getType(); 5841 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(SrcTy, DestTy)) 5842 return CK_NoOp; 5843 5844 switch (Type::ScalarTypeKind SrcKind = SrcTy->getScalarTypeKind()) { 5845 case Type::STK_MemberPointer: 5846 llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C"); 5847 5848 case Type::STK_CPointer: 5849 case Type::STK_BlockPointer: 5850 case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer: 5851 switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) { 5852 case Type::STK_CPointer: { 5853 LangAS SrcAS = SrcTy->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace(); 5854 LangAS DestAS = DestTy->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace(); 5855 if (SrcAS != DestAS) 5856 return CK_AddressSpaceConversion; 5857 return CK_BitCast; 5858 } 5859 case Type::STK_BlockPointer: 5860 return (SrcKind == Type::STK_BlockPointer 5861 ? CK_BitCast : CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast); 5862 case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer: 5863 if (SrcKind == Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer) 5864 return CK_BitCast; 5865 if (SrcKind == Type::STK_CPointer) 5866 return CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast; 5867 maybeExtendBlockObject(Src); 5868 return CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast; 5869 case Type::STK_Bool: 5870 return CK_PointerToBoolean; 5871 case Type::STK_Integral: 5872 return CK_PointerToIntegral; 5873 case Type::STK_Floating: 5874 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex: 5875 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex: 5876 case Type::STK_MemberPointer: 5877 llvm_unreachable("illegal cast from pointer"); 5878 } 5879 llvm_unreachable("Should have returned before this"); 5880 5881 case Type::STK_Bool: // casting from bool is like casting from an integer 5882 case Type::STK_Integral: 5883 switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) { 5884 case Type::STK_CPointer: 5885 case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer: 5886 case Type::STK_BlockPointer: 5887 if (Src.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 5888 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) 5889 return CK_NullToPointer; 5890 return CK_IntegralToPointer; 5891 case Type::STK_Bool: 5892 return CK_IntegralToBoolean; 5893 case Type::STK_Integral: 5894 return CK_IntegralCast; 5895 case Type::STK_Floating: 5896 return CK_IntegralToFloating; 5897 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex: 5898 Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(), 5899 DestTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(), 5900 CK_IntegralCast); 5901 return CK_IntegralRealToComplex; 5902 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex: 5903 Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(), 5904 DestTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(), 5905 CK_IntegralToFloating); 5906 return CK_FloatingRealToComplex; 5907 case Type::STK_MemberPointer: 5908 llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C"); 5909 } 5910 llvm_unreachable("Should have returned before this"); 5911 5912 case Type::STK_Floating: 5913 switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) { 5914 case Type::STK_Floating: 5915 return CK_FloatingCast; 5916 case Type::STK_Bool: 5917 return CK_FloatingToBoolean; 5918 case Type::STK_Integral: 5919 return CK_FloatingToIntegral; 5920 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex: 5921 Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(), 5922 DestTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(), 5923 CK_FloatingCast); 5924 return CK_FloatingRealToComplex; 5925 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex: 5926 Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(), 5927 DestTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(), 5928 CK_FloatingToIntegral); 5929 return CK_IntegralRealToComplex; 5930 case Type::STK_CPointer: 5931 case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer: 5932 case Type::STK_BlockPointer: 5933 llvm_unreachable("valid float->pointer cast?"); 5934 case Type::STK_MemberPointer: 5935 llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C"); 5936 } 5937 llvm_unreachable("Should have returned before this"); 5938 5939 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex: 5940 switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) { 5941 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex: 5942 return CK_FloatingComplexCast; 5943 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex: 5944 return CK_FloatingComplexToIntegralComplex; 5945 case Type::STK_Floating: { 5946 QualType ET = SrcTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(); 5947 if (Context.hasSameType(ET, DestTy)) 5948 return CK_FloatingComplexToReal; 5949 Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(), ET, CK_FloatingComplexToReal); 5950 return CK_FloatingCast; 5951 } 5952 case Type::STK_Bool: 5953 return CK_FloatingComplexToBoolean; 5954 case Type::STK_Integral: 5955 Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(), 5956 SrcTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(), 5957 CK_FloatingComplexToReal); 5958 return CK_FloatingToIntegral; 5959 case Type::STK_CPointer: 5960 case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer: 5961 case Type::STK_BlockPointer: 5962 llvm_unreachable("valid complex float->pointer cast?"); 5963 case Type::STK_MemberPointer: 5964 llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C"); 5965 } 5966 llvm_unreachable("Should have returned before this"); 5967 5968 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex: 5969 switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) { 5970 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex: 5971 return CK_IntegralComplexToFloatingComplex; 5972 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex: 5973 return CK_IntegralComplexCast; 5974 case Type::STK_Integral: { 5975 QualType ET = SrcTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(); 5976 if (Context.hasSameType(ET, DestTy)) 5977 return CK_IntegralComplexToReal; 5978 Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(), ET, CK_IntegralComplexToReal); 5979 return CK_IntegralCast; 5980 } 5981 case Type::STK_Bool: 5982 return CK_IntegralComplexToBoolean; 5983 case Type::STK_Floating: 5984 Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(), 5985 SrcTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(), 5986 CK_IntegralComplexToReal); 5987 return CK_IntegralToFloating; 5988 case Type::STK_CPointer: 5989 case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer: 5990 case Type::STK_BlockPointer: 5991 llvm_unreachable("valid complex int->pointer cast?"); 5992 case Type::STK_MemberPointer: 5993 llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C"); 5994 } 5995 llvm_unreachable("Should have returned before this"); 5996 } 5997 5998 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled scalar cast"); 5999 } 6000 6001 static bool breakDownVectorType(QualType type, uint64_t &len, 6002 QualType &eltType) { 6003 // Vectors are simple. 6004 if (const VectorType *vecType = type->getAs<VectorType>()) { 6005 len = vecType->getNumElements(); 6006 eltType = vecType->getElementType(); 6007 assert(eltType->isScalarType()); 6008 return true; 6009 } 6010 6011 // We allow lax conversion to and from non-vector types, but only if 6012 // they're real types (i.e. non-complex, non-pointer scalar types). 6013 if (!type->isRealType()) return false; 6014 6015 len = 1; 6016 eltType = type; 6017 return true; 6018 } 6019 6020 /// Are the two types lax-compatible vector types? That is, given 6021 /// that one of them is a vector, do they have equal storage sizes, 6022 /// where the storage size is the number of elements times the element 6023 /// size? 6024 /// 6025 /// This will also return false if either of the types is neither a 6026 /// vector nor a real type. 6027 bool Sema::areLaxCompatibleVectorTypes(QualType srcTy, QualType destTy) { 6028 assert(destTy->isVectorType() || srcTy->isVectorType()); 6029 6030 // Disallow lax conversions between scalars and ExtVectors (these 6031 // conversions are allowed for other vector types because common headers 6032 // depend on them). Most scalar OP ExtVector cases are handled by the 6033 // splat path anyway, which does what we want (convert, not bitcast). 6034 // What this rules out for ExtVectors is crazy things like char4*float. 6035 if (srcTy->isScalarType() && destTy->isExtVectorType()) return false; 6036 if (destTy->isScalarType() && srcTy->isExtVectorType()) return false; 6037 6038 uint64_t srcLen, destLen; 6039 QualType srcEltTy, destEltTy; 6040 if (!breakDownVectorType(srcTy, srcLen, srcEltTy)) return false; 6041 if (!breakDownVectorType(destTy, destLen, destEltTy)) return false; 6042 6043 // ASTContext::getTypeSize will return the size rounded up to a 6044 // power of 2, so instead of using that, we need to use the raw 6045 // element size multiplied by the element count. 6046 uint64_t srcEltSize = Context.getTypeSize(srcEltTy); 6047 uint64_t destEltSize = Context.getTypeSize(destEltTy); 6048 6049 return (srcLen * srcEltSize == destLen * destEltSize); 6050 } 6051 6052 /// Is this a legal conversion between two types, one of which is 6053 /// known to be a vector type? 6054 bool Sema::isLaxVectorConversion(QualType srcTy, QualType destTy) { 6055 assert(destTy->isVectorType() || srcTy->isVectorType()); 6056 6057 if (!Context.getLangOpts().LaxVectorConversions) 6058 return false; 6059 return areLaxCompatibleVectorTypes(srcTy, destTy); 6060 } 6061 6062 bool Sema::CheckVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType VectorTy, QualType Ty, 6063 CastKind &Kind) { 6064 assert(VectorTy->isVectorType() && "Not a vector type!"); 6065 6066 if (Ty->isVectorType() || Ty->isIntegralType(Context)) { 6067 if (!areLaxCompatibleVectorTypes(Ty, VectorTy)) 6068 return Diag(R.getBegin(), 6069 Ty->isVectorType() ? 6070 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vectors : 6071 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_integer) 6072 << VectorTy << Ty << R; 6073 } else 6074 return Diag(R.getBegin(), 6075 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar) 6076 << VectorTy << Ty << R; 6077 6078 Kind = CK_BitCast; 6079 return false; 6080 } 6081 6082 ExprResult Sema::prepareVectorSplat(QualType VectorTy, Expr *SplattedExpr) { 6083 QualType DestElemTy = VectorTy->castAs<VectorType>()->getElementType(); 6084 6085 if (DestElemTy == SplattedExpr->getType()) 6086 return SplattedExpr; 6087 6088 assert(DestElemTy->isFloatingType() || 6089 DestElemTy->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()); 6090 6091 CastKind CK; 6092 if (VectorTy->isExtVectorType() && SplattedExpr->getType()->isBooleanType()) { 6093 // OpenCL requires that we convert `true` boolean expressions to -1, but 6094 // only when splatting vectors. 6095 if (DestElemTy->isFloatingType()) { 6096 // To avoid having to have a CK_BooleanToSignedFloating cast kind, we cast 6097 // in two steps: boolean to signed integral, then to floating. 6098 ExprResult CastExprRes = ImpCastExprToType(SplattedExpr, Context.IntTy, 6099 CK_BooleanToSignedIntegral); 6100 SplattedExpr = CastExprRes.get(); 6101 CK = CK_IntegralToFloating; 6102 } else { 6103 CK = CK_BooleanToSignedIntegral; 6104 } 6105 } else { 6106 ExprResult CastExprRes = SplattedExpr; 6107 CK = PrepareScalarCast(CastExprRes, DestElemTy); 6108 if (CastExprRes.isInvalid()) 6109 return ExprError(); 6110 SplattedExpr = CastExprRes.get(); 6111 } 6112 return ImpCastExprToType(SplattedExpr, DestElemTy, CK); 6113 } 6114 6115 ExprResult Sema::CheckExtVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType DestTy, 6116 Expr *CastExpr, CastKind &Kind) { 6117 assert(DestTy->isExtVectorType() && "Not an extended vector type!"); 6118 6119 QualType SrcTy = CastExpr->getType(); 6120 6121 // If SrcTy is a VectorType, the total size must match to explicitly cast to 6122 // an ExtVectorType. 6123 // In OpenCL, casts between vectors of different types are not allowed. 6124 // (See OpenCL 6.2). 6125 if (SrcTy->isVectorType()) { 6126 if (!areLaxCompatibleVectorTypes(SrcTy, DestTy) || 6127 (getLangOpts().OpenCL && 6128 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(DestTy, SrcTy))) { 6129 Diag(R.getBegin(),diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_ext_vectors) 6130 << DestTy << SrcTy << R; 6131 return ExprError(); 6132 } 6133 Kind = CK_BitCast; 6134 return CastExpr; 6135 } 6136 6137 // All non-pointer scalars can be cast to ExtVector type. The appropriate 6138 // conversion will take place first from scalar to elt type, and then 6139 // splat from elt type to vector. 6140 if (SrcTy->isPointerType()) 6141 return Diag(R.getBegin(), 6142 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar) 6143 << DestTy << SrcTy << R; 6144 6145 Kind = CK_VectorSplat; 6146 return prepareVectorSplat(DestTy, CastExpr); 6147 } 6148 6149 ExprResult 6150 Sema::ActOnCastExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc, 6151 Declarator &D, ParsedType &Ty, 6152 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *CastExpr) { 6153 assert(!D.isInvalidType() && (CastExpr != nullptr) && 6154 "ActOnCastExpr(): missing type or expr"); 6155 6156 TypeSourceInfo *castTInfo = GetTypeForDeclaratorCast(D, CastExpr->getType()); 6157 if (D.isInvalidType()) 6158 return ExprError(); 6159 6160 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 6161 // Check that there are no default arguments (C++ only). 6162 CheckExtraCXXDefaultArguments(D); 6163 } else { 6164 // Make sure any TypoExprs have been dealt with. 6165 ExprResult Res = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(CastExpr); 6166 if (!Res.isUsable()) 6167 return ExprError(); 6168 CastExpr = Res.get(); 6169 } 6170 6171 checkUnusedDeclAttributes(D); 6172 6173 QualType castType = castTInfo->getType(); 6174 Ty = CreateParsedType(castType, castTInfo); 6175 6176 bool isVectorLiteral = false; 6177 6178 // Check for an altivec or OpenCL literal, 6179 // i.e. all the elements are integer constants. 6180 ParenExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ParenExpr>(CastExpr); 6181 ParenListExpr *PLE = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(CastExpr); 6182 if ((getLangOpts().AltiVec || getLangOpts().ZVector || getLangOpts().OpenCL) 6183 && castType->isVectorType() && (PE || PLE)) { 6184 if (PLE && PLE->getNumExprs() == 0) { 6185 Diag(PLE->getExprLoc(), diag::err_altivec_empty_initializer); 6186 return ExprError(); 6187 } 6188 if (PE || PLE->getNumExprs() == 1) { 6189 Expr *E = (PE ? PE->getSubExpr() : PLE->getExpr(0)); 6190 if (!E->getType()->isVectorType()) 6191 isVectorLiteral = true; 6192 } 6193 else 6194 isVectorLiteral = true; 6195 } 6196 6197 // If this is a vector initializer, '(' type ')' '(' init, ..., init ')' 6198 // then handle it as such. 6199 if (isVectorLiteral) 6200 return BuildVectorLiteral(LParenLoc, RParenLoc, CastExpr, castTInfo); 6201 6202 // If the Expr being casted is a ParenListExpr, handle it specially. 6203 // This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a 6204 // sequence of BinOp comma operators. 6205 if (isa<ParenListExpr>(CastExpr)) { 6206 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, CastExpr); 6207 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 6208 CastExpr = Result.get(); 6209 } 6210 6211 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !castType->isVoidType() && 6212 !getSourceManager().isInSystemMacro(LParenLoc)) 6213 Diag(LParenLoc, diag::warn_old_style_cast) << CastExpr->getSourceRange(); 6214 6215 CheckTollFreeBridgeCast(castType, CastExpr); 6216 6217 CheckObjCBridgeRelatedCast(castType, CastExpr); 6218 6219 DiscardMisalignedMemberAddress(castType.getTypePtr(), CastExpr); 6220 6221 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, castTInfo, RParenLoc, CastExpr); 6222 } 6223 6224 ExprResult Sema::BuildVectorLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, 6225 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *E, 6226 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) { 6227 assert((isa<ParenListExpr>(E) || isa<ParenExpr>(E)) && 6228 "Expected paren or paren list expression"); 6229 6230 Expr **exprs; 6231 unsigned numExprs; 6232 Expr *subExpr; 6233 SourceLocation LiteralLParenLoc, LiteralRParenLoc; 6234 if (ParenListExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(E)) { 6235 LiteralLParenLoc = PE->getLParenLoc(); 6236 LiteralRParenLoc = PE->getRParenLoc(); 6237 exprs = PE->getExprs(); 6238 numExprs = PE->getNumExprs(); 6239 } else { // isa<ParenExpr> by assertion at function entrance 6240 LiteralLParenLoc = cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getLParen(); 6241 LiteralRParenLoc = cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getRParen(); 6242 subExpr = cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr(); 6243 exprs = &subExpr; 6244 numExprs = 1; 6245 } 6246 6247 QualType Ty = TInfo->getType(); 6248 assert(Ty->isVectorType() && "Expected vector type"); 6249 6250 SmallVector<Expr *, 8> initExprs; 6251 const VectorType *VTy = Ty->getAs<VectorType>(); 6252 unsigned numElems = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()->getNumElements(); 6253 6254 // '(...)' form of vector initialization in AltiVec: the number of 6255 // initializers must be one or must match the size of the vector. 6256 // If a single value is specified in the initializer then it will be 6257 // replicated to all the components of the vector 6258 if (VTy->getVectorKind() == VectorType::AltiVecVector) { 6259 // The number of initializers must be one or must match the size of the 6260 // vector. If a single value is specified in the initializer then it will 6261 // be replicated to all the components of the vector 6262 if (numExprs == 1) { 6263 QualType ElemTy = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()->getElementType(); 6264 ExprResult Literal = DefaultLvalueConversion(exprs[0]); 6265 if (Literal.isInvalid()) 6266 return ExprError(); 6267 Literal = ImpCastExprToType(Literal.get(), ElemTy, 6268 PrepareScalarCast(Literal, ElemTy)); 6269 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Literal.get()); 6270 } 6271 else if (numExprs < numElems) { 6272 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), 6273 diag::err_incorrect_number_of_vector_initializers); 6274 return ExprError(); 6275 } 6276 else 6277 initExprs.append(exprs, exprs + numExprs); 6278 } 6279 else { 6280 // For OpenCL, when the number of initializers is a single value, 6281 // it will be replicated to all components of the vector. 6282 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && 6283 VTy->getVectorKind() == VectorType::GenericVector && 6284 numExprs == 1) { 6285 QualType ElemTy = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()->getElementType(); 6286 ExprResult Literal = DefaultLvalueConversion(exprs[0]); 6287 if (Literal.isInvalid()) 6288 return ExprError(); 6289 Literal = ImpCastExprToType(Literal.get(), ElemTy, 6290 PrepareScalarCast(Literal, ElemTy)); 6291 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Literal.get()); 6292 } 6293 6294 initExprs.append(exprs, exprs + numExprs); 6295 } 6296 // FIXME: This means that pretty-printing the final AST will produce curly 6297 // braces instead of the original commas. 6298 InitListExpr *initE = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LiteralLParenLoc, 6299 initExprs, LiteralRParenLoc); 6300 initE->setType(Ty); 6301 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, initE); 6302 } 6303 6304 /// This is not an AltiVec-style cast or or C++ direct-initialization, so turn 6305 /// the ParenListExpr into a sequence of comma binary operators. 6306 ExprResult 6307 Sema::MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope *S, Expr *OrigExpr) { 6308 ParenListExpr *E = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(OrigExpr); 6309 if (!E) 6310 return OrigExpr; 6311 6312 ExprResult Result(E->getExpr(0)); 6313 6314 for (unsigned i = 1, e = E->getNumExprs(); i != e && !Result.isInvalid(); ++i) 6315 Result = ActOnBinOp(S, E->getExprLoc(), tok::comma, Result.get(), 6316 E->getExpr(i)); 6317 6318 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 6319 6320 return ActOnParenExpr(E->getLParenLoc(), E->getRParenLoc(), Result.get()); 6321 } 6322 6323 ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenListExpr(SourceLocation L, 6324 SourceLocation R, 6325 MultiExprArg Val) { 6326 Expr *expr = new (Context) ParenListExpr(Context, L, Val, R); 6327 return expr; 6328 } 6329 6330 /// Emit a specialized diagnostic when one expression is a null pointer 6331 /// constant and the other is not a pointer. Returns true if a diagnostic is 6332 /// emitted. 6333 bool Sema::DiagnoseConditionalForNull(Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr, 6334 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) { 6335 Expr *NullExpr = LHSExpr; 6336 Expr *NonPointerExpr = RHSExpr; 6337 Expr::NullPointerConstantKind NullKind = 6338 NullExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 6339 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull); 6340 6341 if (NullKind == Expr::NPCK_NotNull) { 6342 NullExpr = RHSExpr; 6343 NonPointerExpr = LHSExpr; 6344 NullKind = 6345 NullExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 6346 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull); 6347 } 6348 6349 if (NullKind == Expr::NPCK_NotNull) 6350 return false; 6351 6352 if (NullKind == Expr::NPCK_ZeroExpression) 6353 return false; 6354 6355 if (NullKind == Expr::NPCK_ZeroLiteral) { 6356 // In this case, check to make sure that we got here from a "NULL" 6357 // string in the source code. 6358 NullExpr = NullExpr->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 6359 SourceLocation loc = NullExpr->getExprLoc(); 6360 if (!findMacroSpelling(loc, "NULL")) 6361 return false; 6362 } 6363 6364 int DiagType = (NullKind == Expr::NPCK_CXX11_nullptr); 6365 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands_null) 6366 << NonPointerExpr->getType() << DiagType 6367 << NonPointerExpr->getSourceRange(); 6368 return true; 6369 } 6370 6371 /// Return false if the condition expression is valid, true otherwise. 6372 static bool checkCondition(Sema &S, Expr *Cond, SourceLocation QuestionLoc) { 6373 QualType CondTy = Cond->getType(); 6374 6375 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.i says the condition cannot be a floating point type. 6376 if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL && CondTy->isFloatingType()) { 6377 S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_nonfloat) 6378 << CondTy << Cond->getSourceRange(); 6379 return true; 6380 } 6381 6382 // C99 6.5.15p2 6383 if (CondTy->isScalarType()) return false; 6384 6385 S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar) 6386 << CondTy << Cond->getSourceRange(); 6387 return true; 6388 } 6389 6390 /// Handle when one or both operands are void type. 6391 static QualType checkConditionalVoidType(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, 6392 ExprResult &RHS) { 6393 Expr *LHSExpr = LHS.get(); 6394 Expr *RHSExpr = RHS.get(); 6395 6396 if (!LHSExpr->getType()->isVoidType()) 6397 S.Diag(RHSExpr->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void) 6398 << RHSExpr->getSourceRange(); 6399 if (!RHSExpr->getType()->isVoidType()) 6400 S.Diag(LHSExpr->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void) 6401 << LHSExpr->getSourceRange(); 6402 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), S.Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid); 6403 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), S.Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid); 6404 return S.Context.VoidTy; 6405 } 6406 6407 /// Return false if the NullExpr can be promoted to PointerTy, 6408 /// true otherwise. 6409 static bool checkConditionalNullPointer(Sema &S, ExprResult &NullExpr, 6410 QualType PointerTy) { 6411 if ((!PointerTy->isAnyPointerType() && !PointerTy->isBlockPointerType()) || 6412 !NullExpr.get()->isNullPointerConstant(S.Context, 6413 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) 6414 return true; 6415 6416 NullExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(NullExpr.get(), PointerTy, CK_NullToPointer); 6417 return false; 6418 } 6419 6420 /// Checks compatibility between two pointers and return the resulting 6421 /// type. 6422 static QualType checkConditionalPointerCompatibility(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, 6423 ExprResult &RHS, 6424 SourceLocation Loc) { 6425 QualType LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType(); 6426 QualType RHSTy = RHS.get()->getType(); 6427 6428 if (S.Context.hasSameType(LHSTy, RHSTy)) { 6429 // Two identical pointers types are always compatible. 6430 return LHSTy; 6431 } 6432 6433 QualType lhptee, rhptee; 6434 6435 // Get the pointee types. 6436 bool IsBlockPointer = false; 6437 if (const BlockPointerType *LHSBTy = LHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) { 6438 lhptee = LHSBTy->getPointeeType(); 6439 rhptee = RHSTy->castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 6440 IsBlockPointer = true; 6441 } else { 6442 lhptee = LHSTy->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 6443 rhptee = RHSTy->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 6444 } 6445 6446 // C99 6.5.15p6: If both operands are pointers to compatible types or to 6447 // differently qualified versions of compatible types, the result type is 6448 // a pointer to an appropriately qualified version of the composite 6449 // type. 6450 6451 // Only CVR-qualifiers exist in the standard, and the differently-qualified 6452 // clause doesn't make sense for our extensions. E.g. address space 2 should 6453 // be incompatible with address space 3: they may live on different devices or 6454 // anything. 6455 Qualifiers lhQual = lhptee.getQualifiers(); 6456 Qualifiers rhQual = rhptee.getQualifiers(); 6457 6458 LangAS ResultAddrSpace = LangAS::Default; 6459 LangAS LAddrSpace = lhQual.getAddressSpace(); 6460 LangAS RAddrSpace = rhQual.getAddressSpace(); 6461 if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 6462 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.5 - Conversion between pointers to distinct address 6463 // spaces is disallowed. 6464 if (lhQual.isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(rhQual)) 6465 ResultAddrSpace = LAddrSpace; 6466 else if (rhQual.isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(lhQual)) 6467 ResultAddrSpace = RAddrSpace; 6468 else { 6469 S.Diag(Loc, 6470 diag::err_typecheck_op_on_nonoverlapping_address_space_pointers) 6471 << LHSTy << RHSTy << 2 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() 6472 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 6473 return QualType(); 6474 } 6475 } 6476 6477 unsigned MergedCVRQual = lhQual.getCVRQualifiers() | rhQual.getCVRQualifiers(); 6478 auto LHSCastKind = CK_BitCast, RHSCastKind = CK_BitCast; 6479 lhQual.removeCVRQualifiers(); 6480 rhQual.removeCVRQualifiers(); 6481 6482 // OpenCL v2.0 specification doesn't extend compatibility of type qualifiers 6483 // (C99 6.7.3) for address spaces. We assume that the check should behave in 6484 // the same manner as it's defined for CVR qualifiers, so for OpenCL two 6485 // qual types are compatible iff 6486 // * corresponded types are compatible 6487 // * CVR qualifiers are equal 6488 // * address spaces are equal 6489 // Thus for conditional operator we merge CVR and address space unqualified 6490 // pointees and if there is a composite type we return a pointer to it with 6491 // merged qualifiers. 6492 if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 6493 LHSCastKind = LAddrSpace == ResultAddrSpace 6494 ? CK_BitCast 6495 : CK_AddressSpaceConversion; 6496 RHSCastKind = RAddrSpace == ResultAddrSpace 6497 ? CK_BitCast 6498 : CK_AddressSpaceConversion; 6499 lhQual.removeAddressSpace(); 6500 rhQual.removeAddressSpace(); 6501 } 6502 6503 lhptee = S.Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(), lhQual); 6504 rhptee = S.Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee.getUnqualifiedType(), rhQual); 6505 6506 QualType CompositeTy = S.Context.mergeTypes(lhptee, rhptee); 6507 6508 if (CompositeTy.isNull()) { 6509 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good 6510 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick 6511 // to get a consistent AST. 6512 QualType incompatTy; 6513 incompatTy = S.Context.getPointerType( 6514 S.Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(S.Context.VoidTy, ResultAddrSpace)); 6515 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), incompatTy, LHSCastKind); 6516 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), incompatTy, RHSCastKind); 6517 // FIXME: For OpenCL the warning emission and cast to void* leaves a room 6518 // for casts between types with incompatible address space qualifiers. 6519 // For the following code the compiler produces casts between global and 6520 // local address spaces of the corresponded innermost pointees: 6521 // local int *global *a; 6522 // global int *global *b; 6523 // a = (0 ? a : b); // see C99 6.5.16.1.p1. 6524 S.Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers) 6525 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() 6526 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 6527 return incompatTy; 6528 } 6529 6530 // The pointer types are compatible. 6531 // In case of OpenCL ResultTy should have the address space qualifier 6532 // which is a superset of address spaces of both the 2nd and the 3rd 6533 // operands of the conditional operator. 6534 QualType ResultTy = [&, ResultAddrSpace]() { 6535 if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 6536 Qualifiers CompositeQuals = CompositeTy.getQualifiers(); 6537 CompositeQuals.setAddressSpace(ResultAddrSpace); 6538 return S.Context 6539 .getQualifiedType(CompositeTy.getUnqualifiedType(), CompositeQuals) 6540 .withCVRQualifiers(MergedCVRQual); 6541 } 6542 return CompositeTy.withCVRQualifiers(MergedCVRQual); 6543 }(); 6544 if (IsBlockPointer) 6545 ResultTy = S.Context.getBlockPointerType(ResultTy); 6546 else 6547 ResultTy = S.Context.getPointerType(ResultTy); 6548 6549 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), ResultTy, LHSCastKind); 6550 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), ResultTy, RHSCastKind); 6551 return ResultTy; 6552 } 6553 6554 /// Return the resulting type when the operands are both block pointers. 6555 static QualType checkConditionalBlockPointerCompatibility(Sema &S, 6556 ExprResult &LHS, 6557 ExprResult &RHS, 6558 SourceLocation Loc) { 6559 QualType LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType(); 6560 QualType RHSTy = RHS.get()->getType(); 6561 6562 if (!LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || !RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) { 6563 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() || RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) { 6564 QualType destType = S.Context.getPointerType(S.Context.VoidTy); 6565 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), destType, CK_BitCast); 6566 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), destType, CK_BitCast); 6567 return destType; 6568 } 6569 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands) 6570 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() 6571 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 6572 return QualType(); 6573 } 6574 6575 // We have 2 block pointer types. 6576 return checkConditionalPointerCompatibility(S, LHS, RHS, Loc); 6577 } 6578 6579 /// Return the resulting type when the operands are both pointers. 6580 static QualType 6581 checkConditionalObjectPointersCompatibility(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, 6582 ExprResult &RHS, 6583 SourceLocation Loc) { 6584 // get the pointer types 6585 QualType LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType(); 6586 QualType RHSTy = RHS.get()->getType(); 6587 6588 // get the "pointed to" types 6589 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 6590 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 6591 6592 // ignore qualifiers on void (C99 6.5.15p3, clause 6) 6593 if (lhptee->isVoidType() && rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) { 6594 // Figure out necessary qualifiers (C99 6.5.15p6) 6595 QualType destPointee 6596 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers()); 6597 QualType destType = S.Context.getPointerType(destPointee); 6598 // Add qualifiers if necessary. 6599 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), destType, CK_NoOp); 6600 // Promote to void*. 6601 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), destType, CK_BitCast); 6602 return destType; 6603 } 6604 if (rhptee->isVoidType() && lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) { 6605 QualType destPointee 6606 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers()); 6607 QualType destType = S.Context.getPointerType(destPointee); 6608 // Add qualifiers if necessary. 6609 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), destType, CK_NoOp); 6610 // Promote to void*. 6611 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), destType, CK_BitCast); 6612 return destType; 6613 } 6614 6615 return checkConditionalPointerCompatibility(S, LHS, RHS, Loc); 6616 } 6617 6618 /// Return false if the first expression is not an integer and the second 6619 /// expression is not a pointer, true otherwise. 6620 static bool checkPointerIntegerMismatch(Sema &S, ExprResult &Int, 6621 Expr* PointerExpr, SourceLocation Loc, 6622 bool IsIntFirstExpr) { 6623 if (!PointerExpr->getType()->isPointerType() || 6624 !Int.get()->getType()->isIntegerType()) 6625 return false; 6626 6627 Expr *Expr1 = IsIntFirstExpr ? Int.get() : PointerExpr; 6628 Expr *Expr2 = IsIntFirstExpr ? PointerExpr : Int.get(); 6629 6630 S.Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch) 6631 << Expr1->getType() << Expr2->getType() 6632 << Expr1->getSourceRange() << Expr2->getSourceRange(); 6633 Int = S.ImpCastExprToType(Int.get(), PointerExpr->getType(), 6634 CK_IntegralToPointer); 6635 return true; 6636 } 6637 6638 /// Simple conversion between integer and floating point types. 6639 /// 6640 /// Used when handling the OpenCL conditional operator where the 6641 /// condition is a vector while the other operands are scalar. 6642 /// 6643 /// OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.i and s6.11.6 together require that the scalar 6644 /// types are either integer or floating type. Between the two 6645 /// operands, the type with the higher rank is defined as the "result 6646 /// type". The other operand needs to be promoted to the same type. No 6647 /// other type promotion is allowed. We cannot use 6648 /// UsualArithmeticConversions() for this purpose, since it always 6649 /// promotes promotable types. 6650 static QualType OpenCLArithmeticConversions(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, 6651 ExprResult &RHS, 6652 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) { 6653 LHS = S.DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHS.get()); 6654 if (LHS.isInvalid()) 6655 return QualType(); 6656 RHS = S.DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS.get()); 6657 if (RHS.isInvalid()) 6658 return QualType(); 6659 6660 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers. 6661 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent. 6662 QualType LHSType = 6663 S.Context.getCanonicalType(LHS.get()->getType()).getUnqualifiedType(); 6664 QualType RHSType = 6665 S.Context.getCanonicalType(RHS.get()->getType()).getUnqualifiedType(); 6666 6667 if (!LHSType->isIntegerType() && !LHSType->isRealFloatingType()) { 6668 S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_int_float) 6669 << LHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 6670 return QualType(); 6671 } 6672 6673 if (!RHSType->isIntegerType() && !RHSType->isRealFloatingType()) { 6674 S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_int_float) 6675 << RHSType << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 6676 return QualType(); 6677 } 6678 6679 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed. 6680 if (LHSType == RHSType) 6681 return LHSType; 6682 6683 // Now handle "real" floating types (i.e. float, double, long double). 6684 if (LHSType->isRealFloatingType() || RHSType->isRealFloatingType()) 6685 return handleFloatConversion(S, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType, 6686 /*IsCompAssign = */ false); 6687 6688 // Finally, we have two differing integer types. 6689 return handleIntegerConversion<doIntegralCast, doIntegralCast> 6690 (S, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType, /*IsCompAssign = */ false); 6691 } 6692 6693 /// Convert scalar operands to a vector that matches the 6694 /// condition in length. 6695 /// 6696 /// Used when handling the OpenCL conditional operator where the 6697 /// condition is a vector while the other operands are scalar. 6698 /// 6699 /// We first compute the "result type" for the scalar operands 6700 /// according to OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.i. Both operands are then converted 6701 /// into a vector of that type where the length matches the condition 6702 /// vector type. s6.11.6 requires that the element types of the result 6703 /// and the condition must have the same number of bits. 6704 static QualType 6705 OpenCLConvertScalarsToVectors(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 6706 QualType CondTy, SourceLocation QuestionLoc) { 6707 QualType ResTy = OpenCLArithmeticConversions(S, LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc); 6708 if (ResTy.isNull()) return QualType(); 6709 6710 const VectorType *CV = CondTy->getAs<VectorType>(); 6711 assert(CV); 6712 6713 // Determine the vector result type 6714 unsigned NumElements = CV->getNumElements(); 6715 QualType VectorTy = S.Context.getExtVectorType(ResTy, NumElements); 6716 6717 // Ensure that all types have the same number of bits 6718 if (S.Context.getTypeSize(CV->getElementType()) 6719 != S.Context.getTypeSize(ResTy)) { 6720 // Since VectorTy is created internally, it does not pretty print 6721 // with an OpenCL name. Instead, we just print a description. 6722 std::string EleTyName = ResTy.getUnqualifiedType().getAsString(); 6723 SmallString<64> Str; 6724 llvm::raw_svector_ostream OS(Str); 6725 OS << "(vector of " << NumElements << " '" << EleTyName << "' values)"; 6726 S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_conditional_vector_element_size) 6727 << CondTy << OS.str(); 6728 return QualType(); 6729 } 6730 6731 // Convert operands to the vector result type 6732 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), VectorTy, CK_VectorSplat); 6733 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), VectorTy, CK_VectorSplat); 6734 6735 return VectorTy; 6736 } 6737 6738 /// Return false if this is a valid OpenCL condition vector 6739 static bool checkOpenCLConditionVector(Sema &S, Expr *Cond, 6740 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) { 6741 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.11.6 says the elements of the vector must be of 6742 // integral type. 6743 const VectorType *CondTy = Cond->getType()->getAs<VectorType>(); 6744 assert(CondTy); 6745 QualType EleTy = CondTy->getElementType(); 6746 if (EleTy->isIntegerType()) return false; 6747 6748 S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_nonfloat) 6749 << Cond->getType() << Cond->getSourceRange(); 6750 return true; 6751 } 6752 6753 /// Return false if the vector condition type and the vector 6754 /// result type are compatible. 6755 /// 6756 /// OpenCL v1.1 s6.11.6 requires that both vector types have the same 6757 /// number of elements, and their element types have the same number 6758 /// of bits. 6759 static bool checkVectorResult(Sema &S, QualType CondTy, QualType VecResTy, 6760 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) { 6761 const VectorType *CV = CondTy->getAs<VectorType>(); 6762 const VectorType *RV = VecResTy->getAs<VectorType>(); 6763 assert(CV && RV); 6764 6765 if (CV->getNumElements() != RV->getNumElements()) { 6766 S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_conditional_vector_size) 6767 << CondTy << VecResTy; 6768 return true; 6769 } 6770 6771 QualType CVE = CV->getElementType(); 6772 QualType RVE = RV->getElementType(); 6773 6774 if (S.Context.getTypeSize(CVE) != S.Context.getTypeSize(RVE)) { 6775 S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_conditional_vector_element_size) 6776 << CondTy << VecResTy; 6777 return true; 6778 } 6779 6780 return false; 6781 } 6782 6783 /// Return the resulting type for the conditional operator in 6784 /// OpenCL (aka "ternary selection operator", OpenCL v1.1 6785 /// s6.3.i) when the condition is a vector type. 6786 static QualType 6787 OpenCLCheckVectorConditional(Sema &S, ExprResult &Cond, 6788 ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 6789 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) { 6790 Cond = S.DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Cond.get()); 6791 if (Cond.isInvalid()) 6792 return QualType(); 6793 QualType CondTy = Cond.get()->getType(); 6794 6795 if (checkOpenCLConditionVector(S, Cond.get(), QuestionLoc)) 6796 return QualType(); 6797 6798 // If either operand is a vector then find the vector type of the 6799 // result as specified in OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.i. 6800 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() || 6801 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) { 6802 QualType VecResTy = S.CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc, 6803 /*isCompAssign*/false, 6804 /*AllowBothBool*/true, 6805 /*AllowBoolConversions*/false); 6806 if (VecResTy.isNull()) return QualType(); 6807 // The result type must match the condition type as specified in 6808 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.11.6. 6809 if (checkVectorResult(S, CondTy, VecResTy, QuestionLoc)) 6810 return QualType(); 6811 return VecResTy; 6812 } 6813 6814 // Both operands are scalar. 6815 return OpenCLConvertScalarsToVectors(S, LHS, RHS, CondTy, QuestionLoc); 6816 } 6817 6818 /// Return true if the Expr is block type 6819 static bool checkBlockType(Sema &S, const Expr *E) { 6820 if (const CallExpr *CE = dyn_cast<CallExpr>(E)) { 6821 QualType Ty = CE->getCallee()->getType(); 6822 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType()) { 6823 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_opencl_ternary_with_block); 6824 return true; 6825 } 6826 } 6827 return false; 6828 } 6829 6830 /// Note that LHS is not null here, even if this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension. 6831 /// In that case, LHS = cond. 6832 /// C99 6.5.15 6833 QualType Sema::CheckConditionalOperands(ExprResult &Cond, ExprResult &LHS, 6834 ExprResult &RHS, ExprValueKind &VK, 6835 ExprObjectKind &OK, 6836 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) { 6837 6838 ExprResult LHSResult = CheckPlaceholderExpr(LHS.get()); 6839 if (!LHSResult.isUsable()) return QualType(); 6840 LHS = LHSResult; 6841 6842 ExprResult RHSResult = CheckPlaceholderExpr(RHS.get()); 6843 if (!RHSResult.isUsable()) return QualType(); 6844 RHS = RHSResult; 6845 6846 // C++ is sufficiently different to merit its own checker. 6847 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 6848 return CXXCheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, VK, OK, QuestionLoc); 6849 6850 VK = VK_RValue; 6851 OK = OK_Ordinary; 6852 6853 // The OpenCL operator with a vector condition is sufficiently 6854 // different to merit its own checker. 6855 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && Cond.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) 6856 return OpenCLCheckVectorConditional(*this, Cond, LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc); 6857 6858 // First, check the condition. 6859 Cond = UsualUnaryConversions(Cond.get()); 6860 if (Cond.isInvalid()) 6861 return QualType(); 6862 if (checkCondition(*this, Cond.get(), QuestionLoc)) 6863 return QualType(); 6864 6865 // Now check the two expressions. 6866 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() || 6867 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) 6868 return CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc, /*isCompAssign*/false, 6869 /*AllowBothBool*/true, 6870 /*AllowBoolConversions*/false); 6871 6872 QualType ResTy = UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS); 6873 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid()) 6874 return QualType(); 6875 6876 QualType LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType(); 6877 QualType RHSTy = RHS.get()->getType(); 6878 6879 // Diagnose attempts to convert between __float128 and long double where 6880 // such conversions currently can't be handled. 6881 if (unsupportedTypeConversion(*this, LHSTy, RHSTy)) { 6882 Diag(QuestionLoc, 6883 diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands) << LHSTy << RHSTy 6884 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 6885 return QualType(); 6886 } 6887 6888 // OpenCL v2.0 s6.12.5 - Blocks cannot be used as expressions of the ternary 6889 // selection operator (?:). 6890 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && 6891 (checkBlockType(*this, LHS.get()) | checkBlockType(*this, RHS.get()))) { 6892 return QualType(); 6893 } 6894 6895 // If both operands have arithmetic type, do the usual arithmetic conversions 6896 // to find a common type: C99 6.5.15p3,5. 6897 if (LHSTy->isArithmeticType() && RHSTy->isArithmeticType()) { 6898 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), ResTy, PrepareScalarCast(LHS, ResTy)); 6899 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), ResTy, PrepareScalarCast(RHS, ResTy)); 6900 6901 return ResTy; 6902 } 6903 6904 // If both operands are the same structure or union type, the result is that 6905 // type. 6906 if (const RecordType *LHSRT = LHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { // C99 6.5.15p3 6907 if (const RecordType *RHSRT = RHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) 6908 if (LHSRT->getDecl() == RHSRT->getDecl()) 6909 // "If both the operands have structure or union type, the result has 6910 // that type." This implies that CV qualifiers are dropped. 6911 return LHSTy.getUnqualifiedType(); 6912 // FIXME: Type of conditional expression must be complete in C mode. 6913 } 6914 6915 // C99 6.5.15p5: "If both operands have void type, the result has void type." 6916 // The following || allows only one side to be void (a GCC-ism). 6917 if (LHSTy->isVoidType() || RHSTy->isVoidType()) { 6918 return checkConditionalVoidType(*this, LHS, RHS); 6919 } 6920 6921 // C99 6.5.15p6 - "if one operand is a null pointer constant, the result has 6922 // the type of the other operand." 6923 if (!checkConditionalNullPointer(*this, RHS, LHSTy)) return LHSTy; 6924 if (!checkConditionalNullPointer(*this, LHS, RHSTy)) return RHSTy; 6925 6926 // All objective-c pointer type analysis is done here. 6927 QualType compositeType = FindCompositeObjCPointerType(LHS, RHS, 6928 QuestionLoc); 6929 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid()) 6930 return QualType(); 6931 if (!compositeType.isNull()) 6932 return compositeType; 6933 6934 6935 // Handle block pointer types. 6936 if (LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) 6937 return checkConditionalBlockPointerCompatibility(*this, LHS, RHS, 6938 QuestionLoc); 6939 6940 // Check constraints for C object pointers types (C99 6.5.15p3,6). 6941 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isPointerType()) 6942 return checkConditionalObjectPointersCompatibility(*this, LHS, RHS, 6943 QuestionLoc); 6944 6945 // GCC compatibility: soften pointer/integer mismatch. Note that 6946 // null pointers have been filtered out by this point. 6947 if (checkPointerIntegerMismatch(*this, LHS, RHS.get(), QuestionLoc, 6948 /*isIntFirstExpr=*/true)) 6949 return RHSTy; 6950 if (checkPointerIntegerMismatch(*this, RHS, LHS.get(), QuestionLoc, 6951 /*isIntFirstExpr=*/false)) 6952 return LHSTy; 6953 6954 // Emit a better diagnostic if one of the expressions is a null pointer 6955 // constant and the other is not a pointer type. In this case, the user most 6956 // likely forgot to take the address of the other expression. 6957 if (DiagnoseConditionalForNull(LHS.get(), RHS.get(), QuestionLoc)) 6958 return QualType(); 6959 6960 // Otherwise, the operands are not compatible. 6961 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands) 6962 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() 6963 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 6964 return QualType(); 6965 } 6966 6967 /// FindCompositeObjCPointerType - Helper method to find composite type of 6968 /// two objective-c pointer types of the two input expressions. 6969 QualType Sema::FindCompositeObjCPointerType(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 6970 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) { 6971 QualType LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType(); 6972 QualType RHSTy = RHS.get()->getType(); 6973 6974 // Handle things like Class and struct objc_class*. Here we case the result 6975 // to the pseudo-builtin, because that will be implicitly cast back to the 6976 // redefinition type if an attempt is made to access its fields. 6977 if (LHSTy->isObjCClassType() && 6978 (Context.hasSameType(RHSTy, Context.getObjCClassRedefinitionType()))) { 6979 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSTy, CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast); 6980 return LHSTy; 6981 } 6982 if (RHSTy->isObjCClassType() && 6983 (Context.hasSameType(LHSTy, Context.getObjCClassRedefinitionType()))) { 6984 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSTy, CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast); 6985 return RHSTy; 6986 } 6987 // And the same for struct objc_object* / id 6988 if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() && 6989 (Context.hasSameType(RHSTy, Context.getObjCIdRedefinitionType()))) { 6990 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSTy, CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast); 6991 return LHSTy; 6992 } 6993 if (RHSTy->isObjCIdType() && 6994 (Context.hasSameType(LHSTy, Context.getObjCIdRedefinitionType()))) { 6995 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSTy, CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast); 6996 return RHSTy; 6997 } 6998 // And the same for struct objc_selector* / SEL 6999 if (Context.isObjCSelType(LHSTy) && 7000 (Context.hasSameType(RHSTy, Context.getObjCSelRedefinitionType()))) { 7001 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSTy, CK_BitCast); 7002 return LHSTy; 7003 } 7004 if (Context.isObjCSelType(RHSTy) && 7005 (Context.hasSameType(LHSTy, Context.getObjCSelRedefinitionType()))) { 7006 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSTy, CK_BitCast); 7007 return RHSTy; 7008 } 7009 // Check constraints for Objective-C object pointers types. 7010 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 7011 7012 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) { 7013 // Two identical object pointer types are always compatible. 7014 return LHSTy; 7015 } 7016 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHSTy->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 7017 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHSTy->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 7018 QualType compositeType = LHSTy; 7019 7020 // If both operands are interfaces and either operand can be 7021 // assigned to the other, use that type as the composite 7022 // type. This allows 7023 // xxx ? (A*) a : (B*) b 7024 // where B is a subclass of A. 7025 // 7026 // Additionally, as for assignment, if either type is 'id' 7027 // allow silent coercion. Finally, if the types are 7028 // incompatible then make sure to use 'id' as the composite 7029 // type so the result is acceptable for sending messages to. 7030 7031 // FIXME: Consider unifying with 'areComparableObjCPointerTypes'. 7032 // It could return the composite type. 7033 if (!(compositeType = 7034 Context.areCommonBaseCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)).isNull()) { 7035 // Nothing more to do. 7036 } else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)) { 7037 compositeType = RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? RHSTy : LHSTy; 7038 } else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT)) { 7039 compositeType = LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? LHSTy : RHSTy; 7040 } else if ((LHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || 7041 RHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) && 7042 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(LHSTy, RHSTy, true)) { 7043 // Need to handle "id<xx>" explicitly. 7044 // GCC allows qualified id and any Objective-C type to devolve to 7045 // id. Currently localizing to here until clear this should be 7046 // part of ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible. 7047 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType(); 7048 } else if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() || RHSTy->isObjCIdType()) { 7049 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType(); 7050 } else { 7051 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands) 7052 << LHSTy << RHSTy 7053 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 7054 QualType incompatTy = Context.getObjCIdType(); 7055 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), incompatTy, CK_BitCast); 7056 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), incompatTy, CK_BitCast); 7057 return incompatTy; 7058 } 7059 // The object pointer types are compatible. 7060 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), compositeType, CK_BitCast); 7061 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), compositeType, CK_BitCast); 7062 return compositeType; 7063 } 7064 // Check Objective-C object pointer types and 'void *' 7065 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 7066 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) { 7067 // ARC forbids the implicit conversion of object pointers to 'void *', 7068 // so these types are not compatible. 7069 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_cond_voidptr_arc) << LHSTy << RHSTy 7070 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 7071 LHS = RHS = true; 7072 return QualType(); 7073 } 7074 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 7075 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 7076 QualType destPointee 7077 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers()); 7078 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee); 7079 // Add qualifiers if necessary. 7080 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), destType, CK_NoOp); 7081 // Promote to void*. 7082 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), destType, CK_BitCast); 7083 return destType; 7084 } 7085 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) { 7086 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) { 7087 // ARC forbids the implicit conversion of object pointers to 'void *', 7088 // so these types are not compatible. 7089 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_cond_voidptr_arc) << LHSTy << RHSTy 7090 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 7091 LHS = RHS = true; 7092 return QualType(); 7093 } 7094 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 7095 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 7096 QualType destPointee 7097 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers()); 7098 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee); 7099 // Add qualifiers if necessary. 7100 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), destType, CK_NoOp); 7101 // Promote to void*. 7102 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), destType, CK_BitCast); 7103 return destType; 7104 } 7105 return QualType(); 7106 } 7107 7108 /// SuggestParentheses - Emit a note with a fixit hint that wraps 7109 /// ParenRange in parentheses. 7110 static void SuggestParentheses(Sema &Self, SourceLocation Loc, 7111 const PartialDiagnostic &Note, 7112 SourceRange ParenRange) { 7113 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.getLocForEndOfToken(ParenRange.getEnd()); 7114 if (ParenRange.getBegin().isFileID() && ParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() && 7115 EndLoc.isValid()) { 7116 Self.Diag(Loc, Note) 7117 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(ParenRange.getBegin(), "(") 7118 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")"); 7119 } else { 7120 // We can't display the parentheses, so just show the bare note. 7121 Self.Diag(Loc, Note) << ParenRange; 7122 } 7123 } 7124 7125 static bool IsArithmeticOp(BinaryOperatorKind Opc) { 7126 return BinaryOperator::isAdditiveOp(Opc) || 7127 BinaryOperator::isMultiplicativeOp(Opc) || 7128 BinaryOperator::isShiftOp(Opc); 7129 } 7130 7131 /// IsArithmeticBinaryExpr - Returns true if E is an arithmetic binary 7132 /// expression, either using a built-in or overloaded operator, 7133 /// and sets *OpCode to the opcode and *RHSExprs to the right-hand side 7134 /// expression. 7135 static bool IsArithmeticBinaryExpr(Expr *E, BinaryOperatorKind *Opcode, 7136 Expr **RHSExprs) { 7137 // Don't strip parenthesis: we should not warn if E is in parenthesis. 7138 E = E->IgnoreImpCasts(); 7139 E = E->IgnoreConversionOperator(); 7140 E = E->IgnoreImpCasts(); 7141 if (auto *MTE = dyn_cast<MaterializeTemporaryExpr>(E)) { 7142 E = MTE->GetTemporaryExpr(); 7143 E = E->IgnoreImpCasts(); 7144 } 7145 7146 // Built-in binary operator. 7147 if (BinaryOperator *OP = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E)) { 7148 if (IsArithmeticOp(OP->getOpcode())) { 7149 *Opcode = OP->getOpcode(); 7150 *RHSExprs = OP->getRHS(); 7151 return true; 7152 } 7153 } 7154 7155 // Overloaded operator. 7156 if (CXXOperatorCallExpr *Call = dyn_cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) { 7157 if (Call->getNumArgs() != 2) 7158 return false; 7159 7160 // Make sure this is really a binary operator that is safe to pass into 7161 // BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOpcode(), e.g. it's not a subscript op. 7162 OverloadedOperatorKind OO = Call->getOperator(); 7163 if (OO < OO_Plus || OO > OO_Arrow || 7164 OO == OO_PlusPlus || OO == OO_MinusMinus) 7165 return false; 7166 7167 BinaryOperatorKind OpKind = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOpcode(OO); 7168 if (IsArithmeticOp(OpKind)) { 7169 *Opcode = OpKind; 7170 *RHSExprs = Call->getArg(1); 7171 return true; 7172 } 7173 } 7174 7175 return false; 7176 } 7177 7178 /// ExprLooksBoolean - Returns true if E looks boolean, i.e. it has boolean type 7179 /// or is a logical expression such as (x==y) which has int type, but is 7180 /// commonly interpreted as boolean. 7181 static bool ExprLooksBoolean(Expr *E) { 7182 E = E->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 7183 7184 if (E->getType()->isBooleanType()) 7185 return true; 7186 if (BinaryOperator *OP = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E)) 7187 return OP->isComparisonOp() || OP->isLogicalOp(); 7188 if (UnaryOperator *OP = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(E)) 7189 return OP->getOpcode() == UO_LNot; 7190 if (E->getType()->isPointerType()) 7191 return true; 7192 // FIXME: What about overloaded operator calls returning "unspecified boolean 7193 // type"s (commonly pointer-to-members)? 7194 7195 return false; 7196 } 7197 7198 /// DiagnoseConditionalPrecedence - Emit a warning when a conditional operator 7199 /// and binary operator are mixed in a way that suggests the programmer assumed 7200 /// the conditional operator has higher precedence, for example: 7201 /// "int x = a + someBinaryCondition ? 1 : 2". 7202 static void DiagnoseConditionalPrecedence(Sema &Self, 7203 SourceLocation OpLoc, 7204 Expr *Condition, 7205 Expr *LHSExpr, 7206 Expr *RHSExpr) { 7207 BinaryOperatorKind CondOpcode; 7208 Expr *CondRHS; 7209 7210 if (!IsArithmeticBinaryExpr(Condition, &CondOpcode, &CondRHS)) 7211 return; 7212 if (!ExprLooksBoolean(CondRHS)) 7213 return; 7214 7215 // The condition is an arithmetic binary expression, with a right- 7216 // hand side that looks boolean, so warn. 7217 7218 Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_precedence_conditional) 7219 << Condition->getSourceRange() 7220 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(CondOpcode); 7221 7222 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc, 7223 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence) 7224 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(CondOpcode), 7225 SourceRange(Condition->getLocStart(), Condition->getLocEnd())); 7226 7227 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc, 7228 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_conditional_first), 7229 SourceRange(CondRHS->getLocStart(), RHSExpr->getLocEnd())); 7230 } 7231 7232 /// Compute the nullability of a conditional expression. 7233 static QualType computeConditionalNullability(QualType ResTy, bool IsBin, 7234 QualType LHSTy, QualType RHSTy, 7235 ASTContext &Ctx) { 7236 if (!ResTy->isAnyPointerType()) 7237 return ResTy; 7238 7239 auto GetNullability = [&Ctx](QualType Ty) { 7240 Optional<NullabilityKind> Kind = Ty->getNullability(Ctx); 7241 if (Kind) 7242 return *Kind; 7243 return NullabilityKind::Unspecified; 7244 }; 7245 7246 auto LHSKind = GetNullability(LHSTy), RHSKind = GetNullability(RHSTy); 7247 NullabilityKind MergedKind; 7248 7249 // Compute nullability of a binary conditional expression. 7250 if (IsBin) { 7251 if (LHSKind == NullabilityKind::NonNull) 7252 MergedKind = NullabilityKind::NonNull; 7253 else 7254 MergedKind = RHSKind; 7255 // Compute nullability of a normal conditional expression. 7256 } else { 7257 if (LHSKind == NullabilityKind::Nullable || 7258 RHSKind == NullabilityKind::Nullable) 7259 MergedKind = NullabilityKind::Nullable; 7260 else if (LHSKind == NullabilityKind::NonNull) 7261 MergedKind = RHSKind; 7262 else if (RHSKind == NullabilityKind::NonNull) 7263 MergedKind = LHSKind; 7264 else 7265 MergedKind = NullabilityKind::Unspecified; 7266 } 7267 7268 // Return if ResTy already has the correct nullability. 7269 if (GetNullability(ResTy) == MergedKind) 7270 return ResTy; 7271 7272 // Strip all nullability from ResTy. 7273 while (ResTy->getNullability(Ctx)) 7274 ResTy = ResTy.getSingleStepDesugaredType(Ctx); 7275 7276 // Create a new AttributedType with the new nullability kind. 7277 auto NewAttr = AttributedType::getNullabilityAttrKind(MergedKind); 7278 return Ctx.getAttributedType(NewAttr, ResTy, ResTy); 7279 } 7280 7281 /// ActOnConditionalOp - Parse a ?: operation. Note that 'LHS' may be null 7282 /// in the case of a the GNU conditional expr extension. 7283 ExprResult Sema::ActOnConditionalOp(SourceLocation QuestionLoc, 7284 SourceLocation ColonLoc, 7285 Expr *CondExpr, Expr *LHSExpr, 7286 Expr *RHSExpr) { 7287 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 7288 // C cannot handle TypoExpr nodes in the condition because it 7289 // doesn't handle dependent types properly, so make sure any TypoExprs have 7290 // been dealt with before checking the operands. 7291 ExprResult CondResult = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(CondExpr); 7292 ExprResult LHSResult = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(LHSExpr); 7293 ExprResult RHSResult = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(RHSExpr); 7294 7295 if (!CondResult.isUsable()) 7296 return ExprError(); 7297 7298 if (LHSExpr) { 7299 if (!LHSResult.isUsable()) 7300 return ExprError(); 7301 } 7302 7303 if (!RHSResult.isUsable()) 7304 return ExprError(); 7305 7306 CondExpr = CondResult.get(); 7307 LHSExpr = LHSResult.get(); 7308 RHSExpr = RHSResult.get(); 7309 } 7310 7311 // If this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension, analyze the types as though the LHS 7312 // was the condition. 7313 OpaqueValueExpr *opaqueValue = nullptr; 7314 Expr *commonExpr = nullptr; 7315 if (!LHSExpr) { 7316 commonExpr = CondExpr; 7317 // Lower out placeholder types first. This is important so that we don't 7318 // try to capture a placeholder. This happens in few cases in C++; such 7319 // as Objective-C++'s dictionary subscripting syntax. 7320 if (commonExpr->hasPlaceholderType()) { 7321 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(commonExpr); 7322 if (!result.isUsable()) return ExprError(); 7323 commonExpr = result.get(); 7324 } 7325 // We usually want to apply unary conversions *before* saving, except 7326 // in the special case of a C++ l-value conditional. 7327 if (!(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 7328 && !commonExpr->isTypeDependent() 7329 && commonExpr->getValueKind() == RHSExpr->getValueKind() 7330 && commonExpr->isGLValue() 7331 && commonExpr->isOrdinaryOrBitFieldObject() 7332 && RHSExpr->isOrdinaryOrBitFieldObject() 7333 && Context.hasSameType(commonExpr->getType(), RHSExpr->getType()))) { 7334 ExprResult commonRes = UsualUnaryConversions(commonExpr); 7335 if (commonRes.isInvalid()) 7336 return ExprError(); 7337 commonExpr = commonRes.get(); 7338 } 7339 7340 // If the common expression is a class or array prvalue, materialize it 7341 // so that we can safely refer to it multiple times. 7342 if (commonExpr->isRValue() && (commonExpr->getType()->isRecordType() || 7343 commonExpr->getType()->isArrayType())) { 7344 ExprResult MatExpr = TemporaryMaterializationConversion(commonExpr); 7345 if (MatExpr.isInvalid()) 7346 return ExprError(); 7347 commonExpr = MatExpr.get(); 7348 } 7349 7350 opaqueValue = new (Context) OpaqueValueExpr(commonExpr->getExprLoc(), 7351 commonExpr->getType(), 7352 commonExpr->getValueKind(), 7353 commonExpr->getObjectKind(), 7354 commonExpr); 7355 LHSExpr = CondExpr = opaqueValue; 7356 } 7357 7358 QualType LHSTy = LHSExpr->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExpr->getType(); 7359 ExprValueKind VK = VK_RValue; 7360 ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary; 7361 ExprResult Cond = CondExpr, LHS = LHSExpr, RHS = RHSExpr; 7362 QualType result = CheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, 7363 VK, OK, QuestionLoc); 7364 if (result.isNull() || Cond.isInvalid() || LHS.isInvalid() || 7365 RHS.isInvalid()) 7366 return ExprError(); 7367 7368 DiagnoseConditionalPrecedence(*this, QuestionLoc, Cond.get(), LHS.get(), 7369 RHS.get()); 7370 7371 CheckBoolLikeConversion(Cond.get(), QuestionLoc); 7372 7373 result = computeConditionalNullability(result, commonExpr, LHSTy, RHSTy, 7374 Context); 7375 7376 if (!commonExpr) 7377 return new (Context) 7378 ConditionalOperator(Cond.get(), QuestionLoc, LHS.get(), ColonLoc, 7379 RHS.get(), result, VK, OK); 7380 7381 return new (Context) BinaryConditionalOperator( 7382 commonExpr, opaqueValue, Cond.get(), LHS.get(), RHS.get(), QuestionLoc, 7383 ColonLoc, result, VK, OK); 7384 } 7385 7386 // checkPointerTypesForAssignment - This is a very tricky routine (despite 7387 // being closely modeled after the C99 spec:-). The odd characteristic of this 7388 // routine is it effectively iqnores the qualifiers on the top level pointee. 7389 // This circumvents the usual type rules specified in 6.2.7p1 & 6.7.5.[1-3]. 7390 // FIXME: add a couple examples in this comment. 7391 static Sema::AssignConvertType 7392 checkPointerTypesForAssignment(Sema &S, QualType LHSType, QualType RHSType) { 7393 assert(LHSType.isCanonical() && "LHS not canonicalized!"); 7394 assert(RHSType.isCanonical() && "RHS not canonicalized!"); 7395 7396 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level) 7397 const Type *lhptee, *rhptee; 7398 Qualifiers lhq, rhq; 7399 std::tie(lhptee, lhq) = 7400 cast<PointerType>(LHSType)->getPointeeType().split().asPair(); 7401 std::tie(rhptee, rhq) = 7402 cast<PointerType>(RHSType)->getPointeeType().split().asPair(); 7403 7404 Sema::AssignConvertType ConvTy = Sema::Compatible; 7405 7406 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: This following citation is common to constraints 7407 // 3 & 4 (below). ...and the type *pointed to* by the left has all the 7408 // qualifiers of the type *pointed to* by the right; 7409 7410 // As a special case, 'non-__weak A *' -> 'non-__weak const *' is okay. 7411 if (lhq.getObjCLifetime() != rhq.getObjCLifetime() && 7412 lhq.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(rhq)) { 7413 // Ignore lifetime for further calculation. 7414 lhq.removeObjCLifetime(); 7415 rhq.removeObjCLifetime(); 7416 } 7417 7418 if (!lhq.compatiblyIncludes(rhq)) { 7419 // Treat address-space mismatches as fatal. TODO: address subspaces 7420 if (!lhq.isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(rhq)) 7421 ConvTy = Sema::IncompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers; 7422 7423 // It's okay to add or remove GC or lifetime qualifiers when converting to 7424 // and from void*. 7425 else if (lhq.withoutObjCGCAttr().withoutObjCLifetime() 7426 .compatiblyIncludes( 7427 rhq.withoutObjCGCAttr().withoutObjCLifetime()) 7428 && (lhptee->isVoidType() || rhptee->isVoidType())) 7429 ; // keep old 7430 7431 // Treat lifetime mismatches as fatal. 7432 else if (lhq.getObjCLifetime() != rhq.getObjCLifetime()) 7433 ConvTy = Sema::IncompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers; 7434 7435 // For GCC/MS compatibility, other qualifier mismatches are treated 7436 // as still compatible in C. 7437 else ConvTy = Sema::CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers; 7438 } 7439 7440 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 4): If one operand is a pointer to an object or 7441 // incomplete type and the other is a pointer to a qualified or unqualified 7442 // version of void... 7443 if (lhptee->isVoidType()) { 7444 if (rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) 7445 return ConvTy; 7446 7447 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer. 7448 assert(rhptee->isFunctionType()); 7449 return Sema::FunctionVoidPointer; 7450 } 7451 7452 if (rhptee->isVoidType()) { 7453 if (lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) 7454 return ConvTy; 7455 7456 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer. 7457 assert(lhptee->isFunctionType()); 7458 return Sema::FunctionVoidPointer; 7459 } 7460 7461 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 3): both operands are pointers to qualified or 7462 // unqualified versions of compatible types, ... 7463 QualType ltrans = QualType(lhptee, 0), rtrans = QualType(rhptee, 0); 7464 if (!S.Context.typesAreCompatible(ltrans, rtrans)) { 7465 // Check if the pointee types are compatible ignoring the sign. 7466 // We explicitly check for char so that we catch "char" vs 7467 // "unsigned char" on systems where "char" is unsigned. 7468 if (lhptee->isCharType()) 7469 ltrans = S.Context.UnsignedCharTy; 7470 else if (lhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation()) 7471 ltrans = S.Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(ltrans); 7472 7473 if (rhptee->isCharType()) 7474 rtrans = S.Context.UnsignedCharTy; 7475 else if (rhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation()) 7476 rtrans = S.Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(rtrans); 7477 7478 if (ltrans == rtrans) { 7479 // Types are compatible ignoring the sign. Qualifier incompatibility 7480 // takes priority over sign incompatibility because the sign 7481 // warning can be disabled. 7482 if (ConvTy != Sema::Compatible) 7483 return ConvTy; 7484 7485 return Sema::IncompatiblePointerSign; 7486 } 7487 7488 // If we are a multi-level pointer, it's possible that our issue is simply 7489 // one of qualification - e.g. char ** -> const char ** is not allowed. If 7490 // the eventual target type is the same and the pointers have the same 7491 // level of indirection, this must be the issue. 7492 if (isa<PointerType>(lhptee) && isa<PointerType>(rhptee)) { 7493 do { 7494 lhptee = cast<PointerType>(lhptee)->getPointeeType().getTypePtr(); 7495 rhptee = cast<PointerType>(rhptee)->getPointeeType().getTypePtr(); 7496 } while (isa<PointerType>(lhptee) && isa<PointerType>(rhptee)); 7497 7498 if (lhptee == rhptee) 7499 return Sema::IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers; 7500 } 7501 7502 // General pointer incompatibility takes priority over qualifiers. 7503 return Sema::IncompatiblePointer; 7504 } 7505 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 7506 S.IsFunctionConversion(ltrans, rtrans, ltrans)) 7507 return Sema::IncompatiblePointer; 7508 return ConvTy; 7509 } 7510 7511 /// checkBlockPointerTypesForAssignment - This routine determines whether two 7512 /// block pointer types are compatible or whether a block and normal pointer 7513 /// are compatible. It is more restrict than comparing two function pointer 7514 // types. 7515 static Sema::AssignConvertType 7516 checkBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(Sema &S, QualType LHSType, 7517 QualType RHSType) { 7518 assert(LHSType.isCanonical() && "LHS not canonicalized!"); 7519 assert(RHSType.isCanonical() && "RHS not canonicalized!"); 7520 7521 QualType lhptee, rhptee; 7522 7523 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level) 7524 lhptee = cast<BlockPointerType>(LHSType)->getPointeeType(); 7525 rhptee = cast<BlockPointerType>(RHSType)->getPointeeType(); 7526 7527 // In C++, the types have to match exactly. 7528 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 7529 return Sema::IncompatibleBlockPointer; 7530 7531 Sema::AssignConvertType ConvTy = Sema::Compatible; 7532 7533 // For blocks we enforce that qualifiers are identical. 7534 Qualifiers LQuals = lhptee.getLocalQualifiers(); 7535 Qualifiers RQuals = rhptee.getLocalQualifiers(); 7536 if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 7537 LQuals.removeAddressSpace(); 7538 RQuals.removeAddressSpace(); 7539 } 7540 if (LQuals != RQuals) 7541 ConvTy = Sema::CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers; 7542 7543 // FIXME: OpenCL doesn't define the exact compile time semantics for a block 7544 // assignment. 7545 // The current behavior is similar to C++ lambdas. A block might be 7546 // assigned to a variable iff its return type and parameters are compatible 7547 // (C99 6.2.7) with the corresponding return type and parameters of the LHS of 7548 // an assignment. Presumably it should behave in way that a function pointer 7549 // assignment does in C, so for each parameter and return type: 7550 // * CVR and address space of LHS should be a superset of CVR and address 7551 // space of RHS. 7552 // * unqualified types should be compatible. 7553 if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 7554 if (!S.Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible( 7555 S.Context.getQualifiedType(LHSType.getUnqualifiedType(), LQuals), 7556 S.Context.getQualifiedType(RHSType.getUnqualifiedType(), RQuals))) 7557 return Sema::IncompatibleBlockPointer; 7558 } else if (!S.Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(LHSType, RHSType)) 7559 return Sema::IncompatibleBlockPointer; 7560 7561 return ConvTy; 7562 } 7563 7564 /// checkObjCPointerTypesForAssignment - Compares two objective-c pointer types 7565 /// for assignment compatibility. 7566 static Sema::AssignConvertType 7567 checkObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(Sema &S, QualType LHSType, 7568 QualType RHSType) { 7569 assert(LHSType.isCanonical() && "LHS was not canonicalized!"); 7570 assert(RHSType.isCanonical() && "RHS was not canonicalized!"); 7571 7572 if (LHSType->isObjCBuiltinType()) { 7573 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers. 7574 if (LHSType->isObjCClassType() && !RHSType->isObjCBuiltinType() && 7575 !RHSType->isObjCQualifiedClassType()) 7576 return Sema::IncompatiblePointer; 7577 return Sema::Compatible; 7578 } 7579 if (RHSType->isObjCBuiltinType()) { 7580 if (RHSType->isObjCClassType() && !LHSType->isObjCBuiltinType() && 7581 !LHSType->isObjCQualifiedClassType()) 7582 return Sema::IncompatiblePointer; 7583 return Sema::Compatible; 7584 } 7585 QualType lhptee = LHSType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 7586 QualType rhptee = RHSType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 7587 7588 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee) && 7589 // make an exception for id<P> 7590 !LHSType->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) 7591 return Sema::CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers; 7592 7593 if (S.Context.typesAreCompatible(LHSType, RHSType)) 7594 return Sema::Compatible; 7595 if (LHSType->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || RHSType->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) 7596 return Sema::IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId; 7597 return Sema::IncompatiblePointer; 7598 } 7599 7600 Sema::AssignConvertType 7601 Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(SourceLocation Loc, 7602 QualType LHSType, QualType RHSType) { 7603 // Fake up an opaque expression. We don't actually care about what 7604 // cast operations are required, so if CheckAssignmentConstraints 7605 // adds casts to this they'll be wasted, but fortunately that doesn't 7606 // usually happen on valid code. 7607 OpaqueValueExpr RHSExpr(Loc, RHSType, VK_RValue); 7608 ExprResult RHSPtr = &RHSExpr; 7609 CastKind K; 7610 7611 return CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHSPtr, K, /*ConvertRHS=*/false); 7612 } 7613 7614 /// This helper function returns true if QT is a vector type that has element 7615 /// type ElementType. 7616 static bool isVector(QualType QT, QualType ElementType) { 7617 if (const VectorType *VT = QT->getAs<VectorType>()) 7618 return VT->getElementType() == ElementType; 7619 return false; 7620 } 7621 7622 /// CheckAssignmentConstraints (C99 6.5.16) - This routine currently 7623 /// has code to accommodate several GCC extensions when type checking 7624 /// pointers. Here are some objectionable examples that GCC considers warnings: 7625 /// 7626 /// int a, *pint; 7627 /// short *pshort; 7628 /// struct foo *pfoo; 7629 /// 7630 /// pint = pshort; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type 7631 /// a = pint; // warning: assignment makes integer from pointer without a cast 7632 /// pint = a; // warning: assignment makes pointer from integer without a cast 7633 /// pint = pfoo; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type 7634 /// 7635 /// As a result, the code for dealing with pointers is more complex than the 7636 /// C99 spec dictates. 7637 /// 7638 /// Sets 'Kind' for any result kind except Incompatible. 7639 Sema::AssignConvertType 7640 Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType LHSType, ExprResult &RHS, 7641 CastKind &Kind, bool ConvertRHS) { 7642 QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType(); 7643 QualType OrigLHSType = LHSType; 7644 7645 // Get canonical types. We're not formatting these types, just comparing 7646 // them. 7647 LHSType = Context.getCanonicalType(LHSType).getUnqualifiedType(); 7648 RHSType = Context.getCanonicalType(RHSType).getUnqualifiedType(); 7649 7650 // Common case: no conversion required. 7651 if (LHSType == RHSType) { 7652 Kind = CK_NoOp; 7653 return Compatible; 7654 } 7655 7656 // If we have an atomic type, try a non-atomic assignment, then just add an 7657 // atomic qualification step. 7658 if (const AtomicType *AtomicTy = dyn_cast<AtomicType>(LHSType)) { 7659 Sema::AssignConvertType result = 7660 CheckAssignmentConstraints(AtomicTy->getValueType(), RHS, Kind); 7661 if (result != Compatible) 7662 return result; 7663 if (Kind != CK_NoOp && ConvertRHS) 7664 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), AtomicTy->getValueType(), Kind); 7665 Kind = CK_NonAtomicToAtomic; 7666 return Compatible; 7667 } 7668 7669 // If the left-hand side is a reference type, then we are in a 7670 // (rare!) case where we've allowed the use of references in C, 7671 // e.g., as a parameter type in a built-in function. In this case, 7672 // just make sure that the type referenced is compatible with the 7673 // right-hand side type. The caller is responsible for adjusting 7674 // LHSType so that the resulting expression does not have reference 7675 // type. 7676 if (const ReferenceType *LHSTypeRef = LHSType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) { 7677 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LHSTypeRef->getPointeeType(), RHSType)) { 7678 Kind = CK_LValueBitCast; 7679 return Compatible; 7680 } 7681 return Incompatible; 7682 } 7683 7684 // Allow scalar to ExtVector assignments, and assignments of an ExtVector type 7685 // to the same ExtVector type. 7686 if (LHSType->isExtVectorType()) { 7687 if (RHSType->isExtVectorType()) 7688 return Incompatible; 7689 if (RHSType->isArithmeticType()) { 7690 // CK_VectorSplat does T -> vector T, so first cast to the element type. 7691 if (ConvertRHS) 7692 RHS = prepareVectorSplat(LHSType, RHS.get()); 7693 Kind = CK_VectorSplat; 7694 return Compatible; 7695 } 7696 } 7697 7698 // Conversions to or from vector type. 7699 if (LHSType->isVectorType() || RHSType->isVectorType()) { 7700 if (LHSType->isVectorType() && RHSType->isVectorType()) { 7701 // Allow assignments of an AltiVec vector type to an equivalent GCC 7702 // vector type and vice versa 7703 if (Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(LHSType, RHSType)) { 7704 Kind = CK_BitCast; 7705 return Compatible; 7706 } 7707 7708 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both 7709 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a bitcast; 7710 // no bits are changed but the result type is different. 7711 if (isLaxVectorConversion(RHSType, LHSType)) { 7712 Kind = CK_BitCast; 7713 return IncompatibleVectors; 7714 } 7715 } 7716 7717 // When the RHS comes from another lax conversion (e.g. binops between 7718 // scalars and vectors) the result is canonicalized as a vector. When the 7719 // LHS is also a vector, the lax is allowed by the condition above. Handle 7720 // the case where LHS is a scalar. 7721 if (LHSType->isScalarType()) { 7722 const VectorType *VecType = RHSType->getAs<VectorType>(); 7723 if (VecType && VecType->getNumElements() == 1 && 7724 isLaxVectorConversion(RHSType, LHSType)) { 7725 ExprResult *VecExpr = &RHS; 7726 *VecExpr = ImpCastExprToType(VecExpr->get(), LHSType, CK_BitCast); 7727 Kind = CK_BitCast; 7728 return Compatible; 7729 } 7730 } 7731 7732 return Incompatible; 7733 } 7734 7735 // Diagnose attempts to convert between __float128 and long double where 7736 // such conversions currently can't be handled. 7737 if (unsupportedTypeConversion(*this, LHSType, RHSType)) 7738 return Incompatible; 7739 7740 // Disallow assigning a _Complex to a real type in C++ mode since it simply 7741 // discards the imaginary part. 7742 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && RHSType->getAs<ComplexType>() && 7743 !LHSType->getAs<ComplexType>()) 7744 return Incompatible; 7745 7746 // Arithmetic conversions. 7747 if (LHSType->isArithmeticType() && RHSType->isArithmeticType() && 7748 !(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && LHSType->isEnumeralType())) { 7749 if (ConvertRHS) 7750 Kind = PrepareScalarCast(RHS, LHSType); 7751 return Compatible; 7752 } 7753 7754 // Conversions to normal pointers. 7755 if (const PointerType *LHSPointer = dyn_cast<PointerType>(LHSType)) { 7756 // U* -> T* 7757 if (isa<PointerType>(RHSType)) { 7758 LangAS AddrSpaceL = LHSPointer->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace(); 7759 LangAS AddrSpaceR = RHSType->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace(); 7760 Kind = AddrSpaceL != AddrSpaceR ? CK_AddressSpaceConversion : CK_BitCast; 7761 return checkPointerTypesForAssignment(*this, LHSType, RHSType); 7762 } 7763 7764 // int -> T* 7765 if (RHSType->isIntegerType()) { 7766 Kind = CK_IntegralToPointer; // FIXME: null? 7767 return IntToPointer; 7768 } 7769 7770 // C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers, 7771 // with two exceptions: 7772 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(RHSType)) { 7773 // - conversions to void* 7774 if (LHSPointer->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) { 7775 Kind = CK_BitCast; 7776 return Compatible; 7777 } 7778 7779 // - conversions from 'Class' to the redefinition type 7780 if (RHSType->isObjCClassType() && 7781 Context.hasSameType(LHSType, 7782 Context.getObjCClassRedefinitionType())) { 7783 Kind = CK_BitCast; 7784 return Compatible; 7785 } 7786 7787 Kind = CK_BitCast; 7788 return IncompatiblePointer; 7789 } 7790 7791 // U^ -> void* 7792 if (RHSType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) { 7793 if (LHSPointer->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) { 7794 LangAS AddrSpaceL = LHSPointer->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace(); 7795 LangAS AddrSpaceR = RHSType->getAs<BlockPointerType>() 7796 ->getPointeeType() 7797 .getAddressSpace(); 7798 Kind = 7799 AddrSpaceL != AddrSpaceR ? CK_AddressSpaceConversion : CK_BitCast; 7800 return Compatible; 7801 } 7802 } 7803 7804 return Incompatible; 7805 } 7806 7807 // Conversions to block pointers. 7808 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(LHSType)) { 7809 // U^ -> T^ 7810 if (RHSType->isBlockPointerType()) { 7811 LangAS AddrSpaceL = LHSType->getAs<BlockPointerType>() 7812 ->getPointeeType() 7813 .getAddressSpace(); 7814 LangAS AddrSpaceR = RHSType->getAs<BlockPointerType>() 7815 ->getPointeeType() 7816 .getAddressSpace(); 7817 Kind = AddrSpaceL != AddrSpaceR ? CK_AddressSpaceConversion : CK_BitCast; 7818 return checkBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(*this, LHSType, RHSType); 7819 } 7820 7821 // int or null -> T^ 7822 if (RHSType->isIntegerType()) { 7823 Kind = CK_IntegralToPointer; // FIXME: null 7824 return IntToBlockPointer; 7825 } 7826 7827 // id -> T^ 7828 if (getLangOpts().ObjC1 && RHSType->isObjCIdType()) { 7829 Kind = CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast; 7830 return Compatible; 7831 } 7832 7833 // void* -> T^ 7834 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = RHSType->getAs<PointerType>()) 7835 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) { 7836 Kind = CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast; 7837 return Compatible; 7838 } 7839 7840 return Incompatible; 7841 } 7842 7843 // Conversions to Objective-C pointers. 7844 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(LHSType)) { 7845 // A* -> B* 7846 if (RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 7847 Kind = CK_BitCast; 7848 Sema::AssignConvertType result = 7849 checkObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(*this, LHSType, RHSType); 7850 if (getLangOpts().allowsNonTrivialObjCLifetimeQualifiers() && 7851 result == Compatible && 7852 !CheckObjCARCUnavailableWeakConversion(OrigLHSType, RHSType)) 7853 result = IncompatibleObjCWeakRef; 7854 return result; 7855 } 7856 7857 // int or null -> A* 7858 if (RHSType->isIntegerType()) { 7859 Kind = CK_IntegralToPointer; // FIXME: null 7860 return IntToPointer; 7861 } 7862 7863 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers, 7864 // with two exceptions: 7865 if (isa<PointerType>(RHSType)) { 7866 Kind = CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast; 7867 7868 // - conversions from 'void*' 7869 if (RHSType->isVoidPointerType()) { 7870 return Compatible; 7871 } 7872 7873 // - conversions to 'Class' from its redefinition type 7874 if (LHSType->isObjCClassType() && 7875 Context.hasSameType(RHSType, 7876 Context.getObjCClassRedefinitionType())) { 7877 return Compatible; 7878 } 7879 7880 return IncompatiblePointer; 7881 } 7882 7883 // Only under strict condition T^ is compatible with an Objective-C pointer. 7884 if (RHSType->isBlockPointerType() && 7885 LHSType->isBlockCompatibleObjCPointerType(Context)) { 7886 if (ConvertRHS) 7887 maybeExtendBlockObject(RHS); 7888 Kind = CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast; 7889 return Compatible; 7890 } 7891 7892 return Incompatible; 7893 } 7894 7895 // Conversions from pointers that are not covered by the above. 7896 if (isa<PointerType>(RHSType)) { 7897 // T* -> _Bool 7898 if (LHSType == Context.BoolTy) { 7899 Kind = CK_PointerToBoolean; 7900 return Compatible; 7901 } 7902 7903 // T* -> int 7904 if (LHSType->isIntegerType()) { 7905 Kind = CK_PointerToIntegral; 7906 return PointerToInt; 7907 } 7908 7909 return Incompatible; 7910 } 7911 7912 // Conversions from Objective-C pointers that are not covered by the above. 7913 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(RHSType)) { 7914 // T* -> _Bool 7915 if (LHSType == Context.BoolTy) { 7916 Kind = CK_PointerToBoolean; 7917 return Compatible; 7918 } 7919 7920 // T* -> int 7921 if (LHSType->isIntegerType()) { 7922 Kind = CK_PointerToIntegral; 7923 return PointerToInt; 7924 } 7925 7926 return Incompatible; 7927 } 7928 7929 // struct A -> struct B 7930 if (isa<TagType>(LHSType) && isa<TagType>(RHSType)) { 7931 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LHSType, RHSType)) { 7932 Kind = CK_NoOp; 7933 return Compatible; 7934 } 7935 } 7936 7937 if (LHSType->isSamplerT() && RHSType->isIntegerType()) { 7938 Kind = CK_IntToOCLSampler; 7939 return Compatible; 7940 } 7941 7942 return Incompatible; 7943 } 7944 7945 /// Constructs a transparent union from an expression that is 7946 /// used to initialize the transparent union. 7947 static void ConstructTransparentUnion(Sema &S, ASTContext &C, 7948 ExprResult &EResult, QualType UnionType, 7949 FieldDecl *Field) { 7950 // Build an initializer list that designates the appropriate member 7951 // of the transparent union. 7952 Expr *E = EResult.get(); 7953 InitListExpr *Initializer = new (C) InitListExpr(C, SourceLocation(), 7954 E, SourceLocation()); 7955 Initializer->setType(UnionType); 7956 Initializer->setInitializedFieldInUnion(Field); 7957 7958 // Build a compound literal constructing a value of the transparent 7959 // union type from this initializer list. 7960 TypeSourceInfo *unionTInfo = C.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(UnionType); 7961 EResult = new (C) CompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation(), unionTInfo, UnionType, 7962 VK_RValue, Initializer, false); 7963 } 7964 7965 Sema::AssignConvertType 7966 Sema::CheckTransparentUnionArgumentConstraints(QualType ArgType, 7967 ExprResult &RHS) { 7968 QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType(); 7969 7970 // If the ArgType is a Union type, we want to handle a potential 7971 // transparent_union GCC extension. 7972 const RecordType *UT = ArgType->getAsUnionType(); 7973 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>()) 7974 return Incompatible; 7975 7976 // The field to initialize within the transparent union. 7977 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl(); 7978 FieldDecl *InitField = nullptr; 7979 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields. 7980 for (auto *it : UD->fields()) { 7981 if (it->getType()->isPointerType()) { 7982 // If the transparent union contains a pointer type, we allow: 7983 // 1) void pointer 7984 // 2) null pointer constant 7985 if (RHSType->isPointerType()) 7986 if (RHSType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) { 7987 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), it->getType(), CK_BitCast); 7988 InitField = it; 7989 break; 7990 } 7991 7992 if (RHS.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 7993 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) { 7994 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), it->getType(), 7995 CK_NullToPointer); 7996 InitField = it; 7997 break; 7998 } 7999 } 8000 8001 CastKind Kind; 8002 if (CheckAssignmentConstraints(it->getType(), RHS, Kind) 8003 == Compatible) { 8004 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), it->getType(), Kind); 8005 InitField = it; 8006 break; 8007 } 8008 } 8009 8010 if (!InitField) 8011 return Incompatible; 8012 8013 ConstructTransparentUnion(*this, Context, RHS, ArgType, InitField); 8014 return Compatible; 8015 } 8016 8017 Sema::AssignConvertType 8018 Sema::CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(QualType LHSType, ExprResult &CallerRHS, 8019 bool Diagnose, 8020 bool DiagnoseCFAudited, 8021 bool ConvertRHS) { 8022 // We need to be able to tell the caller whether we diagnosed a problem, if 8023 // they ask us to issue diagnostics. 8024 assert((ConvertRHS || !Diagnose) && "can't indicate whether we diagnosed"); 8025 8026 // If ConvertRHS is false, we want to leave the caller's RHS untouched. Sadly, 8027 // we can't avoid *all* modifications at the moment, so we need some somewhere 8028 // to put the updated value. 8029 ExprResult LocalRHS = CallerRHS; 8030 ExprResult &RHS = ConvertRHS ? CallerRHS : LocalRHS; 8031 8032 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 8033 if (!LHSType->isRecordType() && !LHSType->isAtomicType()) { 8034 // C++ 5.17p3: If the left operand is not of class type, the 8035 // expression is implicitly converted (C++ 4) to the 8036 // cv-unqualified type of the left operand. 8037 QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType(); 8038 if (Diagnose) { 8039 RHS = PerformImplicitConversion(RHS.get(), LHSType.getUnqualifiedType(), 8040 AA_Assigning); 8041 } else { 8042 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = 8043 TryImplicitConversion(RHS.get(), LHSType.getUnqualifiedType(), 8044 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 8045 /*AllowExplicit=*/false, 8046 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 8047 /*CStyle=*/false, 8048 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false); 8049 if (ICS.isFailure()) 8050 return Incompatible; 8051 RHS = PerformImplicitConversion(RHS.get(), LHSType.getUnqualifiedType(), 8052 ICS, AA_Assigning); 8053 } 8054 if (RHS.isInvalid()) 8055 return Incompatible; 8056 Sema::AssignConvertType result = Compatible; 8057 if (getLangOpts().allowsNonTrivialObjCLifetimeQualifiers() && 8058 !CheckObjCARCUnavailableWeakConversion(LHSType, RHSType)) 8059 result = IncompatibleObjCWeakRef; 8060 return result; 8061 } 8062 8063 // FIXME: Currently, we fall through and treat C++ classes like C 8064 // structures. 8065 // FIXME: We also fall through for atomics; not sure what should 8066 // happen there, though. 8067 } else if (RHS.get()->getType() == Context.OverloadTy) { 8068 // As a set of extensions to C, we support overloading on functions. These 8069 // functions need to be resolved here. 8070 DeclAccessPair DAP; 8071 if (FunctionDecl *FD = ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction( 8072 RHS.get(), LHSType, /*Complain=*/false, DAP)) 8073 RHS = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(RHS.get(), DAP, FD); 8074 else 8075 return Incompatible; 8076 } 8077 8078 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is a pointer and the right is 8079 // a null pointer constant. 8080 if ((LHSType->isPointerType() || LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || 8081 LHSType->isBlockPointerType()) && 8082 RHS.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 8083 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) { 8084 if (Diagnose || ConvertRHS) { 8085 CastKind Kind; 8086 CXXCastPath Path; 8087 CheckPointerConversion(RHS.get(), LHSType, Kind, Path, 8088 /*IgnoreBaseAccess=*/false, Diagnose); 8089 if (ConvertRHS) 8090 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, Kind, VK_RValue, &Path); 8091 } 8092 return Compatible; 8093 } 8094 8095 // This check seems unnatural, however it is necessary to ensure the proper 8096 // conversion of functions/arrays. If the conversion were done for all 8097 // DeclExpr's (created by ActOnIdExpression), it would mess up the unary 8098 // expressions that suppress this implicit conversion (&, sizeof). 8099 // 8100 // Suppress this for references: C++ 8.5.3p5. 8101 if (!LHSType->isReferenceType()) { 8102 // FIXME: We potentially allocate here even if ConvertRHS is false. 8103 RHS = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS.get(), Diagnose); 8104 if (RHS.isInvalid()) 8105 return Incompatible; 8106 } 8107 8108 Expr *PRE = RHS.get()->IgnoreParenCasts(); 8109 if (Diagnose && isa<ObjCProtocolExpr>(PRE)) { 8110 ObjCProtocolDecl *PDecl = cast<ObjCProtocolExpr>(PRE)->getProtocol(); 8111 if (PDecl && !PDecl->hasDefinition()) { 8112 Diag(PRE->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_atprotocol_protocol) << PDecl; 8113 Diag(PDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_entity_declared_at) << PDecl; 8114 } 8115 } 8116 8117 CastKind Kind; 8118 Sema::AssignConvertType result = 8119 CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHS, Kind, ConvertRHS); 8120 8121 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: The value of the right operand is converted to the 8122 // type of the assignment expression. 8123 // CheckAssignmentConstraints allows the left-hand side to be a reference, 8124 // so that we can use references in built-in functions even in C. 8125 // The getNonReferenceType() call makes sure that the resulting expression 8126 // does not have reference type. 8127 if (result != Incompatible && RHS.get()->getType() != LHSType) { 8128 QualType Ty = LHSType.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 8129 Expr *E = RHS.get(); 8130 8131 // Check for various Objective-C errors. If we are not reporting 8132 // diagnostics and just checking for errors, e.g., during overload 8133 // resolution, return Incompatible to indicate the failure. 8134 if (getLangOpts().allowsNonTrivialObjCLifetimeQualifiers() && 8135 CheckObjCConversion(SourceRange(), Ty, E, CCK_ImplicitConversion, 8136 Diagnose, DiagnoseCFAudited) != ACR_okay) { 8137 if (!Diagnose) 8138 return Incompatible; 8139 } 8140 if (getLangOpts().ObjC1 && 8141 (CheckObjCBridgeRelatedConversions(E->getLocStart(), LHSType, 8142 E->getType(), E, Diagnose) || 8143 ConversionToObjCStringLiteralCheck(LHSType, E, Diagnose))) { 8144 if (!Diagnose) 8145 return Incompatible; 8146 // Replace the expression with a corrected version and continue so we 8147 // can find further errors. 8148 RHS = E; 8149 return Compatible; 8150 } 8151 8152 if (ConvertRHS) 8153 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(E, Ty, Kind); 8154 } 8155 return result; 8156 } 8157 8158 namespace { 8159 /// The original operand to an operator, prior to the application of the usual 8160 /// arithmetic conversions and converting the arguments of a builtin operator 8161 /// candidate. 8162 struct OriginalOperand { 8163 explicit OriginalOperand(Expr *Op) : Orig(Op), Conversion(nullptr) { 8164 if (auto *MTE = dyn_cast<MaterializeTemporaryExpr>(Op)) 8165 Op = MTE->GetTemporaryExpr(); 8166 if (auto *BTE = dyn_cast<CXXBindTemporaryExpr>(Op)) 8167 Op = BTE->getSubExpr(); 8168 if (auto *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Op)) { 8169 Orig = ICE->getSubExprAsWritten(); 8170 Conversion = ICE->getConversionFunction(); 8171 } 8172 } 8173 8174 QualType getType() const { return Orig->getType(); } 8175 8176 Expr *Orig; 8177 NamedDecl *Conversion; 8178 }; 8179 } 8180 8181 QualType Sema::InvalidOperands(SourceLocation Loc, ExprResult &LHS, 8182 ExprResult &RHS) { 8183 OriginalOperand OrigLHS(LHS.get()), OrigRHS(RHS.get()); 8184 8185 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_operands) 8186 << OrigLHS.getType() << OrigRHS.getType() 8187 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 8188 8189 // If a user-defined conversion was applied to either of the operands prior 8190 // to applying the built-in operator rules, tell the user about it. 8191 if (OrigLHS.Conversion) { 8192 Diag(OrigLHS.Conversion->getLocation(), 8193 diag::note_typecheck_invalid_operands_converted) 8194 << 0 << LHS.get()->getType(); 8195 } 8196 if (OrigRHS.Conversion) { 8197 Diag(OrigRHS.Conversion->getLocation(), 8198 diag::note_typecheck_invalid_operands_converted) 8199 << 1 << RHS.get()->getType(); 8200 } 8201 8202 return QualType(); 8203 } 8204 8205 // Diagnose cases where a scalar was implicitly converted to a vector and 8206 // diagnose the underlying types. Otherwise, diagnose the error 8207 // as invalid vector logical operands for non-C++ cases. 8208 QualType Sema::InvalidLogicalVectorOperands(SourceLocation Loc, ExprResult &LHS, 8209 ExprResult &RHS) { 8210 QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->IgnoreImpCasts()->getType(); 8211 QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->IgnoreImpCasts()->getType(); 8212 8213 bool LHSNatVec = LHSType->isVectorType(); 8214 bool RHSNatVec = RHSType->isVectorType(); 8215 8216 if (!(LHSNatVec && RHSNatVec)) { 8217 Expr *Vector = LHSNatVec ? LHS.get() : RHS.get(); 8218 Expr *NonVector = !LHSNatVec ? LHS.get() : RHS.get(); 8219 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_logical_vector_expr_gnu_cpp_restrict) 8220 << 0 << Vector->getType() << NonVector->IgnoreImpCasts()->getType() 8221 << Vector->getSourceRange(); 8222 return QualType(); 8223 } 8224 8225 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_logical_vector_expr_gnu_cpp_restrict) 8226 << 1 << LHSType << RHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() 8227 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 8228 8229 return QualType(); 8230 } 8231 8232 /// Try to convert a value of non-vector type to a vector type by converting 8233 /// the type to the element type of the vector and then performing a splat. 8234 /// If the language is OpenCL, we only use conversions that promote scalar 8235 /// rank; for C, Obj-C, and C++ we allow any real scalar conversion except 8236 /// for float->int. 8237 /// 8238 /// OpenCL V2.0 6.2.6.p2: 8239 /// An error shall occur if any scalar operand type has greater rank 8240 /// than the type of the vector element. 8241 /// 8242 /// \param scalar - if non-null, actually perform the conversions 8243 /// \return true if the operation fails (but without diagnosing the failure) 8244 static bool tryVectorConvertAndSplat(Sema &S, ExprResult *scalar, 8245 QualType scalarTy, 8246 QualType vectorEltTy, 8247 QualType vectorTy, 8248 unsigned &DiagID) { 8249 // The conversion to apply to the scalar before splatting it, 8250 // if necessary. 8251 CastKind scalarCast = CK_NoOp; 8252 8253 if (vectorEltTy->isIntegralType(S.Context)) { 8254 if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL && (scalarTy->isRealFloatingType() || 8255 (scalarTy->isIntegerType() && 8256 S.Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(vectorEltTy, scalarTy) < 0))) { 8257 DiagID = diag::err_opencl_scalar_type_rank_greater_than_vector_type; 8258 return true; 8259 } 8260 if (!scalarTy->isIntegralType(S.Context)) 8261 return true; 8262 scalarCast = CK_IntegralCast; 8263 } else if (vectorEltTy->isRealFloatingType()) { 8264 if (scalarTy->isRealFloatingType()) { 8265 if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL && 8266 S.Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(vectorEltTy, scalarTy) < 0) { 8267 DiagID = diag::err_opencl_scalar_type_rank_greater_than_vector_type; 8268 return true; 8269 } 8270 scalarCast = CK_FloatingCast; 8271 } 8272 else if (scalarTy->isIntegralType(S.Context)) 8273 scalarCast = CK_IntegralToFloating; 8274 else 8275 return true; 8276 } else { 8277 return true; 8278 } 8279 8280 // Adjust scalar if desired. 8281 if (scalar) { 8282 if (scalarCast != CK_NoOp) 8283 *scalar = S.ImpCastExprToType(scalar->get(), vectorEltTy, scalarCast); 8284 *scalar = S.ImpCastExprToType(scalar->get(), vectorTy, CK_VectorSplat); 8285 } 8286 return false; 8287 } 8288 8289 /// Convert vector E to a vector with the same number of elements but different 8290 /// element type. 8291 static ExprResult convertVector(Expr *E, QualType ElementType, Sema &S) { 8292 const auto *VecTy = E->getType()->getAs<VectorType>(); 8293 assert(VecTy && "Expression E must be a vector"); 8294 QualType NewVecTy = S.Context.getVectorType(ElementType, 8295 VecTy->getNumElements(), 8296 VecTy->getVectorKind()); 8297 8298 // Look through the implicit cast. Return the subexpression if its type is 8299 // NewVecTy. 8300 if (auto *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)) 8301 if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType() == NewVecTy) 8302 return ICE->getSubExpr(); 8303 8304 auto Cast = ElementType->isIntegerType() ? CK_IntegralCast : CK_FloatingCast; 8305 return S.ImpCastExprToType(E, NewVecTy, Cast); 8306 } 8307 8308 /// Test if a (constant) integer Int can be casted to another integer type 8309 /// IntTy without losing precision. 8310 static bool canConvertIntToOtherIntTy(Sema &S, ExprResult *Int, 8311 QualType OtherIntTy) { 8312 QualType IntTy = Int->get()->getType().getUnqualifiedType(); 8313 8314 // Reject cases where the value of the Int is unknown as that would 8315 // possibly cause truncation, but accept cases where the scalar can be 8316 // demoted without loss of precision. 8317 llvm::APSInt Result; 8318 bool CstInt = Int->get()->EvaluateAsInt(Result, S.Context); 8319 int Order = S.Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(OtherIntTy, IntTy); 8320 bool IntSigned = IntTy->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation(); 8321 bool OtherIntSigned = OtherIntTy->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation(); 8322 8323 if (CstInt) { 8324 // If the scalar is constant and is of a higher order and has more active 8325 // bits that the vector element type, reject it. 8326 unsigned NumBits = IntSigned 8327 ? (Result.isNegative() ? Result.getMinSignedBits() 8328 : Result.getActiveBits()) 8329 : Result.getActiveBits(); 8330 if (Order < 0 && S.Context.getIntWidth(OtherIntTy) < NumBits) 8331 return true; 8332 8333 // If the signedness of the scalar type and the vector element type 8334 // differs and the number of bits is greater than that of the vector 8335 // element reject it. 8336 return (IntSigned != OtherIntSigned && 8337 NumBits > S.Context.getIntWidth(OtherIntTy)); 8338 } 8339 8340 // Reject cases where the value of the scalar is not constant and it's 8341 // order is greater than that of the vector element type. 8342 return (Order < 0); 8343 } 8344 8345 /// Test if a (constant) integer Int can be casted to floating point type 8346 /// FloatTy without losing precision. 8347 static bool canConvertIntTyToFloatTy(Sema &S, ExprResult *Int, 8348 QualType FloatTy) { 8349 QualType IntTy = Int->get()->getType().getUnqualifiedType(); 8350 8351 // Determine if the integer constant can be expressed as a floating point 8352 // number of the appropriate type. 8353 llvm::APSInt Result; 8354 bool CstInt = Int->get()->EvaluateAsInt(Result, S.Context); 8355 uint64_t Bits = 0; 8356 if (CstInt) { 8357 // Reject constants that would be truncated if they were converted to 8358 // the floating point type. Test by simple to/from conversion. 8359 // FIXME: Ideally the conversion to an APFloat and from an APFloat 8360 // could be avoided if there was a convertFromAPInt method 8361 // which could signal back if implicit truncation occurred. 8362 llvm::APFloat Float(S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(FloatTy)); 8363 Float.convertFromAPInt(Result, IntTy->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation(), 8364 llvm::APFloat::rmTowardZero); 8365 llvm::APSInt ConvertBack(S.Context.getIntWidth(IntTy), 8366 !IntTy->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation()); 8367 bool Ignored = false; 8368 Float.convertToInteger(ConvertBack, llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven, 8369 &Ignored); 8370 if (Result != ConvertBack) 8371 return true; 8372 } else { 8373 // Reject types that cannot be fully encoded into the mantissa of 8374 // the float. 8375 Bits = S.Context.getTypeSize(IntTy); 8376 unsigned FloatPrec = llvm::APFloat::semanticsPrecision( 8377 S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(FloatTy)); 8378 if (Bits > FloatPrec) 8379 return true; 8380 } 8381 8382 return false; 8383 } 8384 8385 /// Attempt to convert and splat Scalar into a vector whose types matches 8386 /// Vector following GCC conversion rules. The rule is that implicit 8387 /// conversion can occur when Scalar can be casted to match Vector's element 8388 /// type without causing truncation of Scalar. 8389 static bool tryGCCVectorConvertAndSplat(Sema &S, ExprResult *Scalar, 8390 ExprResult *Vector) { 8391 QualType ScalarTy = Scalar->get()->getType().getUnqualifiedType(); 8392 QualType VectorTy = Vector->get()->getType().getUnqualifiedType(); 8393 const VectorType *VT = VectorTy->getAs<VectorType>(); 8394 8395 assert(!isa<ExtVectorType>(VT) && 8396 "ExtVectorTypes should not be handled here!"); 8397 8398 QualType VectorEltTy = VT->getElementType(); 8399 8400 // Reject cases where the vector element type or the scalar element type are 8401 // not integral or floating point types. 8402 if (!VectorEltTy->isArithmeticType() || !ScalarTy->isArithmeticType()) 8403 return true; 8404 8405 // The conversion to apply to the scalar before splatting it, 8406 // if necessary. 8407 CastKind ScalarCast = CK_NoOp; 8408 8409 // Accept cases where the vector elements are integers and the scalar is 8410 // an integer. 8411 // FIXME: Notionally if the scalar was a floating point value with a precise 8412 // integral representation, we could cast it to an appropriate integer 8413 // type and then perform the rest of the checks here. GCC will perform 8414 // this conversion in some cases as determined by the input language. 8415 // We should accept it on a language independent basis. 8416 if (VectorEltTy->isIntegralType(S.Context) && 8417 ScalarTy->isIntegralType(S.Context) && 8418 S.Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(VectorEltTy, ScalarTy)) { 8419 8420 if (canConvertIntToOtherIntTy(S, Scalar, VectorEltTy)) 8421 return true; 8422 8423 ScalarCast = CK_IntegralCast; 8424 } else if (VectorEltTy->isRealFloatingType()) { 8425 if (ScalarTy->isRealFloatingType()) { 8426 8427 // Reject cases where the scalar type is not a constant and has a higher 8428 // Order than the vector element type. 8429 llvm::APFloat Result(0.0); 8430 bool CstScalar = Scalar->get()->EvaluateAsFloat(Result, S.Context); 8431 int Order = S.Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(VectorEltTy, ScalarTy); 8432 if (!CstScalar && Order < 0) 8433 return true; 8434 8435 // If the scalar cannot be safely casted to the vector element type, 8436 // reject it. 8437 if (CstScalar) { 8438 bool Truncated = false; 8439 Result.convert(S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(VectorEltTy), 8440 llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven, &Truncated); 8441 if (Truncated) 8442 return true; 8443 } 8444 8445 ScalarCast = CK_FloatingCast; 8446 } else if (ScalarTy->isIntegralType(S.Context)) { 8447 if (canConvertIntTyToFloatTy(S, Scalar, VectorEltTy)) 8448 return true; 8449 8450 ScalarCast = CK_IntegralToFloating; 8451 } else 8452 return true; 8453 } 8454 8455 // Adjust scalar if desired. 8456 if (Scalar) { 8457 if (ScalarCast != CK_NoOp) 8458 *Scalar = S.ImpCastExprToType(Scalar->get(), VectorEltTy, ScalarCast); 8459 *Scalar = S.ImpCastExprToType(Scalar->get(), VectorTy, CK_VectorSplat); 8460 } 8461 return false; 8462 } 8463 8464 QualType Sema::CheckVectorOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 8465 SourceLocation Loc, bool IsCompAssign, 8466 bool AllowBothBool, 8467 bool AllowBoolConversions) { 8468 if (!IsCompAssign) { 8469 LHS = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHS.get()); 8470 if (LHS.isInvalid()) 8471 return QualType(); 8472 } 8473 RHS = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS.get()); 8474 if (RHS.isInvalid()) 8475 return QualType(); 8476 8477 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers. 8478 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent. 8479 QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType().getUnqualifiedType(); 8480 QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType().getUnqualifiedType(); 8481 8482 const VectorType *LHSVecType = LHSType->getAs<VectorType>(); 8483 const VectorType *RHSVecType = RHSType->getAs<VectorType>(); 8484 assert(LHSVecType || RHSVecType); 8485 8486 // AltiVec-style "vector bool op vector bool" combinations are allowed 8487 // for some operators but not others. 8488 if (!AllowBothBool && 8489 LHSVecType && LHSVecType->getVectorKind() == VectorType::AltiVecBool && 8490 RHSVecType && RHSVecType->getVectorKind() == VectorType::AltiVecBool) 8491 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 8492 8493 // If the vector types are identical, return. 8494 if (Context.hasSameType(LHSType, RHSType)) 8495 return LHSType; 8496 8497 // If we have compatible AltiVec and GCC vector types, use the AltiVec type. 8498 if (LHSVecType && RHSVecType && 8499 Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(LHSType, RHSType)) { 8500 if (isa<ExtVectorType>(LHSVecType)) { 8501 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_BitCast); 8502 return LHSType; 8503 } 8504 8505 if (!IsCompAssign) 8506 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_BitCast); 8507 return RHSType; 8508 } 8509 8510 // AllowBoolConversions says that bool and non-bool AltiVec vectors 8511 // can be mixed, with the result being the non-bool type. The non-bool 8512 // operand must have integer element type. 8513 if (AllowBoolConversions && LHSVecType && RHSVecType && 8514 LHSVecType->getNumElements() == RHSVecType->getNumElements() && 8515 (Context.getTypeSize(LHSVecType->getElementType()) == 8516 Context.getTypeSize(RHSVecType->getElementType()))) { 8517 if (LHSVecType->getVectorKind() == VectorType::AltiVecVector && 8518 LHSVecType->getElementType()->isIntegerType() && 8519 RHSVecType->getVectorKind() == VectorType::AltiVecBool) { 8520 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_BitCast); 8521 return LHSType; 8522 } 8523 if (!IsCompAssign && 8524 LHSVecType->getVectorKind() == VectorType::AltiVecBool && 8525 RHSVecType->getVectorKind() == VectorType::AltiVecVector && 8526 RHSVecType->getElementType()->isIntegerType()) { 8527 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_BitCast); 8528 return RHSType; 8529 } 8530 } 8531 8532 // If there's a vector type and a scalar, try to convert the scalar to 8533 // the vector element type and splat. 8534 unsigned DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable; 8535 if (!RHSVecType) { 8536 if (isa<ExtVectorType>(LHSVecType)) { 8537 if (!tryVectorConvertAndSplat(*this, &RHS, RHSType, 8538 LHSVecType->getElementType(), LHSType, 8539 DiagID)) 8540 return LHSType; 8541 } else { 8542 if (!tryGCCVectorConvertAndSplat(*this, &RHS, &LHS)) 8543 return LHSType; 8544 } 8545 } 8546 if (!LHSVecType) { 8547 if (isa<ExtVectorType>(RHSVecType)) { 8548 if (!tryVectorConvertAndSplat(*this, (IsCompAssign ? nullptr : &LHS), 8549 LHSType, RHSVecType->getElementType(), 8550 RHSType, DiagID)) 8551 return RHSType; 8552 } else { 8553 if (LHS.get()->getValueKind() == VK_LValue || 8554 !tryGCCVectorConvertAndSplat(*this, &LHS, &RHS)) 8555 return RHSType; 8556 } 8557 } 8558 8559 // FIXME: The code below also handles conversion between vectors and 8560 // non-scalars, we should break this down into fine grained specific checks 8561 // and emit proper diagnostics. 8562 QualType VecType = LHSVecType ? LHSType : RHSType; 8563 const VectorType *VT = LHSVecType ? LHSVecType : RHSVecType; 8564 QualType OtherType = LHSVecType ? RHSType : LHSType; 8565 ExprResult *OtherExpr = LHSVecType ? &RHS : &LHS; 8566 if (isLaxVectorConversion(OtherType, VecType)) { 8567 // If we're allowing lax vector conversions, only the total (data) size 8568 // needs to be the same. For non compound assignment, if one of the types is 8569 // scalar, the result is always the vector type. 8570 if (!IsCompAssign) { 8571 *OtherExpr = ImpCastExprToType(OtherExpr->get(), VecType, CK_BitCast); 8572 return VecType; 8573 // In a compound assignment, lhs += rhs, 'lhs' is a lvalue src, forbidding 8574 // any implicit cast. Here, the 'rhs' should be implicit casted to 'lhs' 8575 // type. Note that this is already done by non-compound assignments in 8576 // CheckAssignmentConstraints. If it's a scalar type, only bitcast for 8577 // <1 x T> -> T. The result is also a vector type. 8578 } else if (OtherType->isExtVectorType() || OtherType->isVectorType() || 8579 (OtherType->isScalarType() && VT->getNumElements() == 1)) { 8580 ExprResult *RHSExpr = &RHS; 8581 *RHSExpr = ImpCastExprToType(RHSExpr->get(), LHSType, CK_BitCast); 8582 return VecType; 8583 } 8584 } 8585 8586 // Okay, the expression is invalid. 8587 8588 // If there's a non-vector, non-real operand, diagnose that. 8589 if ((!RHSVecType && !RHSType->isRealType()) || 8590 (!LHSVecType && !LHSType->isRealType())) { 8591 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable_non_scalar) 8592 << LHSType << RHSType 8593 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 8594 return QualType(); 8595 } 8596 8597 // OpenCL V1.1 6.2.6.p1: 8598 // If the operands are of more than one vector type, then an error shall 8599 // occur. Implicit conversions between vector types are not permitted, per 8600 // section 6.2.1. 8601 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && 8602 RHSVecType && isa<ExtVectorType>(RHSVecType) && 8603 LHSVecType && isa<ExtVectorType>(LHSVecType)) { 8604 Diag(Loc, diag::err_opencl_implicit_vector_conversion) << LHSType 8605 << RHSType; 8606 return QualType(); 8607 } 8608 8609 8610 // If there is a vector type that is not a ExtVector and a scalar, we reach 8611 // this point if scalar could not be converted to the vector's element type 8612 // without truncation. 8613 if ((RHSVecType && !isa<ExtVectorType>(RHSVecType)) || 8614 (LHSVecType && !isa<ExtVectorType>(LHSVecType))) { 8615 QualType Scalar = LHSVecType ? RHSType : LHSType; 8616 QualType Vector = LHSVecType ? LHSType : RHSType; 8617 unsigned ScalarOrVector = LHSVecType && RHSVecType ? 1 : 0; 8618 Diag(Loc, 8619 diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable_implict_truncation) 8620 << ScalarOrVector << Scalar << Vector; 8621 8622 return QualType(); 8623 } 8624 8625 // Otherwise, use the generic diagnostic. 8626 Diag(Loc, DiagID) 8627 << LHSType << RHSType 8628 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 8629 return QualType(); 8630 } 8631 8632 // checkArithmeticNull - Detect when a NULL constant is used improperly in an 8633 // expression. These are mainly cases where the null pointer is used as an 8634 // integer instead of a pointer. 8635 static void checkArithmeticNull(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 8636 SourceLocation Loc, bool IsCompare) { 8637 // The canonical way to check for a GNU null is with isNullPointerConstant, 8638 // but we use a bit of a hack here for speed; this is a relatively 8639 // hot path, and isNullPointerConstant is slow. 8640 bool LHSNull = isa<GNUNullExpr>(LHS.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts()); 8641 bool RHSNull = isa<GNUNullExpr>(RHS.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts()); 8642 8643 QualType NonNullType = LHSNull ? RHS.get()->getType() : LHS.get()->getType(); 8644 8645 // Avoid analyzing cases where the result will either be invalid (and 8646 // diagnosed as such) or entirely valid and not something to warn about. 8647 if ((!LHSNull && !RHSNull) || NonNullType->isBlockPointerType() || 8648 NonNullType->isMemberPointerType() || NonNullType->isFunctionType()) 8649 return; 8650 8651 // Comparison operations would not make sense with a null pointer no matter 8652 // what the other expression is. 8653 if (!IsCompare) { 8654 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_null_in_arithmetic_operation) 8655 << (LHSNull ? LHS.get()->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 8656 << (RHSNull ? RHS.get()->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()); 8657 return; 8658 } 8659 8660 // The rest of the operations only make sense with a null pointer 8661 // if the other expression is a pointer. 8662 if (LHSNull == RHSNull || NonNullType->isAnyPointerType() || 8663 NonNullType->canDecayToPointerType()) 8664 return; 8665 8666 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_null_in_comparison_operation) 8667 << LHSNull /* LHS is NULL */ << NonNullType 8668 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 8669 } 8670 8671 static void DiagnoseBadDivideOrRemainderValues(Sema& S, ExprResult &LHS, 8672 ExprResult &RHS, 8673 SourceLocation Loc, bool IsDiv) { 8674 // Check for division/remainder by zero. 8675 llvm::APSInt RHSValue; 8676 if (!RHS.get()->isValueDependent() && 8677 RHS.get()->EvaluateAsInt(RHSValue, S.Context) && RHSValue == 0) 8678 S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, RHS.get(), 8679 S.PDiag(diag::warn_remainder_division_by_zero) 8680 << IsDiv << RHS.get()->getSourceRange()); 8681 } 8682 8683 QualType Sema::CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 8684 SourceLocation Loc, 8685 bool IsCompAssign, bool IsDiv) { 8686 checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompare=*/false); 8687 8688 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() || 8689 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) 8690 return CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, IsCompAssign, 8691 /*AllowBothBool*/getLangOpts().AltiVec, 8692 /*AllowBoolConversions*/false); 8693 8694 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS, IsCompAssign); 8695 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid()) 8696 return QualType(); 8697 8698 8699 if (compType.isNull() || !compType->isArithmeticType()) 8700 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 8701 if (IsDiv) 8702 DiagnoseBadDivideOrRemainderValues(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, IsDiv); 8703 return compType; 8704 } 8705 8706 QualType Sema::CheckRemainderOperands( 8707 ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc, bool IsCompAssign) { 8708 checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompare=*/false); 8709 8710 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() || 8711 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) { 8712 if (LHS.get()->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() && 8713 RHS.get()->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation()) 8714 return CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, IsCompAssign, 8715 /*AllowBothBool*/getLangOpts().AltiVec, 8716 /*AllowBoolConversions*/false); 8717 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 8718 } 8719 8720 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS, IsCompAssign); 8721 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid()) 8722 return QualType(); 8723 8724 if (compType.isNull() || !compType->isIntegerType()) 8725 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 8726 DiagnoseBadDivideOrRemainderValues(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, false /* IsDiv */); 8727 return compType; 8728 } 8729 8730 /// Diagnose invalid arithmetic on two void pointers. 8731 static void diagnoseArithmeticOnTwoVoidPointers(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 8732 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 8733 S.Diag(Loc, S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 8734 ? diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type 8735 : diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr) 8736 << 1 /* two pointers */ << LHSExpr->getSourceRange() 8737 << RHSExpr->getSourceRange(); 8738 } 8739 8740 /// Diagnose invalid arithmetic on a void pointer. 8741 static void diagnoseArithmeticOnVoidPointer(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 8742 Expr *Pointer) { 8743 S.Diag(Loc, S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 8744 ? diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type 8745 : diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr) 8746 << 0 /* one pointer */ << Pointer->getSourceRange(); 8747 } 8748 8749 /// Diagnose invalid arithmetic on a null pointer. 8750 /// 8751 /// If \p IsGNUIdiom is true, the operation is using the 'p = (i8*)nullptr + n' 8752 /// idiom, which we recognize as a GNU extension. 8753 /// 8754 static void diagnoseArithmeticOnNullPointer(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 8755 Expr *Pointer, bool IsGNUIdiom) { 8756 if (IsGNUIdiom) 8757 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_gnu_null_ptr_arith) 8758 << Pointer->getSourceRange(); 8759 else 8760 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_pointer_arith_null_ptr) 8761 << S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus << Pointer->getSourceRange(); 8762 } 8763 8764 /// Diagnose invalid arithmetic on two function pointers. 8765 static void diagnoseArithmeticOnTwoFunctionPointers(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 8766 Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS) { 8767 assert(LHS->getType()->isAnyPointerType()); 8768 assert(RHS->getType()->isAnyPointerType()); 8769 S.Diag(Loc, S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 8770 ? diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type 8771 : diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith) 8772 << 1 /* two pointers */ << LHS->getType()->getPointeeType() 8773 // We only show the second type if it differs from the first. 8774 << (unsigned)!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(LHS->getType(), 8775 RHS->getType()) 8776 << RHS->getType()->getPointeeType() 8777 << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange(); 8778 } 8779 8780 /// Diagnose invalid arithmetic on a function pointer. 8781 static void diagnoseArithmeticOnFunctionPointer(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 8782 Expr *Pointer) { 8783 assert(Pointer->getType()->isAnyPointerType()); 8784 S.Diag(Loc, S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 8785 ? diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type 8786 : diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith) 8787 << 0 /* one pointer */ << Pointer->getType()->getPointeeType() 8788 << 0 /* one pointer, so only one type */ 8789 << Pointer->getSourceRange(); 8790 } 8791 8792 /// Emit error if Operand is incomplete pointer type 8793 /// 8794 /// \returns True if pointer has incomplete type 8795 static bool checkArithmeticIncompletePointerType(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 8796 Expr *Operand) { 8797 QualType ResType = Operand->getType(); 8798 if (const AtomicType *ResAtomicType = ResType->getAs<AtomicType>()) 8799 ResType = ResAtomicType->getValueType(); 8800 8801 assert(ResType->isAnyPointerType() && !ResType->isDependentType()); 8802 QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType(); 8803 return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, PointeeTy, 8804 diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type, 8805 PointeeTy, Operand->getSourceRange()); 8806 } 8807 8808 /// Check the validity of an arithmetic pointer operand. 8809 /// 8810 /// If the operand has pointer type, this code will check for pointer types 8811 /// which are invalid in arithmetic operations. These will be diagnosed 8812 /// appropriately, including whether or not the use is supported as an 8813 /// extension. 8814 /// 8815 /// \returns True when the operand is valid to use (even if as an extension). 8816 static bool checkArithmeticOpPointerOperand(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 8817 Expr *Operand) { 8818 QualType ResType = Operand->getType(); 8819 if (const AtomicType *ResAtomicType = ResType->getAs<AtomicType>()) 8820 ResType = ResAtomicType->getValueType(); 8821 8822 if (!ResType->isAnyPointerType()) return true; 8823 8824 QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType(); 8825 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) { 8826 diagnoseArithmeticOnVoidPointer(S, Loc, Operand); 8827 return !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus; 8828 } 8829 if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) { 8830 diagnoseArithmeticOnFunctionPointer(S, Loc, Operand); 8831 return !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus; 8832 } 8833 8834 if (checkArithmeticIncompletePointerType(S, Loc, Operand)) return false; 8835 8836 return true; 8837 } 8838 8839 /// Check the validity of a binary arithmetic operation w.r.t. pointer 8840 /// operands. 8841 /// 8842 /// This routine will diagnose any invalid arithmetic on pointer operands much 8843 /// like \see checkArithmeticOpPointerOperand. However, it has special logic 8844 /// for emitting a single diagnostic even for operations where both LHS and RHS 8845 /// are (potentially problematic) pointers. 8846 /// 8847 /// \returns True when the operand is valid to use (even if as an extension). 8848 static bool checkArithmeticBinOpPointerOperands(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 8849 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 8850 bool isLHSPointer = LHSExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType(); 8851 bool isRHSPointer = RHSExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType(); 8852 if (!isLHSPointer && !isRHSPointer) return true; 8853 8854 QualType LHSPointeeTy, RHSPointeeTy; 8855 if (isLHSPointer) LHSPointeeTy = LHSExpr->getType()->getPointeeType(); 8856 if (isRHSPointer) RHSPointeeTy = RHSExpr->getType()->getPointeeType(); 8857 8858 // if both are pointers check if operation is valid wrt address spaces 8859 if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL && isLHSPointer && isRHSPointer) { 8860 const PointerType *lhsPtr = LHSExpr->getType()->getAs<PointerType>(); 8861 const PointerType *rhsPtr = RHSExpr->getType()->getAs<PointerType>(); 8862 if (!lhsPtr->isAddressSpaceOverlapping(*rhsPtr)) { 8863 S.Diag(Loc, 8864 diag::err_typecheck_op_on_nonoverlapping_address_space_pointers) 8865 << LHSExpr->getType() << RHSExpr->getType() << 1 /*arithmetic op*/ 8866 << LHSExpr->getSourceRange() << RHSExpr->getSourceRange(); 8867 return false; 8868 } 8869 } 8870 8871 // Check for arithmetic on pointers to incomplete types. 8872 bool isLHSVoidPtr = isLHSPointer && LHSPointeeTy->isVoidType(); 8873 bool isRHSVoidPtr = isRHSPointer && RHSPointeeTy->isVoidType(); 8874 if (isLHSVoidPtr || isRHSVoidPtr) { 8875 if (!isRHSVoidPtr) diagnoseArithmeticOnVoidPointer(S, Loc, LHSExpr); 8876 else if (!isLHSVoidPtr) diagnoseArithmeticOnVoidPointer(S, Loc, RHSExpr); 8877 else diagnoseArithmeticOnTwoVoidPointers(S, Loc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 8878 8879 return !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus; 8880 } 8881 8882 bool isLHSFuncPtr = isLHSPointer && LHSPointeeTy->isFunctionType(); 8883 bool isRHSFuncPtr = isRHSPointer && RHSPointeeTy->isFunctionType(); 8884 if (isLHSFuncPtr || isRHSFuncPtr) { 8885 if (!isRHSFuncPtr) diagnoseArithmeticOnFunctionPointer(S, Loc, LHSExpr); 8886 else if (!isLHSFuncPtr) diagnoseArithmeticOnFunctionPointer(S, Loc, 8887 RHSExpr); 8888 else diagnoseArithmeticOnTwoFunctionPointers(S, Loc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 8889 8890 return !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus; 8891 } 8892 8893 if (isLHSPointer && checkArithmeticIncompletePointerType(S, Loc, LHSExpr)) 8894 return false; 8895 if (isRHSPointer && checkArithmeticIncompletePointerType(S, Loc, RHSExpr)) 8896 return false; 8897 8898 return true; 8899 } 8900 8901 /// diagnoseStringPlusInt - Emit a warning when adding an integer to a string 8902 /// literal. 8903 static void diagnoseStringPlusInt(Sema &Self, SourceLocation OpLoc, 8904 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 8905 StringLiteral* StrExpr = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(LHSExpr->IgnoreImpCasts()); 8906 Expr* IndexExpr = RHSExpr; 8907 if (!StrExpr) { 8908 StrExpr = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(RHSExpr->IgnoreImpCasts()); 8909 IndexExpr = LHSExpr; 8910 } 8911 8912 bool IsStringPlusInt = StrExpr && 8913 IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType(); 8914 if (!IsStringPlusInt || IndexExpr->isValueDependent()) 8915 return; 8916 8917 llvm::APSInt index; 8918 if (IndexExpr->EvaluateAsInt(index, Self.getASTContext())) { 8919 unsigned StrLenWithNull = StrExpr->getLength() + 1; 8920 if (index.isNonNegative() && 8921 index <= llvm::APSInt(llvm::APInt(index.getBitWidth(), StrLenWithNull), 8922 index.isUnsigned())) 8923 return; 8924 } 8925 8926 SourceRange DiagRange(LHSExpr->getLocStart(), RHSExpr->getLocEnd()); 8927 Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_string_plus_int) 8928 << DiagRange << IndexExpr->IgnoreImpCasts()->getType(); 8929 8930 // Only print a fixit for "str" + int, not for int + "str". 8931 if (IndexExpr == RHSExpr) { 8932 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.getLocForEndOfToken(RHSExpr->getLocEnd()); 8933 Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_string_plus_scalar_silence) 8934 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(LHSExpr->getLocStart(), "&") 8935 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(OpLoc), "[") 8936 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, "]"); 8937 } else 8938 Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_string_plus_scalar_silence); 8939 } 8940 8941 /// Emit a warning when adding a char literal to a string. 8942 static void diagnoseStringPlusChar(Sema &Self, SourceLocation OpLoc, 8943 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 8944 const Expr *StringRefExpr = LHSExpr; 8945 const CharacterLiteral *CharExpr = 8946 dyn_cast<CharacterLiteral>(RHSExpr->IgnoreImpCasts()); 8947 8948 if (!CharExpr) { 8949 CharExpr = dyn_cast<CharacterLiteral>(LHSExpr->IgnoreImpCasts()); 8950 StringRefExpr = RHSExpr; 8951 } 8952 8953 if (!CharExpr || !StringRefExpr) 8954 return; 8955 8956 const QualType StringType = StringRefExpr->getType(); 8957 8958 // Return if not a PointerType. 8959 if (!StringType->isAnyPointerType()) 8960 return; 8961 8962 // Return if not a CharacterType. 8963 if (!StringType->getPointeeType()->isAnyCharacterType()) 8964 return; 8965 8966 ASTContext &Ctx = Self.getASTContext(); 8967 SourceRange DiagRange(LHSExpr->getLocStart(), RHSExpr->getLocEnd()); 8968 8969 const QualType CharType = CharExpr->getType(); 8970 if (!CharType->isAnyCharacterType() && 8971 CharType->isIntegerType() && 8972 llvm::isUIntN(Ctx.getCharWidth(), CharExpr->getValue())) { 8973 Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_string_plus_char) 8974 << DiagRange << Ctx.CharTy; 8975 } else { 8976 Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_string_plus_char) 8977 << DiagRange << CharExpr->getType(); 8978 } 8979 8980 // Only print a fixit for str + char, not for char + str. 8981 if (isa<CharacterLiteral>(RHSExpr->IgnoreImpCasts())) { 8982 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.getLocForEndOfToken(RHSExpr->getLocEnd()); 8983 Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_string_plus_scalar_silence) 8984 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(LHSExpr->getLocStart(), "&") 8985 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(OpLoc), "[") 8986 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, "]"); 8987 } else { 8988 Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_string_plus_scalar_silence); 8989 } 8990 } 8991 8992 /// Emit error when two pointers are incompatible. 8993 static void diagnosePointerIncompatibility(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 8994 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 8995 assert(LHSExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType()); 8996 assert(RHSExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType()); 8997 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible) 8998 << LHSExpr->getType() << RHSExpr->getType() << LHSExpr->getSourceRange() 8999 << RHSExpr->getSourceRange(); 9000 } 9001 9002 // C99 6.5.6 9003 QualType Sema::CheckAdditionOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 9004 SourceLocation Loc, BinaryOperatorKind Opc, 9005 QualType* CompLHSTy) { 9006 checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompare=*/false); 9007 9008 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() || 9009 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) { 9010 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands( 9011 LHS, RHS, Loc, CompLHSTy, 9012 /*AllowBothBool*/getLangOpts().AltiVec, 9013 /*AllowBoolConversions*/getLangOpts().ZVector); 9014 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType; 9015 return compType; 9016 } 9017 9018 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS, CompLHSTy); 9019 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid()) 9020 return QualType(); 9021 9022 // Diagnose "string literal" '+' int and string '+' "char literal". 9023 if (Opc == BO_Add) { 9024 diagnoseStringPlusInt(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get()); 9025 diagnoseStringPlusChar(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get()); 9026 } 9027 9028 // handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic). 9029 if (!compType.isNull() && compType->isArithmeticType()) { 9030 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType; 9031 return compType; 9032 } 9033 9034 // Type-checking. Ultimately the pointer's going to be in PExp; 9035 // note that we bias towards the LHS being the pointer. 9036 Expr *PExp = LHS.get(), *IExp = RHS.get(); 9037 9038 bool isObjCPointer; 9039 if (PExp->getType()->isPointerType()) { 9040 isObjCPointer = false; 9041 } else if (PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 9042 isObjCPointer = true; 9043 } else { 9044 std::swap(PExp, IExp); 9045 if (PExp->getType()->isPointerType()) { 9046 isObjCPointer = false; 9047 } else if (PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 9048 isObjCPointer = true; 9049 } else { 9050 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 9051 } 9052 } 9053 assert(PExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType()); 9054 9055 if (!IExp->getType()->isIntegerType()) 9056 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 9057 9058 // Adding to a null pointer results in undefined behavior. 9059 if (PExp->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant( 9060 Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull)) { 9061 // In C++ adding zero to a null pointer is defined. 9062 llvm::APSInt KnownVal; 9063 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || 9064 (!IExp->isValueDependent() && 9065 (!IExp->EvaluateAsInt(KnownVal, Context) || KnownVal != 0))) { 9066 // Check the conditions to see if this is the 'p = nullptr + n' idiom. 9067 bool IsGNUIdiom = BinaryOperator::isNullPointerArithmeticExtension( 9068 Context, BO_Add, PExp, IExp); 9069 diagnoseArithmeticOnNullPointer(*this, Loc, PExp, IsGNUIdiom); 9070 } 9071 } 9072 9073 if (!checkArithmeticOpPointerOperand(*this, Loc, PExp)) 9074 return QualType(); 9075 9076 if (isObjCPointer && checkArithmeticOnObjCPointer(*this, Loc, PExp)) 9077 return QualType(); 9078 9079 // Check array bounds for pointer arithemtic 9080 CheckArrayAccess(PExp, IExp); 9081 9082 if (CompLHSTy) { 9083 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(LHS.get()); 9084 if (LHSTy.isNull()) { 9085 LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType(); 9086 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType()) 9087 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy); 9088 } 9089 *CompLHSTy = LHSTy; 9090 } 9091 9092 return PExp->getType(); 9093 } 9094 9095 // C99 6.5.6 9096 QualType Sema::CheckSubtractionOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 9097 SourceLocation Loc, 9098 QualType* CompLHSTy) { 9099 checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompare=*/false); 9100 9101 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() || 9102 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) { 9103 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands( 9104 LHS, RHS, Loc, CompLHSTy, 9105 /*AllowBothBool*/getLangOpts().AltiVec, 9106 /*AllowBoolConversions*/getLangOpts().ZVector); 9107 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType; 9108 return compType; 9109 } 9110 9111 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS, CompLHSTy); 9112 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid()) 9113 return QualType(); 9114 9115 // Enforce type constraints: C99 6.5.6p3. 9116 9117 // Handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic). 9118 if (!compType.isNull() && compType->isArithmeticType()) { 9119 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType; 9120 return compType; 9121 } 9122 9123 // Either ptr - int or ptr - ptr. 9124 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) { 9125 QualType lpointee = LHS.get()->getType()->getPointeeType(); 9126 9127 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts. 9128 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() && 9129 checkArithmeticOnObjCPointer(*this, Loc, LHS.get())) 9130 return QualType(); 9131 9132 // The result type of a pointer-int computation is the pointer type. 9133 if (RHS.get()->getType()->isIntegerType()) { 9134 // Subtracting from a null pointer should produce a warning. 9135 // The last argument to the diagnose call says this doesn't match the 9136 // GNU int-to-pointer idiom. 9137 if (LHS.get()->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 9138 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull)) { 9139 // In C++ adding zero to a null pointer is defined. 9140 llvm::APSInt KnownVal; 9141 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || 9142 (!RHS.get()->isValueDependent() && 9143 (!RHS.get()->EvaluateAsInt(KnownVal, Context) || KnownVal != 0))) { 9144 diagnoseArithmeticOnNullPointer(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), false); 9145 } 9146 } 9147 9148 if (!checkArithmeticOpPointerOperand(*this, Loc, LHS.get())) 9149 return QualType(); 9150 9151 // Check array bounds for pointer arithemtic 9152 CheckArrayAccess(LHS.get(), RHS.get(), /*ArraySubscriptExpr*/nullptr, 9153 /*AllowOnePastEnd*/true, /*IndexNegated*/true); 9154 9155 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = LHS.get()->getType(); 9156 return LHS.get()->getType(); 9157 } 9158 9159 // Handle pointer-pointer subtractions. 9160 if (const PointerType *RHSPTy 9161 = RHS.get()->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) { 9162 QualType rpointee = RHSPTy->getPointeeType(); 9163 9164 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 9165 // Pointee types must be the same: C++ [expr.add] 9166 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lpointee, rpointee)) { 9167 diagnosePointerIncompatibility(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get()); 9168 } 9169 } else { 9170 // Pointee types must be compatible C99 6.5.6p3 9171 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible( 9172 Context.getCanonicalType(lpointee).getUnqualifiedType(), 9173 Context.getCanonicalType(rpointee).getUnqualifiedType())) { 9174 diagnosePointerIncompatibility(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get()); 9175 return QualType(); 9176 } 9177 } 9178 9179 if (!checkArithmeticBinOpPointerOperands(*this, Loc, 9180 LHS.get(), RHS.get())) 9181 return QualType(); 9182 9183 // FIXME: Add warnings for nullptr - ptr. 9184 9185 // The pointee type may have zero size. As an extension, a structure or 9186 // union may have zero size or an array may have zero length. In this 9187 // case subtraction does not make sense. 9188 if (!rpointee->isVoidType() && !rpointee->isFunctionType()) { 9189 CharUnits ElementSize = Context.getTypeSizeInChars(rpointee); 9190 if (ElementSize.isZero()) { 9191 Diag(Loc,diag::warn_sub_ptr_zero_size_types) 9192 << rpointee.getUnqualifiedType() 9193 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 9194 } 9195 } 9196 9197 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = LHS.get()->getType(); 9198 return Context.getPointerDiffType(); 9199 } 9200 } 9201 9202 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 9203 } 9204 9205 static bool isScopedEnumerationType(QualType T) { 9206 if (const EnumType *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>()) 9207 return ET->getDecl()->isScoped(); 9208 return false; 9209 } 9210 9211 static void DiagnoseBadShiftValues(Sema& S, ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 9212 SourceLocation Loc, BinaryOperatorKind Opc, 9213 QualType LHSType) { 9214 // OpenCL 6.3j: shift values are effectively % word size of LHS (more defined), 9215 // so skip remaining warnings as we don't want to modify values within Sema. 9216 if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL) 9217 return; 9218 9219 llvm::APSInt Right; 9220 // Check right/shifter operand 9221 if (RHS.get()->isValueDependent() || 9222 !RHS.get()->EvaluateAsInt(Right, S.Context)) 9223 return; 9224 9225 if (Right.isNegative()) { 9226 S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, RHS.get(), 9227 S.PDiag(diag::warn_shift_negative) 9228 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange()); 9229 return; 9230 } 9231 llvm::APInt LeftBits(Right.getBitWidth(), 9232 S.Context.getTypeSize(LHS.get()->getType())); 9233 if (Right.uge(LeftBits)) { 9234 S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, RHS.get(), 9235 S.PDiag(diag::warn_shift_gt_typewidth) 9236 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange()); 9237 return; 9238 } 9239 if (Opc != BO_Shl) 9240 return; 9241 9242 // When left shifting an ICE which is signed, we can check for overflow which 9243 // according to C++ has undefined behavior ([expr.shift] 5.8/2). Unsigned 9244 // integers have defined behavior modulo one more than the maximum value 9245 // representable in the result type, so never warn for those. 9246 llvm::APSInt Left; 9247 if (LHS.get()->isValueDependent() || 9248 LHSType->hasUnsignedIntegerRepresentation() || 9249 !LHS.get()->EvaluateAsInt(Left, S.Context)) 9250 return; 9251 9252 // If LHS does not have a signed type and non-negative value 9253 // then, the behavior is undefined. Warn about it. 9254 if (Left.isNegative() && !S.getLangOpts().isSignedOverflowDefined()) { 9255 S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, LHS.get(), 9256 S.PDiag(diag::warn_shift_lhs_negative) 9257 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()); 9258 return; 9259 } 9260 9261 llvm::APInt ResultBits = 9262 static_cast<llvm::APInt&>(Right) + Left.getMinSignedBits(); 9263 if (LeftBits.uge(ResultBits)) 9264 return; 9265 llvm::APSInt Result = Left.extend(ResultBits.getLimitedValue()); 9266 Result = Result.shl(Right); 9267 9268 // Print the bit representation of the signed integer as an unsigned 9269 // hexadecimal number. 9270 SmallString<40> HexResult; 9271 Result.toString(HexResult, 16, /*Signed =*/false, /*Literal =*/true); 9272 9273 // If we are only missing a sign bit, this is less likely to result in actual 9274 // bugs -- if the result is cast back to an unsigned type, it will have the 9275 // expected value. Thus we place this behind a different warning that can be 9276 // turned off separately if needed. 9277 if (LeftBits == ResultBits - 1) { 9278 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_result_sets_sign_bit) 9279 << HexResult << LHSType 9280 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 9281 return; 9282 } 9283 9284 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_result_gt_typewidth) 9285 << HexResult.str() << Result.getMinSignedBits() << LHSType 9286 << Left.getBitWidth() << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() 9287 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 9288 } 9289 9290 /// Return the resulting type when a vector is shifted 9291 /// by a scalar or vector shift amount. 9292 static QualType checkVectorShift(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 9293 SourceLocation Loc, bool IsCompAssign) { 9294 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.j says RHS can be a vector only if LHS is a vector. 9295 if ((S.LangOpts.OpenCL || S.LangOpts.ZVector) && 9296 !LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) { 9297 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_shift_rhs_only_vector) 9298 << RHS.get()->getType() << LHS.get()->getType() 9299 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 9300 return QualType(); 9301 } 9302 9303 if (!IsCompAssign) { 9304 LHS = S.UsualUnaryConversions(LHS.get()); 9305 if (LHS.isInvalid()) return QualType(); 9306 } 9307 9308 RHS = S.UsualUnaryConversions(RHS.get()); 9309 if (RHS.isInvalid()) return QualType(); 9310 9311 QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType(); 9312 // Note that LHS might be a scalar because the routine calls not only in 9313 // OpenCL case. 9314 const VectorType *LHSVecTy = LHSType->getAs<VectorType>(); 9315 QualType LHSEleType = LHSVecTy ? LHSVecTy->getElementType() : LHSType; 9316 9317 // Note that RHS might not be a vector. 9318 QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType(); 9319 const VectorType *RHSVecTy = RHSType->getAs<VectorType>(); 9320 QualType RHSEleType = RHSVecTy ? RHSVecTy->getElementType() : RHSType; 9321 9322 // The operands need to be integers. 9323 if (!LHSEleType->isIntegerType()) { 9324 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_expect_int) 9325 << LHS.get()->getType() << LHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 9326 return QualType(); 9327 } 9328 9329 if (!RHSEleType->isIntegerType()) { 9330 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_expect_int) 9331 << RHS.get()->getType() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 9332 return QualType(); 9333 } 9334 9335 if (!LHSVecTy) { 9336 assert(RHSVecTy); 9337 if (IsCompAssign) 9338 return RHSType; 9339 if (LHSEleType != RHSEleType) { 9340 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(),RHSEleType, CK_IntegralCast); 9341 LHSEleType = RHSEleType; 9342 } 9343 QualType VecTy = 9344 S.Context.getExtVectorType(LHSEleType, RHSVecTy->getNumElements()); 9345 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), VecTy, CK_VectorSplat); 9346 LHSType = VecTy; 9347 } else if (RHSVecTy) { 9348 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.j says that for vector types, the operators 9349 // are applied component-wise. So if RHS is a vector, then ensure 9350 // that the number of elements is the same as LHS... 9351 if (RHSVecTy->getNumElements() != LHSVecTy->getNumElements()) { 9352 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_lengths_not_equal) 9353 << LHS.get()->getType() << RHS.get()->getType() 9354 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 9355 return QualType(); 9356 } 9357 if (!S.LangOpts.OpenCL && !S.LangOpts.ZVector) { 9358 const BuiltinType *LHSBT = LHSEleType->getAs<clang::BuiltinType>(); 9359 const BuiltinType *RHSBT = RHSEleType->getAs<clang::BuiltinType>(); 9360 if (LHSBT != RHSBT && 9361 S.Context.getTypeSize(LHSBT) != S.Context.getTypeSize(RHSBT)) { 9362 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_typecheck_vector_element_sizes_not_equal) 9363 << LHS.get()->getType() << RHS.get()->getType() 9364 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 9365 } 9366 } 9367 } else { 9368 // ...else expand RHS to match the number of elements in LHS. 9369 QualType VecTy = 9370 S.Context.getExtVectorType(RHSEleType, LHSVecTy->getNumElements()); 9371 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), VecTy, CK_VectorSplat); 9372 } 9373 9374 return LHSType; 9375 } 9376 9377 // C99 6.5.7 9378 QualType Sema::CheckShiftOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 9379 SourceLocation Loc, BinaryOperatorKind Opc, 9380 bool IsCompAssign) { 9381 checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompare=*/false); 9382 9383 // Vector shifts promote their scalar inputs to vector type. 9384 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() || 9385 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) { 9386 if (LangOpts.ZVector) { 9387 // The shift operators for the z vector extensions work basically 9388 // like general shifts, except that neither the LHS nor the RHS is 9389 // allowed to be a "vector bool". 9390 if (auto LHSVecType = LHS.get()->getType()->getAs<VectorType>()) 9391 if (LHSVecType->getVectorKind() == VectorType::AltiVecBool) 9392 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 9393 if (auto RHSVecType = RHS.get()->getType()->getAs<VectorType>()) 9394 if (RHSVecType->getVectorKind() == VectorType::AltiVecBool) 9395 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 9396 } 9397 return checkVectorShift(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, IsCompAssign); 9398 } 9399 9400 // Shifts don't perform usual arithmetic conversions, they just do integer 9401 // promotions on each operand. C99 6.5.7p3 9402 9403 // For the LHS, do usual unary conversions, but then reset them away 9404 // if this is a compound assignment. 9405 ExprResult OldLHS = LHS; 9406 LHS = UsualUnaryConversions(LHS.get()); 9407 if (LHS.isInvalid()) 9408 return QualType(); 9409 QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType(); 9410 if (IsCompAssign) LHS = OldLHS; 9411 9412 // The RHS is simpler. 9413 RHS = UsualUnaryConversions(RHS.get()); 9414 if (RHS.isInvalid()) 9415 return QualType(); 9416 QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType(); 9417 9418 // C99 6.5.7p2: Each of the operands shall have integer type. 9419 if (!LHSType->hasIntegerRepresentation() || 9420 !RHSType->hasIntegerRepresentation()) 9421 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 9422 9423 // C++0x: Don't allow scoped enums. FIXME: Use something better than 9424 // hasIntegerRepresentation() above instead of this. 9425 if (isScopedEnumerationType(LHSType) || 9426 isScopedEnumerationType(RHSType)) { 9427 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 9428 } 9429 // Sanity-check shift operands 9430 DiagnoseBadShiftValues(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, Opc, LHSType); 9431 9432 // "The type of the result is that of the promoted left operand." 9433 return LHSType; 9434 } 9435 9436 /// If two different enums are compared, raise a warning. 9437 static void checkEnumComparison(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *LHS, 9438 Expr *RHS) { 9439 QualType LHSStrippedType = LHS->IgnoreParenImpCasts()->getType(); 9440 QualType RHSStrippedType = RHS->IgnoreParenImpCasts()->getType(); 9441 9442 const EnumType *LHSEnumType = LHSStrippedType->getAs<EnumType>(); 9443 if (!LHSEnumType) 9444 return; 9445 const EnumType *RHSEnumType = RHSStrippedType->getAs<EnumType>(); 9446 if (!RHSEnumType) 9447 return; 9448 9449 // Ignore anonymous enums. 9450 if (!LHSEnumType->getDecl()->getIdentifier() && 9451 !LHSEnumType->getDecl()->getTypedefNameForAnonDecl()) 9452 return; 9453 if (!RHSEnumType->getDecl()->getIdentifier() && 9454 !RHSEnumType->getDecl()->getTypedefNameForAnonDecl()) 9455 return; 9456 9457 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(LHSStrippedType, RHSStrippedType)) 9458 return; 9459 9460 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_comparison_of_mixed_enum_types) 9461 << LHSStrippedType << RHSStrippedType 9462 << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange(); 9463 } 9464 9465 /// Diagnose bad pointer comparisons. 9466 static void diagnoseDistinctPointerComparison(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 9467 ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 9468 bool IsError) { 9469 S.Diag(Loc, IsError ? diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers 9470 : diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers) 9471 << LHS.get()->getType() << RHS.get()->getType() 9472 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 9473 } 9474 9475 /// Returns false if the pointers are converted to a composite type, 9476 /// true otherwise. 9477 static bool convertPointersToCompositeType(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 9478 ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS) { 9479 // C++ [expr.rel]p2: 9480 // [...] Pointer conversions (4.10) and qualification 9481 // conversions (4.4) are performed on pointer operands (or on 9482 // a pointer operand and a null pointer constant) to bring 9483 // them to their composite pointer type. [...] 9484 // 9485 // C++ [expr.eq]p1 uses the same notion for (in)equality 9486 // comparisons of pointers. 9487 9488 QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType(); 9489 QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType(); 9490 assert(LHSType->isPointerType() || RHSType->isPointerType() || 9491 LHSType->isMemberPointerType() || RHSType->isMemberPointerType()); 9492 9493 QualType T = S.FindCompositePointerType(Loc, LHS, RHS); 9494 if (T.isNull()) { 9495 if ((LHSType->isPointerType() || LHSType->isMemberPointerType()) && 9496 (RHSType->isPointerType() || RHSType->isMemberPointerType())) 9497 diagnoseDistinctPointerComparison(S, Loc, LHS, RHS, /*isError*/true); 9498 else 9499 S.InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 9500 return true; 9501 } 9502 9503 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), T, CK_BitCast); 9504 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), T, CK_BitCast); 9505 return false; 9506 } 9507 9508 static void diagnoseFunctionPointerToVoidComparison(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 9509 ExprResult &LHS, 9510 ExprResult &RHS, 9511 bool IsError) { 9512 S.Diag(Loc, IsError ? diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void 9513 : diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void) 9514 << LHS.get()->getType() << RHS.get()->getType() 9515 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 9516 } 9517 9518 static bool isObjCObjectLiteral(ExprResult &E) { 9519 switch (E.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts()->getStmtClass()) { 9520 case Stmt::ObjCArrayLiteralClass: 9521 case Stmt::ObjCDictionaryLiteralClass: 9522 case Stmt::ObjCStringLiteralClass: 9523 case Stmt::ObjCBoxedExprClass: 9524 return true; 9525 default: 9526 // Note that ObjCBoolLiteral is NOT an object literal! 9527 return false; 9528 } 9529 } 9530 9531 static bool hasIsEqualMethod(Sema &S, const Expr *LHS, const Expr *RHS) { 9532 const ObjCObjectPointerType *Type = 9533 LHS->getType()->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 9534 9535 // If this is not actually an Objective-C object, bail out. 9536 if (!Type) 9537 return false; 9538 9539 // Get the LHS object's interface type. 9540 QualType InterfaceType = Type->getPointeeType(); 9541 9542 // If the RHS isn't an Objective-C object, bail out. 9543 if (!RHS->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) 9544 return false; 9545 9546 // Try to find the -isEqual: method. 9547 Selector IsEqualSel = S.NSAPIObj->getIsEqualSelector(); 9548 ObjCMethodDecl *Method = S.LookupMethodInObjectType(IsEqualSel, 9549 InterfaceType, 9550 /*instance=*/true); 9551 if (!Method) { 9552 if (Type->isObjCIdType()) { 9553 // For 'id', just check the global pool. 9554 Method = S.LookupInstanceMethodInGlobalPool(IsEqualSel, SourceRange(), 9555 /*receiverId=*/true); 9556 } else { 9557 // Check protocols. 9558 Method = S.LookupMethodInQualifiedType(IsEqualSel, Type, 9559 /*instance=*/true); 9560 } 9561 } 9562 9563 if (!Method) 9564 return false; 9565 9566 QualType T = Method->parameters()[0]->getType(); 9567 if (!T->isObjCObjectPointerType()) 9568 return false; 9569 9570 QualType R = Method->getReturnType(); 9571 if (!R->isScalarType()) 9572 return false; 9573 9574 return true; 9575 } 9576 9577 Sema::ObjCLiteralKind Sema::CheckLiteralKind(Expr *FromE) { 9578 FromE = FromE->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 9579 switch (FromE->getStmtClass()) { 9580 default: 9581 break; 9582 case Stmt::ObjCStringLiteralClass: 9583 // "string literal" 9584 return LK_String; 9585 case Stmt::ObjCArrayLiteralClass: 9586 // "array literal" 9587 return LK_Array; 9588 case Stmt::ObjCDictionaryLiteralClass: 9589 // "dictionary literal" 9590 return LK_Dictionary; 9591 case Stmt::BlockExprClass: 9592 return LK_Block; 9593 case Stmt::ObjCBoxedExprClass: { 9594 Expr *Inner = cast<ObjCBoxedExpr>(FromE)->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens(); 9595 switch (Inner->getStmtClass()) { 9596 case Stmt::IntegerLiteralClass: 9597 case Stmt::FloatingLiteralClass: 9598 case Stmt::CharacterLiteralClass: 9599 case Stmt::ObjCBoolLiteralExprClass: 9600 case Stmt::CXXBoolLiteralExprClass: 9601 // "numeric literal" 9602 return LK_Numeric; 9603 case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass: { 9604 CastKind CK = cast<CastExpr>(Inner)->getCastKind(); 9605 // Boolean literals can be represented by implicit casts. 9606 if (CK == CK_IntegralToBoolean || CK == CK_IntegralCast) 9607 return LK_Numeric; 9608 break; 9609 } 9610 default: 9611 break; 9612 } 9613 return LK_Boxed; 9614 } 9615 } 9616 return LK_None; 9617 } 9618 9619 static void diagnoseObjCLiteralComparison(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 9620 ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 9621 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc){ 9622 Expr *Literal; 9623 Expr *Other; 9624 if (isObjCObjectLiteral(LHS)) { 9625 Literal = LHS.get(); 9626 Other = RHS.get(); 9627 } else { 9628 Literal = RHS.get(); 9629 Other = LHS.get(); 9630 } 9631 9632 // Don't warn on comparisons against nil. 9633 Other = Other->IgnoreParenCasts(); 9634 if (Other->isNullPointerConstant(S.getASTContext(), 9635 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull)) 9636 return; 9637 9638 // This should be kept in sync with warn_objc_literal_comparison. 9639 // LK_String should always be after the other literals, since it has its own 9640 // warning flag. 9641 Sema::ObjCLiteralKind LiteralKind = S.CheckLiteralKind(Literal); 9642 assert(LiteralKind != Sema::LK_Block); 9643 if (LiteralKind == Sema::LK_None) { 9644 llvm_unreachable("Unknown Objective-C object literal kind"); 9645 } 9646 9647 if (LiteralKind == Sema::LK_String) 9648 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_objc_string_literal_comparison) 9649 << Literal->getSourceRange(); 9650 else 9651 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_objc_literal_comparison) 9652 << LiteralKind << Literal->getSourceRange(); 9653 9654 if (BinaryOperator::isEqualityOp(Opc) && 9655 hasIsEqualMethod(S, LHS.get(), RHS.get())) { 9656 SourceLocation Start = LHS.get()->getLocStart(); 9657 SourceLocation End = S.getLocForEndOfToken(RHS.get()->getLocEnd()); 9658 CharSourceRange OpRange = 9659 CharSourceRange::getCharRange(Loc, S.getLocForEndOfToken(Loc)); 9660 9661 S.Diag(Loc, diag::note_objc_literal_comparison_isequal) 9662 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Start, Opc == BO_EQ ? "[" : "![") 9663 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpRange, " isEqual:") 9664 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(End, "]"); 9665 } 9666 } 9667 9668 /// Warns on !x < y, !x & y where !(x < y), !(x & y) was probably intended. 9669 static void diagnoseLogicalNotOnLHSofCheck(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, 9670 ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc, 9671 BinaryOperatorKind Opc) { 9672 // Check that left hand side is !something. 9673 UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(LHS.get()->IgnoreImpCasts()); 9674 if (!UO || UO->getOpcode() != UO_LNot) return; 9675 9676 // Only check if the right hand side is non-bool arithmetic type. 9677 if (RHS.get()->isKnownToHaveBooleanValue()) return; 9678 9679 // Make sure that the something in !something is not bool. 9680 Expr *SubExpr = UO->getSubExpr()->IgnoreImpCasts(); 9681 if (SubExpr->isKnownToHaveBooleanValue()) return; 9682 9683 // Emit warning. 9684 bool IsBitwiseOp = Opc == BO_And || Opc == BO_Or || Opc == BO_Xor; 9685 S.Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_logical_not_on_lhs_of_check) 9686 << Loc << IsBitwiseOp; 9687 9688 // First note suggest !(x < y) 9689 SourceLocation FirstOpen = SubExpr->getLocStart(); 9690 SourceLocation FirstClose = RHS.get()->getLocEnd(); 9691 FirstClose = S.getLocForEndOfToken(FirstClose); 9692 if (FirstClose.isInvalid()) 9693 FirstOpen = SourceLocation(); 9694 S.Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::note_logical_not_fix) 9695 << IsBitwiseOp 9696 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstOpen, "(") 9697 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstClose, ")"); 9698 9699 // Second note suggests (!x) < y 9700 SourceLocation SecondOpen = LHS.get()->getLocStart(); 9701 SourceLocation SecondClose = LHS.get()->getLocEnd(); 9702 SecondClose = S.getLocForEndOfToken(SecondClose); 9703 if (SecondClose.isInvalid()) 9704 SecondOpen = SourceLocation(); 9705 S.Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::note_logical_not_silence_with_parens) 9706 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondOpen, "(") 9707 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondClose, ")"); 9708 } 9709 9710 // Get the decl for a simple expression: a reference to a variable, 9711 // an implicit C++ field reference, or an implicit ObjC ivar reference. 9712 static ValueDecl *getCompareDecl(Expr *E) { 9713 if (DeclRefExpr *DR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) 9714 return DR->getDecl(); 9715 if (ObjCIvarRefExpr *Ivar = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(E)) { 9716 if (Ivar->isFreeIvar()) 9717 return Ivar->getDecl(); 9718 } 9719 if (MemberExpr *Mem = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E)) { 9720 if (Mem->isImplicitAccess()) 9721 return Mem->getMemberDecl(); 9722 } 9723 return nullptr; 9724 } 9725 9726 /// Diagnose some forms of syntactically-obvious tautological comparison. 9727 static void diagnoseTautologicalComparison(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 9728 Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS, 9729 BinaryOperatorKind Opc) { 9730 Expr *LHSStripped = LHS->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 9731 Expr *RHSStripped = RHS->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 9732 9733 QualType LHSType = LHS->getType(); 9734 QualType RHSType = RHS->getType(); 9735 if (LHSType->hasFloatingRepresentation() || 9736 (LHSType->isBlockPointerType() && !BinaryOperator::isEqualityOp(Opc)) || 9737 LHS->getLocStart().isMacroID() || RHS->getLocStart().isMacroID() || 9738 S.inTemplateInstantiation()) 9739 return; 9740 9741 // Comparisons between two array types are ill-formed for operator<=>, so 9742 // we shouldn't emit any additional warnings about it. 9743 if (Opc == BO_Cmp && LHSType->isArrayType() && RHSType->isArrayType()) 9744 return; 9745 9746 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form 9747 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and 9748 // often indicate logic errors in the program. 9749 // 9750 // NOTE: Don't warn about comparison expressions resulting from macro 9751 // expansion. Also don't warn about comparisons which are only self 9752 // comparisons within a template instantiation. The warnings should catch 9753 // obvious cases in the definition of the template anyways. The idea is to 9754 // warn when the typed comparison operator will always evaluate to the same 9755 // result. 9756 ValueDecl *DL = getCompareDecl(LHSStripped); 9757 ValueDecl *DR = getCompareDecl(RHSStripped); 9758 if (DL && DR && declaresSameEntity(DL, DR)) { 9759 StringRef Result; 9760 switch (Opc) { 9761 case BO_EQ: case BO_LE: case BO_GE: 9762 Result = "true"; 9763 break; 9764 case BO_NE: case BO_LT: case BO_GT: 9765 Result = "false"; 9766 break; 9767 case BO_Cmp: 9768 Result = "'std::strong_ordering::equal'"; 9769 break; 9770 default: 9771 break; 9772 } 9773 S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, nullptr, 9774 S.PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always) 9775 << 0 /*self-comparison*/ << !Result.empty() 9776 << Result); 9777 } else if (DL && DR && 9778 DL->getType()->isArrayType() && DR->getType()->isArrayType() && 9779 !DL->isWeak() && !DR->isWeak()) { 9780 // What is it always going to evaluate to? 9781 StringRef Result; 9782 switch(Opc) { 9783 case BO_EQ: // e.g. array1 == array2 9784 Result = "false"; 9785 break; 9786 case BO_NE: // e.g. array1 != array2 9787 Result = "true"; 9788 break; 9789 default: // e.g. array1 <= array2 9790 // The best we can say is 'a constant' 9791 break; 9792 } 9793 S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, nullptr, 9794 S.PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always) 9795 << 1 /*array comparison*/ 9796 << !Result.empty() << Result); 9797 } 9798 9799 if (isa<CastExpr>(LHSStripped)) 9800 LHSStripped = LHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts(); 9801 if (isa<CastExpr>(RHSStripped)) 9802 RHSStripped = RHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts(); 9803 9804 // Warn about comparisons against a string constant (unless the other 9805 // operand is null); the user probably wants strcmp. 9806 Expr *LiteralString = nullptr; 9807 Expr *LiteralStringStripped = nullptr; 9808 if ((isa<StringLiteral>(LHSStripped) || isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LHSStripped)) && 9809 !RHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(S.Context, 9810 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) { 9811 LiteralString = LHS; 9812 LiteralStringStripped = LHSStripped; 9813 } else if ((isa<StringLiteral>(RHSStripped) || 9814 isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(RHSStripped)) && 9815 !LHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(S.Context, 9816 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) { 9817 LiteralString = RHS; 9818 LiteralStringStripped = RHSStripped; 9819 } 9820 9821 if (LiteralString) { 9822 S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, nullptr, 9823 S.PDiag(diag::warn_stringcompare) 9824 << isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LiteralStringStripped) 9825 << LiteralString->getSourceRange()); 9826 } 9827 } 9828 9829 static ImplicitConversionKind castKindToImplicitConversionKind(CastKind CK) { 9830 switch (CK) { 9831 default: { 9832 #ifndef NDEBUG 9833 llvm::errs() << "unhandled cast kind: " << CastExpr::getCastKindName(CK) 9834 << "\n"; 9835 #endif 9836 llvm_unreachable("unhandled cast kind"); 9837 } 9838 case CK_UserDefinedConversion: 9839 return ICK_Identity; 9840 case CK_LValueToRValue: 9841 return ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue; 9842 case CK_ArrayToPointerDecay: 9843 return ICK_Array_To_Pointer; 9844 case CK_FunctionToPointerDecay: 9845 return ICK_Function_To_Pointer; 9846 case CK_IntegralCast: 9847 return ICK_Integral_Conversion; 9848 case CK_FloatingCast: 9849 return ICK_Floating_Conversion; 9850 case CK_IntegralToFloating: 9851 case CK_FloatingToIntegral: 9852 return ICK_Floating_Integral; 9853 case CK_IntegralComplexCast: 9854 case CK_FloatingComplexCast: 9855 case CK_FloatingComplexToIntegralComplex: 9856 case CK_IntegralComplexToFloatingComplex: 9857 return ICK_Complex_Conversion; 9858 case CK_FloatingComplexToReal: 9859 case CK_FloatingRealToComplex: 9860 case CK_IntegralComplexToReal: 9861 case CK_IntegralRealToComplex: 9862 return ICK_Complex_Real; 9863 } 9864 } 9865 9866 static bool checkThreeWayNarrowingConversion(Sema &S, QualType ToType, Expr *E, 9867 QualType FromType, 9868 SourceLocation Loc) { 9869 // Check for a narrowing implicit conversion. 9870 StandardConversionSequence SCS; 9871 SCS.setAsIdentityConversion(); 9872 SCS.setToType(0, FromType); 9873 SCS.setToType(1, ToType); 9874 if (const auto *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)) 9875 SCS.Second = castKindToImplicitConversionKind(ICE->getCastKind()); 9876 9877 APValue PreNarrowingValue; 9878 QualType PreNarrowingType; 9879 switch (SCS.getNarrowingKind(S.Context, E, PreNarrowingValue, 9880 PreNarrowingType, 9881 /*IgnoreFloatToIntegralConversion*/ true)) { 9882 case NK_Dependent_Narrowing: 9883 // Implicit conversion to a narrower type, but the expression is 9884 // value-dependent so we can't tell whether it's actually narrowing. 9885 case NK_Not_Narrowing: 9886 return false; 9887 9888 case NK_Constant_Narrowing: 9889 // Implicit conversion to a narrower type, and the value is not a constant 9890 // expression. 9891 S.Diag(E->getLocStart(), diag::err_spaceship_argument_narrowing) 9892 << /*Constant*/ 1 9893 << PreNarrowingValue.getAsString(S.Context, PreNarrowingType) << ToType; 9894 return true; 9895 9896 case NK_Variable_Narrowing: 9897 // Implicit conversion to a narrower type, and the value is not a constant 9898 // expression. 9899 case NK_Type_Narrowing: 9900 S.Diag(E->getLocStart(), diag::err_spaceship_argument_narrowing) 9901 << /*Constant*/ 0 << FromType << ToType; 9902 // TODO: It's not a constant expression, but what if the user intended it 9903 // to be? Can we produce notes to help them figure out why it isn't? 9904 return true; 9905 } 9906 llvm_unreachable("unhandled case in switch"); 9907 } 9908 9909 static QualType checkArithmeticOrEnumeralThreeWayCompare(Sema &S, 9910 ExprResult &LHS, 9911 ExprResult &RHS, 9912 SourceLocation Loc) { 9913 using CCT = ComparisonCategoryType; 9914 9915 QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType(); 9916 QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType(); 9917 // Dig out the original argument type and expression before implicit casts 9918 // were applied. These are the types/expressions we need to check the 9919 // [expr.spaceship] requirements against. 9920 ExprResult LHSStripped = LHS.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 9921 ExprResult RHSStripped = RHS.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 9922 QualType LHSStrippedType = LHSStripped.get()->getType(); 9923 QualType RHSStrippedType = RHSStripped.get()->getType(); 9924 9925 // C++2a [expr.spaceship]p3: If one of the operands is of type bool and the 9926 // other is not, the program is ill-formed. 9927 if (LHSStrippedType->isBooleanType() != RHSStrippedType->isBooleanType()) { 9928 S.InvalidOperands(Loc, LHSStripped, RHSStripped); 9929 return QualType(); 9930 } 9931 9932 int NumEnumArgs = (int)LHSStrippedType->isEnumeralType() + 9933 RHSStrippedType->isEnumeralType(); 9934 if (NumEnumArgs == 1) { 9935 bool LHSIsEnum = LHSStrippedType->isEnumeralType(); 9936 QualType OtherTy = LHSIsEnum ? RHSStrippedType : LHSStrippedType; 9937 if (OtherTy->hasFloatingRepresentation()) { 9938 S.InvalidOperands(Loc, LHSStripped, RHSStripped); 9939 return QualType(); 9940 } 9941 } 9942 if (NumEnumArgs == 2) { 9943 // C++2a [expr.spaceship]p5: If both operands have the same enumeration 9944 // type E, the operator yields the result of converting the operands 9945 // to the underlying type of E and applying <=> to the converted operands. 9946 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(LHSStrippedType, RHSStrippedType)) { 9947 S.InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 9948 return QualType(); 9949 } 9950 QualType IntType = 9951 LHSStrippedType->getAs<EnumType>()->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 9952 assert(IntType->isArithmeticType()); 9953 9954 // We can't use `CK_IntegralCast` when the underlying type is 'bool', so we 9955 // promote the boolean type, and all other promotable integer types, to 9956 // avoid this. 9957 if (IntType->isPromotableIntegerType()) 9958 IntType = S.Context.getPromotedIntegerType(IntType); 9959 9960 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), IntType, CK_IntegralCast); 9961 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), IntType, CK_IntegralCast); 9962 LHSType = RHSType = IntType; 9963 } 9964 9965 // C++2a [expr.spaceship]p4: If both operands have arithmetic types, the 9966 // usual arithmetic conversions are applied to the operands. 9967 QualType Type = S.UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS); 9968 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid()) 9969 return QualType(); 9970 if (Type.isNull()) 9971 return S.InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 9972 assert(Type->isArithmeticType() || Type->isEnumeralType()); 9973 9974 bool HasNarrowing = checkThreeWayNarrowingConversion( 9975 S, Type, LHS.get(), LHSType, LHS.get()->getLocStart()); 9976 HasNarrowing |= checkThreeWayNarrowingConversion( 9977 S, Type, RHS.get(), RHSType, RHS.get()->getLocStart()); 9978 if (HasNarrowing) 9979 return QualType(); 9980 9981 assert(!Type.isNull() && "composite type for <=> has not been set"); 9982 9983 auto TypeKind = [&]() { 9984 if (const ComplexType *CT = Type->getAs<ComplexType>()) { 9985 if (CT->getElementType()->hasFloatingRepresentation()) 9986 return CCT::WeakEquality; 9987 return CCT::StrongEquality; 9988 } 9989 if (Type->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) 9990 return CCT::StrongOrdering; 9991 if (Type->hasFloatingRepresentation()) 9992 return CCT::PartialOrdering; 9993 llvm_unreachable("other types are unimplemented"); 9994 }(); 9995 9996 return S.CheckComparisonCategoryType(TypeKind, Loc); 9997 } 9998 9999 static QualType checkArithmeticOrEnumeralCompare(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, 10000 ExprResult &RHS, 10001 SourceLocation Loc, 10002 BinaryOperatorKind Opc) { 10003 if (Opc == BO_Cmp) 10004 return checkArithmeticOrEnumeralThreeWayCompare(S, LHS, RHS, Loc); 10005 10006 // C99 6.5.8p3 / C99 6.5.9p4 10007 QualType Type = S.UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS); 10008 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid()) 10009 return QualType(); 10010 if (Type.isNull()) 10011 return S.InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 10012 assert(Type->isArithmeticType() || Type->isEnumeralType()); 10013 10014 checkEnumComparison(S, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get()); 10015 10016 if (Type->isAnyComplexType() && BinaryOperator::isRelationalOp(Opc)) 10017 return S.InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 10018 10019 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==. 10020 if (Type->hasFloatingRepresentation() && BinaryOperator::isEqualityOp(Opc)) 10021 S.CheckFloatComparison(Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get()); 10022 10023 // The result of comparisons is 'bool' in C++, 'int' in C. 10024 return S.Context.getLogicalOperationType(); 10025 } 10026 10027 // C99 6.5.8, C++ [expr.rel] 10028 QualType Sema::CheckCompareOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 10029 SourceLocation Loc, 10030 BinaryOperatorKind Opc) { 10031 bool IsRelational = BinaryOperator::isRelationalOp(Opc); 10032 bool IsThreeWay = Opc == BO_Cmp; 10033 auto IsAnyPointerType = [](ExprResult E) { 10034 QualType Ty = E.get()->getType(); 10035 return Ty->isPointerType() || Ty->isMemberPointerType(); 10036 }; 10037 10038 // C++2a [expr.spaceship]p6: If at least one of the operands is of pointer 10039 // type, array-to-pointer, ..., conversions are performed on both operands to 10040 // bring them to their composite type. 10041 // Otherwise, all comparisons expect an rvalue, so convert to rvalue before 10042 // any type-related checks. 10043 if (!IsThreeWay || IsAnyPointerType(LHS) || IsAnyPointerType(RHS)) { 10044 LHS = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHS.get()); 10045 if (LHS.isInvalid()) 10046 return QualType(); 10047 RHS = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS.get()); 10048 if (RHS.isInvalid()) 10049 return QualType(); 10050 } else { 10051 LHS = DefaultLvalueConversion(LHS.get()); 10052 if (LHS.isInvalid()) 10053 return QualType(); 10054 RHS = DefaultLvalueConversion(RHS.get()); 10055 if (RHS.isInvalid()) 10056 return QualType(); 10057 } 10058 10059 checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompare=*/true); 10060 10061 // Handle vector comparisons separately. 10062 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() || 10063 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) 10064 return CheckVectorCompareOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, Opc); 10065 10066 diagnoseLogicalNotOnLHSofCheck(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, Opc); 10067 diagnoseTautologicalComparison(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get(), Opc); 10068 10069 QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType(); 10070 QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType(); 10071 if ((LHSType->isArithmeticType() || LHSType->isEnumeralType()) && 10072 (RHSType->isArithmeticType() || RHSType->isEnumeralType())) 10073 return checkArithmeticOrEnumeralCompare(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, Opc); 10074 10075 const Expr::NullPointerConstantKind LHSNullKind = 10076 LHS.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull); 10077 const Expr::NullPointerConstantKind RHSNullKind = 10078 RHS.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull); 10079 bool LHSIsNull = LHSNullKind != Expr::NPCK_NotNull; 10080 bool RHSIsNull = RHSNullKind != Expr::NPCK_NotNull; 10081 10082 auto computeResultTy = [&]() { 10083 if (Opc != BO_Cmp) 10084 return Context.getLogicalOperationType(); 10085 assert(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus); 10086 assert(Context.hasSameType(LHS.get()->getType(), RHS.get()->getType())); 10087 10088 QualType CompositeTy = LHS.get()->getType(); 10089 assert(!CompositeTy->isReferenceType()); 10090 10091 auto buildResultTy = [&](ComparisonCategoryType Kind) { 10092 return CheckComparisonCategoryType(Kind, Loc); 10093 }; 10094 10095 // C++2a [expr.spaceship]p7: If the composite pointer type is a function 10096 // pointer type, a pointer-to-member type, or std::nullptr_t, the 10097 // result is of type std::strong_equality 10098 if (CompositeTy->isFunctionPointerType() || 10099 CompositeTy->isMemberPointerType() || CompositeTy->isNullPtrType()) 10100 // FIXME: consider making the function pointer case produce 10101 // strong_ordering not strong_equality, per P0946R0-Jax18 discussion 10102 // and direction polls 10103 return buildResultTy(ComparisonCategoryType::StrongEquality); 10104 10105 // C++2a [expr.spaceship]p8: If the composite pointer type is an object 10106 // pointer type, p <=> q is of type std::strong_ordering. 10107 if (CompositeTy->isPointerType()) { 10108 // P0946R0: Comparisons between a null pointer constant and an object 10109 // pointer result in std::strong_equality 10110 if (LHSIsNull != RHSIsNull) 10111 return buildResultTy(ComparisonCategoryType::StrongEquality); 10112 return buildResultTy(ComparisonCategoryType::StrongOrdering); 10113 } 10114 // C++2a [expr.spaceship]p9: Otherwise, the program is ill-formed. 10115 // TODO: Extend support for operator<=> to ObjC types. 10116 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 10117 }; 10118 10119 10120 if (!IsRelational && LHSIsNull != RHSIsNull) { 10121 bool IsEquality = Opc == BO_EQ; 10122 if (RHSIsNull) 10123 DiagnoseAlwaysNonNullPointer(LHS.get(), RHSNullKind, IsEquality, 10124 RHS.get()->getSourceRange()); 10125 else 10126 DiagnoseAlwaysNonNullPointer(RHS.get(), LHSNullKind, IsEquality, 10127 LHS.get()->getSourceRange()); 10128 } 10129 10130 if ((LHSType->isIntegerType() && !LHSIsNull) || 10131 (RHSType->isIntegerType() && !RHSIsNull)) { 10132 // Skip normal pointer conversion checks in this case; we have better 10133 // diagnostics for this below. 10134 } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 10135 // Equality comparison of a function pointer to a void pointer is invalid, 10136 // but we allow it as an extension. 10137 // FIXME: If we really want to allow this, should it be part of composite 10138 // pointer type computation so it works in conditionals too? 10139 if (!IsRelational && 10140 ((LHSType->isFunctionPointerType() && RHSType->isVoidPointerType()) || 10141 (RHSType->isFunctionPointerType() && LHSType->isVoidPointerType()))) { 10142 // This is a gcc extension compatibility comparison. 10143 // In a SFINAE context, we treat this as a hard error to maintain 10144 // conformance with the C++ standard. 10145 diagnoseFunctionPointerToVoidComparison( 10146 *this, Loc, LHS, RHS, /*isError*/ (bool)isSFINAEContext()); 10147 10148 if (isSFINAEContext()) 10149 return QualType(); 10150 10151 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_BitCast); 10152 return computeResultTy(); 10153 } 10154 10155 // C++ [expr.eq]p2: 10156 // If at least one operand is a pointer [...] bring them to their 10157 // composite pointer type. 10158 // C++ [expr.spaceship]p6 10159 // If at least one of the operands is of pointer type, [...] bring them 10160 // to their composite pointer type. 10161 // C++ [expr.rel]p2: 10162 // If both operands are pointers, [...] bring them to their composite 10163 // pointer type. 10164 if ((int)LHSType->isPointerType() + (int)RHSType->isPointerType() >= 10165 (IsRelational ? 2 : 1) && 10166 (!LangOpts.ObjCAutoRefCount || !(LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || 10167 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()))) { 10168 if (convertPointersToCompositeType(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS)) 10169 return QualType(); 10170 return computeResultTy(); 10171 } 10172 } else if (LHSType->isPointerType() && 10173 RHSType->isPointerType()) { // C99 6.5.8p2 10174 // All of the following pointer-related warnings are GCC extensions, except 10175 // when handling null pointer constants. 10176 QualType LCanPointeeTy = 10177 LHSType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getCanonicalType(); 10178 QualType RCanPointeeTy = 10179 RHSType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getCanonicalType(); 10180 10181 // C99 6.5.9p2 and C99 6.5.8p2 10182 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType(), 10183 RCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType())) { 10184 // Valid unless a relational comparison of function pointers 10185 if (IsRelational && LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) { 10186 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_function_pointers) 10187 << LHSType << RHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() 10188 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 10189 } 10190 } else if (!IsRelational && 10191 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) { 10192 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer 10193 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) 10194 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) 10195 diagnoseFunctionPointerToVoidComparison(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS, 10196 /*isError*/false); 10197 } else { 10198 // Invalid 10199 diagnoseDistinctPointerComparison(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS, /*isError*/false); 10200 } 10201 if (LCanPointeeTy != RCanPointeeTy) { 10202 // Treat NULL constant as a special case in OpenCL. 10203 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) { 10204 const PointerType *LHSPtr = LHSType->getAs<PointerType>(); 10205 if (!LHSPtr->isAddressSpaceOverlapping(*RHSType->getAs<PointerType>())) { 10206 Diag(Loc, 10207 diag::err_typecheck_op_on_nonoverlapping_address_space_pointers) 10208 << LHSType << RHSType << 0 /* comparison */ 10209 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 10210 } 10211 } 10212 LangAS AddrSpaceL = LCanPointeeTy.getAddressSpace(); 10213 LangAS AddrSpaceR = RCanPointeeTy.getAddressSpace(); 10214 CastKind Kind = AddrSpaceL != AddrSpaceR ? CK_AddressSpaceConversion 10215 : CK_BitCast; 10216 if (LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) 10217 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, Kind); 10218 else 10219 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, Kind); 10220 } 10221 return computeResultTy(); 10222 } 10223 10224 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 10225 // C++ [expr.eq]p4: 10226 // Two operands of type std::nullptr_t or one operand of type 10227 // std::nullptr_t and the other a null pointer constant compare equal. 10228 if (!IsRelational && LHSIsNull && RHSIsNull) { 10229 if (LHSType->isNullPtrType()) { 10230 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_NullToPointer); 10231 return computeResultTy(); 10232 } 10233 if (RHSType->isNullPtrType()) { 10234 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_NullToPointer); 10235 return computeResultTy(); 10236 } 10237 } 10238 10239 // Comparison of Objective-C pointers and block pointers against nullptr_t. 10240 // These aren't covered by the composite pointer type rules. 10241 if (!IsRelational && RHSType->isNullPtrType() && 10242 (LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || LHSType->isBlockPointerType())) { 10243 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_NullToPointer); 10244 return computeResultTy(); 10245 } 10246 if (!IsRelational && LHSType->isNullPtrType() && 10247 (RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || RHSType->isBlockPointerType())) { 10248 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_NullToPointer); 10249 return computeResultTy(); 10250 } 10251 10252 if (IsRelational && 10253 ((LHSType->isNullPtrType() && RHSType->isPointerType()) || 10254 (RHSType->isNullPtrType() && LHSType->isPointerType()))) { 10255 // HACK: Relational comparison of nullptr_t against a pointer type is 10256 // invalid per DR583, but we allow it within std::less<> and friends, 10257 // since otherwise common uses of it break. 10258 // FIXME: Consider removing this hack once LWG fixes std::less<> and 10259 // friends to have std::nullptr_t overload candidates. 10260 DeclContext *DC = CurContext; 10261 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(DC)) 10262 DC = DC->getParent(); 10263 if (auto *CTSD = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(DC)) { 10264 if (CTSD->isInStdNamespace() && 10265 llvm::StringSwitch<bool>(CTSD->getName()) 10266 .Cases("less", "less_equal", "greater", "greater_equal", true) 10267 .Default(false)) { 10268 if (RHSType->isNullPtrType()) 10269 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_NullToPointer); 10270 else 10271 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_NullToPointer); 10272 return computeResultTy(); 10273 } 10274 } 10275 } 10276 10277 // C++ [expr.eq]p2: 10278 // If at least one operand is a pointer to member, [...] bring them to 10279 // their composite pointer type. 10280 if (!IsRelational && 10281 (LHSType->isMemberPointerType() || RHSType->isMemberPointerType())) { 10282 if (convertPointersToCompositeType(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS)) 10283 return QualType(); 10284 else 10285 return computeResultTy(); 10286 } 10287 } 10288 10289 // Handle block pointer types. 10290 if (!IsRelational && LHSType->isBlockPointerType() && 10291 RHSType->isBlockPointerType()) { 10292 QualType lpointee = LHSType->castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 10293 QualType rpointee = RHSType->castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 10294 10295 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull && 10296 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lpointee, rpointee)) { 10297 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks) 10298 << LHSType << RHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() 10299 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 10300 } 10301 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_BitCast); 10302 return computeResultTy(); 10303 } 10304 10305 // Allow block pointers to be compared with null pointer constants. 10306 if (!IsRelational 10307 && ((LHSType->isBlockPointerType() && RHSType->isPointerType()) 10308 || (LHSType->isPointerType() && RHSType->isBlockPointerType()))) { 10309 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) { 10310 if (!((RHSType->isPointerType() && RHSType->castAs<PointerType>() 10311 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) 10312 || (LHSType->isPointerType() && LHSType->castAs<PointerType>() 10313 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()))) 10314 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks) 10315 << LHSType << RHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() 10316 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 10317 } 10318 if (LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) 10319 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, 10320 RHSType->isPointerType() ? CK_BitCast 10321 : CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast); 10322 else 10323 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, 10324 LHSType->isPointerType() ? CK_BitCast 10325 : CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast); 10326 return computeResultTy(); 10327 } 10328 10329 if (LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || 10330 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 10331 const PointerType *LPT = LHSType->getAs<PointerType>(); 10332 const PointerType *RPT = RHSType->getAs<PointerType>(); 10333 if (LPT || RPT) { 10334 bool LPtrToVoid = LPT ? LPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType() : false; 10335 bool RPtrToVoid = RPT ? RPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType() : false; 10336 10337 if (!LPtrToVoid && !RPtrToVoid && 10338 !Context.typesAreCompatible(LHSType, RHSType)) { 10339 diagnoseDistinctPointerComparison(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS, 10340 /*isError*/false); 10341 } 10342 if (LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) { 10343 Expr *E = LHS.get(); 10344 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) 10345 CheckObjCConversion(SourceRange(), RHSType, E, 10346 CCK_ImplicitConversion); 10347 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(E, RHSType, 10348 RPT ? CK_BitCast :CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast); 10349 } 10350 else { 10351 Expr *E = RHS.get(); 10352 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) 10353 CheckObjCConversion(SourceRange(), LHSType, E, CCK_ImplicitConversion, 10354 /*Diagnose=*/true, 10355 /*DiagnoseCFAudited=*/false, Opc); 10356 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(E, LHSType, 10357 LPT ? CK_BitCast :CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast); 10358 } 10359 return computeResultTy(); 10360 } 10361 if (LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && 10362 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 10363 if (!Context.areComparableObjCPointerTypes(LHSType, RHSType)) 10364 diagnoseDistinctPointerComparison(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS, 10365 /*isError*/false); 10366 if (isObjCObjectLiteral(LHS) || isObjCObjectLiteral(RHS)) 10367 diagnoseObjCLiteralComparison(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS, Opc); 10368 10369 if (LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) 10370 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_BitCast); 10371 else 10372 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_BitCast); 10373 return computeResultTy(); 10374 } 10375 10376 if (!IsRelational && LHSType->isBlockPointerType() && 10377 RHSType->isBlockCompatibleObjCPointerType(Context)) { 10378 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, 10379 CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast); 10380 return computeResultTy(); 10381 } else if (!IsRelational && 10382 LHSType->isBlockCompatibleObjCPointerType(Context) && 10383 RHSType->isBlockPointerType()) { 10384 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, 10385 CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast); 10386 return computeResultTy(); 10387 } 10388 } 10389 if ((LHSType->isAnyPointerType() && RHSType->isIntegerType()) || 10390 (LHSType->isIntegerType() && RHSType->isAnyPointerType())) { 10391 unsigned DiagID = 0; 10392 bool isError = false; 10393 if (LangOpts.DebuggerSupport) { 10394 // Under a debugger, allow the comparison of pointers to integers, 10395 // since users tend to want to compare addresses. 10396 } else if ((LHSIsNull && LHSType->isIntegerType()) || 10397 (RHSIsNull && RHSType->isIntegerType())) { 10398 if (IsRelational) { 10399 isError = getLangOpts().CPlusPlus; 10400 DiagID = 10401 isError ? diag::err_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero 10402 : diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero; 10403 } 10404 } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 10405 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer; 10406 isError = true; 10407 } else if (IsRelational) 10408 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer; 10409 else 10410 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer; 10411 10412 if (DiagID) { 10413 Diag(Loc, DiagID) 10414 << LHSType << RHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() 10415 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 10416 if (isError) 10417 return QualType(); 10418 } 10419 10420 if (LHSType->isIntegerType()) 10421 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, 10422 LHSIsNull ? CK_NullToPointer : CK_IntegralToPointer); 10423 else 10424 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, 10425 RHSIsNull ? CK_NullToPointer : CK_IntegralToPointer); 10426 return computeResultTy(); 10427 } 10428 10429 // Handle block pointers. 10430 if (!IsRelational && RHSIsNull 10431 && LHSType->isBlockPointerType() && RHSType->isIntegerType()) { 10432 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_NullToPointer); 10433 return computeResultTy(); 10434 } 10435 if (!IsRelational && LHSIsNull 10436 && LHSType->isIntegerType() && RHSType->isBlockPointerType()) { 10437 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_NullToPointer); 10438 return computeResultTy(); 10439 } 10440 10441 if (getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion >= 200) { 10442 if (LHSIsNull && RHSType->isQueueT()) { 10443 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_NullToPointer); 10444 return computeResultTy(); 10445 } 10446 10447 if (LHSType->isQueueT() && RHSIsNull) { 10448 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_NullToPointer); 10449 return computeResultTy(); 10450 } 10451 } 10452 10453 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 10454 } 10455 10456 // Return a signed ext_vector_type that is of identical size and number of 10457 // elements. For floating point vectors, return an integer type of identical 10458 // size and number of elements. In the non ext_vector_type case, search from 10459 // the largest type to the smallest type to avoid cases where long long == long, 10460 // where long gets picked over long long. 10461 QualType Sema::GetSignedVectorType(QualType V) { 10462 const VectorType *VTy = V->getAs<VectorType>(); 10463 unsigned TypeSize = Context.getTypeSize(VTy->getElementType()); 10464 10465 if (isa<ExtVectorType>(VTy)) { 10466 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.CharTy)) 10467 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.CharTy, VTy->getNumElements()); 10468 else if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.ShortTy)) 10469 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.ShortTy, VTy->getNumElements()); 10470 else if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy)) 10471 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements()); 10472 else if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy)) 10473 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements()); 10474 assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy) && 10475 "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare"); 10476 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements()); 10477 } 10478 10479 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy)) 10480 return Context.getVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements(), 10481 VectorType::GenericVector); 10482 else if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy)) 10483 return Context.getVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements(), 10484 VectorType::GenericVector); 10485 else if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy)) 10486 return Context.getVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements(), 10487 VectorType::GenericVector); 10488 else if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.ShortTy)) 10489 return Context.getVectorType(Context.ShortTy, VTy->getNumElements(), 10490 VectorType::GenericVector); 10491 assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.CharTy) && 10492 "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare"); 10493 return Context.getVectorType(Context.CharTy, VTy->getNumElements(), 10494 VectorType::GenericVector); 10495 } 10496 10497 /// CheckVectorCompareOperands - vector comparisons are a clang extension that 10498 /// operates on extended vector types. Instead of producing an IntTy result, 10499 /// like a scalar comparison, a vector comparison produces a vector of integer 10500 /// types. 10501 QualType Sema::CheckVectorCompareOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 10502 SourceLocation Loc, 10503 BinaryOperatorKind Opc) { 10504 // Check to make sure we're operating on vectors of the same type and width, 10505 // Allowing one side to be a scalar of element type. 10506 QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompAssign*/false, 10507 /*AllowBothBool*/true, 10508 /*AllowBoolConversions*/getLangOpts().ZVector); 10509 if (vType.isNull()) 10510 return vType; 10511 10512 QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType(); 10513 10514 // If AltiVec, the comparison results in a numeric type, i.e. 10515 // bool for C++, int for C 10516 if (getLangOpts().AltiVec && 10517 vType->getAs<VectorType>()->getVectorKind() == VectorType::AltiVecVector) 10518 return Context.getLogicalOperationType(); 10519 10520 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form 10521 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and 10522 // often indicate logic errors in the program. 10523 diagnoseTautologicalComparison(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get(), Opc); 10524 10525 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==. 10526 if (BinaryOperator::isEqualityOp(Opc) && 10527 LHSType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) { 10528 assert(RHS.get()->getType()->hasFloatingRepresentation()); 10529 CheckFloatComparison(Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get()); 10530 } 10531 10532 // Return a signed type for the vector. 10533 return GetSignedVectorType(vType); 10534 } 10535 10536 QualType Sema::CheckVectorLogicalOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 10537 SourceLocation Loc) { 10538 // Ensure that either both operands are of the same vector type, or 10539 // one operand is of a vector type and the other is of its element type. 10540 QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, false, 10541 /*AllowBothBool*/true, 10542 /*AllowBoolConversions*/false); 10543 if (vType.isNull()) 10544 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 10545 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion < 120 && 10546 vType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) 10547 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 10548 // FIXME: The check for C++ here is for GCC compatibility. GCC rejects the 10549 // usage of the logical operators && and || with vectors in C. This 10550 // check could be notionally dropped. 10551 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 10552 !(isa<ExtVectorType>(vType->getAs<VectorType>()))) 10553 return InvalidLogicalVectorOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 10554 10555 return GetSignedVectorType(LHS.get()->getType()); 10556 } 10557 10558 inline QualType Sema::CheckBitwiseOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 10559 SourceLocation Loc, 10560 BinaryOperatorKind Opc) { 10561 checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompare=*/false); 10562 10563 bool IsCompAssign = 10564 Opc == BO_AndAssign || Opc == BO_OrAssign || Opc == BO_XorAssign; 10565 10566 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() || 10567 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) { 10568 if (LHS.get()->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() && 10569 RHS.get()->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation()) 10570 return CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, IsCompAssign, 10571 /*AllowBothBool*/true, 10572 /*AllowBoolConversions*/getLangOpts().ZVector); 10573 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 10574 } 10575 10576 if (Opc == BO_And) 10577 diagnoseLogicalNotOnLHSofCheck(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, Opc); 10578 10579 ExprResult LHSResult = LHS, RHSResult = RHS; 10580 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(LHSResult, RHSResult, 10581 IsCompAssign); 10582 if (LHSResult.isInvalid() || RHSResult.isInvalid()) 10583 return QualType(); 10584 LHS = LHSResult.get(); 10585 RHS = RHSResult.get(); 10586 10587 if (!compType.isNull() && compType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()) 10588 return compType; 10589 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 10590 } 10591 10592 // C99 6.5.[13,14] 10593 inline QualType Sema::CheckLogicalOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 10594 SourceLocation Loc, 10595 BinaryOperatorKind Opc) { 10596 // Check vector operands differently. 10597 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() || RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) 10598 return CheckVectorLogicalOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc); 10599 10600 // Diagnose cases where the user write a logical and/or but probably meant a 10601 // bitwise one. We do this when the LHS is a non-bool integer and the RHS 10602 // is a constant. 10603 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isIntegerType() && 10604 !LHS.get()->getType()->isBooleanType() && 10605 RHS.get()->getType()->isIntegerType() && !RHS.get()->isValueDependent() && 10606 // Don't warn in macros or template instantiations. 10607 !Loc.isMacroID() && !inTemplateInstantiation()) { 10608 // If the RHS can be constant folded, and if it constant folds to something 10609 // that isn't 0 or 1 (which indicate a potential logical operation that 10610 // happened to fold to true/false) then warn. 10611 // Parens on the RHS are ignored. 10612 llvm::APSInt Result; 10613 if (RHS.get()->EvaluateAsInt(Result, Context)) 10614 if ((getLangOpts().Bool && !RHS.get()->getType()->isBooleanType() && 10615 !RHS.get()->getExprLoc().isMacroID()) || 10616 (Result != 0 && Result != 1)) { 10617 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_logical_instead_of_bitwise) 10618 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange() 10619 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&&" : "||"); 10620 // Suggest replacing the logical operator with the bitwise version 10621 Diag(Loc, diag::note_logical_instead_of_bitwise_change_operator) 10622 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&" : "|") 10623 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange( 10624 Loc, getLocForEndOfToken(Loc)), 10625 Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&" : "|"); 10626 if (Opc == BO_LAnd) 10627 // Suggest replacing "Foo() && kNonZero" with "Foo()" 10628 Diag(Loc, diag::note_logical_instead_of_bitwise_remove_constant) 10629 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval( 10630 SourceRange(getLocForEndOfToken(LHS.get()->getLocEnd()), 10631 RHS.get()->getLocEnd())); 10632 } 10633 } 10634 10635 if (!Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 10636 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.g: The logical operators and (&&), or (||) do 10637 // not operate on the built-in scalar and vector float types. 10638 if (Context.getLangOpts().OpenCL && 10639 Context.getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion < 120) { 10640 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isFloatingType() || 10641 RHS.get()->getType()->isFloatingType()) 10642 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 10643 } 10644 10645 LHS = UsualUnaryConversions(LHS.get()); 10646 if (LHS.isInvalid()) 10647 return QualType(); 10648 10649 RHS = UsualUnaryConversions(RHS.get()); 10650 if (RHS.isInvalid()) 10651 return QualType(); 10652 10653 if (!LHS.get()->getType()->isScalarType() || 10654 !RHS.get()->getType()->isScalarType()) 10655 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 10656 10657 return Context.IntTy; 10658 } 10659 10660 // The following is safe because we only use this method for 10661 // non-overloadable operands. 10662 10663 // C++ [expr.log.and]p1 10664 // C++ [expr.log.or]p1 10665 // The operands are both contextually converted to type bool. 10666 ExprResult LHSRes = PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(LHS.get()); 10667 if (LHSRes.isInvalid()) 10668 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 10669 LHS = LHSRes; 10670 10671 ExprResult RHSRes = PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(RHS.get()); 10672 if (RHSRes.isInvalid()) 10673 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 10674 RHS = RHSRes; 10675 10676 // C++ [expr.log.and]p2 10677 // C++ [expr.log.or]p2 10678 // The result is a bool. 10679 return Context.BoolTy; 10680 } 10681 10682 static bool IsReadonlyMessage(Expr *E, Sema &S) { 10683 const MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E); 10684 if (!ME) return false; 10685 if (!isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl())) return false; 10686 ObjCMessageExpr *Base = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>( 10687 ME->getBase()->IgnoreImplicit()->IgnoreParenImpCasts()); 10688 if (!Base) return false; 10689 return Base->getMethodDecl() != nullptr; 10690 } 10691 10692 /// Is the given expression (which must be 'const') a reference to a 10693 /// variable which was originally non-const, but which has become 10694 /// 'const' due to being captured within a block? 10695 enum NonConstCaptureKind { NCCK_None, NCCK_Block, NCCK_Lambda }; 10696 static NonConstCaptureKind isReferenceToNonConstCapture(Sema &S, Expr *E) { 10697 assert(E->isLValue() && E->getType().isConstQualified()); 10698 E = E->IgnoreParens(); 10699 10700 // Must be a reference to a declaration from an enclosing scope. 10701 DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E); 10702 if (!DRE) return NCCK_None; 10703 if (!DRE->refersToEnclosingVariableOrCapture()) return NCCK_None; 10704 10705 // The declaration must be a variable which is not declared 'const'. 10706 VarDecl *var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(DRE->getDecl()); 10707 if (!var) return NCCK_None; 10708 if (var->getType().isConstQualified()) return NCCK_None; 10709 assert(var->hasLocalStorage() && "capture added 'const' to non-local?"); 10710 10711 // Decide whether the first capture was for a block or a lambda. 10712 DeclContext *DC = S.CurContext, *Prev = nullptr; 10713 // Decide whether the first capture was for a block or a lambda. 10714 while (DC) { 10715 // For init-capture, it is possible that the variable belongs to the 10716 // template pattern of the current context. 10717 if (auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DC)) 10718 if (var->isInitCapture() && 10719 FD->getTemplateInstantiationPattern() == var->getDeclContext()) 10720 break; 10721 if (DC == var->getDeclContext()) 10722 break; 10723 Prev = DC; 10724 DC = DC->getParent(); 10725 } 10726 // Unless we have an init-capture, we've gone one step too far. 10727 if (!var->isInitCapture()) 10728 DC = Prev; 10729 return (isa<BlockDecl>(DC) ? NCCK_Block : NCCK_Lambda); 10730 } 10731 10732 static bool IsTypeModifiable(QualType Ty, bool IsDereference) { 10733 Ty = Ty.getNonReferenceType(); 10734 if (IsDereference && Ty->isPointerType()) 10735 Ty = Ty->getPointeeType(); 10736 return !Ty.isConstQualified(); 10737 } 10738 10739 // Update err_typecheck_assign_const and note_typecheck_assign_const 10740 // when this enum is changed. 10741 enum { 10742 ConstFunction, 10743 ConstVariable, 10744 ConstMember, 10745 ConstMethod, 10746 NestedConstMember, 10747 ConstUnknown, // Keep as last element 10748 }; 10749 10750 /// Emit the "read-only variable not assignable" error and print notes to give 10751 /// more information about why the variable is not assignable, such as pointing 10752 /// to the declaration of a const variable, showing that a method is const, or 10753 /// that the function is returning a const reference. 10754 static void DiagnoseConstAssignment(Sema &S, const Expr *E, 10755 SourceLocation Loc) { 10756 SourceRange ExprRange = E->getSourceRange(); 10757 10758 // Only emit one error on the first const found. All other consts will emit 10759 // a note to the error. 10760 bool DiagnosticEmitted = false; 10761 10762 // Track if the current expression is the result of a dereference, and if the 10763 // next checked expression is the result of a dereference. 10764 bool IsDereference = false; 10765 bool NextIsDereference = false; 10766 10767 // Loop to process MemberExpr chains. 10768 while (true) { 10769 IsDereference = NextIsDereference; 10770 10771 E = E->IgnoreImplicit()->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 10772 if (const MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E)) { 10773 NextIsDereference = ME->isArrow(); 10774 const ValueDecl *VD = ME->getMemberDecl(); 10775 if (const FieldDecl *Field = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(VD)) { 10776 // Mutable fields can be modified even if the class is const. 10777 if (Field->isMutable()) { 10778 assert(DiagnosticEmitted && "Expected diagnostic not emitted."); 10779 break; 10780 } 10781 10782 if (!IsTypeModifiable(Field->getType(), IsDereference)) { 10783 if (!DiagnosticEmitted) { 10784 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_assign_const) 10785 << ExprRange << ConstMember << false /*static*/ << Field 10786 << Field->getType(); 10787 DiagnosticEmitted = true; 10788 } 10789 S.Diag(VD->getLocation(), diag::note_typecheck_assign_const) 10790 << ConstMember << false /*static*/ << Field << Field->getType() 10791 << Field->getSourceRange(); 10792 } 10793 E = ME->getBase(); 10794 continue; 10795 } else if (const VarDecl *VDecl = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(VD)) { 10796 if (VDecl->getType().isConstQualified()) { 10797 if (!DiagnosticEmitted) { 10798 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_assign_const) 10799 << ExprRange << ConstMember << true /*static*/ << VDecl 10800 << VDecl->getType(); 10801 DiagnosticEmitted = true; 10802 } 10803 S.Diag(VD->getLocation(), diag::note_typecheck_assign_const) 10804 << ConstMember << true /*static*/ << VDecl << VDecl->getType() 10805 << VDecl->getSourceRange(); 10806 } 10807 // Static fields do not inherit constness from parents. 10808 break; 10809 } 10810 break; // End MemberExpr 10811 } else if (const ArraySubscriptExpr *ASE = 10812 dyn_cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)) { 10813 E = ASE->getBase()->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 10814 continue; 10815 } else if (const ExtVectorElementExpr *EVE = 10816 dyn_cast<ExtVectorElementExpr>(E)) { 10817 E = EVE->getBase()->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 10818 continue; 10819 } 10820 break; 10821 } 10822 10823 if (const CallExpr *CE = dyn_cast<CallExpr>(E)) { 10824 // Function calls 10825 const FunctionDecl *FD = CE->getDirectCallee(); 10826 if (FD && !IsTypeModifiable(FD->getReturnType(), IsDereference)) { 10827 if (!DiagnosticEmitted) { 10828 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_assign_const) << ExprRange 10829 << ConstFunction << FD; 10830 DiagnosticEmitted = true; 10831 } 10832 S.Diag(FD->getReturnTypeSourceRange().getBegin(), 10833 diag::note_typecheck_assign_const) 10834 << ConstFunction << FD << FD->getReturnType() 10835 << FD->getReturnTypeSourceRange(); 10836 } 10837 } else if (const DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) { 10838 // Point to variable declaration. 10839 if (const ValueDecl *VD = DRE->getDecl()) { 10840 if (!IsTypeModifiable(VD->getType(), IsDereference)) { 10841 if (!DiagnosticEmitted) { 10842 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_assign_const) 10843 << ExprRange << ConstVariable << VD << VD->getType(); 10844 DiagnosticEmitted = true; 10845 } 10846 S.Diag(VD->getLocation(), diag::note_typecheck_assign_const) 10847 << ConstVariable << VD << VD->getType() << VD->getSourceRange(); 10848 } 10849 } 10850 } else if (isa<CXXThisExpr>(E)) { 10851 if (const DeclContext *DC = S.getFunctionLevelDeclContext()) { 10852 if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)) { 10853 if (MD->isConst()) { 10854 if (!DiagnosticEmitted) { 10855 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_assign_const) << ExprRange 10856 << ConstMethod << MD; 10857 DiagnosticEmitted = true; 10858 } 10859 S.Diag(MD->getLocation(), diag::note_typecheck_assign_const) 10860 << ConstMethod << MD << MD->getSourceRange(); 10861 } 10862 } 10863 } 10864 } 10865 10866 if (DiagnosticEmitted) 10867 return; 10868 10869 // Can't determine a more specific message, so display the generic error. 10870 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_assign_const) << ExprRange << ConstUnknown; 10871 } 10872 10873 enum OriginalExprKind { 10874 OEK_Variable, 10875 OEK_Member, 10876 OEK_LValue 10877 }; 10878 10879 static void DiagnoseRecursiveConstFields(Sema &S, const ValueDecl *VD, 10880 const RecordType *Ty, 10881 SourceLocation Loc, SourceRange Range, 10882 OriginalExprKind OEK, 10883 bool &DiagnosticEmitted, 10884 bool IsNested = false) { 10885 // We walk the record hierarchy breadth-first to ensure that we print 10886 // diagnostics in field nesting order. 10887 // First, check every field for constness. 10888 for (const FieldDecl *Field : Ty->getDecl()->fields()) { 10889 if (Field->getType().isConstQualified()) { 10890 if (!DiagnosticEmitted) { 10891 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_assign_const) 10892 << Range << NestedConstMember << OEK << VD 10893 << IsNested << Field; 10894 DiagnosticEmitted = true; 10895 } 10896 S.Diag(Field->getLocation(), diag::note_typecheck_assign_const) 10897 << NestedConstMember << IsNested << Field 10898 << Field->getType() << Field->getSourceRange(); 10899 } 10900 } 10901 // Then, recurse. 10902 for (const FieldDecl *Field : Ty->getDecl()->fields()) { 10903 QualType FTy = Field->getType(); 10904 if (const RecordType *FieldRecTy = FTy->getAs<RecordType>()) 10905 DiagnoseRecursiveConstFields(S, VD, FieldRecTy, Loc, Range, 10906 OEK, DiagnosticEmitted, true); 10907 } 10908 } 10909 10910 /// Emit an error for the case where a record we are trying to assign to has a 10911 /// const-qualified field somewhere in its hierarchy. 10912 static void DiagnoseRecursiveConstFields(Sema &S, const Expr *E, 10913 SourceLocation Loc) { 10914 QualType Ty = E->getType(); 10915 assert(Ty->isRecordType() && "lvalue was not record?"); 10916 SourceRange Range = E->getSourceRange(); 10917 const RecordType *RTy = Ty.getCanonicalType()->getAs<RecordType>(); 10918 bool DiagEmitted = false; 10919 10920 if (const MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E)) 10921 DiagnoseRecursiveConstFields(S, ME->getMemberDecl(), RTy, Loc, 10922 Range, OEK_Member, DiagEmitted); 10923 else if (const DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) 10924 DiagnoseRecursiveConstFields(S, DRE->getDecl(), RTy, Loc, 10925 Range, OEK_Variable, DiagEmitted); 10926 else 10927 DiagnoseRecursiveConstFields(S, nullptr, RTy, Loc, 10928 Range, OEK_LValue, DiagEmitted); 10929 if (!DiagEmitted) 10930 DiagnoseConstAssignment(S, E, Loc); 10931 } 10932 10933 /// CheckForModifiableLvalue - Verify that E is a modifiable lvalue. If not, 10934 /// emit an error and return true. If so, return false. 10935 static bool CheckForModifiableLvalue(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc, Sema &S) { 10936 assert(!E->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::PseudoObject)); 10937 10938 S.CheckShadowingDeclModification(E, Loc); 10939 10940 SourceLocation OrigLoc = Loc; 10941 Expr::isModifiableLvalueResult IsLV = E->isModifiableLvalue(S.Context, 10942 &Loc); 10943 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary && IsReadonlyMessage(E, S)) 10944 IsLV = Expr::MLV_InvalidMessageExpression; 10945 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid) 10946 return false; 10947 10948 unsigned DiagID = 0; 10949 bool NeedType = false; 10950 switch (IsLV) { // C99 6.5.16p2 10951 case Expr::MLV_ConstQualified: 10952 // Use a specialized diagnostic when we're assigning to an object 10953 // from an enclosing function or block. 10954 if (NonConstCaptureKind NCCK = isReferenceToNonConstCapture(S, E)) { 10955 if (NCCK == NCCK_Block) 10956 DiagID = diag::err_block_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue; 10957 else 10958 DiagID = diag::err_lambda_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue; 10959 break; 10960 } 10961 10962 // In ARC, use some specialized diagnostics for occasions where we 10963 // infer 'const'. These are always pseudo-strong variables. 10964 if (S.getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) { 10965 DeclRefExpr *declRef = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParenCasts()); 10966 if (declRef && isa<VarDecl>(declRef->getDecl())) { 10967 VarDecl *var = cast<VarDecl>(declRef->getDecl()); 10968 10969 // Use the normal diagnostic if it's pseudo-__strong but the 10970 // user actually wrote 'const'. 10971 if (var->isARCPseudoStrong() && 10972 (!var->getTypeSourceInfo() || 10973 !var->getTypeSourceInfo()->getType().isConstQualified())) { 10974 // There are two pseudo-strong cases: 10975 // - self 10976 ObjCMethodDecl *method = S.getCurMethodDecl(); 10977 if (method && var == method->getSelfDecl()) 10978 DiagID = method->isClassMethod() 10979 ? diag::err_typecheck_arc_assign_self_class_method 10980 : diag::err_typecheck_arc_assign_self; 10981 10982 // - fast enumeration variables 10983 else 10984 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_arr_assign_enumeration; 10985 10986 SourceRange Assign; 10987 if (Loc != OrigLoc) 10988 Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc); 10989 S.Diag(Loc, DiagID) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign; 10990 // We need to preserve the AST regardless, so migration tool 10991 // can do its job. 10992 return false; 10993 } 10994 } 10995 } 10996 10997 // If none of the special cases above are triggered, then this is a 10998 // simple const assignment. 10999 if (DiagID == 0) { 11000 DiagnoseConstAssignment(S, E, Loc); 11001 return true; 11002 } 11003 11004 break; 11005 case Expr::MLV_ConstAddrSpace: 11006 DiagnoseConstAssignment(S, E, Loc); 11007 return true; 11008 case Expr::MLV_ConstQualifiedField: 11009 DiagnoseRecursiveConstFields(S, E, Loc); 11010 return true; 11011 case Expr::MLV_ArrayType: 11012 case Expr::MLV_ArrayTemporary: 11013 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_array_not_modifiable_lvalue; 11014 NeedType = true; 11015 break; 11016 case Expr::MLV_NotObjectType: 11017 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_non_object_not_modifiable_lvalue; 11018 NeedType = true; 11019 break; 11020 case Expr::MLV_LValueCast: 11021 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_lvalue_casts_not_supported; 11022 break; 11023 case Expr::MLV_Valid: 11024 llvm_unreachable("did not take early return for MLV_Valid"); 11025 case Expr::MLV_InvalidExpression: 11026 case Expr::MLV_MemberFunction: 11027 case Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary: 11028 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_expression_not_modifiable_lvalue; 11029 break; 11030 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteType: 11031 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteVoidType: 11032 return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, E->getType(), 11033 diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_type_not_modifiable_lvalue, E); 11034 case Expr::MLV_DuplicateVectorComponents: 11035 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_duplicate_vector_components_not_mlvalue; 11036 break; 11037 case Expr::MLV_NoSetterProperty: 11038 llvm_unreachable("readonly properties should be processed differently"); 11039 case Expr::MLV_InvalidMessageExpression: 11040 DiagID = diag::err_readonly_message_assignment; 11041 break; 11042 case Expr::MLV_SubObjCPropertySetting: 11043 DiagID = diag::err_no_subobject_property_setting; 11044 break; 11045 } 11046 11047 SourceRange Assign; 11048 if (Loc != OrigLoc) 11049 Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc); 11050 if (NeedType) 11051 S.Diag(Loc, DiagID) << E->getType() << E->getSourceRange() << Assign; 11052 else 11053 S.Diag(Loc, DiagID) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign; 11054 return true; 11055 } 11056 11057 static void CheckIdentityFieldAssignment(Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr, 11058 SourceLocation Loc, 11059 Sema &Sema) { 11060 if (Sema.inTemplateInstantiation()) 11061 return; 11062 if (Sema.isUnevaluatedContext()) 11063 return; 11064 if (Loc.isInvalid() || Loc.isMacroID()) 11065 return; 11066 if (LHSExpr->getExprLoc().isMacroID() || RHSExpr->getExprLoc().isMacroID()) 11067 return; 11068 11069 // C / C++ fields 11070 MemberExpr *ML = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(LHSExpr); 11071 MemberExpr *MR = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(RHSExpr); 11072 if (ML && MR) { 11073 if (!(isa<CXXThisExpr>(ML->getBase()) && isa<CXXThisExpr>(MR->getBase()))) 11074 return; 11075 const ValueDecl *LHSDecl = 11076 cast<ValueDecl>(ML->getMemberDecl()->getCanonicalDecl()); 11077 const ValueDecl *RHSDecl = 11078 cast<ValueDecl>(MR->getMemberDecl()->getCanonicalDecl()); 11079 if (LHSDecl != RHSDecl) 11080 return; 11081 if (LHSDecl->getType().isVolatileQualified()) 11082 return; 11083 if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = LHSDecl->getType()->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 11084 if (RefTy->getPointeeType().isVolatileQualified()) 11085 return; 11086 11087 Sema.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_identity_field_assign) << 0; 11088 } 11089 11090 // Objective-C instance variables 11091 ObjCIvarRefExpr *OL = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(LHSExpr); 11092 ObjCIvarRefExpr *OR = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(RHSExpr); 11093 if (OL && OR && OL->getDecl() == OR->getDecl()) { 11094 DeclRefExpr *RL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(OL->getBase()->IgnoreImpCasts()); 11095 DeclRefExpr *RR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(OR->getBase()->IgnoreImpCasts()); 11096 if (RL && RR && RL->getDecl() == RR->getDecl()) 11097 Sema.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_identity_field_assign) << 1; 11098 } 11099 } 11100 11101 // C99 6.5.16.1 11102 QualType Sema::CheckAssignmentOperands(Expr *LHSExpr, ExprResult &RHS, 11103 SourceLocation Loc, 11104 QualType CompoundType) { 11105 assert(!LHSExpr->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::PseudoObject)); 11106 11107 // Verify that LHS is a modifiable lvalue, and emit error if not. 11108 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(LHSExpr, Loc, *this)) 11109 return QualType(); 11110 11111 QualType LHSType = LHSExpr->getType(); 11112 QualType RHSType = CompoundType.isNull() ? RHS.get()->getType() : 11113 CompoundType; 11114 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.1.1.1 p2: 11115 // The half data type can only be used to declare a pointer to a buffer that 11116 // contains half values 11117 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && !getOpenCLOptions().isEnabled("cl_khr_fp16") && 11118 LHSType->isHalfType()) { 11119 Diag(Loc, diag::err_opencl_half_load_store) << 1 11120 << LHSType.getUnqualifiedType(); 11121 return QualType(); 11122 } 11123 11124 AssignConvertType ConvTy; 11125 if (CompoundType.isNull()) { 11126 Expr *RHSCheck = RHS.get(); 11127 11128 CheckIdentityFieldAssignment(LHSExpr, RHSCheck, Loc, *this); 11129 11130 QualType LHSTy(LHSType); 11131 ConvTy = CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(LHSTy, RHS); 11132 if (RHS.isInvalid()) 11133 return QualType(); 11134 // Special case of NSObject attributes on c-style pointer types. 11135 if (ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer && 11136 ((Context.isObjCNSObjectType(LHSType) && 11137 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) || 11138 (Context.isObjCNSObjectType(RHSType) && 11139 LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()))) 11140 ConvTy = Compatible; 11141 11142 if (ConvTy == Compatible && 11143 LHSType->isObjCObjectType()) 11144 Diag(Loc, diag::err_objc_object_assignment) 11145 << LHSType; 11146 11147 // If the RHS is a unary plus or minus, check to see if they = and + are 11148 // right next to each other. If so, the user may have typo'd "x =+ 4" 11149 // instead of "x += 4". 11150 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(RHSCheck)) 11151 RHSCheck = ICE->getSubExpr(); 11152 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(RHSCheck)) { 11153 if ((UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus || 11154 UO->getOpcode() == UO_Minus) && 11155 Loc.isFileID() && UO->getOperatorLoc().isFileID() && 11156 // Only if the two operators are exactly adjacent. 11157 Loc.getLocWithOffset(1) == UO->getOperatorLoc() && 11158 // And there is a space or other character before the subexpr of the 11159 // unary +/-. We don't want to warn on "x=-1". 11160 Loc.getLocWithOffset(2) != UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart() && 11161 UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart().isFileID()) { 11162 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_compound_assign) 11163 << (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ? "+" : "-") 11164 << SourceRange(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO->getOperatorLoc()); 11165 } 11166 } 11167 11168 if (ConvTy == Compatible) { 11169 if (LHSType.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Strong) { 11170 // Warn about retain cycles where a block captures the LHS, but 11171 // not if the LHS is a simple variable into which the block is 11172 // being stored...unless that variable can be captured by reference! 11173 const Expr *InnerLHS = LHSExpr->IgnoreParenCasts(); 11174 const DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(InnerLHS); 11175 if (!DRE || DRE->getDecl()->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) 11176 checkRetainCycles(LHSExpr, RHS.get()); 11177 } 11178 11179 if (LHSType.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Strong || 11180 LHSType.isNonWeakInMRRWithObjCWeak(Context)) { 11181 // It is safe to assign a weak reference into a strong variable. 11182 // Although this code can still have problems: 11183 // id x = self.weakProp; 11184 // id y = self.weakProp; 11185 // we do not warn to warn spuriously when 'x' and 'y' are on separate 11186 // paths through the function. This should be revisited if 11187 // -Wrepeated-use-of-weak is made flow-sensitive. 11188 // For ObjCWeak only, we do not warn if the assign is to a non-weak 11189 // variable, which will be valid for the current autorelease scope. 11190 if (!Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_arc_repeated_use_of_weak, 11191 RHS.get()->getLocStart())) 11192 getCurFunction()->markSafeWeakUse(RHS.get()); 11193 11194 } else if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount || getLangOpts().ObjCWeak) { 11195 checkUnsafeExprAssigns(Loc, LHSExpr, RHS.get()); 11196 } 11197 } 11198 } else { 11199 // Compound assignment "x += y" 11200 ConvTy = CheckAssignmentConstraints(Loc, LHSType, RHSType); 11201 } 11202 11203 if (DiagnoseAssignmentResult(ConvTy, Loc, LHSType, RHSType, 11204 RHS.get(), AA_Assigning)) 11205 return QualType(); 11206 11207 CheckForNullPointerDereference(*this, LHSExpr); 11208 11209 // C99 6.5.16p3: The type of an assignment expression is the type of the 11210 // left operand unless the left operand has qualified type, in which case 11211 // it is the unqualified version of the type of the left operand. 11212 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: In simple assignment, the value of the right operand 11213 // is converted to the type of the assignment expression (above). 11214 // C++ 5.17p1: the type of the assignment expression is that of its left 11215 // operand. 11216 return (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 11217 ? LHSType : LHSType.getUnqualifiedType()); 11218 } 11219 11220 // Only ignore explicit casts to void. 11221 static bool IgnoreCommaOperand(const Expr *E) { 11222 E = E->IgnoreParens(); 11223 11224 if (const CastExpr *CE = dyn_cast<CastExpr>(E)) { 11225 if (CE->getCastKind() == CK_ToVoid) { 11226 return true; 11227 } 11228 } 11229 11230 return false; 11231 } 11232 11233 // Look for instances where it is likely the comma operator is confused with 11234 // another operator. There is a whitelist of acceptable expressions for the 11235 // left hand side of the comma operator, otherwise emit a warning. 11236 void Sema::DiagnoseCommaOperator(const Expr *LHS, SourceLocation Loc) { 11237 // No warnings in macros 11238 if (Loc.isMacroID()) 11239 return; 11240 11241 // Don't warn in template instantiations. 11242 if (inTemplateInstantiation()) 11243 return; 11244 11245 // Scope isn't fine-grained enough to whitelist the specific cases, so 11246 // instead, skip more than needed, then call back into here with the 11247 // CommaVisitor in SemaStmt.cpp. 11248 // The whitelisted locations are the initialization and increment portions 11249 // of a for loop. The additional checks are on the condition of 11250 // if statements, do/while loops, and for loops. 11251 const unsigned ForIncrementFlags = 11252 Scope::ControlScope | Scope::ContinueScope | Scope::BreakScope; 11253 const unsigned ForInitFlags = Scope::ControlScope | Scope::DeclScope; 11254 const unsigned ScopeFlags = getCurScope()->getFlags(); 11255 if ((ScopeFlags & ForIncrementFlags) == ForIncrementFlags || 11256 (ScopeFlags & ForInitFlags) == ForInitFlags) 11257 return; 11258 11259 // If there are multiple comma operators used together, get the RHS of the 11260 // of the comma operator as the LHS. 11261 while (const BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHS)) { 11262 if (BO->getOpcode() != BO_Comma) 11263 break; 11264 LHS = BO->getRHS(); 11265 } 11266 11267 // Only allow some expressions on LHS to not warn. 11268 if (IgnoreCommaOperand(LHS)) 11269 return; 11270 11271 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_comma_operator); 11272 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::note_cast_to_void) 11273 << LHS->getSourceRange() 11274 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(LHS->getLocStart(), 11275 LangOpts.CPlusPlus ? "static_cast<void>(" 11276 : "(void)(") 11277 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(PP.getLocForEndOfToken(LHS->getLocEnd()), 11278 ")"); 11279 } 11280 11281 // C99 6.5.17 11282 static QualType CheckCommaOperands(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 11283 SourceLocation Loc) { 11284 LHS = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(LHS.get()); 11285 RHS = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(RHS.get()); 11286 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid()) 11287 return QualType(); 11288 11289 // C's comma performs lvalue conversion (C99 6.3.2.1) on both its 11290 // operands, but not unary promotions. 11291 // C++'s comma does not do any conversions at all (C++ [expr.comma]p1). 11292 11293 // So we treat the LHS as a ignored value, and in C++ we allow the 11294 // containing site to determine what should be done with the RHS. 11295 LHS = S.IgnoredValueConversions(LHS.get()); 11296 if (LHS.isInvalid()) 11297 return QualType(); 11298 11299 S.DiagnoseUnusedExprResult(LHS.get()); 11300 11301 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 11302 RHS = S.DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS.get()); 11303 if (RHS.isInvalid()) 11304 return QualType(); 11305 if (!RHS.get()->getType()->isVoidType()) 11306 S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, RHS.get()->getType(), 11307 diag::err_incomplete_type); 11308 } 11309 11310 if (!S.getDiagnostics().isIgnored(diag::warn_comma_operator, Loc)) 11311 S.DiagnoseCommaOperator(LHS.get(), Loc); 11312 11313 return RHS.get()->getType(); 11314 } 11315 11316 /// CheckIncrementDecrementOperand - unlike most "Check" methods, this routine 11317 /// doesn't need to call UsualUnaryConversions or UsualArithmeticConversions. 11318 static QualType CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Sema &S, Expr *Op, 11319 ExprValueKind &VK, 11320 ExprObjectKind &OK, 11321 SourceLocation OpLoc, 11322 bool IsInc, bool IsPrefix) { 11323 if (Op->isTypeDependent()) 11324 return S.Context.DependentTy; 11325 11326 QualType ResType = Op->getType(); 11327 // Atomic types can be used for increment / decrement where the non-atomic 11328 // versions can, so ignore the _Atomic() specifier for the purpose of 11329 // checking. 11330 if (const AtomicType *ResAtomicType = ResType->getAs<AtomicType>()) 11331 ResType = ResAtomicType->getValueType(); 11332 11333 assert(!ResType.isNull() && "no type for increment/decrement expression"); 11334 11335 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && ResType->isBooleanType()) { 11336 // Decrement of bool is not allowed. 11337 if (!IsInc) { 11338 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_decrement_bool) << Op->getSourceRange(); 11339 return QualType(); 11340 } 11341 // Increment of bool sets it to true, but is deprecated. 11342 S.Diag(OpLoc, S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 ? diag::ext_increment_bool 11343 : diag::warn_increment_bool) 11344 << Op->getSourceRange(); 11345 } else if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && ResType->isEnumeralType()) { 11346 // Error on enum increments and decrements in C++ mode 11347 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_increment_decrement_enum) << IsInc << ResType; 11348 return QualType(); 11349 } else if (ResType->isRealType()) { 11350 // OK! 11351 } else if (ResType->isPointerType()) { 11352 // C99 6.5.2.4p2, 6.5.6p2 11353 if (!checkArithmeticOpPointerOperand(S, OpLoc, Op)) 11354 return QualType(); 11355 } else if (ResType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 11356 // On modern runtimes, ObjC pointer arithmetic is forbidden. 11357 // Otherwise, we just need a complete type. 11358 if (checkArithmeticIncompletePointerType(S, OpLoc, Op) || 11359 checkArithmeticOnObjCPointer(S, OpLoc, Op)) 11360 return QualType(); 11361 } else if (ResType->isAnyComplexType()) { 11362 // C99 does not support ++/-- on complex types, we allow as an extension. 11363 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_increment_complex) 11364 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange(); 11365 } else if (ResType->isPlaceholderType()) { 11366 ExprResult PR = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(Op); 11367 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType(); 11368 return CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(S, PR.get(), VK, OK, OpLoc, 11369 IsInc, IsPrefix); 11370 } else if (S.getLangOpts().AltiVec && ResType->isVectorType()) { 11371 // OK! ( C/C++ Language Extensions for CBEA(Version 2.6) 10.3 ) 11372 } else if (S.getLangOpts().ZVector && ResType->isVectorType() && 11373 (ResType->getAs<VectorType>()->getVectorKind() != 11374 VectorType::AltiVecBool)) { 11375 // The z vector extensions allow ++ and -- for non-bool vectors. 11376 } else if(S.getLangOpts().OpenCL && ResType->isVectorType() && 11377 ResType->getAs<VectorType>()->getElementType()->isIntegerType()) { 11378 // OpenCL V1.2 6.3 says dec/inc ops operate on integer vector types. 11379 } else { 11380 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_illegal_increment_decrement) 11381 << ResType << int(IsInc) << Op->getSourceRange(); 11382 return QualType(); 11383 } 11384 // At this point, we know we have a real, complex or pointer type. 11385 // Now make sure the operand is a modifiable lvalue. 11386 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(Op, OpLoc, S)) 11387 return QualType(); 11388 // In C++, a prefix increment is the same type as the operand. Otherwise 11389 // (in C or with postfix), the increment is the unqualified type of the 11390 // operand. 11391 if (IsPrefix && S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 11392 VK = VK_LValue; 11393 OK = Op->getObjectKind(); 11394 return ResType; 11395 } else { 11396 VK = VK_RValue; 11397 return ResType.getUnqualifiedType(); 11398 } 11399 } 11400 11401 11402 /// getPrimaryDecl - Helper function for CheckAddressOfOperand(). 11403 /// This routine allows us to typecheck complex/recursive expressions 11404 /// where the declaration is needed for type checking. We only need to 11405 /// handle cases when the expression references a function designator 11406 /// or is an lvalue. Here are some examples: 11407 /// - &(x) => x 11408 /// - &*****f => f for f a function designator. 11409 /// - &s.xx => s 11410 /// - &s.zz[1].yy -> s, if zz is an array 11411 /// - *(x + 1) -> x, if x is an array 11412 /// - &"123"[2] -> 0 11413 /// - & __real__ x -> x 11414 static ValueDecl *getPrimaryDecl(Expr *E) { 11415 switch (E->getStmtClass()) { 11416 case Stmt::DeclRefExprClass: 11417 return cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)->getDecl(); 11418 case Stmt::MemberExprClass: 11419 // If this is an arrow operator, the address is an offset from 11420 // the base's value, so the object the base refers to is 11421 // irrelevant. 11422 if (cast<MemberExpr>(E)->isArrow()) 11423 return nullptr; 11424 // Otherwise, the expression refers to a part of the base 11425 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<MemberExpr>(E)->getBase()); 11426 case Stmt::ArraySubscriptExprClass: { 11427 // FIXME: This code shouldn't be necessary! We should catch the implicit 11428 // promotion of register arrays earlier. 11429 Expr* Base = cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)->getBase(); 11430 if (ImplicitCastExpr* ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Base)) { 11431 if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType()->isArrayType()) 11432 return getPrimaryDecl(ICE->getSubExpr()); 11433 } 11434 return nullptr; 11435 } 11436 case Stmt::UnaryOperatorClass: { 11437 UnaryOperator *UO = cast<UnaryOperator>(E); 11438 11439 switch(UO->getOpcode()) { 11440 case UO_Real: 11441 case UO_Imag: 11442 case UO_Extension: 11443 return getPrimaryDecl(UO->getSubExpr()); 11444 default: 11445 return nullptr; 11446 } 11447 } 11448 case Stmt::ParenExprClass: 11449 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr()); 11450 case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass: 11451 // If the result of an implicit cast is an l-value, we care about 11452 // the sub-expression; otherwise, the result here doesn't matter. 11453 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)->getSubExpr()); 11454 default: 11455 return nullptr; 11456 } 11457 } 11458 11459 namespace { 11460 enum { 11461 AO_Bit_Field = 0, 11462 AO_Vector_Element = 1, 11463 AO_Property_Expansion = 2, 11464 AO_Register_Variable = 3, 11465 AO_No_Error = 4 11466 }; 11467 } 11468 /// Diagnose invalid operand for address of operations. 11469 /// 11470 /// \param Type The type of operand which cannot have its address taken. 11471 static void diagnoseAddressOfInvalidType(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 11472 Expr *E, unsigned Type) { 11473 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of) << Type << E->getSourceRange(); 11474 } 11475 11476 /// CheckAddressOfOperand - The operand of & must be either a function 11477 /// designator or an lvalue designating an object. If it is an lvalue, the 11478 /// object cannot be declared with storage class register or be a bit field. 11479 /// Note: The usual conversions are *not* applied to the operand of the & 11480 /// operator (C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4]), and its result is never an lvalue. 11481 /// In C++, the operand might be an overloaded function name, in which case 11482 /// we allow the '&' but retain the overloaded-function type. 11483 QualType Sema::CheckAddressOfOperand(ExprResult &OrigOp, SourceLocation OpLoc) { 11484 if (const BuiltinType *PTy = OrigOp.get()->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()){ 11485 if (PTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) { 11486 Expr *E = OrigOp.get()->IgnoreParens(); 11487 if (!isa<OverloadExpr>(E)) { 11488 assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(E)->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf); 11489 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof_addrof_function) 11490 << OrigOp.get()->getSourceRange(); 11491 return QualType(); 11492 } 11493 11494 OverloadExpr *Ovl = cast<OverloadExpr>(E); 11495 if (isa<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(Ovl)) 11496 if (!ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(Ovl)) { 11497 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function) 11498 << OrigOp.get()->getSourceRange(); 11499 return QualType(); 11500 } 11501 11502 return Context.OverloadTy; 11503 } 11504 11505 if (PTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::UnknownAny) 11506 return Context.UnknownAnyTy; 11507 11508 if (PTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::BoundMember) { 11509 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function) 11510 << OrigOp.get()->getSourceRange(); 11511 return QualType(); 11512 } 11513 11514 OrigOp = CheckPlaceholderExpr(OrigOp.get()); 11515 if (OrigOp.isInvalid()) return QualType(); 11516 } 11517 11518 if (OrigOp.get()->isTypeDependent()) 11519 return Context.DependentTy; 11520 11521 assert(!OrigOp.get()->getType()->isPlaceholderType()); 11522 11523 // Make sure to ignore parentheses in subsequent checks 11524 Expr *op = OrigOp.get()->IgnoreParens(); 11525 11526 // In OpenCL captures for blocks called as lambda functions 11527 // are located in the private address space. Blocks used in 11528 // enqueue_kernel can be located in a different address space 11529 // depending on a vendor implementation. Thus preventing 11530 // taking an address of the capture to avoid invalid AS casts. 11531 if (LangOpts.OpenCL) { 11532 auto* VarRef = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(op); 11533 if (VarRef && VarRef->refersToEnclosingVariableOrCapture()) { 11534 Diag(op->getExprLoc(), diag::err_opencl_taking_address_capture); 11535 return QualType(); 11536 } 11537 } 11538 11539 if (getLangOpts().C99) { 11540 // Implement C99-only parts of addressof rules. 11541 if (UnaryOperator* uOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(op)) { 11542 if (uOp->getOpcode() == UO_Deref) 11543 // Per C99 6.5.3.2, the address of a deref always returns a valid result 11544 // (assuming the deref expression is valid). 11545 return uOp->getSubExpr()->getType(); 11546 } 11547 // Technically, there should be a check for array subscript 11548 // expressions here, but the result of one is always an lvalue anyway. 11549 } 11550 ValueDecl *dcl = getPrimaryDecl(op); 11551 11552 if (auto *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(dcl)) 11553 if (!checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(FD, /*Complain=*/true, 11554 op->getLocStart())) 11555 return QualType(); 11556 11557 Expr::LValueClassification lval = op->ClassifyLValue(Context); 11558 unsigned AddressOfError = AO_No_Error; 11559 11560 if (lval == Expr::LV_ClassTemporary || lval == Expr::LV_ArrayTemporary) { 11561 bool sfinae = (bool)isSFINAEContext(); 11562 Diag(OpLoc, isSFINAEContext() ? diag::err_typecheck_addrof_temporary 11563 : diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_temporary) 11564 << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange(); 11565 if (sfinae) 11566 return QualType(); 11567 // Materialize the temporary as an lvalue so that we can take its address. 11568 OrigOp = op = 11569 CreateMaterializeTemporaryExpr(op->getType(), OrigOp.get(), true); 11570 } else if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(op)) { 11571 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType()); 11572 } else if (lval == Expr::LV_MemberFunction) { 11573 // If it's an instance method, make a member pointer. 11574 // The expression must have exactly the form &A::foo. 11575 11576 // If the underlying expression isn't a decl ref, give up. 11577 if (!isa<DeclRefExpr>(op)) { 11578 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function) 11579 << OrigOp.get()->getSourceRange(); 11580 return QualType(); 11581 } 11582 DeclRefExpr *DRE = cast<DeclRefExpr>(op); 11583 CXXMethodDecl *MD = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DRE->getDecl()); 11584 11585 // The id-expression was parenthesized. 11586 if (OrigOp.get() != DRE) { 11587 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_parens_pointer_member_function) 11588 << OrigOp.get()->getSourceRange(); 11589 11590 // The method was named without a qualifier. 11591 } else if (!DRE->getQualifier()) { 11592 if (MD->getParent()->getName().empty()) 11593 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function) 11594 << op->getSourceRange(); 11595 else { 11596 SmallString<32> Str; 11597 StringRef Qual = (MD->getParent()->getName() + "::").toStringRef(Str); 11598 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function) 11599 << op->getSourceRange() 11600 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(op->getSourceRange().getBegin(), Qual); 11601 } 11602 } 11603 11604 // Taking the address of a dtor is illegal per C++ [class.dtor]p2. 11605 if (isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(MD)) 11606 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_addrof_dtor) << op->getSourceRange(); 11607 11608 QualType MPTy = Context.getMemberPointerType( 11609 op->getType(), Context.getTypeDeclType(MD->getParent()).getTypePtr()); 11610 // Under the MS ABI, lock down the inheritance model now. 11611 if (Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft()) 11612 (void)isCompleteType(OpLoc, MPTy); 11613 return MPTy; 11614 } else if (lval != Expr::LV_Valid && lval != Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) { 11615 // C99 6.5.3.2p1 11616 // The operand must be either an l-value or a function designator 11617 if (!op->getType()->isFunctionType()) { 11618 // Use a special diagnostic for loads from property references. 11619 if (isa<PseudoObjectExpr>(op)) { 11620 AddressOfError = AO_Property_Expansion; 11621 } else { 11622 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof) 11623 << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange(); 11624 return QualType(); 11625 } 11626 } 11627 } else if (op->getObjectKind() == OK_BitField) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1 11628 // The operand cannot be a bit-field 11629 AddressOfError = AO_Bit_Field; 11630 } else if (op->getObjectKind() == OK_VectorComponent) { 11631 // The operand cannot be an element of a vector 11632 AddressOfError = AO_Vector_Element; 11633 } else if (dcl) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1 11634 // We have an lvalue with a decl. Make sure the decl is not declared 11635 // with the register storage-class specifier. 11636 if (const VarDecl *vd = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(dcl)) { 11637 // in C++ it is not error to take address of a register 11638 // variable (c++03 7.1.1P3) 11639 if (vd->getStorageClass() == SC_Register && 11640 !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 11641 AddressOfError = AO_Register_Variable; 11642 } 11643 } else if (isa<MSPropertyDecl>(dcl)) { 11644 AddressOfError = AO_Property_Expansion; 11645 } else if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) { 11646 return Context.OverloadTy; 11647 } else if (isa<FieldDecl>(dcl) || isa<IndirectFieldDecl>(dcl)) { 11648 // Okay: we can take the address of a field. 11649 // Could be a pointer to member, though, if there is an explicit 11650 // scope qualifier for the class. 11651 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier()) { 11652 DeclContext *Ctx = dcl->getDeclContext(); 11653 if (Ctx && Ctx->isRecord()) { 11654 if (dcl->getType()->isReferenceType()) { 11655 Diag(OpLoc, 11656 diag::err_cannot_form_pointer_to_member_of_reference_type) 11657 << dcl->getDeclName() << dcl->getType(); 11658 return QualType(); 11659 } 11660 11661 while (cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) 11662 Ctx = Ctx->getParent(); 11663 11664 QualType MPTy = Context.getMemberPointerType( 11665 op->getType(), 11666 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)).getTypePtr()); 11667 // Under the MS ABI, lock down the inheritance model now. 11668 if (Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft()) 11669 (void)isCompleteType(OpLoc, MPTy); 11670 return MPTy; 11671 } 11672 } 11673 } else if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(dcl) && !isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(dcl) && 11674 !isa<BindingDecl>(dcl)) 11675 llvm_unreachable("Unknown/unexpected decl type"); 11676 } 11677 11678 if (AddressOfError != AO_No_Error) { 11679 diagnoseAddressOfInvalidType(*this, OpLoc, op, AddressOfError); 11680 return QualType(); 11681 } 11682 11683 if (lval == Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) { 11684 // Taking the address of a void variable is technically illegal, but we 11685 // allow it in cases which are otherwise valid. 11686 // Example: "extern void x; void* y = &x;". 11687 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_void) << op->getSourceRange(); 11688 } 11689 11690 // If the operand has type "type", the result has type "pointer to type". 11691 if (op->getType()->isObjCObjectType()) 11692 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(op->getType()); 11693 11694 CheckAddressOfPackedMember(op); 11695 11696 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType()); 11697 } 11698 11699 static void RecordModifiableNonNullParam(Sema &S, const Expr *Exp) { 11700 const DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(Exp); 11701 if (!DRE) 11702 return; 11703 const Decl *D = DRE->getDecl(); 11704 if (!D) 11705 return; 11706 const ParmVarDecl *Param = dyn_cast<ParmVarDecl>(D); 11707 if (!Param) 11708 return; 11709 if (const FunctionDecl* FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Param->getDeclContext())) 11710 if (!FD->hasAttr<NonNullAttr>() && !Param->hasAttr<NonNullAttr>()) 11711 return; 11712 if (FunctionScopeInfo *FD = S.getCurFunction()) 11713 if (!FD->ModifiedNonNullParams.count(Param)) 11714 FD->ModifiedNonNullParams.insert(Param); 11715 } 11716 11717 /// CheckIndirectionOperand - Type check unary indirection (prefix '*'). 11718 static QualType CheckIndirectionOperand(Sema &S, Expr *Op, ExprValueKind &VK, 11719 SourceLocation OpLoc) { 11720 if (Op->isTypeDependent()) 11721 return S.Context.DependentTy; 11722 11723 ExprResult ConvResult = S.UsualUnaryConversions(Op); 11724 if (ConvResult.isInvalid()) 11725 return QualType(); 11726 Op = ConvResult.get(); 11727 QualType OpTy = Op->getType(); 11728 QualType Result; 11729 11730 if (isa<CXXReinterpretCastExpr>(Op)) { 11731 QualType OpOrigType = Op->IgnoreParenCasts()->getType(); 11732 S.CheckCompatibleReinterpretCast(OpOrigType, OpTy, /*IsDereference*/true, 11733 Op->getSourceRange()); 11734 } 11735 11736 if (const PointerType *PT = OpTy->getAs<PointerType>()) 11737 { 11738 Result = PT->getPointeeType(); 11739 } 11740 else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = 11741 OpTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) 11742 Result = OPT->getPointeeType(); 11743 else { 11744 ExprResult PR = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(Op); 11745 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType(); 11746 if (PR.get() != Op) 11747 return CheckIndirectionOperand(S, PR.get(), VK, OpLoc); 11748 } 11749 11750 if (Result.isNull()) { 11751 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_indirection_requires_pointer) 11752 << OpTy << Op->getSourceRange(); 11753 return QualType(); 11754 } 11755 11756 // Note that per both C89 and C99, indirection is always legal, even if Result 11757 // is an incomplete type or void. It would be possible to warn about 11758 // dereferencing a void pointer, but it's completely well-defined, and such a 11759 // warning is unlikely to catch any mistakes. In C++, indirection is not valid 11760 // for pointers to 'void' but is fine for any other pointer type: 11761 // 11762 // C++ [expr.unary.op]p1: 11763 // [...] the expression to which [the unary * operator] is applied shall 11764 // be a pointer to an object type, or a pointer to a function type 11765 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && Result->isVoidType()) 11766 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_indirection_through_void_pointer) 11767 << OpTy << Op->getSourceRange(); 11768 11769 // Dereferences are usually l-values... 11770 VK = VK_LValue; 11771 11772 // ...except that certain expressions are never l-values in C. 11773 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && Result.isCForbiddenLValueType()) 11774 VK = VK_RValue; 11775 11776 return Result; 11777 } 11778 11779 BinaryOperatorKind Sema::ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(tok::TokenKind Kind) { 11780 BinaryOperatorKind Opc; 11781 switch (Kind) { 11782 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown binop!"); 11783 case tok::periodstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemD; break; 11784 case tok::arrowstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemI; break; 11785 case tok::star: Opc = BO_Mul; break; 11786 case tok::slash: Opc = BO_Div; break; 11787 case tok::percent: Opc = BO_Rem; break; 11788 case tok::plus: Opc = BO_Add; break; 11789 case tok::minus: Opc = BO_Sub; break; 11790 case tok::lessless: Opc = BO_Shl; break; 11791 case tok::greatergreater: Opc = BO_Shr; break; 11792 case tok::lessequal: Opc = BO_LE; break; 11793 case tok::less: Opc = BO_LT; break; 11794 case tok::greaterequal: Opc = BO_GE; break; 11795 case tok::greater: Opc = BO_GT; break; 11796 case tok::exclaimequal: Opc = BO_NE; break; 11797 case tok::equalequal: Opc = BO_EQ; break; 11798 case tok::spaceship: Opc = BO_Cmp; break; 11799 case tok::amp: Opc = BO_And; break; 11800 case tok::caret: Opc = BO_Xor; break; 11801 case tok::pipe: Opc = BO_Or; break; 11802 case tok::ampamp: Opc = BO_LAnd; break; 11803 case tok::pipepipe: Opc = BO_LOr; break; 11804 case tok::equal: Opc = BO_Assign; break; 11805 case tok::starequal: Opc = BO_MulAssign; break; 11806 case tok::slashequal: Opc = BO_DivAssign; break; 11807 case tok::percentequal: Opc = BO_RemAssign; break; 11808 case tok::plusequal: Opc = BO_AddAssign; break; 11809 case tok::minusequal: Opc = BO_SubAssign; break; 11810 case tok::lesslessequal: Opc = BO_ShlAssign; break; 11811 case tok::greatergreaterequal: Opc = BO_ShrAssign; break; 11812 case tok::ampequal: Opc = BO_AndAssign; break; 11813 case tok::caretequal: Opc = BO_XorAssign; break; 11814 case tok::pipeequal: Opc = BO_OrAssign; break; 11815 case tok::comma: Opc = BO_Comma; break; 11816 } 11817 return Opc; 11818 } 11819 11820 static inline UnaryOperatorKind ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode( 11821 tok::TokenKind Kind) { 11822 UnaryOperatorKind Opc; 11823 switch (Kind) { 11824 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown unary op!"); 11825 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PreInc; break; 11826 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PreDec; break; 11827 case tok::amp: Opc = UO_AddrOf; break; 11828 case tok::star: Opc = UO_Deref; break; 11829 case tok::plus: Opc = UO_Plus; break; 11830 case tok::minus: Opc = UO_Minus; break; 11831 case tok::tilde: Opc = UO_Not; break; 11832 case tok::exclaim: Opc = UO_LNot; break; 11833 case tok::kw___real: Opc = UO_Real; break; 11834 case tok::kw___imag: Opc = UO_Imag; break; 11835 case tok::kw___extension__: Opc = UO_Extension; break; 11836 } 11837 return Opc; 11838 } 11839 11840 /// DiagnoseSelfAssignment - Emits a warning if a value is assigned to itself. 11841 /// This warning suppressed in the event of macro expansions. 11842 static void DiagnoseSelfAssignment(Sema &S, Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr, 11843 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsBuiltin) { 11844 if (S.inTemplateInstantiation()) 11845 return; 11846 if (S.isUnevaluatedContext()) 11847 return; 11848 if (OpLoc.isInvalid() || OpLoc.isMacroID()) 11849 return; 11850 LHSExpr = LHSExpr->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 11851 RHSExpr = RHSExpr->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 11852 const DeclRefExpr *LHSDeclRef = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSExpr); 11853 const DeclRefExpr *RHSDeclRef = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHSExpr); 11854 if (!LHSDeclRef || !RHSDeclRef || 11855 LHSDeclRef->getLocation().isMacroID() || 11856 RHSDeclRef->getLocation().isMacroID()) 11857 return; 11858 const ValueDecl *LHSDecl = 11859 cast<ValueDecl>(LHSDeclRef->getDecl()->getCanonicalDecl()); 11860 const ValueDecl *RHSDecl = 11861 cast<ValueDecl>(RHSDeclRef->getDecl()->getCanonicalDecl()); 11862 if (LHSDecl != RHSDecl) 11863 return; 11864 if (LHSDecl->getType().isVolatileQualified()) 11865 return; 11866 if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = LHSDecl->getType()->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 11867 if (RefTy->getPointeeType().isVolatileQualified()) 11868 return; 11869 11870 S.Diag(OpLoc, IsBuiltin ? diag::warn_self_assignment_builtin 11871 : diag::warn_self_assignment_overloaded) 11872 << LHSDeclRef->getType() << LHSExpr->getSourceRange() 11873 << RHSExpr->getSourceRange(); 11874 } 11875 11876 /// Check if a bitwise-& is performed on an Objective-C pointer. This 11877 /// is usually indicative of introspection within the Objective-C pointer. 11878 static void checkObjCPointerIntrospection(Sema &S, ExprResult &L, ExprResult &R, 11879 SourceLocation OpLoc) { 11880 if (!S.getLangOpts().ObjC1) 11881 return; 11882 11883 const Expr *ObjCPointerExpr = nullptr, *OtherExpr = nullptr; 11884 const Expr *LHS = L.get(); 11885 const Expr *RHS = R.get(); 11886 11887 if (LHS->IgnoreParenCasts()->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 11888 ObjCPointerExpr = LHS; 11889 OtherExpr = RHS; 11890 } 11891 else if (RHS->IgnoreParenCasts()->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 11892 ObjCPointerExpr = RHS; 11893 OtherExpr = LHS; 11894 } 11895 11896 // This warning is deliberately made very specific to reduce false 11897 // positives with logic that uses '&' for hashing. This logic mainly 11898 // looks for code trying to introspect into tagged pointers, which 11899 // code should generally never do. 11900 if (ObjCPointerExpr && isa<IntegerLiteral>(OtherExpr->IgnoreParenCasts())) { 11901 unsigned Diag = diag::warn_objc_pointer_masking; 11902 // Determine if we are introspecting the result of performSelectorXXX. 11903 const Expr *Ex = ObjCPointerExpr->IgnoreParenCasts(); 11904 // Special case messages to -performSelector and friends, which 11905 // can return non-pointer values boxed in a pointer value. 11906 // Some clients may wish to silence warnings in this subcase. 11907 if (const ObjCMessageExpr *ME = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Ex)) { 11908 Selector S = ME->getSelector(); 11909 StringRef SelArg0 = S.getNameForSlot(0); 11910 if (SelArg0.startswith("performSelector")) 11911 Diag = diag::warn_objc_pointer_masking_performSelector; 11912 } 11913 11914 S.Diag(OpLoc, Diag) 11915 << ObjCPointerExpr->getSourceRange(); 11916 } 11917 } 11918 11919 static NamedDecl *getDeclFromExpr(Expr *E) { 11920 if (!E) 11921 return nullptr; 11922 if (auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) 11923 return DRE->getDecl(); 11924 if (auto *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E)) 11925 return ME->getMemberDecl(); 11926 if (auto *IRE = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(E)) 11927 return IRE->getDecl(); 11928 return nullptr; 11929 } 11930 11931 // This helper function promotes a binary operator's operands (which are of a 11932 // half vector type) to a vector of floats and then truncates the result to 11933 // a vector of either half or short. 11934 static ExprResult convertHalfVecBinOp(Sema &S, ExprResult LHS, ExprResult RHS, 11935 BinaryOperatorKind Opc, QualType ResultTy, 11936 ExprValueKind VK, ExprObjectKind OK, 11937 bool IsCompAssign, SourceLocation OpLoc, 11938 FPOptions FPFeatures) { 11939 auto &Context = S.getASTContext(); 11940 assert((isVector(ResultTy, Context.HalfTy) || 11941 isVector(ResultTy, Context.ShortTy)) && 11942 "Result must be a vector of half or short"); 11943 assert(isVector(LHS.get()->getType(), Context.HalfTy) && 11944 isVector(RHS.get()->getType(), Context.HalfTy) && 11945 "both operands expected to be a half vector"); 11946 11947 RHS = convertVector(RHS.get(), Context.FloatTy, S); 11948 QualType BinOpResTy = RHS.get()->getType(); 11949 11950 // If Opc is a comparison, ResultType is a vector of shorts. In that case, 11951 // change BinOpResTy to a vector of ints. 11952 if (isVector(ResultTy, Context.ShortTy)) 11953 BinOpResTy = S.GetSignedVectorType(BinOpResTy); 11954 11955 if (IsCompAssign) 11956 return new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator( 11957 LHS.get(), RHS.get(), Opc, ResultTy, VK, OK, BinOpResTy, BinOpResTy, 11958 OpLoc, FPFeatures); 11959 11960 LHS = convertVector(LHS.get(), Context.FloatTy, S); 11961 auto *BO = new (Context) BinaryOperator(LHS.get(), RHS.get(), Opc, BinOpResTy, 11962 VK, OK, OpLoc, FPFeatures); 11963 return convertVector(BO, ResultTy->getAs<VectorType>()->getElementType(), S); 11964 } 11965 11966 static std::pair<ExprResult, ExprResult> 11967 CorrectDelayedTyposInBinOp(Sema &S, BinaryOperatorKind Opc, Expr *LHSExpr, 11968 Expr *RHSExpr) { 11969 ExprResult LHS = LHSExpr, RHS = RHSExpr; 11970 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 11971 // C cannot handle TypoExpr nodes on either side of a binop because it 11972 // doesn't handle dependent types properly, so make sure any TypoExprs have 11973 // been dealt with before checking the operands. 11974 LHS = S.CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(LHS); 11975 RHS = S.CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(RHS, [Opc, LHS](Expr *E) { 11976 if (Opc != BO_Assign) 11977 return ExprResult(E); 11978 // Avoid correcting the RHS to the same Expr as the LHS. 11979 Decl *D = getDeclFromExpr(E); 11980 return (D && D == getDeclFromExpr(LHS.get())) ? ExprError() : E; 11981 }); 11982 } 11983 return std::make_pair(LHS, RHS); 11984 } 11985 11986 /// Returns true if conversion between vectors of halfs and vectors of floats 11987 /// is needed. 11988 static bool needsConversionOfHalfVec(bool OpRequiresConversion, ASTContext &Ctx, 11989 QualType SrcType) { 11990 return OpRequiresConversion && !Ctx.getLangOpts().NativeHalfType && 11991 !Ctx.getTargetInfo().useFP16ConversionIntrinsics() && 11992 isVector(SrcType, Ctx.HalfTy); 11993 } 11994 11995 /// CreateBuiltinBinOp - Creates a new built-in binary operation with 11996 /// operator @p Opc at location @c TokLoc. This routine only supports 11997 /// built-in operations; ActOnBinOp handles overloaded operators. 11998 ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, 11999 BinaryOperatorKind Opc, 12000 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 12001 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && isa<InitListExpr>(RHSExpr)) { 12002 // The syntax only allows initializer lists on the RHS of assignment, 12003 // so we don't need to worry about accepting invalid code for 12004 // non-assignment operators. 12005 // C++11 5.17p9: 12006 // The meaning of x = {v} [...] is that of x = T(v) [...]. The meaning 12007 // of x = {} is x = T(). 12008 InitializationKind Kind = InitializationKind::CreateDirectList( 12009 RHSExpr->getLocStart(), RHSExpr->getLocStart(), RHSExpr->getLocEnd()); 12010 InitializedEntity Entity = 12011 InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(LHSExpr->getType()); 12012 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, RHSExpr); 12013 ExprResult Init = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind, RHSExpr); 12014 if (Init.isInvalid()) 12015 return Init; 12016 RHSExpr = Init.get(); 12017 } 12018 12019 ExprResult LHS = LHSExpr, RHS = RHSExpr; 12020 QualType ResultTy; // Result type of the binary operator. 12021 // The following two variables are used for compound assignment operators 12022 QualType CompLHSTy; // Type of LHS after promotions for computation 12023 QualType CompResultTy; // Type of computation result 12024 ExprValueKind VK = VK_RValue; 12025 ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary; 12026 bool ConvertHalfVec = false; 12027 12028 std::tie(LHS, RHS) = CorrectDelayedTyposInBinOp(*this, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 12029 if (!LHS.isUsable() || !RHS.isUsable()) 12030 return ExprError(); 12031 12032 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 12033 QualType LHSTy = LHSExpr->getType(); 12034 QualType RHSTy = RHSExpr->getType(); 12035 // OpenCLC v2.0 s6.13.11.1 allows atomic variables to be initialized by 12036 // the ATOMIC_VAR_INIT macro. 12037 if (LHSTy->isAtomicType() || RHSTy->isAtomicType()) { 12038 SourceRange SR(LHSExpr->getLocStart(), RHSExpr->getLocEnd()); 12039 if (BO_Assign == Opc) 12040 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_opencl_atomic_init) << 0 << SR; 12041 else 12042 ResultTy = InvalidOperands(OpLoc, LHS, RHS); 12043 return ExprError(); 12044 } 12045 12046 // OpenCL special types - image, sampler, pipe, and blocks are to be used 12047 // only with a builtin functions and therefore should be disallowed here. 12048 if (LHSTy->isImageType() || RHSTy->isImageType() || 12049 LHSTy->isSamplerT() || RHSTy->isSamplerT() || 12050 LHSTy->isPipeType() || RHSTy->isPipeType() || 12051 LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) { 12052 ResultTy = InvalidOperands(OpLoc, LHS, RHS); 12053 return ExprError(); 12054 } 12055 } 12056 12057 switch (Opc) { 12058 case BO_Assign: 12059 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, QualType()); 12060 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 12061 LHS.get()->getObjectKind() != OK_ObjCProperty) { 12062 VK = LHS.get()->getValueKind(); 12063 OK = LHS.get()->getObjectKind(); 12064 } 12065 if (!ResultTy.isNull()) { 12066 DiagnoseSelfAssignment(*this, LHS.get(), RHS.get(), OpLoc, true); 12067 DiagnoseSelfMove(LHS.get(), RHS.get(), OpLoc); 12068 } 12069 RecordModifiableNonNullParam(*this, LHS.get()); 12070 break; 12071 case BO_PtrMemD: 12072 case BO_PtrMemI: 12073 ResultTy = CheckPointerToMemberOperands(LHS, RHS, VK, OpLoc, 12074 Opc == BO_PtrMemI); 12075 break; 12076 case BO_Mul: 12077 case BO_Div: 12078 ConvertHalfVec = true; 12079 ResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, false, 12080 Opc == BO_Div); 12081 break; 12082 case BO_Rem: 12083 ResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc); 12084 break; 12085 case BO_Add: 12086 ConvertHalfVec = true; 12087 ResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc); 12088 break; 12089 case BO_Sub: 12090 ConvertHalfVec = true; 12091 ResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc); 12092 break; 12093 case BO_Shl: 12094 case BO_Shr: 12095 ResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc); 12096 break; 12097 case BO_LE: 12098 case BO_LT: 12099 case BO_GE: 12100 case BO_GT: 12101 ConvertHalfVec = true; 12102 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc); 12103 break; 12104 case BO_EQ: 12105 case BO_NE: 12106 ConvertHalfVec = true; 12107 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc); 12108 break; 12109 case BO_Cmp: 12110 ConvertHalfVec = true; 12111 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc); 12112 assert(ResultTy.isNull() || ResultTy->getAsCXXRecordDecl()); 12113 break; 12114 case BO_And: 12115 checkObjCPointerIntrospection(*this, LHS, RHS, OpLoc); 12116 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 12117 case BO_Xor: 12118 case BO_Or: 12119 ResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc); 12120 break; 12121 case BO_LAnd: 12122 case BO_LOr: 12123 ConvertHalfVec = true; 12124 ResultTy = CheckLogicalOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc); 12125 break; 12126 case BO_MulAssign: 12127 case BO_DivAssign: 12128 ConvertHalfVec = true; 12129 CompResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, true, 12130 Opc == BO_DivAssign); 12131 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy; 12132 if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid()) 12133 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy); 12134 break; 12135 case BO_RemAssign: 12136 CompResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, true); 12137 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy; 12138 if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid()) 12139 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy); 12140 break; 12141 case BO_AddAssign: 12142 ConvertHalfVec = true; 12143 CompResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc, &CompLHSTy); 12144 if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid()) 12145 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy); 12146 break; 12147 case BO_SubAssign: 12148 ConvertHalfVec = true; 12149 CompResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy); 12150 if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid()) 12151 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy); 12152 break; 12153 case BO_ShlAssign: 12154 case BO_ShrAssign: 12155 CompResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc, true); 12156 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy; 12157 if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid()) 12158 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy); 12159 break; 12160 case BO_AndAssign: 12161 case BO_OrAssign: // fallthrough 12162 DiagnoseSelfAssignment(*this, LHS.get(), RHS.get(), OpLoc, true); 12163 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 12164 case BO_XorAssign: 12165 CompResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc); 12166 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy; 12167 if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid()) 12168 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy); 12169 break; 12170 case BO_Comma: 12171 ResultTy = CheckCommaOperands(*this, LHS, RHS, OpLoc); 12172 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !RHS.isInvalid()) { 12173 VK = RHS.get()->getValueKind(); 12174 OK = RHS.get()->getObjectKind(); 12175 } 12176 break; 12177 } 12178 if (ResultTy.isNull() || LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid()) 12179 return ExprError(); 12180 12181 // Some of the binary operations require promoting operands of half vector to 12182 // float vectors and truncating the result back to half vector. For now, we do 12183 // this only when HalfArgsAndReturn is set (that is, when the target is arm or 12184 // arm64). 12185 assert(isVector(RHS.get()->getType(), Context.HalfTy) == 12186 isVector(LHS.get()->getType(), Context.HalfTy) && 12187 "both sides are half vectors or neither sides are"); 12188 ConvertHalfVec = needsConversionOfHalfVec(ConvertHalfVec, Context, 12189 LHS.get()->getType()); 12190 12191 // Check for array bounds violations for both sides of the BinaryOperator 12192 CheckArrayAccess(LHS.get()); 12193 CheckArrayAccess(RHS.get()); 12194 12195 if (const ObjCIsaExpr *OISA = dyn_cast<ObjCIsaExpr>(LHS.get()->IgnoreParenCasts())) { 12196 NamedDecl *ObjectSetClass = LookupSingleName(TUScope, 12197 &Context.Idents.get("object_setClass"), 12198 SourceLocation(), LookupOrdinaryName); 12199 if (ObjectSetClass && isa<ObjCIsaExpr>(LHS.get())) { 12200 SourceLocation RHSLocEnd = getLocForEndOfToken(RHS.get()->getLocEnd()); 12201 Diag(LHS.get()->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_assign) << 12202 FixItHint::CreateInsertion(LHS.get()->getLocStart(), "object_setClass(") << 12203 FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(OISA->getOpLoc(), OpLoc), ",") << 12204 FixItHint::CreateInsertion(RHSLocEnd, ")"); 12205 } 12206 else 12207 Diag(LHS.get()->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_assign); 12208 } 12209 else if (const ObjCIvarRefExpr *OIRE = 12210 dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(LHS.get()->IgnoreParenCasts())) 12211 DiagnoseDirectIsaAccess(*this, OIRE, OpLoc, RHS.get()); 12212 12213 // Opc is not a compound assignment if CompResultTy is null. 12214 if (CompResultTy.isNull()) { 12215 if (ConvertHalfVec) 12216 return convertHalfVecBinOp(*this, LHS, RHS, Opc, ResultTy, VK, OK, false, 12217 OpLoc, FPFeatures); 12218 return new (Context) BinaryOperator(LHS.get(), RHS.get(), Opc, ResultTy, VK, 12219 OK, OpLoc, FPFeatures); 12220 } 12221 12222 // Handle compound assignments. 12223 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && LHS.get()->getObjectKind() != 12224 OK_ObjCProperty) { 12225 VK = VK_LValue; 12226 OK = LHS.get()->getObjectKind(); 12227 } 12228 12229 if (ConvertHalfVec) 12230 return convertHalfVecBinOp(*this, LHS, RHS, Opc, ResultTy, VK, OK, true, 12231 OpLoc, FPFeatures); 12232 12233 return new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator( 12234 LHS.get(), RHS.get(), Opc, ResultTy, VK, OK, CompLHSTy, CompResultTy, 12235 OpLoc, FPFeatures); 12236 } 12237 12238 /// DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence - Emit a warning when bitwise and comparison 12239 /// operators are mixed in a way that suggests that the programmer forgot that 12240 /// comparison operators have higher precedence. The most typical example of 12241 /// such code is "flags & 0x0020 != 0", which is equivalent to "flags & 1". 12242 static void DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc, 12243 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *LHSExpr, 12244 Expr *RHSExpr) { 12245 BinaryOperator *LHSBO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSExpr); 12246 BinaryOperator *RHSBO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(RHSExpr); 12247 12248 // Check that one of the sides is a comparison operator and the other isn't. 12249 bool isLeftComp = LHSBO && LHSBO->isComparisonOp(); 12250 bool isRightComp = RHSBO && RHSBO->isComparisonOp(); 12251 if (isLeftComp == isRightComp) 12252 return; 12253 12254 // Bitwise operations are sometimes used as eager logical ops. 12255 // Don't diagnose this. 12256 bool isLeftBitwise = LHSBO && LHSBO->isBitwiseOp(); 12257 bool isRightBitwise = RHSBO && RHSBO->isBitwiseOp(); 12258 if (isLeftBitwise || isRightBitwise) 12259 return; 12260 12261 SourceRange DiagRange = isLeftComp ? SourceRange(LHSExpr->getLocStart(), 12262 OpLoc) 12263 : SourceRange(OpLoc, RHSExpr->getLocEnd()); 12264 StringRef OpStr = isLeftComp ? LHSBO->getOpcodeStr() : RHSBO->getOpcodeStr(); 12265 SourceRange ParensRange = isLeftComp ? 12266 SourceRange(LHSBO->getRHS()->getLocStart(), RHSExpr->getLocEnd()) 12267 : SourceRange(LHSExpr->getLocStart(), RHSBO->getLHS()->getLocEnd()); 12268 12269 Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel) 12270 << DiagRange << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << OpStr; 12271 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc, 12272 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence) << OpStr, 12273 (isLeftComp ? LHSExpr : RHSExpr)->getSourceRange()); 12274 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc, 12275 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first) 12276 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), 12277 ParensRange); 12278 } 12279 12280 /// It accepts a '&&' expr that is inside a '||' one. 12281 /// Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps the '&&' expression 12282 /// in parentheses. 12283 static void 12284 EmitDiagnosticForLogicalAndInLogicalOr(Sema &Self, SourceLocation OpLoc, 12285 BinaryOperator *Bop) { 12286 assert(Bop->getOpcode() == BO_LAnd); 12287 Self.Diag(Bop->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_logical_and_in_logical_or) 12288 << Bop->getSourceRange() << OpLoc; 12289 SuggestParentheses(Self, Bop->getOperatorLoc(), 12290 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence) 12291 << Bop->getOpcodeStr(), 12292 Bop->getSourceRange()); 12293 } 12294 12295 /// Returns true if the given expression can be evaluated as a constant 12296 /// 'true'. 12297 static bool EvaluatesAsTrue(Sema &S, Expr *E) { 12298 bool Res; 12299 return !E->isValueDependent() && 12300 E->EvaluateAsBooleanCondition(Res, S.getASTContext()) && Res; 12301 } 12302 12303 /// Returns true if the given expression can be evaluated as a constant 12304 /// 'false'. 12305 static bool EvaluatesAsFalse(Sema &S, Expr *E) { 12306 bool Res; 12307 return !E->isValueDependent() && 12308 E->EvaluateAsBooleanCondition(Res, S.getASTContext()) && !Res; 12309 } 12310 12311 /// Look for '&&' in the left hand of a '||' expr. 12312 static void DiagnoseLogicalAndInLogicalOrLHS(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc, 12313 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 12314 if (BinaryOperator *Bop = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSExpr)) { 12315 if (Bop->getOpcode() == BO_LAnd) { 12316 // If it's "a && b || 0" don't warn since the precedence doesn't matter. 12317 if (EvaluatesAsFalse(S, RHSExpr)) 12318 return; 12319 // If it's "1 && a || b" don't warn since the precedence doesn't matter. 12320 if (!EvaluatesAsTrue(S, Bop->getLHS())) 12321 return EmitDiagnosticForLogicalAndInLogicalOr(S, OpLoc, Bop); 12322 } else if (Bop->getOpcode() == BO_LOr) { 12323 if (BinaryOperator *RBop = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Bop->getRHS())) { 12324 // If it's "a || b && 1 || c" we didn't warn earlier for 12325 // "a || b && 1", but warn now. 12326 if (RBop->getOpcode() == BO_LAnd && EvaluatesAsTrue(S, RBop->getRHS())) 12327 return EmitDiagnosticForLogicalAndInLogicalOr(S, OpLoc, RBop); 12328 } 12329 } 12330 } 12331 } 12332 12333 /// Look for '&&' in the right hand of a '||' expr. 12334 static void DiagnoseLogicalAndInLogicalOrRHS(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc, 12335 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 12336 if (BinaryOperator *Bop = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(RHSExpr)) { 12337 if (Bop->getOpcode() == BO_LAnd) { 12338 // If it's "0 || a && b" don't warn since the precedence doesn't matter. 12339 if (EvaluatesAsFalse(S, LHSExpr)) 12340 return; 12341 // If it's "a || b && 1" don't warn since the precedence doesn't matter. 12342 if (!EvaluatesAsTrue(S, Bop->getRHS())) 12343 return EmitDiagnosticForLogicalAndInLogicalOr(S, OpLoc, Bop); 12344 } 12345 } 12346 } 12347 12348 /// Look for bitwise op in the left or right hand of a bitwise op with 12349 /// lower precedence and emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps 12350 /// the '&' expression in parentheses. 12351 static void DiagnoseBitwiseOpInBitwiseOp(Sema &S, BinaryOperatorKind Opc, 12352 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *SubExpr) { 12353 if (BinaryOperator *Bop = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(SubExpr)) { 12354 if (Bop->isBitwiseOp() && Bop->getOpcode() < Opc) { 12355 S.Diag(Bop->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_bitwise_op_in_bitwise_op) 12356 << Bop->getOpcodeStr() << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) 12357 << Bop->getSourceRange() << OpLoc; 12358 SuggestParentheses(S, Bop->getOperatorLoc(), 12359 S.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence) 12360 << Bop->getOpcodeStr(), 12361 Bop->getSourceRange()); 12362 } 12363 } 12364 } 12365 12366 static void DiagnoseAdditionInShift(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc, 12367 Expr *SubExpr, StringRef Shift) { 12368 if (BinaryOperator *Bop = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(SubExpr)) { 12369 if (Bop->getOpcode() == BO_Add || Bop->getOpcode() == BO_Sub) { 12370 StringRef Op = Bop->getOpcodeStr(); 12371 S.Diag(Bop->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_addition_in_bitshift) 12372 << Bop->getSourceRange() << OpLoc << Shift << Op; 12373 SuggestParentheses(S, Bop->getOperatorLoc(), 12374 S.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence) << Op, 12375 Bop->getSourceRange()); 12376 } 12377 } 12378 } 12379 12380 static void DiagnoseShiftCompare(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc, 12381 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 12382 CXXOperatorCallExpr *OCE = dyn_cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(LHSExpr); 12383 if (!OCE) 12384 return; 12385 12386 FunctionDecl *FD = OCE->getDirectCallee(); 12387 if (!FD || !FD->isOverloadedOperator()) 12388 return; 12389 12390 OverloadedOperatorKind Kind = FD->getOverloadedOperator(); 12391 if (Kind != OO_LessLess && Kind != OO_GreaterGreater) 12392 return; 12393 12394 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_overloaded_shift_in_comparison) 12395 << LHSExpr->getSourceRange() << RHSExpr->getSourceRange() 12396 << (Kind == OO_LessLess); 12397 SuggestParentheses(S, OCE->getOperatorLoc(), 12398 S.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence) 12399 << (Kind == OO_LessLess ? "<<" : ">>"), 12400 OCE->getSourceRange()); 12401 SuggestParentheses(S, OpLoc, 12402 S.PDiag(diag::note_evaluate_comparison_first), 12403 SourceRange(OCE->getArg(1)->getLocStart(), 12404 RHSExpr->getLocEnd())); 12405 } 12406 12407 /// DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence - Emit warnings for expressions with tricky 12408 /// precedence. 12409 static void DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc, 12410 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *LHSExpr, 12411 Expr *RHSExpr){ 12412 // Diagnose "arg1 'bitwise' arg2 'eq' arg3". 12413 if (BinaryOperator::isBitwiseOp(Opc)) 12414 DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Self, Opc, OpLoc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 12415 12416 // Diagnose "arg1 & arg2 | arg3" 12417 if ((Opc == BO_Or || Opc == BO_Xor) && 12418 !OpLoc.isMacroID()/* Don't warn in macros. */) { 12419 DiagnoseBitwiseOpInBitwiseOp(Self, Opc, OpLoc, LHSExpr); 12420 DiagnoseBitwiseOpInBitwiseOp(Self, Opc, OpLoc, RHSExpr); 12421 } 12422 12423 // Warn about arg1 || arg2 && arg3, as GCC 4.3+ does. 12424 // We don't warn for 'assert(a || b && "bad")' since this is safe. 12425 if (Opc == BO_LOr && !OpLoc.isMacroID()/* Don't warn in macros. */) { 12426 DiagnoseLogicalAndInLogicalOrLHS(Self, OpLoc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 12427 DiagnoseLogicalAndInLogicalOrRHS(Self, OpLoc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 12428 } 12429 12430 if ((Opc == BO_Shl && LHSExpr->getType()->isIntegralType(Self.getASTContext())) 12431 || Opc == BO_Shr) { 12432 StringRef Shift = BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc); 12433 DiagnoseAdditionInShift(Self, OpLoc, LHSExpr, Shift); 12434 DiagnoseAdditionInShift(Self, OpLoc, RHSExpr, Shift); 12435 } 12436 12437 // Warn on overloaded shift operators and comparisons, such as: 12438 // cout << 5 == 4; 12439 if (BinaryOperator::isComparisonOp(Opc)) 12440 DiagnoseShiftCompare(Self, OpLoc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 12441 } 12442 12443 // Binary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator. 12444 ExprResult Sema::ActOnBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation TokLoc, 12445 tok::TokenKind Kind, 12446 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 12447 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(Kind); 12448 assert(LHSExpr && "ActOnBinOp(): missing left expression"); 12449 assert(RHSExpr && "ActOnBinOp(): missing right expression"); 12450 12451 // Emit warnings for tricky precedence issues, e.g. "bitfield & 0x4 == 0" 12452 DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(*this, Opc, TokLoc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 12453 12454 return BuildBinOp(S, TokLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 12455 } 12456 12457 /// Build an overloaded binary operator expression in the given scope. 12458 static ExprResult BuildOverloadedBinOp(Sema &S, Scope *Sc, SourceLocation OpLoc, 12459 BinaryOperatorKind Opc, 12460 Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS) { 12461 switch (Opc) { 12462 case BO_Assign: 12463 case BO_DivAssign: 12464 case BO_RemAssign: 12465 case BO_SubAssign: 12466 case BO_AndAssign: 12467 case BO_OrAssign: 12468 case BO_XorAssign: 12469 DiagnoseSelfAssignment(S, LHS, RHS, OpLoc, false); 12470 CheckIdentityFieldAssignment(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, S); 12471 break; 12472 default: 12473 break; 12474 } 12475 12476 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this 12477 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local 12478 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of 12479 // the arguments. 12480 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions; 12481 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp 12482 = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc); 12483 if (Sc && OverOp != OO_None && OverOp != OO_Equal) 12484 S.LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, Sc, LHS->getType(), 12485 RHS->getType(), Functions); 12486 12487 // Build the (potentially-overloaded, potentially-dependent) 12488 // binary operation. 12489 return S.CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, LHS, RHS); 12490 } 12491 12492 ExprResult Sema::BuildBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc, 12493 BinaryOperatorKind Opc, 12494 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 12495 ExprResult LHS, RHS; 12496 std::tie(LHS, RHS) = CorrectDelayedTyposInBinOp(*this, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 12497 if (!LHS.isUsable() || !RHS.isUsable()) 12498 return ExprError(); 12499 LHSExpr = LHS.get(); 12500 RHSExpr = RHS.get(); 12501 12502 // We want to end up calling one of checkPseudoObjectAssignment 12503 // (if the LHS is a pseudo-object), BuildOverloadedBinOp (if 12504 // both expressions are overloadable or either is type-dependent), 12505 // or CreateBuiltinBinOp (in any other case). We also want to get 12506 // any placeholder types out of the way. 12507 12508 // Handle pseudo-objects in the LHS. 12509 if (const BuiltinType *pty = LHSExpr->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) { 12510 // Assignments with a pseudo-object l-value need special analysis. 12511 if (pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::PseudoObject && 12512 BinaryOperator::isAssignmentOp(Opc)) 12513 return checkPseudoObjectAssignment(S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 12514 12515 // Don't resolve overloads if the other type is overloadable. 12516 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) { 12517 // We can't actually test that if we still have a placeholder, 12518 // though. Fortunately, none of the exceptions we see in that 12519 // code below are valid when the LHS is an overload set. Note 12520 // that an overload set can be dependently-typed, but it never 12521 // instantiates to having an overloadable type. 12522 ExprResult resolvedRHS = CheckPlaceholderExpr(RHSExpr); 12523 if (resolvedRHS.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 12524 RHSExpr = resolvedRHS.get(); 12525 12526 if (RHSExpr->isTypeDependent() || 12527 RHSExpr->getType()->isOverloadableType()) 12528 return BuildOverloadedBinOp(*this, S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 12529 } 12530 12531 // If we're instantiating "a.x < b" or "A::x < b" and 'x' names a function 12532 // template, diagnose the missing 'template' keyword instead of diagnosing 12533 // an invalid use of a bound member function. 12534 // 12535 // Note that "A::x < b" might be valid if 'b' has an overloadable type due 12536 // to C++1z [over.over]/1.4, but we already checked for that case above. 12537 if (Opc == BO_LT && inTemplateInstantiation() && 12538 (pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::BoundMember || 12539 pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload)) { 12540 auto *OE = dyn_cast<OverloadExpr>(LHSExpr); 12541 if (OE && !OE->hasTemplateKeyword() && !OE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs() && 12542 std::any_of(OE->decls_begin(), OE->decls_end(), [](NamedDecl *ND) { 12543 return isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(ND); 12544 })) { 12545 Diag(OE->getQualifier() ? OE->getQualifierLoc().getBeginLoc() 12546 : OE->getNameLoc(), 12547 diag::err_template_kw_missing) 12548 << OE->getName().getAsString() << ""; 12549 return ExprError(); 12550 } 12551 } 12552 12553 ExprResult LHS = CheckPlaceholderExpr(LHSExpr); 12554 if (LHS.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 12555 LHSExpr = LHS.get(); 12556 } 12557 12558 // Handle pseudo-objects in the RHS. 12559 if (const BuiltinType *pty = RHSExpr->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) { 12560 // An overload in the RHS can potentially be resolved by the type 12561 // being assigned to. 12562 if (Opc == BO_Assign && pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) { 12563 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 12564 (LHSExpr->isTypeDependent() || RHSExpr->isTypeDependent() || 12565 LHSExpr->getType()->isOverloadableType())) 12566 return BuildOverloadedBinOp(*this, S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 12567 12568 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 12569 } 12570 12571 // Don't resolve overloads if the other type is overloadable. 12572 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload && 12573 LHSExpr->getType()->isOverloadableType()) 12574 return BuildOverloadedBinOp(*this, S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 12575 12576 ExprResult resolvedRHS = CheckPlaceholderExpr(RHSExpr); 12577 if (!resolvedRHS.isUsable()) return ExprError(); 12578 RHSExpr = resolvedRHS.get(); 12579 } 12580 12581 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 12582 // If either expression is type-dependent, always build an 12583 // overloaded op. 12584 if (LHSExpr->isTypeDependent() || RHSExpr->isTypeDependent()) 12585 return BuildOverloadedBinOp(*this, S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 12586 12587 // Otherwise, build an overloaded op if either expression has an 12588 // overloadable type. 12589 if (LHSExpr->getType()->isOverloadableType() || 12590 RHSExpr->getType()->isOverloadableType()) 12591 return BuildOverloadedBinOp(*this, S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 12592 } 12593 12594 // Build a built-in binary operation. 12595 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 12596 } 12597 12598 static bool isOverflowingIntegerType(ASTContext &Ctx, QualType T) { 12599 if (T.isNull() || T->isDependentType()) 12600 return false; 12601 12602 if (!T->isPromotableIntegerType()) 12603 return true; 12604 12605 return Ctx.getIntWidth(T) >= Ctx.getIntWidth(Ctx.IntTy); 12606 } 12607 12608 ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, 12609 UnaryOperatorKind Opc, 12610 Expr *InputExpr) { 12611 ExprResult Input = InputExpr; 12612 ExprValueKind VK = VK_RValue; 12613 ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary; 12614 QualType resultType; 12615 bool CanOverflow = false; 12616 12617 bool ConvertHalfVec = false; 12618 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 12619 QualType Ty = InputExpr->getType(); 12620 // The only legal unary operation for atomics is '&'. 12621 if ((Opc != UO_AddrOf && Ty->isAtomicType()) || 12622 // OpenCL special types - image, sampler, pipe, and blocks are to be used 12623 // only with a builtin functions and therefore should be disallowed here. 12624 (Ty->isImageType() || Ty->isSamplerT() || Ty->isPipeType() 12625 || Ty->isBlockPointerType())) { 12626 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr) 12627 << InputExpr->getType() 12628 << Input.get()->getSourceRange()); 12629 } 12630 } 12631 switch (Opc) { 12632 case UO_PreInc: 12633 case UO_PreDec: 12634 case UO_PostInc: 12635 case UO_PostDec: 12636 resultType = CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(*this, Input.get(), VK, OK, 12637 OpLoc, 12638 Opc == UO_PreInc || 12639 Opc == UO_PostInc, 12640 Opc == UO_PreInc || 12641 Opc == UO_PreDec); 12642 CanOverflow = isOverflowingIntegerType(Context, resultType); 12643 break; 12644 case UO_AddrOf: 12645 resultType = CheckAddressOfOperand(Input, OpLoc); 12646 RecordModifiableNonNullParam(*this, InputExpr); 12647 break; 12648 case UO_Deref: { 12649 Input = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input.get()); 12650 if (Input.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 12651 resultType = CheckIndirectionOperand(*this, Input.get(), VK, OpLoc); 12652 break; 12653 } 12654 case UO_Plus: 12655 case UO_Minus: 12656 CanOverflow = Opc == UO_Minus && 12657 isOverflowingIntegerType(Context, Input.get()->getType()); 12658 Input = UsualUnaryConversions(Input.get()); 12659 if (Input.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 12660 // Unary plus and minus require promoting an operand of half vector to a 12661 // float vector and truncating the result back to a half vector. For now, we 12662 // do this only when HalfArgsAndReturns is set (that is, when the target is 12663 // arm or arm64). 12664 ConvertHalfVec = 12665 needsConversionOfHalfVec(true, Context, Input.get()->getType()); 12666 12667 // If the operand is a half vector, promote it to a float vector. 12668 if (ConvertHalfVec) 12669 Input = convertVector(Input.get(), Context.FloatTy, *this); 12670 resultType = Input.get()->getType(); 12671 if (resultType->isDependentType()) 12672 break; 12673 if (resultType->isArithmeticType()) // C99 6.5.3.3p1 12674 break; 12675 else if (resultType->isVectorType() && 12676 // The z vector extensions don't allow + or - with bool vectors. 12677 (!Context.getLangOpts().ZVector || 12678 resultType->getAs<VectorType>()->getVectorKind() != 12679 VectorType::AltiVecBool)) 12680 break; 12681 else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6 12682 Opc == UO_Plus && 12683 resultType->isPointerType()) 12684 break; 12685 12686 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr) 12687 << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange()); 12688 12689 case UO_Not: // bitwise complement 12690 Input = UsualUnaryConversions(Input.get()); 12691 if (Input.isInvalid()) 12692 return ExprError(); 12693 resultType = Input.get()->getType(); 12694 12695 if (resultType->isDependentType()) 12696 break; 12697 // C99 6.5.3.3p1. We allow complex int and float as a GCC extension. 12698 if (resultType->isComplexType() || resultType->isComplexIntegerType()) 12699 // C99 does not support '~' for complex conjugation. 12700 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_complement_complex) 12701 << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange(); 12702 else if (resultType->hasIntegerRepresentation()) 12703 break; 12704 else if (resultType->isExtVectorType() && Context.getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 12705 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.f: The bitwise operator not (~) does not operate 12706 // on vector float types. 12707 QualType T = resultType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType(); 12708 if (!T->isIntegerType()) 12709 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr) 12710 << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange()); 12711 } else { 12712 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr) 12713 << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange()); 12714 } 12715 break; 12716 12717 case UO_LNot: // logical negation 12718 // Unlike +/-/~, integer promotions aren't done here (C99 6.5.3.3p5). 12719 Input = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input.get()); 12720 if (Input.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 12721 resultType = Input.get()->getType(); 12722 12723 // Though we still have to promote half FP to float... 12724 if (resultType->isHalfType() && !Context.getLangOpts().NativeHalfType) { 12725 Input = ImpCastExprToType(Input.get(), Context.FloatTy, CK_FloatingCast).get(); 12726 resultType = Context.FloatTy; 12727 } 12728 12729 if (resultType->isDependentType()) 12730 break; 12731 if (resultType->isScalarType() && !isScopedEnumerationType(resultType)) { 12732 // C99 6.5.3.3p1: ok, fallthrough; 12733 if (Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 12734 // C++03 [expr.unary.op]p8, C++0x [expr.unary.op]p9: 12735 // operand contextually converted to bool. 12736 Input = ImpCastExprToType(Input.get(), Context.BoolTy, 12737 ScalarTypeToBooleanCastKind(resultType)); 12738 } else if (Context.getLangOpts().OpenCL && 12739 Context.getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion < 120) { 12740 // OpenCL v1.1 6.3.h: The logical operator not (!) does not 12741 // operate on scalar float types. 12742 if (!resultType->isIntegerType() && !resultType->isPointerType()) 12743 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr) 12744 << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange()); 12745 } 12746 } else if (resultType->isExtVectorType()) { 12747 if (Context.getLangOpts().OpenCL && 12748 Context.getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion < 120) { 12749 // OpenCL v1.1 6.3.h: The logical operator not (!) does not 12750 // operate on vector float types. 12751 QualType T = resultType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType(); 12752 if (!T->isIntegerType()) 12753 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr) 12754 << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange()); 12755 } 12756 // Vector logical not returns the signed variant of the operand type. 12757 resultType = GetSignedVectorType(resultType); 12758 break; 12759 } else { 12760 // FIXME: GCC's vector extension permits the usage of '!' with a vector 12761 // type in C++. We should allow that here too. 12762 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr) 12763 << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange()); 12764 } 12765 12766 // LNot always has type int. C99 6.5.3.3p5. 12767 // In C++, it's bool. C++ 5.3.1p8 12768 resultType = Context.getLogicalOperationType(); 12769 break; 12770 case UO_Real: 12771 case UO_Imag: 12772 resultType = CheckRealImagOperand(*this, Input, OpLoc, Opc == UO_Real); 12773 // _Real maps ordinary l-values into ordinary l-values. _Imag maps ordinary 12774 // complex l-values to ordinary l-values and all other values to r-values. 12775 if (Input.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 12776 if (Opc == UO_Real || Input.get()->getType()->isAnyComplexType()) { 12777 if (Input.get()->getValueKind() != VK_RValue && 12778 Input.get()->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary) 12779 VK = Input.get()->getValueKind(); 12780 } else if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 12781 // In C, a volatile scalar is read by __imag. In C++, it is not. 12782 Input = DefaultLvalueConversion(Input.get()); 12783 } 12784 break; 12785 case UO_Extension: 12786 resultType = Input.get()->getType(); 12787 VK = Input.get()->getValueKind(); 12788 OK = Input.get()->getObjectKind(); 12789 break; 12790 case UO_Coawait: 12791 // It's unnecessary to represent the pass-through operator co_await in the 12792 // AST; just return the input expression instead. 12793 assert(!Input.get()->getType()->isDependentType() && 12794 "the co_await expression must be non-dependant before " 12795 "building operator co_await"); 12796 return Input; 12797 } 12798 if (resultType.isNull() || Input.isInvalid()) 12799 return ExprError(); 12800 12801 // Check for array bounds violations in the operand of the UnaryOperator, 12802 // except for the '*' and '&' operators that have to be handled specially 12803 // by CheckArrayAccess (as there are special cases like &array[arraysize] 12804 // that are explicitly defined as valid by the standard). 12805 if (Opc != UO_AddrOf && Opc != UO_Deref) 12806 CheckArrayAccess(Input.get()); 12807 12808 auto *UO = new (Context) 12809 UnaryOperator(Input.get(), Opc, resultType, VK, OK, OpLoc, CanOverflow); 12810 // Convert the result back to a half vector. 12811 if (ConvertHalfVec) 12812 return convertVector(UO, Context.HalfTy, *this); 12813 return UO; 12814 } 12815 12816 /// Determine whether the given expression is a qualified member 12817 /// access expression, of a form that could be turned into a pointer to member 12818 /// with the address-of operator. 12819 bool Sema::isQualifiedMemberAccess(Expr *E) { 12820 if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) { 12821 if (!DRE->getQualifier()) 12822 return false; 12823 12824 ValueDecl *VD = DRE->getDecl(); 12825 if (!VD->isCXXClassMember()) 12826 return false; 12827 12828 if (isa<FieldDecl>(VD) || isa<IndirectFieldDecl>(VD)) 12829 return true; 12830 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(VD)) 12831 return Method->isInstance(); 12832 12833 return false; 12834 } 12835 12836 if (UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E)) { 12837 if (!ULE->getQualifier()) 12838 return false; 12839 12840 for (NamedDecl *D : ULE->decls()) { 12841 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) { 12842 if (Method->isInstance()) 12843 return true; 12844 } else { 12845 // Overload set does not contain methods. 12846 break; 12847 } 12848 } 12849 12850 return false; 12851 } 12852 12853 return false; 12854 } 12855 12856 ExprResult Sema::BuildUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc, 12857 UnaryOperatorKind Opc, Expr *Input) { 12858 // First things first: handle placeholders so that the 12859 // overloaded-operator check considers the right type. 12860 if (const BuiltinType *pty = Input->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) { 12861 // Increment and decrement of pseudo-object references. 12862 if (pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::PseudoObject && 12863 UnaryOperator::isIncrementDecrementOp(Opc)) 12864 return checkPseudoObjectIncDec(S, OpLoc, Opc, Input); 12865 12866 // extension is always a builtin operator. 12867 if (Opc == UO_Extension) 12868 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input); 12869 12870 // & gets special logic for several kinds of placeholder. 12871 // The builtin code knows what to do. 12872 if (Opc == UO_AddrOf && 12873 (pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload || 12874 pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::UnknownAny || 12875 pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::BoundMember)) 12876 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input); 12877 12878 // Anything else needs to be handled now. 12879 ExprResult Result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Input); 12880 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 12881 Input = Result.get(); 12882 } 12883 12884 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && Input->getType()->isOverloadableType() && 12885 UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc) != OO_None && 12886 !(Opc == UO_AddrOf && isQualifiedMemberAccess(Input))) { 12887 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this 12888 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local 12889 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of 12890 // the arguments. 12891 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions; 12892 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc); 12893 if (S && OverOp != OO_None) 12894 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, Input->getType(), QualType(), 12895 Functions); 12896 12897 return CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, Input); 12898 } 12899 12900 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input); 12901 } 12902 12903 // Unary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator. 12904 ExprResult Sema::ActOnUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc, 12905 tok::TokenKind Op, Expr *Input) { 12906 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(Op), Input); 12907 } 12908 12909 /// ActOnAddrLabel - Parse the GNU address of label extension: "&&foo". 12910 ExprResult Sema::ActOnAddrLabel(SourceLocation OpLoc, SourceLocation LabLoc, 12911 LabelDecl *TheDecl) { 12912 TheDecl->markUsed(Context); 12913 // Create the AST node. The address of a label always has type 'void*'. 12914 return new (Context) AddrLabelExpr(OpLoc, LabLoc, TheDecl, 12915 Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy)); 12916 } 12917 12918 /// Given the last statement in a statement-expression, check whether 12919 /// the result is a producing expression (like a call to an 12920 /// ns_returns_retained function) and, if so, rebuild it to hoist the 12921 /// release out of the full-expression. Otherwise, return null. 12922 /// Cannot fail. 12923 static Expr *maybeRebuildARCConsumingStmt(Stmt *Statement) { 12924 // Should always be wrapped with one of these. 12925 ExprWithCleanups *cleanups = dyn_cast<ExprWithCleanups>(Statement); 12926 if (!cleanups) return nullptr; 12927 12928 ImplicitCastExpr *cast = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(cleanups->getSubExpr()); 12929 if (!cast || cast->getCastKind() != CK_ARCConsumeObject) 12930 return nullptr; 12931 12932 // Splice out the cast. This shouldn't modify any interesting 12933 // features of the statement. 12934 Expr *producer = cast->getSubExpr(); 12935 assert(producer->getType() == cast->getType()); 12936 assert(producer->getValueKind() == cast->getValueKind()); 12937 cleanups->setSubExpr(producer); 12938 return cleanups; 12939 } 12940 12941 void Sema::ActOnStartStmtExpr() { 12942 PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExprEvalContexts.back().Context); 12943 } 12944 12945 void Sema::ActOnStmtExprError() { 12946 // Note that function is also called by TreeTransform when leaving a 12947 // StmtExpr scope without rebuilding anything. 12948 12949 DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext(); 12950 PopExpressionEvaluationContext(); 12951 } 12952 12953 ExprResult 12954 Sema::ActOnStmtExpr(SourceLocation LPLoc, Stmt *SubStmt, 12955 SourceLocation RPLoc) { // "({..})" 12956 assert(SubStmt && isa<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt) && "Invalid action invocation!"); 12957 CompoundStmt *Compound = cast<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt); 12958 12959 if (hasAnyUnrecoverableErrorsInThisFunction()) 12960 DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext(); 12961 assert(!Cleanup.exprNeedsCleanups() && 12962 "cleanups within StmtExpr not correctly bound!"); 12963 PopExpressionEvaluationContext(); 12964 12965 // FIXME: there are a variety of strange constraints to enforce here, for 12966 // example, it is not possible to goto into a stmt expression apparently. 12967 // More semantic analysis is needed. 12968 12969 // If there are sub-stmts in the compound stmt, take the type of the last one 12970 // as the type of the stmtexpr. 12971 QualType Ty = Context.VoidTy; 12972 bool StmtExprMayBindToTemp = false; 12973 if (!Compound->body_empty()) { 12974 Stmt *LastStmt = Compound->body_back(); 12975 LabelStmt *LastLabelStmt = nullptr; 12976 // If LastStmt is a label, skip down through into the body. 12977 while (LabelStmt *Label = dyn_cast<LabelStmt>(LastStmt)) { 12978 LastLabelStmt = Label; 12979 LastStmt = Label->getSubStmt(); 12980 } 12981 12982 if (Expr *LastE = dyn_cast<Expr>(LastStmt)) { 12983 // Do function/array conversion on the last expression, but not 12984 // lvalue-to-rvalue. However, initialize an unqualified type. 12985 ExprResult LastExpr = DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(LastE); 12986 if (LastExpr.isInvalid()) 12987 return ExprError(); 12988 Ty = LastExpr.get()->getType().getUnqualifiedType(); 12989 12990 if (!Ty->isDependentType() && !LastExpr.get()->isTypeDependent()) { 12991 // In ARC, if the final expression ends in a consume, splice 12992 // the consume out and bind it later. In the alternate case 12993 // (when dealing with a retainable type), the result 12994 // initialization will create a produce. In both cases the 12995 // result will be +1, and we'll need to balance that out with 12996 // a bind. 12997 if (Expr *rebuiltLastStmt 12998 = maybeRebuildARCConsumingStmt(LastExpr.get())) { 12999 LastExpr = rebuiltLastStmt; 13000 } else { 13001 LastExpr = PerformCopyInitialization( 13002 InitializedEntity::InitializeStmtExprResult(LPLoc, Ty), 13003 SourceLocation(), LastExpr); 13004 } 13005 13006 if (LastExpr.isInvalid()) 13007 return ExprError(); 13008 if (LastExpr.get() != nullptr) { 13009 if (!LastLabelStmt) 13010 Compound->setLastStmt(LastExpr.get()); 13011 else 13012 LastLabelStmt->setSubStmt(LastExpr.get()); 13013 StmtExprMayBindToTemp = true; 13014 } 13015 } 13016 } 13017 } 13018 13019 // FIXME: Check that expression type is complete/non-abstract; statement 13020 // expressions are not lvalues. 13021 Expr *ResStmtExpr = new (Context) StmtExpr(Compound, Ty, LPLoc, RPLoc); 13022 if (StmtExprMayBindToTemp) 13023 return MaybeBindToTemporary(ResStmtExpr); 13024 return ResStmtExpr; 13025 } 13026 13027 ExprResult Sema::BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc, 13028 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, 13029 ArrayRef<OffsetOfComponent> Components, 13030 SourceLocation RParenLoc) { 13031 QualType ArgTy = TInfo->getType(); 13032 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType(); 13033 SourceRange TypeRange = TInfo->getTypeLoc().getLocalSourceRange(); 13034 13035 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first 13036 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents 13037 // a struct/union/class. 13038 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType()) 13039 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type) 13040 << ArgTy << TypeRange); 13041 13042 // Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable 13043 // with an incomplete type would be ill-formed. 13044 if (!Dependent 13045 && RequireCompleteType(BuiltinLoc, ArgTy, 13046 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type, TypeRange)) 13047 return ExprError(); 13048 13049 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false; 13050 QualType CurrentType = ArgTy; 13051 SmallVector<OffsetOfNode, 4> Comps; 13052 SmallVector<Expr*, 4> Exprs; 13053 for (const OffsetOfComponent &OC : Components) { 13054 if (OC.isBrackets) { 13055 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements? 13056 if (!CurrentType->isDependentType()) { 13057 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(CurrentType); 13058 if(!AT) 13059 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type) 13060 << CurrentType); 13061 CurrentType = AT->getElementType(); 13062 } else 13063 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy; 13064 13065 ExprResult IdxRval = DefaultLvalueConversion(static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E)); 13066 if (IdxRval.isInvalid()) 13067 return ExprError(); 13068 Expr *Idx = IdxRval.get(); 13069 13070 // The expression must be an integral expression. 13071 // FIXME: An integral constant expression? 13072 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->isValueDependent() && 13073 !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType()) 13074 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(), 13075 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer) 13076 << Idx->getSourceRange()); 13077 13078 // Record this array index. 13079 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Exprs.size(), OC.LocEnd)); 13080 Exprs.push_back(Idx); 13081 continue; 13082 } 13083 13084 // Offset of a field. 13085 if (CurrentType->isDependentType()) { 13086 // We have the offset of a field, but we can't look into the dependent 13087 // type. Just record the identifier of the field. 13088 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocEnd)); 13089 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy; 13090 continue; 13091 } 13092 13093 // We need to have a complete type to look into. 13094 if (RequireCompleteType(OC.LocStart, CurrentType, 13095 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type)) 13096 return ExprError(); 13097 13098 // Look for the designated field. 13099 const RecordType *RC = CurrentType->getAs<RecordType>(); 13100 if (!RC) 13101 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type) 13102 << CurrentType); 13103 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl(); 13104 13105 // C++ [lib.support.types]p5: 13106 // The macro offsetof accepts a restricted set of type arguments in this 13107 // International Standard. type shall be a POD structure or a POD union 13108 // (clause 9). 13109 // C++11 [support.types]p4: 13110 // If type is not a standard-layout class (Clause 9), the results are 13111 // undefined. 13112 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) { 13113 bool IsSafe = LangOpts.CPlusPlus11? CRD->isStandardLayout() : CRD->isPOD(); 13114 unsigned DiagID = 13115 LangOpts.CPlusPlus11? diag::ext_offsetof_non_standardlayout_type 13116 : diag::ext_offsetof_non_pod_type; 13117 13118 if (!IsSafe && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD && 13119 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc, nullptr, 13120 PDiag(DiagID) 13121 << SourceRange(Components[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd) 13122 << CurrentType)) 13123 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true; 13124 } 13125 13126 // Look for the field. 13127 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName); 13128 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD); 13129 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>(); 13130 IndirectFieldDecl *IndirectMemberDecl = nullptr; 13131 if (!MemberDecl) { 13132 if ((IndirectMemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<IndirectFieldDecl>())) 13133 MemberDecl = IndirectMemberDecl->getAnonField(); 13134 } 13135 13136 if (!MemberDecl) 13137 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member) 13138 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart, 13139 OC.LocEnd)); 13140 13141 // C99 7.17p3: 13142 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.) 13143 // 13144 // We diagnose this as an error. 13145 if (MemberDecl->isBitField()) { 13146 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield) 13147 << MemberDecl->getDeclName() 13148 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc); 13149 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl); 13150 return ExprError(); 13151 } 13152 13153 RecordDecl *Parent = MemberDecl->getParent(); 13154 if (IndirectMemberDecl) 13155 Parent = cast<RecordDecl>(IndirectMemberDecl->getDeclContext()); 13156 13157 // If the member was found in a base class, introduce OffsetOfNodes for 13158 // the base class indirections. 13159 CXXBasePaths Paths; 13160 if (IsDerivedFrom(OC.LocStart, CurrentType, Context.getTypeDeclType(Parent), 13161 Paths)) { 13162 if (Paths.getDetectedVirtual()) { 13163 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_field_of_virtual_base) 13164 << MemberDecl->getDeclName() 13165 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc); 13166 return ExprError(); 13167 } 13168 13169 CXXBasePath &Path = Paths.front(); 13170 for (const CXXBasePathElement &B : Path) 13171 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(B.Base)); 13172 } 13173 13174 if (IndirectMemberDecl) { 13175 for (auto *FI : IndirectMemberDecl->chain()) { 13176 assert(isa<FieldDecl>(FI)); 13177 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, 13178 cast<FieldDecl>(FI), OC.LocEnd)); 13179 } 13180 } else 13181 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd)); 13182 13183 CurrentType = MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType(); 13184 } 13185 13186 return OffsetOfExpr::Create(Context, Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc, TInfo, 13187 Comps, Exprs, RParenLoc); 13188 } 13189 13190 ExprResult Sema::ActOnBuiltinOffsetOf(Scope *S, 13191 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc, 13192 SourceLocation TypeLoc, 13193 ParsedType ParsedArgTy, 13194 ArrayRef<OffsetOfComponent> Components, 13195 SourceLocation RParenLoc) { 13196 13197 TypeSourceInfo *ArgTInfo; 13198 QualType ArgTy = GetTypeFromParser(ParsedArgTy, &ArgTInfo); 13199 if (ArgTy.isNull()) 13200 return ExprError(); 13201 13202 if (!ArgTInfo) 13203 ArgTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ArgTy, TypeLoc); 13204 13205 return BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(BuiltinLoc, ArgTInfo, Components, RParenLoc); 13206 } 13207 13208 13209 ExprResult Sema::ActOnChooseExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc, 13210 Expr *CondExpr, 13211 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr, 13212 SourceLocation RPLoc) { 13213 assert((CondExpr && LHSExpr && RHSExpr) && "Missing type argument(s)"); 13214 13215 ExprValueKind VK = VK_RValue; 13216 ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary; 13217 QualType resType; 13218 bool ValueDependent = false; 13219 bool CondIsTrue = false; 13220 if (CondExpr->isTypeDependent() || CondExpr->isValueDependent()) { 13221 resType = Context.DependentTy; 13222 ValueDependent = true; 13223 } else { 13224 // The conditional expression is required to be a constant expression. 13225 llvm::APSInt condEval(32); 13226 ExprResult CondICE 13227 = VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(CondExpr, &condEval, 13228 diag::err_typecheck_choose_expr_requires_constant, false); 13229 if (CondICE.isInvalid()) 13230 return ExprError(); 13231 CondExpr = CondICE.get(); 13232 CondIsTrue = condEval.getZExtValue(); 13233 13234 // If the condition is > zero, then the AST type is the same as the LHSExpr. 13235 Expr *ActiveExpr = CondIsTrue ? LHSExpr : RHSExpr; 13236 13237 resType = ActiveExpr->getType(); 13238 ValueDependent = ActiveExpr->isValueDependent(); 13239 VK = ActiveExpr->getValueKind(); 13240 OK = ActiveExpr->getObjectKind(); 13241 } 13242 13243 return new (Context) 13244 ChooseExpr(BuiltinLoc, CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr, resType, VK, OK, RPLoc, 13245 CondIsTrue, resType->isDependentType(), ValueDependent); 13246 } 13247 13248 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 13249 // Clang Extensions. 13250 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 13251 13252 /// ActOnBlockStart - This callback is invoked when a block literal is started. 13253 void Sema::ActOnBlockStart(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) { 13254 BlockDecl *Block = BlockDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, CaretLoc); 13255 13256 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus) { 13257 Decl *ManglingContextDecl; 13258 if (MangleNumberingContext *MCtx = 13259 getCurrentMangleNumberContext(Block->getDeclContext(), 13260 ManglingContextDecl)) { 13261 unsigned ManglingNumber = MCtx->getManglingNumber(Block); 13262 Block->setBlockMangling(ManglingNumber, ManglingContextDecl); 13263 } 13264 } 13265 13266 PushBlockScope(CurScope, Block); 13267 CurContext->addDecl(Block); 13268 if (CurScope) 13269 PushDeclContext(CurScope, Block); 13270 else 13271 CurContext = Block; 13272 13273 getCurBlock()->HasImplicitReturnType = true; 13274 13275 // Enter a new evaluation context to insulate the block from any 13276 // cleanups from the enclosing full-expression. 13277 PushExpressionEvaluationContext( 13278 ExpressionEvaluationContext::PotentiallyEvaluated); 13279 } 13280 13281 void Sema::ActOnBlockArguments(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Declarator &ParamInfo, 13282 Scope *CurScope) { 13283 assert(ParamInfo.getIdentifier() == nullptr && 13284 "block-id should have no identifier!"); 13285 assert(ParamInfo.getContext() == DeclaratorContext::BlockLiteralContext); 13286 BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock = getCurBlock(); 13287 13288 TypeSourceInfo *Sig = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope); 13289 QualType T = Sig->getType(); 13290 13291 // FIXME: We should allow unexpanded parameter packs here, but that would, 13292 // in turn, make the block expression contain unexpanded parameter packs. 13293 if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(CaretLoc, Sig, UPPC_Block)) { 13294 // Drop the parameters. 13295 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI; 13296 EPI.HasTrailingReturn = false; 13297 EPI.TypeQuals |= DeclSpec::TQ_const; 13298 T = Context.getFunctionType(Context.DependentTy, None, EPI); 13299 Sig = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T); 13300 } 13301 13302 // GetTypeForDeclarator always produces a function type for a block 13303 // literal signature. Furthermore, it is always a FunctionProtoType 13304 // unless the function was written with a typedef. 13305 assert(T->isFunctionType() && 13306 "GetTypeForDeclarator made a non-function block signature"); 13307 13308 // Look for an explicit signature in that function type. 13309 FunctionProtoTypeLoc ExplicitSignature; 13310 13311 if ((ExplicitSignature = 13312 Sig->getTypeLoc().getAsAdjusted<FunctionProtoTypeLoc>())) { 13313 13314 // Check whether that explicit signature was synthesized by 13315 // GetTypeForDeclarator. If so, don't save that as part of the 13316 // written signature. 13317 if (ExplicitSignature.getLocalRangeBegin() == 13318 ExplicitSignature.getLocalRangeEnd()) { 13319 // This would be much cheaper if we stored TypeLocs instead of 13320 // TypeSourceInfos. 13321 TypeLoc Result = ExplicitSignature.getReturnLoc(); 13322 unsigned Size = Result.getFullDataSize(); 13323 Sig = Context.CreateTypeSourceInfo(Result.getType(), Size); 13324 Sig->getTypeLoc().initializeFullCopy(Result, Size); 13325 13326 ExplicitSignature = FunctionProtoTypeLoc(); 13327 } 13328 } 13329 13330 CurBlock->TheDecl->setSignatureAsWritten(Sig); 13331 CurBlock->FunctionType = T; 13332 13333 const FunctionType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionType>(); 13334 QualType RetTy = Fn->getReturnType(); 13335 bool isVariadic = 13336 (isa<FunctionProtoType>(Fn) && cast<FunctionProtoType>(Fn)->isVariadic()); 13337 13338 CurBlock->TheDecl->setIsVariadic(isVariadic); 13339 13340 // Context.DependentTy is used as a placeholder for a missing block 13341 // return type. TODO: what should we do with declarators like: 13342 // ^ * { ... } 13343 // If the answer is "apply template argument deduction".... 13344 if (RetTy != Context.DependentTy) { 13345 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy; 13346 CurBlock->TheDecl->setBlockMissingReturnType(false); 13347 CurBlock->HasImplicitReturnType = false; 13348 } 13349 13350 // Push block parameters from the declarator if we had them. 13351 SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 8> Params; 13352 if (ExplicitSignature) { 13353 for (unsigned I = 0, E = ExplicitSignature.getNumParams(); I != E; ++I) { 13354 ParmVarDecl *Param = ExplicitSignature.getParam(I); 13355 if (Param->getIdentifier() == nullptr && 13356 !Param->isImplicit() && 13357 !Param->isInvalidDecl() && 13358 !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 13359 Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_parameter_name_omitted); 13360 Params.push_back(Param); 13361 } 13362 13363 // Fake up parameter variables if we have a typedef, like 13364 // ^ fntype { ... } 13365 } else if (const FunctionProtoType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) { 13366 for (const auto &I : Fn->param_types()) { 13367 ParmVarDecl *Param = BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef( 13368 CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo.getLocStart(), I); 13369 Params.push_back(Param); 13370 } 13371 } 13372 13373 // Set the parameters on the block decl. 13374 if (!Params.empty()) { 13375 CurBlock->TheDecl->setParams(Params); 13376 CheckParmsForFunctionDef(CurBlock->TheDecl->parameters(), 13377 /*CheckParameterNames=*/false); 13378 } 13379 13380 // Finally we can process decl attributes. 13381 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo); 13382 13383 // Put the parameter variables in scope. 13384 for (auto AI : CurBlock->TheDecl->parameters()) { 13385 AI->setOwningFunction(CurBlock->TheDecl); 13386 13387 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack. 13388 if (AI->getIdentifier()) { 13389 CheckShadow(CurBlock->TheScope, AI); 13390 13391 PushOnScopeChains(AI, CurBlock->TheScope); 13392 } 13393 } 13394 } 13395 13396 /// ActOnBlockError - If there is an error parsing a block, this callback 13397 /// is invoked to pop the information about the block from the action impl. 13398 void Sema::ActOnBlockError(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) { 13399 // Leave the expression-evaluation context. 13400 DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext(); 13401 PopExpressionEvaluationContext(); 13402 13403 // Pop off CurBlock, handle nested blocks. 13404 PopDeclContext(); 13405 PopFunctionScopeInfo(); 13406 } 13407 13408 /// ActOnBlockStmtExpr - This is called when the body of a block statement 13409 /// literal was successfully completed. ^(int x){...} 13410 ExprResult Sema::ActOnBlockStmtExpr(SourceLocation CaretLoc, 13411 Stmt *Body, Scope *CurScope) { 13412 // If blocks are disabled, emit an error. 13413 if (!LangOpts.Blocks) 13414 Diag(CaretLoc, diag::err_blocks_disable) << LangOpts.OpenCL; 13415 13416 // Leave the expression-evaluation context. 13417 if (hasAnyUnrecoverableErrorsInThisFunction()) 13418 DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext(); 13419 assert(!Cleanup.exprNeedsCleanups() && 13420 "cleanups within block not correctly bound!"); 13421 PopExpressionEvaluationContext(); 13422 13423 BlockScopeInfo *BSI = cast<BlockScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes.back()); 13424 13425 if (BSI->HasImplicitReturnType) 13426 deduceClosureReturnType(*BSI); 13427 13428 PopDeclContext(); 13429 13430 QualType RetTy = Context.VoidTy; 13431 if (!BSI->ReturnType.isNull()) 13432 RetTy = BSI->ReturnType; 13433 13434 bool NoReturn = BSI->TheDecl->hasAttr<NoReturnAttr>(); 13435 QualType BlockTy; 13436 13437 // Set the captured variables on the block. 13438 // FIXME: Share capture structure between BlockDecl and CapturingScopeInfo! 13439 SmallVector<BlockDecl::Capture, 4> Captures; 13440 for (Capture &Cap : BSI->Captures) { 13441 if (Cap.isThisCapture()) 13442 continue; 13443 BlockDecl::Capture NewCap(Cap.getVariable(), Cap.isBlockCapture(), 13444 Cap.isNested(), Cap.getInitExpr()); 13445 Captures.push_back(NewCap); 13446 } 13447 BSI->TheDecl->setCaptures(Context, Captures, BSI->CXXThisCaptureIndex != 0); 13448 13449 // If the user wrote a function type in some form, try to use that. 13450 if (!BSI->FunctionType.isNull()) { 13451 const FunctionType *FTy = BSI->FunctionType->getAs<FunctionType>(); 13452 13453 FunctionType::ExtInfo Ext = FTy->getExtInfo(); 13454 if (NoReturn && !Ext.getNoReturn()) Ext = Ext.withNoReturn(true); 13455 13456 // Turn protoless block types into nullary block types. 13457 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FTy)) { 13458 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI; 13459 EPI.ExtInfo = Ext; 13460 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, None, EPI); 13461 13462 // Otherwise, if we don't need to change anything about the function type, 13463 // preserve its sugar structure. 13464 } else if (FTy->getReturnType() == RetTy && 13465 (!NoReturn || FTy->getNoReturnAttr())) { 13466 BlockTy = BSI->FunctionType; 13467 13468 // Otherwise, make the minimal modifications to the function type. 13469 } else { 13470 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(FTy); 13471 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo(); 13472 EPI.TypeQuals = 0; // FIXME: silently? 13473 EPI.ExtInfo = Ext; 13474 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI); 13475 } 13476 13477 // If we don't have a function type, just build one from nothing. 13478 } else { 13479 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI; 13480 EPI.ExtInfo = FunctionType::ExtInfo().withNoReturn(NoReturn); 13481 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, None, EPI); 13482 } 13483 13484 DiagnoseUnusedParameters(BSI->TheDecl->parameters()); 13485 BlockTy = Context.getBlockPointerType(BlockTy); 13486 13487 // If needed, diagnose invalid gotos and switches in the block. 13488 if (getCurFunction()->NeedsScopeChecking() && 13489 !PP.isCodeCompletionEnabled()) 13490 DiagnoseInvalidJumps(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body)); 13491 13492 BSI->TheDecl->setBody(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body)); 13493 13494 if (Body && getCurFunction()->HasPotentialAvailabilityViolations) 13495 DiagnoseUnguardedAvailabilityViolations(BSI->TheDecl); 13496 13497 // Try to apply the named return value optimization. We have to check again 13498 // if we can do this, though, because blocks keep return statements around 13499 // to deduce an implicit return type. 13500 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && RetTy->isRecordType() && 13501 !BSI->TheDecl->isDependentContext()) 13502 computeNRVO(Body, BSI); 13503 13504 BlockExpr *Result = new (Context) BlockExpr(BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy); 13505 AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy WP = AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy(); 13506 PopFunctionScopeInfo(&WP, Result->getBlockDecl(), Result); 13507 13508 // If the block isn't obviously global, i.e. it captures anything at 13509 // all, then we need to do a few things in the surrounding context: 13510 if (Result->getBlockDecl()->hasCaptures()) { 13511 // First, this expression has a new cleanup object. 13512 ExprCleanupObjects.push_back(Result->getBlockDecl()); 13513 Cleanup.setExprNeedsCleanups(true); 13514 13515 // It also gets a branch-protected scope if any of the captured 13516 // variables needs destruction. 13517 for (const auto &CI : Result->getBlockDecl()->captures()) { 13518 const VarDecl *var = CI.getVariable(); 13519 if (var->getType().isDestructedType() != QualType::DK_none) { 13520 setFunctionHasBranchProtectedScope(); 13521 break; 13522 } 13523 } 13524 } 13525 13526 return Result; 13527 } 13528 13529 ExprResult Sema::ActOnVAArg(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc, Expr *E, ParsedType Ty, 13530 SourceLocation RPLoc) { 13531 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo; 13532 GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo); 13533 return BuildVAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, TInfo, RPLoc); 13534 } 13535 13536 ExprResult Sema::BuildVAArgExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc, 13537 Expr *E, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, 13538 SourceLocation RPLoc) { 13539 Expr *OrigExpr = E; 13540 bool IsMS = false; 13541 13542 // CUDA device code does not support varargs. 13543 if (getLangOpts().CUDA && getLangOpts().CUDAIsDevice) { 13544 if (const FunctionDecl *F = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CurContext)) { 13545 CUDAFunctionTarget T = IdentifyCUDATarget(F); 13546 if (T == CFT_Global || T == CFT_Device || T == CFT_HostDevice) 13547 return ExprError(Diag(E->getLocStart(), diag::err_va_arg_in_device)); 13548 } 13549 } 13550 13551 // It might be a __builtin_ms_va_list. (But don't ever mark a va_arg() 13552 // as Microsoft ABI on an actual Microsoft platform, where 13553 // __builtin_ms_va_list and __builtin_va_list are the same.) 13554 if (!E->isTypeDependent() && Context.getTargetInfo().hasBuiltinMSVaList() && 13555 Context.getTargetInfo().getBuiltinVaListKind() != TargetInfo::CharPtrBuiltinVaList) { 13556 QualType MSVaListType = Context.getBuiltinMSVaListType(); 13557 if (Context.hasSameType(MSVaListType, E->getType())) { 13558 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this)) 13559 return ExprError(); 13560 IsMS = true; 13561 } 13562 } 13563 13564 // Get the va_list type 13565 QualType VaListType = Context.getBuiltinVaListType(); 13566 if (!IsMS) { 13567 if (VaListType->isArrayType()) { 13568 // Deal with implicit array decay; for example, on x86-64, 13569 // va_list is an array, but it's supposed to decay to 13570 // a pointer for va_arg. 13571 VaListType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(VaListType); 13572 // Make sure the input expression also decays appropriately. 13573 ExprResult Result = UsualUnaryConversions(E); 13574 if (Result.isInvalid()) 13575 return ExprError(); 13576 E = Result.get(); 13577 } else if (VaListType->isRecordType() && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 13578 // If va_list is a record type and we are compiling in C++ mode, 13579 // check the argument using reference binding. 13580 InitializedEntity Entity = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter( 13581 Context, Context.getLValueReferenceType(VaListType), false); 13582 ExprResult Init = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity, SourceLocation(), E); 13583 if (Init.isInvalid()) 13584 return ExprError(); 13585 E = Init.getAs<Expr>(); 13586 } else { 13587 // Otherwise, the va_list argument must be an l-value because 13588 // it is modified by va_arg. 13589 if (!E->isTypeDependent() && 13590 CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this)) 13591 return ExprError(); 13592 } 13593 } 13594 13595 if (!IsMS && !E->isTypeDependent() && 13596 !Context.hasSameType(VaListType, E->getType())) 13597 return ExprError(Diag(E->getLocStart(), 13598 diag::err_first_argument_to_va_arg_not_of_type_va_list) 13599 << OrigExpr->getType() << E->getSourceRange()); 13600 13601 if (!TInfo->getType()->isDependentType()) { 13602 if (RequireCompleteType(TInfo->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), TInfo->getType(), 13603 diag::err_second_parameter_to_va_arg_incomplete, 13604 TInfo->getTypeLoc())) 13605 return ExprError(); 13606 13607 if (RequireNonAbstractType(TInfo->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), 13608 TInfo->getType(), 13609 diag::err_second_parameter_to_va_arg_abstract, 13610 TInfo->getTypeLoc())) 13611 return ExprError(); 13612 13613 if (!TInfo->getType().isPODType(Context)) { 13614 Diag(TInfo->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), 13615 TInfo->getType()->isObjCLifetimeType() 13616 ? diag::warn_second_parameter_to_va_arg_ownership_qualified 13617 : diag::warn_second_parameter_to_va_arg_not_pod) 13618 << TInfo->getType() 13619 << TInfo->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange(); 13620 } 13621 13622 // Check for va_arg where arguments of the given type will be promoted 13623 // (i.e. this va_arg is guaranteed to have undefined behavior). 13624 QualType PromoteType; 13625 if (TInfo->getType()->isPromotableIntegerType()) { 13626 PromoteType = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(TInfo->getType()); 13627 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(PromoteType, TInfo->getType())) 13628 PromoteType = QualType(); 13629 } 13630 if (TInfo->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float)) 13631 PromoteType = Context.DoubleTy; 13632 if (!PromoteType.isNull()) 13633 DiagRuntimeBehavior(TInfo->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), E, 13634 PDiag(diag::warn_second_parameter_to_va_arg_never_compatible) 13635 << TInfo->getType() 13636 << PromoteType 13637 << TInfo->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange()); 13638 } 13639 13640 QualType T = TInfo->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context); 13641 return new (Context) VAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, TInfo, RPLoc, T, IsMS); 13642 } 13643 13644 ExprResult Sema::ActOnGNUNullExpr(SourceLocation TokenLoc) { 13645 // The type of __null will be int or long, depending on the size of 13646 // pointers on the target. 13647 QualType Ty; 13648 unsigned pw = Context.getTargetInfo().getPointerWidth(0); 13649 if (pw == Context.getTargetInfo().getIntWidth()) 13650 Ty = Context.IntTy; 13651 else if (pw == Context.getTargetInfo().getLongWidth()) 13652 Ty = Context.LongTy; 13653 else if (pw == Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth()) 13654 Ty = Context.LongLongTy; 13655 else { 13656 llvm_unreachable("I don't know size of pointer!"); 13657 } 13658 13659 return new (Context) GNUNullExpr(Ty, TokenLoc); 13660 } 13661 13662 bool Sema::ConversionToObjCStringLiteralCheck(QualType DstType, Expr *&Exp, 13663 bool Diagnose) { 13664 if (!getLangOpts().ObjC1) 13665 return false; 13666 13667 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PT = DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 13668 if (!PT) 13669 return false; 13670 13671 if (!PT->isObjCIdType()) { 13672 // Check if the destination is the 'NSString' interface. 13673 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = PT->getInterfaceDecl(); 13674 if (!ID || !ID->getIdentifier()->isStr("NSString")) 13675 return false; 13676 } 13677 13678 // Ignore any parens, implicit casts (should only be 13679 // array-to-pointer decays), and not-so-opaque values. The last is 13680 // important for making this trigger for property assignments. 13681 Expr *SrcExpr = Exp->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 13682 if (OpaqueValueExpr *OV = dyn_cast<OpaqueValueExpr>(SrcExpr)) 13683 if (OV->getSourceExpr()) 13684 SrcExpr = OV->getSourceExpr()->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 13685 13686 StringLiteral *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(SrcExpr); 13687 if (!SL || !SL->isAscii()) 13688 return false; 13689 if (Diagnose) { 13690 Diag(SL->getLocStart(), diag::err_missing_atsign_prefix) 13691 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SL->getLocStart(), "@"); 13692 Exp = BuildObjCStringLiteral(SL->getLocStart(), SL).get(); 13693 } 13694 return true; 13695 } 13696 13697 static bool maybeDiagnoseAssignmentToFunction(Sema &S, QualType DstType, 13698 const Expr *SrcExpr) { 13699 if (!DstType->isFunctionPointerType() || 13700 !SrcExpr->getType()->isFunctionType()) 13701 return false; 13702 13703 auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(SrcExpr->IgnoreParenImpCasts()); 13704 if (!DRE) 13705 return false; 13706 13707 auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DRE->getDecl()); 13708 if (!FD) 13709 return false; 13710 13711 return !S.checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(FD, 13712 /*Complain=*/true, 13713 SrcExpr->getLocStart()); 13714 } 13715 13716 bool Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentResult(AssignConvertType ConvTy, 13717 SourceLocation Loc, 13718 QualType DstType, QualType SrcType, 13719 Expr *SrcExpr, AssignmentAction Action, 13720 bool *Complained) { 13721 if (Complained) 13722 *Complained = false; 13723 13724 // Decode the result (notice that AST's are still created for extensions). 13725 bool CheckInferredResultType = false; 13726 bool isInvalid = false; 13727 unsigned DiagKind = 0; 13728 FixItHint Hint; 13729 ConversionFixItGenerator ConvHints; 13730 bool MayHaveConvFixit = false; 13731 bool MayHaveFunctionDiff = false; 13732 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = nullptr; 13733 const ObjCProtocolDecl *PDecl = nullptr; 13734 13735 switch (ConvTy) { 13736 case Compatible: 13737 DiagnoseAssignmentEnum(DstType, SrcType, SrcExpr); 13738 return false; 13739 13740 case PointerToInt: 13741 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_int; 13742 ConvHints.tryToFixConversion(SrcExpr, SrcType, DstType, *this); 13743 MayHaveConvFixit = true; 13744 break; 13745 case IntToPointer: 13746 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_int_pointer; 13747 ConvHints.tryToFixConversion(SrcExpr, SrcType, DstType, *this); 13748 MayHaveConvFixit = true; 13749 break; 13750 case IncompatiblePointer: 13751 if (Action == AA_Passing_CFAudited) 13752 DiagKind = diag::err_arc_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer; 13753 else if (SrcType->isFunctionPointerType() && 13754 DstType->isFunctionPointerType()) 13755 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_function_pointer; 13756 else 13757 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer; 13758 13759 CheckInferredResultType = DstType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && 13760 SrcType->isObjCObjectPointerType(); 13761 if (Hint.isNull() && !CheckInferredResultType) { 13762 ConvHints.tryToFixConversion(SrcExpr, SrcType, DstType, *this); 13763 } 13764 else if (CheckInferredResultType) { 13765 SrcType = SrcType.getUnqualifiedType(); 13766 DstType = DstType.getUnqualifiedType(); 13767 } 13768 MayHaveConvFixit = true; 13769 break; 13770 case IncompatiblePointerSign: 13771 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer_sign; 13772 break; 13773 case FunctionVoidPointer: 13774 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_void_func; 13775 break; 13776 case IncompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers: { 13777 // Perform array-to-pointer decay if necessary. 13778 if (SrcType->isArrayType()) SrcType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(SrcType); 13779 13780 Qualifiers lhq = SrcType->getPointeeType().getQualifiers(); 13781 Qualifiers rhq = DstType->getPointeeType().getQualifiers(); 13782 if (lhq.getAddressSpace() != rhq.getAddressSpace()) { 13783 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_incompatible_address_space; 13784 break; 13785 13786 } else if (lhq.getObjCLifetime() != rhq.getObjCLifetime()) { 13787 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_incompatible_ownership; 13788 break; 13789 } 13790 13791 llvm_unreachable("unknown error case for discarding qualifiers!"); 13792 // fallthrough 13793 } 13794 case CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers: 13795 // If the qualifiers lost were because we were applying the 13796 // (deprecated) C++ conversion from a string literal to a char* 13797 // (or wchar_t*), then there was no error (C++ 4.2p2). FIXME: 13798 // Ideally, this check would be performed in 13799 // checkPointerTypesForAssignment. However, that would require a 13800 // bit of refactoring (so that the second argument is an 13801 // expression, rather than a type), which should be done as part 13802 // of a larger effort to fix checkPointerTypesForAssignment for 13803 // C++ semantics. 13804 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 13805 IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(SrcExpr, DstType)) 13806 return false; 13807 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_discards_qualifiers; 13808 break; 13809 case IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers: 13810 DiagKind = diag::ext_nested_pointer_qualifier_mismatch; 13811 break; 13812 case IntToBlockPointer: 13813 DiagKind = diag::err_int_to_block_pointer; 13814 break; 13815 case IncompatibleBlockPointer: 13816 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible_block_pointer; 13817 break; 13818 case IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId: { 13819 if (SrcType->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) { 13820 const ObjCObjectPointerType *srcOPT = 13821 SrcType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 13822 for (auto *srcProto : srcOPT->quals()) { 13823 PDecl = srcProto; 13824 break; 13825 } 13826 if (const ObjCInterfaceType *IFaceT = 13827 DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getInterfaceType()) 13828 IFace = IFaceT->getDecl(); 13829 } 13830 else if (DstType->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) { 13831 const ObjCObjectPointerType *dstOPT = 13832 DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 13833 for (auto *dstProto : dstOPT->quals()) { 13834 PDecl = dstProto; 13835 break; 13836 } 13837 if (const ObjCInterfaceType *IFaceT = 13838 SrcType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getInterfaceType()) 13839 IFace = IFaceT->getDecl(); 13840 } 13841 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id; 13842 break; 13843 } 13844 case IncompatibleVectors: 13845 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_vectors; 13846 break; 13847 case IncompatibleObjCWeakRef: 13848 DiagKind = diag::err_arc_weak_unavailable_assign; 13849 break; 13850 case Incompatible: 13851 if (maybeDiagnoseAssignmentToFunction(*this, DstType, SrcExpr)) { 13852 if (Complained) 13853 *Complained = true; 13854 return true; 13855 } 13856 13857 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible; 13858 ConvHints.tryToFixConversion(SrcExpr, SrcType, DstType, *this); 13859 MayHaveConvFixit = true; 13860 isInvalid = true; 13861 MayHaveFunctionDiff = true; 13862 break; 13863 } 13864 13865 QualType FirstType, SecondType; 13866 switch (Action) { 13867 case AA_Assigning: 13868 case AA_Initializing: 13869 // The destination type comes first. 13870 FirstType = DstType; 13871 SecondType = SrcType; 13872 break; 13873 13874 case AA_Returning: 13875 case AA_Passing: 13876 case AA_Passing_CFAudited: 13877 case AA_Converting: 13878 case AA_Sending: 13879 case AA_Casting: 13880 // The source type comes first. 13881 FirstType = SrcType; 13882 SecondType = DstType; 13883 break; 13884 } 13885 13886 PartialDiagnostic FDiag = PDiag(DiagKind); 13887 if (Action == AA_Passing_CFAudited) 13888 FDiag << FirstType << SecondType << AA_Passing << SrcExpr->getSourceRange(); 13889 else 13890 FDiag << FirstType << SecondType << Action << SrcExpr->getSourceRange(); 13891 13892 // If we can fix the conversion, suggest the FixIts. 13893 assert(ConvHints.isNull() || Hint.isNull()); 13894 if (!ConvHints.isNull()) { 13895 for (FixItHint &H : ConvHints.Hints) 13896 FDiag << H; 13897 } else { 13898 FDiag << Hint; 13899 } 13900 if (MayHaveConvFixit) { FDiag << (unsigned) (ConvHints.Kind); } 13901 13902 if (MayHaveFunctionDiff) 13903 HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(FDiag, SecondType, FirstType); 13904 13905 Diag(Loc, FDiag); 13906 if (DiagKind == diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id && 13907 PDecl && IFace && !IFace->hasDefinition()) 13908 Diag(IFace->getLocation(), diag::note_incomplete_class_and_qualified_id) 13909 << IFace << PDecl; 13910 13911 if (SecondType == Context.OverloadTy) 13912 NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OverloadExpr::find(SrcExpr).Expression, 13913 FirstType, /*TakingAddress=*/true); 13914 13915 if (CheckInferredResultType) 13916 EmitRelatedResultTypeNote(SrcExpr); 13917 13918 if (Action == AA_Returning && ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer) 13919 EmitRelatedResultTypeNoteForReturn(DstType); 13920 13921 if (Complained) 13922 *Complained = true; 13923 return isInvalid; 13924 } 13925 13926 ExprResult Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(Expr *E, 13927 llvm::APSInt *Result) { 13928 class SimpleICEDiagnoser : public VerifyICEDiagnoser { 13929 public: 13930 void diagnoseNotICE(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, SourceRange SR) override { 13931 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_expr_not_ice) << S.LangOpts.CPlusPlus << SR; 13932 } 13933 } Diagnoser; 13934 13935 return VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(E, Result, Diagnoser); 13936 } 13937 13938 ExprResult Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(Expr *E, 13939 llvm::APSInt *Result, 13940 unsigned DiagID, 13941 bool AllowFold) { 13942 class IDDiagnoser : public VerifyICEDiagnoser { 13943 unsigned DiagID; 13944 13945 public: 13946 IDDiagnoser(unsigned DiagID) 13947 : VerifyICEDiagnoser(DiagID == 0), DiagID(DiagID) { } 13948 13949 void diagnoseNotICE(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, SourceRange SR) override { 13950 S.Diag(Loc, DiagID) << SR; 13951 } 13952 } Diagnoser(DiagID); 13953 13954 return VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(E, Result, Diagnoser, AllowFold); 13955 } 13956 13957 void Sema::VerifyICEDiagnoser::diagnoseFold(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 13958 SourceRange SR) { 13959 S.Diag(Loc, diag::ext_expr_not_ice) << SR << S.LangOpts.CPlusPlus; 13960 } 13961 13962 ExprResult 13963 Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(Expr *E, llvm::APSInt *Result, 13964 VerifyICEDiagnoser &Diagnoser, 13965 bool AllowFold) { 13966 SourceLocation DiagLoc = E->getLocStart(); 13967 13968 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) { 13969 // C++11 [expr.const]p5: 13970 // If an expression of literal class type is used in a context where an 13971 // integral constant expression is required, then that class type shall 13972 // have a single non-explicit conversion function to an integral or 13973 // unscoped enumeration type 13974 ExprResult Converted; 13975 class CXX11ConvertDiagnoser : public ICEConvertDiagnoser { 13976 public: 13977 CXX11ConvertDiagnoser(bool Silent) 13978 : ICEConvertDiagnoser(/*AllowScopedEnumerations*/false, 13979 Silent, true) {} 13980 13981 SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseNotInt(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 13982 QualType T) override { 13983 return S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ice_not_integral) << T; 13984 } 13985 13986 SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseIncomplete( 13987 Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) override { 13988 return S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ice_incomplete_type) << T; 13989 } 13990 13991 SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseExplicitConv( 13992 Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T, QualType ConvTy) override { 13993 return S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ice_explicit_conversion) << T << ConvTy; 13994 } 13995 13996 SemaDiagnosticBuilder noteExplicitConv( 13997 Sema &S, CXXConversionDecl *Conv, QualType ConvTy) override { 13998 return S.Diag(Conv->getLocation(), diag::note_ice_conversion_here) 13999 << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy; 14000 } 14001 14002 SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseAmbiguous( 14003 Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) override { 14004 return S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ice_ambiguous_conversion) << T; 14005 } 14006 14007 SemaDiagnosticBuilder noteAmbiguous( 14008 Sema &S, CXXConversionDecl *Conv, QualType ConvTy) override { 14009 return S.Diag(Conv->getLocation(), diag::note_ice_conversion_here) 14010 << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy; 14011 } 14012 14013 SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseConversion( 14014 Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T, QualType ConvTy) override { 14015 llvm_unreachable("conversion functions are permitted"); 14016 } 14017 } ConvertDiagnoser(Diagnoser.Suppress); 14018 14019 Converted = PerformContextualImplicitConversion(DiagLoc, E, 14020 ConvertDiagnoser); 14021 if (Converted.isInvalid()) 14022 return Converted; 14023 E = Converted.get(); 14024 if (!E->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()) 14025 return ExprError(); 14026 } else if (!E->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()) { 14027 // An ICE must be of integral or unscoped enumeration type. 14028 if (!Diagnoser.Suppress) 14029 Diagnoser.diagnoseNotICE(*this, DiagLoc, E->getSourceRange()); 14030 return ExprError(); 14031 } 14032 14033 // Circumvent ICE checking in C++11 to avoid evaluating the expression twice 14034 // in the non-ICE case. 14035 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && E->isIntegerConstantExpr(Context)) { 14036 if (Result) 14037 *Result = E->EvaluateKnownConstInt(Context); 14038 return E; 14039 } 14040 14041 Expr::EvalResult EvalResult; 14042 SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 8> Notes; 14043 EvalResult.Diag = &Notes; 14044 14045 // Try to evaluate the expression, and produce diagnostics explaining why it's 14046 // not a constant expression as a side-effect. 14047 bool Folded = E->EvaluateAsRValue(EvalResult, Context) && 14048 EvalResult.Val.isInt() && !EvalResult.HasSideEffects; 14049 14050 // In C++11, we can rely on diagnostics being produced for any expression 14051 // which is not a constant expression. If no diagnostics were produced, then 14052 // this is a constant expression. 14053 if (Folded && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && Notes.empty()) { 14054 if (Result) 14055 *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt(); 14056 return E; 14057 } 14058 14059 // If our only note is the usual "invalid subexpression" note, just point 14060 // the caret at its location rather than producing an essentially 14061 // redundant note. 14062 if (Notes.size() == 1 && Notes[0].second.getDiagID() == 14063 diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_const_expr) { 14064 DiagLoc = Notes[0].first; 14065 Notes.clear(); 14066 } 14067 14068 if (!Folded || !AllowFold) { 14069 if (!Diagnoser.Suppress) { 14070 Diagnoser.diagnoseNotICE(*this, DiagLoc, E->getSourceRange()); 14071 for (const PartialDiagnosticAt &Note : Notes) 14072 Diag(Note.first, Note.second); 14073 } 14074 14075 return ExprError(); 14076 } 14077 14078 Diagnoser.diagnoseFold(*this, DiagLoc, E->getSourceRange()); 14079 for (const PartialDiagnosticAt &Note : Notes) 14080 Diag(Note.first, Note.second); 14081 14082 if (Result) 14083 *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt(); 14084 return E; 14085 } 14086 14087 namespace { 14088 // Handle the case where we conclude a expression which we speculatively 14089 // considered to be unevaluated is actually evaluated. 14090 class TransformToPE : public TreeTransform<TransformToPE> { 14091 typedef TreeTransform<TransformToPE> BaseTransform; 14092 14093 public: 14094 TransformToPE(Sema &SemaRef) : BaseTransform(SemaRef) { } 14095 14096 // Make sure we redo semantic analysis 14097 bool AlwaysRebuild() { return true; } 14098 14099 // Make sure we handle LabelStmts correctly. 14100 // FIXME: This does the right thing, but maybe we need a more general 14101 // fix to TreeTransform? 14102 StmtResult TransformLabelStmt(LabelStmt *S) { 14103 S->getDecl()->setStmt(nullptr); 14104 return BaseTransform::TransformLabelStmt(S); 14105 } 14106 14107 // We need to special-case DeclRefExprs referring to FieldDecls which 14108 // are not part of a member pointer formation; normal TreeTransforming 14109 // doesn't catch this case because of the way we represent them in the AST. 14110 // FIXME: This is a bit ugly; is it really the best way to handle this 14111 // case? 14112 // 14113 // Error on DeclRefExprs referring to FieldDecls. 14114 ExprResult TransformDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) { 14115 if (isa<FieldDecl>(E->getDecl()) && 14116 !SemaRef.isUnevaluatedContext()) 14117 return SemaRef.Diag(E->getLocation(), 14118 diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use) 14119 << E->getDecl() << E->getSourceRange(); 14120 14121 return BaseTransform::TransformDeclRefExpr(E); 14122 } 14123 14124 // Exception: filter out member pointer formation 14125 ExprResult TransformUnaryOperator(UnaryOperator *E) { 14126 if (E->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf && E->getType()->isMemberPointerType()) 14127 return E; 14128 14129 return BaseTransform::TransformUnaryOperator(E); 14130 } 14131 14132 ExprResult TransformLambdaExpr(LambdaExpr *E) { 14133 // Lambdas never need to be transformed. 14134 return E; 14135 } 14136 }; 14137 } 14138 14139 ExprResult Sema::TransformToPotentiallyEvaluated(Expr *E) { 14140 assert(isUnevaluatedContext() && 14141 "Should only transform unevaluated expressions"); 14142 ExprEvalContexts.back().Context = 14143 ExprEvalContexts[ExprEvalContexts.size()-2].Context; 14144 if (isUnevaluatedContext()) 14145 return E; 14146 return TransformToPE(*this).TransformExpr(E); 14147 } 14148 14149 void 14150 Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext( 14151 ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext, Decl *LambdaContextDecl, 14152 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord::ExpressionKind ExprContext) { 14153 ExprEvalContexts.emplace_back(NewContext, ExprCleanupObjects.size(), Cleanup, 14154 LambdaContextDecl, ExprContext); 14155 Cleanup.reset(); 14156 if (!MaybeODRUseExprs.empty()) 14157 std::swap(MaybeODRUseExprs, ExprEvalContexts.back().SavedMaybeODRUseExprs); 14158 } 14159 14160 void 14161 Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext( 14162 ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext, ReuseLambdaContextDecl_t, 14163 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord::ExpressionKind ExprContext) { 14164 Decl *ClosureContextDecl = ExprEvalContexts.back().ManglingContextDecl; 14165 PushExpressionEvaluationContext(NewContext, ClosureContextDecl, ExprContext); 14166 } 14167 14168 void Sema::PopExpressionEvaluationContext() { 14169 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord& Rec = ExprEvalContexts.back(); 14170 unsigned NumTypos = Rec.NumTypos; 14171 14172 if (!Rec.Lambdas.empty()) { 14173 using ExpressionKind = ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord::ExpressionKind; 14174 if (Rec.ExprContext == ExpressionKind::EK_TemplateArgument || Rec.isUnevaluated() || 14175 (Rec.isConstantEvaluated() && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17)) { 14176 unsigned D; 14177 if (Rec.isUnevaluated()) { 14178 // C++11 [expr.prim.lambda]p2: 14179 // A lambda-expression shall not appear in an unevaluated operand 14180 // (Clause 5). 14181 D = diag::err_lambda_unevaluated_operand; 14182 } else if (Rec.isConstantEvaluated() && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17) { 14183 // C++1y [expr.const]p2: 14184 // A conditional-expression e is a core constant expression unless the 14185 // evaluation of e, following the rules of the abstract machine, would 14186 // evaluate [...] a lambda-expression. 14187 D = diag::err_lambda_in_constant_expression; 14188 } else if (Rec.ExprContext == ExpressionKind::EK_TemplateArgument) { 14189 // C++17 [expr.prim.lamda]p2: 14190 // A lambda-expression shall not appear [...] in a template-argument. 14191 D = diag::err_lambda_in_invalid_context; 14192 } else 14193 llvm_unreachable("Couldn't infer lambda error message."); 14194 14195 for (const auto *L : Rec.Lambdas) 14196 Diag(L->getLocStart(), D); 14197 } else { 14198 // Mark the capture expressions odr-used. This was deferred 14199 // during lambda expression creation. 14200 for (auto *Lambda : Rec.Lambdas) { 14201 for (auto *C : Lambda->capture_inits()) 14202 MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(C); 14203 } 14204 } 14205 } 14206 14207 // When are coming out of an unevaluated context, clear out any 14208 // temporaries that we may have created as part of the evaluation of 14209 // the expression in that context: they aren't relevant because they 14210 // will never be constructed. 14211 if (Rec.isUnevaluated() || Rec.isConstantEvaluated()) { 14212 ExprCleanupObjects.erase(ExprCleanupObjects.begin() + Rec.NumCleanupObjects, 14213 ExprCleanupObjects.end()); 14214 Cleanup = Rec.ParentCleanup; 14215 CleanupVarDeclMarking(); 14216 std::swap(MaybeODRUseExprs, Rec.SavedMaybeODRUseExprs); 14217 // Otherwise, merge the contexts together. 14218 } else { 14219 Cleanup.mergeFrom(Rec.ParentCleanup); 14220 MaybeODRUseExprs.insert(Rec.SavedMaybeODRUseExprs.begin(), 14221 Rec.SavedMaybeODRUseExprs.end()); 14222 } 14223 14224 // Pop the current expression evaluation context off the stack. 14225 ExprEvalContexts.pop_back(); 14226 14227 if (!ExprEvalContexts.empty()) 14228 ExprEvalContexts.back().NumTypos += NumTypos; 14229 else 14230 assert(NumTypos == 0 && "There are outstanding typos after popping the " 14231 "last ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord"); 14232 } 14233 14234 void Sema::DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext() { 14235 ExprCleanupObjects.erase( 14236 ExprCleanupObjects.begin() + ExprEvalContexts.back().NumCleanupObjects, 14237 ExprCleanupObjects.end()); 14238 Cleanup.reset(); 14239 MaybeODRUseExprs.clear(); 14240 } 14241 14242 ExprResult Sema::HandleExprEvaluationContextForTypeof(Expr *E) { 14243 if (!E->getType()->isVariablyModifiedType()) 14244 return E; 14245 return TransformToPotentiallyEvaluated(E); 14246 } 14247 14248 /// Are we within a context in which some evaluation could be performed (be it 14249 /// constant evaluation or runtime evaluation)? Sadly, this notion is not quite 14250 /// captured by C++'s idea of an "unevaluated context". 14251 static bool isEvaluatableContext(Sema &SemaRef) { 14252 switch (SemaRef.ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) { 14253 case Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated: 14254 case Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::UnevaluatedAbstract: 14255 // Expressions in this context are never evaluated. 14256 return false; 14257 14258 case Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::UnevaluatedList: 14259 case Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::ConstantEvaluated: 14260 case Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::PotentiallyEvaluated: 14261 case Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::DiscardedStatement: 14262 // Expressions in this context could be evaluated. 14263 return true; 14264 14265 case Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed: 14266 // Referenced declarations will only be used if the construct in the 14267 // containing expression is used, at which point we'll be given another 14268 // turn to mark them. 14269 return false; 14270 } 14271 llvm_unreachable("Invalid context"); 14272 } 14273 14274 /// Are we within a context in which references to resolved functions or to 14275 /// variables result in odr-use? 14276 static bool isOdrUseContext(Sema &SemaRef, bool SkipDependentUses = true) { 14277 // An expression in a template is not really an expression until it's been 14278 // instantiated, so it doesn't trigger odr-use. 14279 if (SkipDependentUses && SemaRef.CurContext->isDependentContext()) 14280 return false; 14281 14282 switch (SemaRef.ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) { 14283 case Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated: 14284 case Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::UnevaluatedList: 14285 case Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::UnevaluatedAbstract: 14286 case Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::DiscardedStatement: 14287 return false; 14288 14289 case Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::ConstantEvaluated: 14290 case Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::PotentiallyEvaluated: 14291 return true; 14292 14293 case Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed: 14294 return false; 14295 } 14296 llvm_unreachable("Invalid context"); 14297 } 14298 14299 static bool isImplicitlyDefinableConstexprFunction(FunctionDecl *Func) { 14300 CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Func); 14301 return Func->isConstexpr() && 14302 (Func->isImplicitlyInstantiable() || (MD && !MD->isUserProvided())); 14303 } 14304 14305 /// Mark a function referenced, and check whether it is odr-used 14306 /// (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2, C99 6.9p3) 14307 void Sema::MarkFunctionReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, FunctionDecl *Func, 14308 bool MightBeOdrUse) { 14309 assert(Func && "No function?"); 14310 14311 Func->setReferenced(); 14312 14313 // C++11 [basic.def.odr]p3: 14314 // A function whose name appears as a potentially-evaluated expression is 14315 // odr-used if it is the unique lookup result or the selected member of a 14316 // set of overloaded functions [...]. 14317 // 14318 // We (incorrectly) mark overload resolution as an unevaluated context, so we 14319 // can just check that here. 14320 bool OdrUse = MightBeOdrUse && isOdrUseContext(*this); 14321 14322 // Determine whether we require a function definition to exist, per 14323 // C++11 [temp.inst]p3: 14324 // Unless a function template specialization has been explicitly 14325 // instantiated or explicitly specialized, the function template 14326 // specialization is implicitly instantiated when the specialization is 14327 // referenced in a context that requires a function definition to exist. 14328 // 14329 // That is either when this is an odr-use, or when a usage of a constexpr 14330 // function occurs within an evaluatable context. 14331 bool NeedDefinition = 14332 OdrUse || (isEvaluatableContext(*this) && 14333 isImplicitlyDefinableConstexprFunction(Func)); 14334 14335 // C++14 [temp.expl.spec]p6: 14336 // If a template [...] is explicitly specialized then that specialization 14337 // shall be declared before the first use of that specialization that would 14338 // cause an implicit instantiation to take place, in every translation unit 14339 // in which such a use occurs 14340 if (NeedDefinition && 14341 (Func->getTemplateSpecializationKind() != TSK_Undeclared || 14342 Func->getMemberSpecializationInfo())) 14343 checkSpecializationVisibility(Loc, Func); 14344 14345 // C++14 [except.spec]p17: 14346 // An exception-specification is considered to be needed when: 14347 // - the function is odr-used or, if it appears in an unevaluated operand, 14348 // would be odr-used if the expression were potentially-evaluated; 14349 // 14350 // Note, we do this even if MightBeOdrUse is false. That indicates that the 14351 // function is a pure virtual function we're calling, and in that case the 14352 // function was selected by overload resolution and we need to resolve its 14353 // exception specification for a different reason. 14354 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = Func->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 14355 if (FPT && isUnresolvedExceptionSpec(FPT->getExceptionSpecType())) 14356 ResolveExceptionSpec(Loc, FPT); 14357 14358 // If we don't need to mark the function as used, and we don't need to 14359 // try to provide a definition, there's nothing more to do. 14360 if ((Func->isUsed(/*CheckUsedAttr=*/false) || !OdrUse) && 14361 (!NeedDefinition || Func->getBody())) 14362 return; 14363 14364 // Note that this declaration has been used. 14365 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func)) { 14366 Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Constructor->getFirstDecl()); 14367 if (Constructor->isDefaulted() && !Constructor->isDeleted()) { 14368 if (Constructor->isDefaultConstructor()) { 14369 if (Constructor->isTrivial() && !Constructor->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>()) 14370 return; 14371 DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor(Loc, Constructor); 14372 } else if (Constructor->isCopyConstructor()) { 14373 DefineImplicitCopyConstructor(Loc, Constructor); 14374 } else if (Constructor->isMoveConstructor()) { 14375 DefineImplicitMoveConstructor(Loc, Constructor); 14376 } 14377 } else if (Constructor->getInheritedConstructor()) { 14378 DefineInheritingConstructor(Loc, Constructor); 14379 } 14380 } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = 14381 dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(Func)) { 14382 Destructor = cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(Destructor->getFirstDecl()); 14383 if (Destructor->isDefaulted() && !Destructor->isDeleted()) { 14384 if (Destructor->isTrivial() && !Destructor->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>()) 14385 return; 14386 DefineImplicitDestructor(Loc, Destructor); 14387 } 14388 if (Destructor->isVirtual() && getLangOpts().AppleKext) 14389 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Destructor->getParent()); 14390 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Func)) { 14391 if (MethodDecl->isOverloadedOperator() && 14392 MethodDecl->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Equal) { 14393 MethodDecl = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MethodDecl->getFirstDecl()); 14394 if (MethodDecl->isDefaulted() && !MethodDecl->isDeleted()) { 14395 if (MethodDecl->isCopyAssignmentOperator()) 14396 DefineImplicitCopyAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl); 14397 else if (MethodDecl->isMoveAssignmentOperator()) 14398 DefineImplicitMoveAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl); 14399 } 14400 } else if (isa<CXXConversionDecl>(MethodDecl) && 14401 MethodDecl->getParent()->isLambda()) { 14402 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion = 14403 cast<CXXConversionDecl>(MethodDecl->getFirstDecl()); 14404 if (Conversion->isLambdaToBlockPointerConversion()) 14405 DefineImplicitLambdaToBlockPointerConversion(Loc, Conversion); 14406 else 14407 DefineImplicitLambdaToFunctionPointerConversion(Loc, Conversion); 14408 } else if (MethodDecl->isVirtual() && getLangOpts().AppleKext) 14409 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, MethodDecl->getParent()); 14410 } 14411 14412 // Recursive functions should be marked when used from another function. 14413 // FIXME: Is this really right? 14414 if (CurContext == Func) return; 14415 14416 // Implicit instantiation of function templates and member functions of 14417 // class templates. 14418 if (Func->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) { 14419 TemplateSpecializationKind TSK = Func->getTemplateSpecializationKind(); 14420 SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation = Func->getPointOfInstantiation(); 14421 bool FirstInstantiation = PointOfInstantiation.isInvalid(); 14422 if (FirstInstantiation) { 14423 PointOfInstantiation = Loc; 14424 Func->setTemplateSpecializationKind(TSK, PointOfInstantiation); 14425 } else if (TSK != TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) { 14426 // Use the point of use as the point of instantiation, instead of the 14427 // point of explicit instantiation (which we track as the actual point of 14428 // instantiation). This gives better backtraces in diagnostics. 14429 PointOfInstantiation = Loc; 14430 } 14431 14432 if (FirstInstantiation || TSK != TSK_ImplicitInstantiation || 14433 Func->isConstexpr()) { 14434 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Func->getDeclContext()) && 14435 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Func->getDeclContext())->isLocalClass() && 14436 CodeSynthesisContexts.size()) 14437 PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations.push_back( 14438 std::make_pair(Func, PointOfInstantiation)); 14439 else if (Func->isConstexpr()) 14440 // Do not defer instantiations of constexpr functions, to avoid the 14441 // expression evaluator needing to call back into Sema if it sees a 14442 // call to such a function. 14443 InstantiateFunctionDefinition(PointOfInstantiation, Func); 14444 else { 14445 Func->setInstantiationIsPending(true); 14446 PendingInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Func, 14447 PointOfInstantiation)); 14448 // Notify the consumer that a function was implicitly instantiated. 14449 Consumer.HandleCXXImplicitFunctionInstantiation(Func); 14450 } 14451 } 14452 } else { 14453 // Walk redefinitions, as some of them may be instantiable. 14454 for (auto i : Func->redecls()) { 14455 if (!i->isUsed(false) && i->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) 14456 MarkFunctionReferenced(Loc, i, OdrUse); 14457 } 14458 } 14459 14460 if (!OdrUse) return; 14461 14462 // Keep track of used but undefined functions. 14463 if (!Func->isDefined()) { 14464 if (mightHaveNonExternalLinkage(Func)) 14465 UndefinedButUsed.insert(std::make_pair(Func->getCanonicalDecl(), Loc)); 14466 else if (Func->getMostRecentDecl()->isInlined() && 14467 !LangOpts.GNUInline && 14468 !Func->getMostRecentDecl()->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>()) 14469 UndefinedButUsed.insert(std::make_pair(Func->getCanonicalDecl(), Loc)); 14470 else if (isExternalWithNoLinkageType(Func)) 14471 UndefinedButUsed.insert(std::make_pair(Func->getCanonicalDecl(), Loc)); 14472 } 14473 14474 Func->markUsed(Context); 14475 } 14476 14477 static void 14478 diagnoseUncapturableValueReference(Sema &S, SourceLocation loc, 14479 ValueDecl *var, DeclContext *DC) { 14480 DeclContext *VarDC = var->getDeclContext(); 14481 14482 // If the parameter still belongs to the translation unit, then 14483 // we're actually just using one parameter in the declaration of 14484 // the next. 14485 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(var) && 14486 isa<TranslationUnitDecl>(VarDC)) 14487 return; 14488 14489 // For C code, don't diagnose about capture if we're not actually in code 14490 // right now; it's impossible to write a non-constant expression outside of 14491 // function context, so we'll get other (more useful) diagnostics later. 14492 // 14493 // For C++, things get a bit more nasty... it would be nice to suppress this 14494 // diagnostic for certain cases like using a local variable in an array bound 14495 // for a member of a local class, but the correct predicate is not obvious. 14496 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !S.CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod()) 14497 return; 14498 14499 unsigned ValueKind = isa<BindingDecl>(var) ? 1 : 0; 14500 unsigned ContextKind = 3; // unknown 14501 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(VarDC) && 14502 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(VarDC->getParent())->isLambda()) { 14503 ContextKind = 2; 14504 } else if (isa<FunctionDecl>(VarDC)) { 14505 ContextKind = 0; 14506 } else if (isa<BlockDecl>(VarDC)) { 14507 ContextKind = 1; 14508 } 14509 14510 S.Diag(loc, diag::err_reference_to_local_in_enclosing_context) 14511 << var << ValueKind << ContextKind << VarDC; 14512 S.Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::note_entity_declared_at) 14513 << var; 14514 14515 // FIXME: Add additional diagnostic info about class etc. which prevents 14516 // capture. 14517 } 14518 14519 14520 static bool isVariableAlreadyCapturedInScopeInfo(CapturingScopeInfo *CSI, VarDecl *Var, 14521 bool &SubCapturesAreNested, 14522 QualType &CaptureType, 14523 QualType &DeclRefType) { 14524 // Check whether we've already captured it. 14525 if (CSI->CaptureMap.count(Var)) { 14526 // If we found a capture, any subcaptures are nested. 14527 SubCapturesAreNested = true; 14528 14529 // Retrieve the capture type for this variable. 14530 CaptureType = CSI->getCapture(Var).getCaptureType(); 14531 14532 // Compute the type of an expression that refers to this variable. 14533 DeclRefType = CaptureType.getNonReferenceType(); 14534 14535 // Similarly to mutable captures in lambda, all the OpenMP captures by copy 14536 // are mutable in the sense that user can change their value - they are 14537 // private instances of the captured declarations. 14538 const Capture &Cap = CSI->getCapture(Var); 14539 if (Cap.isCopyCapture() && 14540 !(isa<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI) && cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI)->Mutable) && 14541 !(isa<CapturedRegionScopeInfo>(CSI) && 14542 cast<CapturedRegionScopeInfo>(CSI)->CapRegionKind == CR_OpenMP)) 14543 DeclRefType.addConst(); 14544 return true; 14545 } 14546 return false; 14547 } 14548 14549 // Only block literals, captured statements, and lambda expressions can 14550 // capture; other scopes don't work. 14551 static DeclContext *getParentOfCapturingContextOrNull(DeclContext *DC, VarDecl *Var, 14552 SourceLocation Loc, 14553 const bool Diagnose, Sema &S) { 14554 if (isa<BlockDecl>(DC) || isa<CapturedDecl>(DC) || isLambdaCallOperator(DC)) 14555 return getLambdaAwareParentOfDeclContext(DC); 14556 else if (Var->hasLocalStorage()) { 14557 if (Diagnose) 14558 diagnoseUncapturableValueReference(S, Loc, Var, DC); 14559 } 14560 return nullptr; 14561 } 14562 14563 // Certain capturing entities (lambdas, blocks etc.) are not allowed to capture 14564 // certain types of variables (unnamed, variably modified types etc.) 14565 // so check for eligibility. 14566 static bool isVariableCapturable(CapturingScopeInfo *CSI, VarDecl *Var, 14567 SourceLocation Loc, 14568 const bool Diagnose, Sema &S) { 14569 14570 bool IsBlock = isa<BlockScopeInfo>(CSI); 14571 bool IsLambda = isa<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI); 14572 14573 // Lambdas are not allowed to capture unnamed variables 14574 // (e.g. anonymous unions). 14575 // FIXME: The C++11 rule don't actually state this explicitly, but I'm 14576 // assuming that's the intent. 14577 if (IsLambda && !Var->getDeclName()) { 14578 if (Diagnose) { 14579 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_lambda_capture_anonymous_var); 14580 S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at); 14581 } 14582 return false; 14583 } 14584 14585 // Prohibit variably-modified types in blocks; they're difficult to deal with. 14586 if (Var->getType()->isVariablyModifiedType() && IsBlock) { 14587 if (Diagnose) { 14588 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_vm_type); 14589 S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 14590 << Var->getDeclName(); 14591 } 14592 return false; 14593 } 14594 // Prohibit structs with flexible array members too. 14595 // We cannot capture what is in the tail end of the struct. 14596 if (const RecordType *VTTy = Var->getType()->getAs<RecordType>()) { 14597 if (VTTy->getDecl()->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) { 14598 if (Diagnose) { 14599 if (IsBlock) 14600 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_flexarray_type); 14601 else 14602 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_lambda_capture_flexarray_type) 14603 << Var->getDeclName(); 14604 S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 14605 << Var->getDeclName(); 14606 } 14607 return false; 14608 } 14609 } 14610 const bool HasBlocksAttr = Var->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>(); 14611 // Lambdas and captured statements are not allowed to capture __block 14612 // variables; they don't support the expected semantics. 14613 if (HasBlocksAttr && (IsLambda || isa<CapturedRegionScopeInfo>(CSI))) { 14614 if (Diagnose) { 14615 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_capture_block_variable) 14616 << Var->getDeclName() << !IsLambda; 14617 S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 14618 << Var->getDeclName(); 14619 } 14620 return false; 14621 } 14622 // OpenCL v2.0 s6.12.5: Blocks cannot reference/capture other blocks 14623 if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL && IsBlock && 14624 Var->getType()->isBlockPointerType()) { 14625 if (Diagnose) 14626 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_opencl_block_ref_block); 14627 return false; 14628 } 14629 14630 return true; 14631 } 14632 14633 // Returns true if the capture by block was successful. 14634 static bool captureInBlock(BlockScopeInfo *BSI, VarDecl *Var, 14635 SourceLocation Loc, 14636 const bool BuildAndDiagnose, 14637 QualType &CaptureType, 14638 QualType &DeclRefType, 14639 const bool Nested, 14640 Sema &S) { 14641 Expr *CopyExpr = nullptr; 14642 bool ByRef = false; 14643 14644 // Blocks are not allowed to capture arrays. 14645 if (CaptureType->isArrayType()) { 14646 if (BuildAndDiagnose) { 14647 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_array_type); 14648 S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 14649 << Var->getDeclName(); 14650 } 14651 return false; 14652 } 14653 14654 // Forbid the block-capture of autoreleasing variables. 14655 if (CaptureType.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing) { 14656 if (BuildAndDiagnose) { 14657 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_arc_autoreleasing_capture) 14658 << /*block*/ 0; 14659 S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 14660 << Var->getDeclName(); 14661 } 14662 return false; 14663 } 14664 14665 // Warn about implicitly autoreleasing indirect parameters captured by blocks. 14666 if (const auto *PT = CaptureType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 14667 // This function finds out whether there is an AttributedType of kind 14668 // attr_objc_ownership in Ty. The existence of AttributedType of kind 14669 // attr_objc_ownership implies __autoreleasing was explicitly specified 14670 // rather than being added implicitly by the compiler. 14671 auto IsObjCOwnershipAttributedType = [](QualType Ty) { 14672 while (const auto *AttrTy = Ty->getAs<AttributedType>()) { 14673 if (AttrTy->getAttrKind() == AttributedType::attr_objc_ownership) 14674 return true; 14675 14676 // Peel off AttributedTypes that are not of kind objc_ownership. 14677 Ty = AttrTy->getModifiedType(); 14678 } 14679 14680 return false; 14681 }; 14682 14683 QualType PointeeTy = PT->getPointeeType(); 14684 14685 if (PointeeTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() && 14686 PointeeTy.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing && 14687 !IsObjCOwnershipAttributedType(PointeeTy)) { 14688 if (BuildAndDiagnose) { 14689 SourceLocation VarLoc = Var->getLocation(); 14690 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_block_capture_autoreleasing); 14691 S.Diag(VarLoc, diag::note_declare_parameter_strong); 14692 } 14693 } 14694 } 14695 14696 const bool HasBlocksAttr = Var->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>(); 14697 if (HasBlocksAttr || CaptureType->isReferenceType() || 14698 (S.getLangOpts().OpenMP && S.isOpenMPCapturedDecl(Var))) { 14699 // Block capture by reference does not change the capture or 14700 // declaration reference types. 14701 ByRef = true; 14702 } else { 14703 // Block capture by copy introduces 'const'. 14704 CaptureType = CaptureType.getNonReferenceType().withConst(); 14705 DeclRefType = CaptureType; 14706 14707 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && BuildAndDiagnose) { 14708 if (const RecordType *Record = DeclRefType->getAs<RecordType>()) { 14709 // The capture logic needs the destructor, so make sure we mark it. 14710 // Usually this is unnecessary because most local variables have 14711 // their destructors marked at declaration time, but parameters are 14712 // an exception because it's technically only the call site that 14713 // actually requires the destructor. 14714 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(Var)) 14715 S.FinalizeVarWithDestructor(Var, Record); 14716 14717 // Enter a new evaluation context to insulate the copy 14718 // full-expression. 14719 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext scope( 14720 S, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::PotentiallyEvaluated); 14721 14722 // According to the blocks spec, the capture of a variable from 14723 // the stack requires a const copy constructor. This is not true 14724 // of the copy/move done to move a __block variable to the heap. 14725 Expr *DeclRef = new (S.Context) DeclRefExpr(Var, Nested, 14726 DeclRefType.withConst(), 14727 VK_LValue, Loc); 14728 14729 ExprResult Result 14730 = S.PerformCopyInitialization( 14731 InitializedEntity::InitializeBlock(Var->getLocation(), 14732 CaptureType, false), 14733 Loc, DeclRef); 14734 14735 // Build a full-expression copy expression if initialization 14736 // succeeded and used a non-trivial constructor. Recover from 14737 // errors by pretending that the copy isn't necessary. 14738 if (!Result.isInvalid() && 14739 !cast<CXXConstructExpr>(Result.get())->getConstructor() 14740 ->isTrivial()) { 14741 Result = S.MaybeCreateExprWithCleanups(Result); 14742 CopyExpr = Result.get(); 14743 } 14744 } 14745 } 14746 } 14747 14748 // Actually capture the variable. 14749 if (BuildAndDiagnose) 14750 BSI->addCapture(Var, HasBlocksAttr, ByRef, Nested, Loc, 14751 SourceLocation(), CaptureType, CopyExpr); 14752 14753 return true; 14754 14755 } 14756 14757 14758 /// Capture the given variable in the captured region. 14759 static bool captureInCapturedRegion(CapturedRegionScopeInfo *RSI, 14760 VarDecl *Var, 14761 SourceLocation Loc, 14762 const bool BuildAndDiagnose, 14763 QualType &CaptureType, 14764 QualType &DeclRefType, 14765 const bool RefersToCapturedVariable, 14766 Sema &S) { 14767 // By default, capture variables by reference. 14768 bool ByRef = true; 14769 // Using an LValue reference type is consistent with Lambdas (see below). 14770 if (S.getLangOpts().OpenMP && RSI->CapRegionKind == CR_OpenMP) { 14771 if (S.isOpenMPCapturedDecl(Var)) { 14772 bool HasConst = DeclRefType.isConstQualified(); 14773 DeclRefType = DeclRefType.getUnqualifiedType(); 14774 // Don't lose diagnostics about assignments to const. 14775 if (HasConst) 14776 DeclRefType.addConst(); 14777 } 14778 ByRef = S.isOpenMPCapturedByRef(Var, RSI->OpenMPLevel); 14779 } 14780 14781 if (ByRef) 14782 CaptureType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(DeclRefType); 14783 else 14784 CaptureType = DeclRefType; 14785 14786 Expr *CopyExpr = nullptr; 14787 if (BuildAndDiagnose) { 14788 // The current implementation assumes that all variables are captured 14789 // by references. Since there is no capture by copy, no expression 14790 // evaluation will be needed. 14791 RecordDecl *RD = RSI->TheRecordDecl; 14792 14793 FieldDecl *Field 14794 = FieldDecl::Create(S.Context, RD, Loc, Loc, nullptr, CaptureType, 14795 S.Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(CaptureType, Loc), 14796 nullptr, false, ICIS_NoInit); 14797 Field->setImplicit(true); 14798 Field->setAccess(AS_private); 14799 RD->addDecl(Field); 14800 if (S.getLangOpts().OpenMP && RSI->CapRegionKind == CR_OpenMP) 14801 S.setOpenMPCaptureKind(Field, Var, RSI->OpenMPLevel); 14802 14803 CopyExpr = new (S.Context) DeclRefExpr(Var, RefersToCapturedVariable, 14804 DeclRefType, VK_LValue, Loc); 14805 Var->setReferenced(true); 14806 Var->markUsed(S.Context); 14807 } 14808 14809 // Actually capture the variable. 14810 if (BuildAndDiagnose) 14811 RSI->addCapture(Var, /*isBlock*/false, ByRef, RefersToCapturedVariable, Loc, 14812 SourceLocation(), CaptureType, CopyExpr); 14813 14814 14815 return true; 14816 } 14817 14818 /// Create a field within the lambda class for the variable 14819 /// being captured. 14820 static void addAsFieldToClosureType(Sema &S, LambdaScopeInfo *LSI, 14821 QualType FieldType, QualType DeclRefType, 14822 SourceLocation Loc, 14823 bool RefersToCapturedVariable) { 14824 CXXRecordDecl *Lambda = LSI->Lambda; 14825 14826 // Build the non-static data member. 14827 FieldDecl *Field 14828 = FieldDecl::Create(S.Context, Lambda, Loc, Loc, nullptr, FieldType, 14829 S.Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(FieldType, Loc), 14830 nullptr, false, ICIS_NoInit); 14831 Field->setImplicit(true); 14832 Field->setAccess(AS_private); 14833 Lambda->addDecl(Field); 14834 } 14835 14836 /// Capture the given variable in the lambda. 14837 static bool captureInLambda(LambdaScopeInfo *LSI, 14838 VarDecl *Var, 14839 SourceLocation Loc, 14840 const bool BuildAndDiagnose, 14841 QualType &CaptureType, 14842 QualType &DeclRefType, 14843 const bool RefersToCapturedVariable, 14844 const Sema::TryCaptureKind Kind, 14845 SourceLocation EllipsisLoc, 14846 const bool IsTopScope, 14847 Sema &S) { 14848 14849 // Determine whether we are capturing by reference or by value. 14850 bool ByRef = false; 14851 if (IsTopScope && Kind != Sema::TryCapture_Implicit) { 14852 ByRef = (Kind == Sema::TryCapture_ExplicitByRef); 14853 } else { 14854 ByRef = (LSI->ImpCaptureStyle == LambdaScopeInfo::ImpCap_LambdaByref); 14855 } 14856 14857 // Compute the type of the field that will capture this variable. 14858 if (ByRef) { 14859 // C++11 [expr.prim.lambda]p15: 14860 // An entity is captured by reference if it is implicitly or 14861 // explicitly captured but not captured by copy. It is 14862 // unspecified whether additional unnamed non-static data 14863 // members are declared in the closure type for entities 14864 // captured by reference. 14865 // 14866 // FIXME: It is not clear whether we want to build an lvalue reference 14867 // to the DeclRefType or to CaptureType.getNonReferenceType(). GCC appears 14868 // to do the former, while EDG does the latter. Core issue 1249 will 14869 // clarify, but for now we follow GCC because it's a more permissive and 14870 // easily defensible position. 14871 CaptureType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(DeclRefType); 14872 } else { 14873 // C++11 [expr.prim.lambda]p14: 14874 // For each entity captured by copy, an unnamed non-static 14875 // data member is declared in the closure type. The 14876 // declaration order of these members is unspecified. The type 14877 // of such a data member is the type of the corresponding 14878 // captured entity if the entity is not a reference to an 14879 // object, or the referenced type otherwise. [Note: If the 14880 // captured entity is a reference to a function, the 14881 // corresponding data member is also a reference to a 14882 // function. - end note ] 14883 if (const ReferenceType *RefType = CaptureType->getAs<ReferenceType>()){ 14884 if (!RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType()) 14885 CaptureType = RefType->getPointeeType(); 14886 } 14887 14888 // Forbid the lambda copy-capture of autoreleasing variables. 14889 if (CaptureType.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing) { 14890 if (BuildAndDiagnose) { 14891 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_arc_autoreleasing_capture) << /*lambda*/ 1; 14892 S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 14893 << Var->getDeclName(); 14894 } 14895 return false; 14896 } 14897 14898 // Make sure that by-copy captures are of a complete and non-abstract type. 14899 if (BuildAndDiagnose) { 14900 if (!CaptureType->isDependentType() && 14901 S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, CaptureType, 14902 diag::err_capture_of_incomplete_type, 14903 Var->getDeclName())) 14904 return false; 14905 14906 if (S.RequireNonAbstractType(Loc, CaptureType, 14907 diag::err_capture_of_abstract_type)) 14908 return false; 14909 } 14910 } 14911 14912 // Capture this variable in the lambda. 14913 if (BuildAndDiagnose) 14914 addAsFieldToClosureType(S, LSI, CaptureType, DeclRefType, Loc, 14915 RefersToCapturedVariable); 14916 14917 // Compute the type of a reference to this captured variable. 14918 if (ByRef) 14919 DeclRefType = CaptureType.getNonReferenceType(); 14920 else { 14921 // C++ [expr.prim.lambda]p5: 14922 // The closure type for a lambda-expression has a public inline 14923 // function call operator [...]. This function call operator is 14924 // declared const (9.3.1) if and only if the lambda-expression's 14925 // parameter-declaration-clause is not followed by mutable. 14926 DeclRefType = CaptureType.getNonReferenceType(); 14927 if (!LSI->Mutable && !CaptureType->isReferenceType()) 14928 DeclRefType.addConst(); 14929 } 14930 14931 // Add the capture. 14932 if (BuildAndDiagnose) 14933 LSI->addCapture(Var, /*IsBlock=*/false, ByRef, RefersToCapturedVariable, 14934 Loc, EllipsisLoc, CaptureType, /*CopyExpr=*/nullptr); 14935 14936 return true; 14937 } 14938 14939 bool Sema::tryCaptureVariable( 14940 VarDecl *Var, SourceLocation ExprLoc, TryCaptureKind Kind, 14941 SourceLocation EllipsisLoc, bool BuildAndDiagnose, QualType &CaptureType, 14942 QualType &DeclRefType, const unsigned *const FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt) { 14943 // An init-capture is notionally from the context surrounding its 14944 // declaration, but its parent DC is the lambda class. 14945 DeclContext *VarDC = Var->getDeclContext(); 14946 if (Var->isInitCapture()) 14947 VarDC = VarDC->getParent(); 14948 14949 DeclContext *DC = CurContext; 14950 const unsigned MaxFunctionScopesIndex = FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt 14951 ? *FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt : FunctionScopes.size() - 1; 14952 // We need to sync up the Declaration Context with the 14953 // FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt 14954 if (FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt) { 14955 unsigned FSIndex = FunctionScopes.size() - 1; 14956 while (FSIndex != MaxFunctionScopesIndex) { 14957 DC = getLambdaAwareParentOfDeclContext(DC); 14958 --FSIndex; 14959 } 14960 } 14961 14962 14963 // If the variable is declared in the current context, there is no need to 14964 // capture it. 14965 if (VarDC == DC) return true; 14966 14967 // Capture global variables if it is required to use private copy of this 14968 // variable. 14969 bool IsGlobal = !Var->hasLocalStorage(); 14970 if (IsGlobal && !(LangOpts.OpenMP && isOpenMPCapturedDecl(Var))) 14971 return true; 14972 Var = Var->getCanonicalDecl(); 14973 14974 // Walk up the stack to determine whether we can capture the variable, 14975 // performing the "simple" checks that don't depend on type. We stop when 14976 // we've either hit the declared scope of the variable or find an existing 14977 // capture of that variable. We start from the innermost capturing-entity 14978 // (the DC) and ensure that all intervening capturing-entities 14979 // (blocks/lambdas etc.) between the innermost capturer and the variable`s 14980 // declcontext can either capture the variable or have already captured 14981 // the variable. 14982 CaptureType = Var->getType(); 14983 DeclRefType = CaptureType.getNonReferenceType(); 14984 bool Nested = false; 14985 bool Explicit = (Kind != TryCapture_Implicit); 14986 unsigned FunctionScopesIndex = MaxFunctionScopesIndex; 14987 do { 14988 // Only block literals, captured statements, and lambda expressions can 14989 // capture; other scopes don't work. 14990 DeclContext *ParentDC = getParentOfCapturingContextOrNull(DC, Var, 14991 ExprLoc, 14992 BuildAndDiagnose, 14993 *this); 14994 // We need to check for the parent *first* because, if we *have* 14995 // private-captured a global variable, we need to recursively capture it in 14996 // intermediate blocks, lambdas, etc. 14997 if (!ParentDC) { 14998 if (IsGlobal) { 14999 FunctionScopesIndex = MaxFunctionScopesIndex - 1; 15000 break; 15001 } 15002 return true; 15003 } 15004 15005 FunctionScopeInfo *FSI = FunctionScopes[FunctionScopesIndex]; 15006 CapturingScopeInfo *CSI = cast<CapturingScopeInfo>(FSI); 15007 15008 15009 // Check whether we've already captured it. 15010 if (isVariableAlreadyCapturedInScopeInfo(CSI, Var, Nested, CaptureType, 15011 DeclRefType)) { 15012 CSI->getCapture(Var).markUsed(BuildAndDiagnose); 15013 break; 15014 } 15015 // If we are instantiating a generic lambda call operator body, 15016 // we do not want to capture new variables. What was captured 15017 // during either a lambdas transformation or initial parsing 15018 // should be used. 15019 if (isGenericLambdaCallOperatorSpecialization(DC)) { 15020 if (BuildAndDiagnose) { 15021 LambdaScopeInfo *LSI = cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI); 15022 if (LSI->ImpCaptureStyle == CapturingScopeInfo::ImpCap_None) { 15023 Diag(ExprLoc, diag::err_lambda_impcap) << Var->getDeclName(); 15024 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 15025 << Var->getDeclName(); 15026 Diag(LSI->Lambda->getLocStart(), diag::note_lambda_decl); 15027 } else 15028 diagnoseUncapturableValueReference(*this, ExprLoc, Var, DC); 15029 } 15030 return true; 15031 } 15032 // Certain capturing entities (lambdas, blocks etc.) are not allowed to capture 15033 // certain types of variables (unnamed, variably modified types etc.) 15034 // so check for eligibility. 15035 if (!isVariableCapturable(CSI, Var, ExprLoc, BuildAndDiagnose, *this)) 15036 return true; 15037 15038 // Try to capture variable-length arrays types. 15039 if (Var->getType()->isVariablyModifiedType()) { 15040 // We're going to walk down into the type and look for VLA 15041 // expressions. 15042 QualType QTy = Var->getType(); 15043 if (ParmVarDecl *PVD = dyn_cast_or_null<ParmVarDecl>(Var)) 15044 QTy = PVD->getOriginalType(); 15045 captureVariablyModifiedType(Context, QTy, CSI); 15046 } 15047 15048 if (getLangOpts().OpenMP) { 15049 if (auto *RSI = dyn_cast<CapturedRegionScopeInfo>(CSI)) { 15050 // OpenMP private variables should not be captured in outer scope, so 15051 // just break here. Similarly, global variables that are captured in a 15052 // target region should not be captured outside the scope of the region. 15053 if (RSI->CapRegionKind == CR_OpenMP) { 15054 bool IsOpenMPPrivateDecl = isOpenMPPrivateDecl(Var, RSI->OpenMPLevel); 15055 auto IsTargetCap = !IsOpenMPPrivateDecl && 15056 isOpenMPTargetCapturedDecl(Var, RSI->OpenMPLevel); 15057 // When we detect target captures we are looking from inside the 15058 // target region, therefore we need to propagate the capture from the 15059 // enclosing region. Therefore, the capture is not initially nested. 15060 if (IsTargetCap) 15061 adjustOpenMPTargetScopeIndex(FunctionScopesIndex, RSI->OpenMPLevel); 15062 15063 if (IsTargetCap || IsOpenMPPrivateDecl) { 15064 Nested = !IsTargetCap; 15065 DeclRefType = DeclRefType.getUnqualifiedType(); 15066 CaptureType = Context.getLValueReferenceType(DeclRefType); 15067 break; 15068 } 15069 } 15070 } 15071 } 15072 if (CSI->ImpCaptureStyle == CapturingScopeInfo::ImpCap_None && !Explicit) { 15073 // No capture-default, and this is not an explicit capture 15074 // so cannot capture this variable. 15075 if (BuildAndDiagnose) { 15076 Diag(ExprLoc, diag::err_lambda_impcap) << Var->getDeclName(); 15077 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 15078 << Var->getDeclName(); 15079 if (cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI)->Lambda) 15080 Diag(cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI)->Lambda->getLocStart(), 15081 diag::note_lambda_decl); 15082 // FIXME: If we error out because an outer lambda can not implicitly 15083 // capture a variable that an inner lambda explicitly captures, we 15084 // should have the inner lambda do the explicit capture - because 15085 // it makes for cleaner diagnostics later. This would purely be done 15086 // so that the diagnostic does not misleadingly claim that a variable 15087 // can not be captured by a lambda implicitly even though it is captured 15088 // explicitly. Suggestion: 15089 // - create const bool VariableCaptureWasInitiallyExplicit = Explicit 15090 // at the function head 15091 // - cache the StartingDeclContext - this must be a lambda 15092 // - captureInLambda in the innermost lambda the variable. 15093 } 15094 return true; 15095 } 15096 15097 FunctionScopesIndex--; 15098 DC = ParentDC; 15099 Explicit = false; 15100 } while (!VarDC->Equals(DC)); 15101 15102 // Walk back down the scope stack, (e.g. from outer lambda to inner lambda) 15103 // computing the type of the capture at each step, checking type-specific 15104 // requirements, and adding captures if requested. 15105 // If the variable had already been captured previously, we start capturing 15106 // at the lambda nested within that one. 15107 for (unsigned I = ++FunctionScopesIndex, N = MaxFunctionScopesIndex + 1; I != N; 15108 ++I) { 15109 CapturingScopeInfo *CSI = cast<CapturingScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes[I]); 15110 15111 if (BlockScopeInfo *BSI = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(CSI)) { 15112 if (!captureInBlock(BSI, Var, ExprLoc, 15113 BuildAndDiagnose, CaptureType, 15114 DeclRefType, Nested, *this)) 15115 return true; 15116 Nested = true; 15117 } else if (CapturedRegionScopeInfo *RSI = dyn_cast<CapturedRegionScopeInfo>(CSI)) { 15118 if (!captureInCapturedRegion(RSI, Var, ExprLoc, 15119 BuildAndDiagnose, CaptureType, 15120 DeclRefType, Nested, *this)) 15121 return true; 15122 Nested = true; 15123 } else { 15124 LambdaScopeInfo *LSI = cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI); 15125 if (!captureInLambda(LSI, Var, ExprLoc, 15126 BuildAndDiagnose, CaptureType, 15127 DeclRefType, Nested, Kind, EllipsisLoc, 15128 /*IsTopScope*/I == N - 1, *this)) 15129 return true; 15130 Nested = true; 15131 } 15132 } 15133 return false; 15134 } 15135 15136 bool Sema::tryCaptureVariable(VarDecl *Var, SourceLocation Loc, 15137 TryCaptureKind Kind, SourceLocation EllipsisLoc) { 15138 QualType CaptureType; 15139 QualType DeclRefType; 15140 return tryCaptureVariable(Var, Loc, Kind, EllipsisLoc, 15141 /*BuildAndDiagnose=*/true, CaptureType, 15142 DeclRefType, nullptr); 15143 } 15144 15145 bool Sema::NeedToCaptureVariable(VarDecl *Var, SourceLocation Loc) { 15146 QualType CaptureType; 15147 QualType DeclRefType; 15148 return !tryCaptureVariable(Var, Loc, TryCapture_Implicit, SourceLocation(), 15149 /*BuildAndDiagnose=*/false, CaptureType, 15150 DeclRefType, nullptr); 15151 } 15152 15153 QualType Sema::getCapturedDeclRefType(VarDecl *Var, SourceLocation Loc) { 15154 QualType CaptureType; 15155 QualType DeclRefType; 15156 15157 // Determine whether we can capture this variable. 15158 if (tryCaptureVariable(Var, Loc, TryCapture_Implicit, SourceLocation(), 15159 /*BuildAndDiagnose=*/false, CaptureType, 15160 DeclRefType, nullptr)) 15161 return QualType(); 15162 15163 return DeclRefType; 15164 } 15165 15166 15167 15168 // If either the type of the variable or the initializer is dependent, 15169 // return false. Otherwise, determine whether the variable is a constant 15170 // expression. Use this if you need to know if a variable that might or 15171 // might not be dependent is truly a constant expression. 15172 static inline bool IsVariableNonDependentAndAConstantExpression(VarDecl *Var, 15173 ASTContext &Context) { 15174 15175 if (Var->getType()->isDependentType()) 15176 return false; 15177 const VarDecl *DefVD = nullptr; 15178 Var->getAnyInitializer(DefVD); 15179 if (!DefVD) 15180 return false; 15181 EvaluatedStmt *Eval = DefVD->ensureEvaluatedStmt(); 15182 Expr *Init = cast<Expr>(Eval->Value); 15183 if (Init->isValueDependent()) 15184 return false; 15185 return IsVariableAConstantExpression(Var, Context); 15186 } 15187 15188 15189 void Sema::UpdateMarkingForLValueToRValue(Expr *E) { 15190 // Per C++11 [basic.def.odr], a variable is odr-used "unless it is 15191 // an object that satisfies the requirements for appearing in a 15192 // constant expression (5.19) and the lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (4.1) 15193 // is immediately applied." This function handles the lvalue-to-rvalue 15194 // conversion part. 15195 MaybeODRUseExprs.erase(E->IgnoreParens()); 15196 15197 // If we are in a lambda, check if this DeclRefExpr or MemberExpr refers 15198 // to a variable that is a constant expression, and if so, identify it as 15199 // a reference to a variable that does not involve an odr-use of that 15200 // variable. 15201 if (LambdaScopeInfo *LSI = getCurLambda()) { 15202 Expr *SansParensExpr = E->IgnoreParens(); 15203 VarDecl *Var = nullptr; 15204 if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(SansParensExpr)) 15205 Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(DRE->getFoundDecl()); 15206 else if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(SansParensExpr)) 15207 Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()); 15208 15209 if (Var && IsVariableNonDependentAndAConstantExpression(Var, Context)) 15210 LSI->markVariableExprAsNonODRUsed(SansParensExpr); 15211 } 15212 } 15213 15214 ExprResult Sema::ActOnConstantExpression(ExprResult Res) { 15215 Res = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(Res); 15216 15217 if (!Res.isUsable()) 15218 return Res; 15219 15220 // If a constant-expression is a reference to a variable where we delay 15221 // deciding whether it is an odr-use, just assume we will apply the 15222 // lvalue-to-rvalue conversion. In the one case where this doesn't happen 15223 // (a non-type template argument), we have special handling anyway. 15224 UpdateMarkingForLValueToRValue(Res.get()); 15225 return Res; 15226 } 15227 15228 void Sema::CleanupVarDeclMarking() { 15229 for (Expr *E : MaybeODRUseExprs) { 15230 VarDecl *Var; 15231 SourceLocation Loc; 15232 if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) { 15233 Var = cast<VarDecl>(DRE->getDecl()); 15234 Loc = DRE->getLocation(); 15235 } else if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E)) { 15236 Var = cast<VarDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()); 15237 Loc = ME->getMemberLoc(); 15238 } else { 15239 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected expression"); 15240 } 15241 15242 MarkVarDeclODRUsed(Var, Loc, *this, 15243 /*MaxFunctionScopeIndex Pointer*/ nullptr); 15244 } 15245 15246 MaybeODRUseExprs.clear(); 15247 } 15248 15249 15250 static void DoMarkVarDeclReferenced(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, 15251 VarDecl *Var, Expr *E) { 15252 assert((!E || isa<DeclRefExpr>(E) || isa<MemberExpr>(E)) && 15253 "Invalid Expr argument to DoMarkVarDeclReferenced"); 15254 Var->setReferenced(); 15255 15256 TemplateSpecializationKind TSK = Var->getTemplateSpecializationKind(); 15257 15258 bool OdrUseContext = isOdrUseContext(SemaRef); 15259 bool UsableInConstantExpr = 15260 Var->isUsableInConstantExpressions(SemaRef.Context); 15261 bool NeedDefinition = 15262 OdrUseContext || (isEvaluatableContext(SemaRef) && UsableInConstantExpr); 15263 15264 VarTemplateSpecializationDecl *VarSpec = 15265 dyn_cast<VarTemplateSpecializationDecl>(Var); 15266 assert(!isa<VarTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(Var) && 15267 "Can't instantiate a partial template specialization."); 15268 15269 // If this might be a member specialization of a static data member, check 15270 // the specialization is visible. We already did the checks for variable 15271 // template specializations when we created them. 15272 if (NeedDefinition && TSK != TSK_Undeclared && 15273 !isa<VarTemplateSpecializationDecl>(Var)) 15274 SemaRef.checkSpecializationVisibility(Loc, Var); 15275 15276 // Perform implicit instantiation of static data members, static data member 15277 // templates of class templates, and variable template specializations. Delay 15278 // instantiations of variable templates, except for those that could be used 15279 // in a constant expression. 15280 if (NeedDefinition && isTemplateInstantiation(TSK)) { 15281 // Per C++17 [temp.explicit]p10, we may instantiate despite an explicit 15282 // instantiation declaration if a variable is usable in a constant 15283 // expression (among other cases). 15284 bool TryInstantiating = 15285 TSK == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation || 15286 (TSK == TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDeclaration && UsableInConstantExpr); 15287 15288 if (TryInstantiating) { 15289 SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation = Var->getPointOfInstantiation(); 15290 bool FirstInstantiation = PointOfInstantiation.isInvalid(); 15291 if (FirstInstantiation) { 15292 PointOfInstantiation = Loc; 15293 Var->setTemplateSpecializationKind(TSK, PointOfInstantiation); 15294 } 15295 15296 bool InstantiationDependent = false; 15297 bool IsNonDependent = 15298 VarSpec ? !TemplateSpecializationType::anyDependentTemplateArguments( 15299 VarSpec->getTemplateArgsInfo(), InstantiationDependent) 15300 : true; 15301 15302 // Do not instantiate specializations that are still type-dependent. 15303 if (IsNonDependent) { 15304 if (UsableInConstantExpr) { 15305 // Do not defer instantiations of variables that could be used in a 15306 // constant expression. 15307 SemaRef.InstantiateVariableDefinition(PointOfInstantiation, Var); 15308 } else if (FirstInstantiation || 15309 isa<VarTemplateSpecializationDecl>(Var)) { 15310 // FIXME: For a specialization of a variable template, we don't 15311 // distinguish between "declaration and type implicitly instantiated" 15312 // and "implicit instantiation of definition requested", so we have 15313 // no direct way to avoid enqueueing the pending instantiation 15314 // multiple times. 15315 SemaRef.PendingInstantiations 15316 .push_back(std::make_pair(Var, PointOfInstantiation)); 15317 } 15318 } 15319 } 15320 } 15321 15322 // Per C++11 [basic.def.odr], a variable is odr-used "unless it satisfies 15323 // the requirements for appearing in a constant expression (5.19) and, if 15324 // it is an object, the lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (4.1) 15325 // is immediately applied." We check the first part here, and 15326 // Sema::UpdateMarkingForLValueToRValue deals with the second part. 15327 // Note that we use the C++11 definition everywhere because nothing in 15328 // C++03 depends on whether we get the C++03 version correct. The second 15329 // part does not apply to references, since they are not objects. 15330 if (OdrUseContext && E && 15331 IsVariableAConstantExpression(Var, SemaRef.Context)) { 15332 // A reference initialized by a constant expression can never be 15333 // odr-used, so simply ignore it. 15334 if (!Var->getType()->isReferenceType() || 15335 (SemaRef.LangOpts.OpenMP && SemaRef.isOpenMPCapturedDecl(Var))) 15336 SemaRef.MaybeODRUseExprs.insert(E); 15337 } else if (OdrUseContext) { 15338 MarkVarDeclODRUsed(Var, Loc, SemaRef, 15339 /*MaxFunctionScopeIndex ptr*/ nullptr); 15340 } else if (isOdrUseContext(SemaRef, /*SkipDependentUses*/false)) { 15341 // If this is a dependent context, we don't need to mark variables as 15342 // odr-used, but we may still need to track them for lambda capture. 15343 // FIXME: Do we also need to do this inside dependent typeid expressions 15344 // (which are modeled as unevaluated at this point)? 15345 const bool RefersToEnclosingScope = 15346 (SemaRef.CurContext != Var->getDeclContext() && 15347 Var->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod() && Var->hasLocalStorage()); 15348 if (RefersToEnclosingScope) { 15349 LambdaScopeInfo *const LSI = 15350 SemaRef.getCurLambda(/*IgnoreNonLambdaCapturingScope=*/true); 15351 if (LSI && (!LSI->CallOperator || 15352 !LSI->CallOperator->Encloses(Var->getDeclContext()))) { 15353 // If a variable could potentially be odr-used, defer marking it so 15354 // until we finish analyzing the full expression for any 15355 // lvalue-to-rvalue 15356 // or discarded value conversions that would obviate odr-use. 15357 // Add it to the list of potential captures that will be analyzed 15358 // later (ActOnFinishFullExpr) for eventual capture and odr-use marking 15359 // unless the variable is a reference that was initialized by a constant 15360 // expression (this will never need to be captured or odr-used). 15361 assert(E && "Capture variable should be used in an expression."); 15362 if (!Var->getType()->isReferenceType() || 15363 !IsVariableNonDependentAndAConstantExpression(Var, SemaRef.Context)) 15364 LSI->addPotentialCapture(E->IgnoreParens()); 15365 } 15366 } 15367 } 15368 } 15369 15370 /// Mark a variable referenced, and check whether it is odr-used 15371 /// (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2, C99 6.9p3). Note that this should not be 15372 /// used directly for normal expressions referring to VarDecl. 15373 void Sema::MarkVariableReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, VarDecl *Var) { 15374 DoMarkVarDeclReferenced(*this, Loc, Var, nullptr); 15375 } 15376 15377 static void MarkExprReferenced(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, 15378 Decl *D, Expr *E, bool MightBeOdrUse) { 15379 if (SemaRef.isInOpenMPDeclareTargetContext()) 15380 SemaRef.checkDeclIsAllowedInOpenMPTarget(E, D); 15381 15382 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) { 15383 DoMarkVarDeclReferenced(SemaRef, Loc, Var, E); 15384 return; 15385 } 15386 15387 SemaRef.MarkAnyDeclReferenced(Loc, D, MightBeOdrUse); 15388 15389 // If this is a call to a method via a cast, also mark the method in the 15390 // derived class used in case codegen can devirtualize the call. 15391 const MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E); 15392 if (!ME) 15393 return; 15394 CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()); 15395 if (!MD) 15396 return; 15397 // Only attempt to devirtualize if this is truly a virtual call. 15398 bool IsVirtualCall = MD->isVirtual() && 15399 ME->performsVirtualDispatch(SemaRef.getLangOpts()); 15400 if (!IsVirtualCall) 15401 return; 15402 15403 // If it's possible to devirtualize the call, mark the called function 15404 // referenced. 15405 CXXMethodDecl *DM = MD->getDevirtualizedMethod( 15406 ME->getBase(), SemaRef.getLangOpts().AppleKext); 15407 if (DM) 15408 SemaRef.MarkAnyDeclReferenced(Loc, DM, MightBeOdrUse); 15409 } 15410 15411 /// Perform reference-marking and odr-use handling for a DeclRefExpr. 15412 void Sema::MarkDeclRefReferenced(DeclRefExpr *E, const Expr *Base) { 15413 // TODO: update this with DR# once a defect report is filed. 15414 // C++11 defect. The address of a pure member should not be an ODR use, even 15415 // if it's a qualified reference. 15416 bool OdrUse = true; 15417 if (const CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(E->getDecl())) 15418 if (Method->isVirtual() && 15419 !Method->getDevirtualizedMethod(Base, getLangOpts().AppleKext)) 15420 OdrUse = false; 15421 MarkExprReferenced(*this, E->getLocation(), E->getDecl(), E, OdrUse); 15422 } 15423 15424 /// Perform reference-marking and odr-use handling for a MemberExpr. 15425 void Sema::MarkMemberReferenced(MemberExpr *E) { 15426 // C++11 [basic.def.odr]p2: 15427 // A non-overloaded function whose name appears as a potentially-evaluated 15428 // expression or a member of a set of candidate functions, if selected by 15429 // overload resolution when referred to from a potentially-evaluated 15430 // expression, is odr-used, unless it is a pure virtual function and its 15431 // name is not explicitly qualified. 15432 bool MightBeOdrUse = true; 15433 if (E->performsVirtualDispatch(getLangOpts())) { 15434 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(E->getMemberDecl())) 15435 if (Method->isPure()) 15436 MightBeOdrUse = false; 15437 } 15438 SourceLocation Loc = E->getMemberLoc().isValid() ? 15439 E->getMemberLoc() : E->getLocStart(); 15440 MarkExprReferenced(*this, Loc, E->getMemberDecl(), E, MightBeOdrUse); 15441 } 15442 15443 /// Perform marking for a reference to an arbitrary declaration. It 15444 /// marks the declaration referenced, and performs odr-use checking for 15445 /// functions and variables. This method should not be used when building a 15446 /// normal expression which refers to a variable. 15447 void Sema::MarkAnyDeclReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, Decl *D, 15448 bool MightBeOdrUse) { 15449 if (MightBeOdrUse) { 15450 if (auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) { 15451 MarkVariableReferenced(Loc, VD); 15452 return; 15453 } 15454 } 15455 if (auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 15456 MarkFunctionReferenced(Loc, FD, MightBeOdrUse); 15457 return; 15458 } 15459 D->setReferenced(); 15460 } 15461 15462 namespace { 15463 // Mark all of the declarations used by a type as referenced. 15464 // FIXME: Not fully implemented yet! We need to have a better understanding 15465 // of when we're entering a context we should not recurse into. 15466 // FIXME: This is and EvaluatedExprMarker are more-or-less equivalent to 15467 // TreeTransforms rebuilding the type in a new context. Rather than 15468 // duplicating the TreeTransform logic, we should consider reusing it here. 15469 // Currently that causes problems when rebuilding LambdaExprs. 15470 class MarkReferencedDecls : public RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> { 15471 Sema &S; 15472 SourceLocation Loc; 15473 15474 public: 15475 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> Inherited; 15476 15477 MarkReferencedDecls(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) : S(S), Loc(Loc) { } 15478 15479 bool TraverseTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg); 15480 }; 15481 } 15482 15483 bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseTemplateArgument( 15484 const TemplateArgument &Arg) { 15485 { 15486 // A non-type template argument is a constant-evaluated context. 15487 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Evaluated( 15488 S, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::ConstantEvaluated); 15489 if (Arg.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Declaration) { 15490 if (Decl *D = Arg.getAsDecl()) 15491 S.MarkAnyDeclReferenced(Loc, D, true); 15492 } else if (Arg.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Expression) { 15493 S.MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Arg.getAsExpr(), false); 15494 } 15495 } 15496 15497 return Inherited::TraverseTemplateArgument(Arg); 15498 } 15499 15500 void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) { 15501 MarkReferencedDecls Marker(*this, Loc); 15502 Marker.TraverseType(T); 15503 } 15504 15505 namespace { 15506 /// Helper class that marks all of the declarations referenced by 15507 /// potentially-evaluated subexpressions as "referenced". 15508 class EvaluatedExprMarker : public EvaluatedExprVisitor<EvaluatedExprMarker> { 15509 Sema &S; 15510 bool SkipLocalVariables; 15511 15512 public: 15513 typedef EvaluatedExprVisitor<EvaluatedExprMarker> Inherited; 15514 15515 EvaluatedExprMarker(Sema &S, bool SkipLocalVariables) 15516 : Inherited(S.Context), S(S), SkipLocalVariables(SkipLocalVariables) { } 15517 15518 void VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) { 15519 // If we were asked not to visit local variables, don't. 15520 if (SkipLocalVariables) { 15521 if (VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(E->getDecl())) 15522 if (VD->hasLocalStorage()) 15523 return; 15524 } 15525 15526 S.MarkDeclRefReferenced(E); 15527 } 15528 15529 void VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) { 15530 S.MarkMemberReferenced(E); 15531 Inherited::VisitMemberExpr(E); 15532 } 15533 15534 void VisitCXXBindTemporaryExpr(CXXBindTemporaryExpr *E) { 15535 S.MarkFunctionReferenced(E->getLocStart(), 15536 const_cast<CXXDestructorDecl*>(E->getTemporary()->getDestructor())); 15537 Visit(E->getSubExpr()); 15538 } 15539 15540 void VisitCXXNewExpr(CXXNewExpr *E) { 15541 if (E->getOperatorNew()) 15542 S.MarkFunctionReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorNew()); 15543 if (E->getOperatorDelete()) 15544 S.MarkFunctionReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorDelete()); 15545 Inherited::VisitCXXNewExpr(E); 15546 } 15547 15548 void VisitCXXDeleteExpr(CXXDeleteExpr *E) { 15549 if (E->getOperatorDelete()) 15550 S.MarkFunctionReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorDelete()); 15551 QualType Destroyed = S.Context.getBaseElementType(E->getDestroyedType()); 15552 if (const RecordType *DestroyedRec = Destroyed->getAs<RecordType>()) { 15553 CXXRecordDecl *Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DestroyedRec->getDecl()); 15554 S.MarkFunctionReferenced(E->getLocStart(), 15555 S.LookupDestructor(Record)); 15556 } 15557 15558 Inherited::VisitCXXDeleteExpr(E); 15559 } 15560 15561 void VisitCXXConstructExpr(CXXConstructExpr *E) { 15562 S.MarkFunctionReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getConstructor()); 15563 Inherited::VisitCXXConstructExpr(E); 15564 } 15565 15566 void VisitCXXDefaultArgExpr(CXXDefaultArgExpr *E) { 15567 Visit(E->getExpr()); 15568 } 15569 15570 void VisitImplicitCastExpr(ImplicitCastExpr *E) { 15571 Inherited::VisitImplicitCastExpr(E); 15572 15573 if (E->getCastKind() == CK_LValueToRValue) 15574 S.UpdateMarkingForLValueToRValue(E->getSubExpr()); 15575 } 15576 }; 15577 } 15578 15579 /// Mark any declarations that appear within this expression or any 15580 /// potentially-evaluated subexpressions as "referenced". 15581 /// 15582 /// \param SkipLocalVariables If true, don't mark local variables as 15583 /// 'referenced'. 15584 void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Expr *E, 15585 bool SkipLocalVariables) { 15586 EvaluatedExprMarker(*this, SkipLocalVariables).Visit(E); 15587 } 15588 15589 /// Emit a diagnostic that describes an effect on the run-time behavior 15590 /// of the program being compiled. 15591 /// 15592 /// This routine emits the given diagnostic when the code currently being 15593 /// type-checked is "potentially evaluated", meaning that there is a 15594 /// possibility that the code will actually be executable. Code in sizeof() 15595 /// expressions, code used only during overload resolution, etc., are not 15596 /// potentially evaluated. This routine will suppress such diagnostics or, 15597 /// in the absolutely nutty case of potentially potentially evaluated 15598 /// expressions (C++ typeid), queue the diagnostic to potentially emit it 15599 /// later. 15600 /// 15601 /// This routine should be used for all diagnostics that describe the run-time 15602 /// behavior of a program, such as passing a non-POD value through an ellipsis. 15603 /// Failure to do so will likely result in spurious diagnostics or failures 15604 /// during overload resolution or within sizeof/alignof/typeof/typeid. 15605 bool Sema::DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc, const Stmt *Statement, 15606 const PartialDiagnostic &PD) { 15607 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) { 15608 case ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated: 15609 case ExpressionEvaluationContext::UnevaluatedList: 15610 case ExpressionEvaluationContext::UnevaluatedAbstract: 15611 case ExpressionEvaluationContext::DiscardedStatement: 15612 // The argument will never be evaluated, so don't complain. 15613 break; 15614 15615 case ExpressionEvaluationContext::ConstantEvaluated: 15616 // Relevant diagnostics should be produced by constant evaluation. 15617 break; 15618 15619 case ExpressionEvaluationContext::PotentiallyEvaluated: 15620 case ExpressionEvaluationContext::PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed: 15621 if (Statement && getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl()) { 15622 FunctionScopes.back()->PossiblyUnreachableDiags. 15623 push_back(sema::PossiblyUnreachableDiag(PD, Loc, Statement)); 15624 return true; 15625 } 15626 15627 // The initializer of a constexpr variable or of the first declaration of a 15628 // static data member is not syntactically a constant evaluated constant, 15629 // but nonetheless is always required to be a constant expression, so we 15630 // can skip diagnosing. 15631 // FIXME: Using the mangling context here is a hack. 15632 if (auto *VD = dyn_cast_or_null<VarDecl>( 15633 ExprEvalContexts.back().ManglingContextDecl)) { 15634 if (VD->isConstexpr() || 15635 (VD->isStaticDataMember() && VD->isFirstDecl() && !VD->isInline())) 15636 break; 15637 // FIXME: For any other kind of variable, we should build a CFG for its 15638 // initializer and check whether the context in question is reachable. 15639 } 15640 15641 Diag(Loc, PD); 15642 return true; 15643 } 15644 15645 return false; 15646 } 15647 15648 bool Sema::CheckCallReturnType(QualType ReturnType, SourceLocation Loc, 15649 CallExpr *CE, FunctionDecl *FD) { 15650 if (ReturnType->isVoidType() || !ReturnType->isIncompleteType()) 15651 return false; 15652 15653 // If we're inside a decltype's expression, don't check for a valid return 15654 // type or construct temporaries until we know whether this is the last call. 15655 if (ExprEvalContexts.back().ExprContext == 15656 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord::EK_Decltype) { 15657 ExprEvalContexts.back().DelayedDecltypeCalls.push_back(CE); 15658 return false; 15659 } 15660 15661 class CallReturnIncompleteDiagnoser : public TypeDiagnoser { 15662 FunctionDecl *FD; 15663 CallExpr *CE; 15664 15665 public: 15666 CallReturnIncompleteDiagnoser(FunctionDecl *FD, CallExpr *CE) 15667 : FD(FD), CE(CE) { } 15668 15669 void diagnose(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) override { 15670 if (!FD) { 15671 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_call_incomplete_return) 15672 << T << CE->getSourceRange(); 15673 return; 15674 } 15675 15676 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_call_function_incomplete_return) 15677 << CE->getSourceRange() << FD->getDeclName() << T; 15678 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_entity_declared_at) 15679 << FD->getDeclName(); 15680 } 15681 } Diagnoser(FD, CE); 15682 15683 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, ReturnType, Diagnoser)) 15684 return true; 15685 15686 return false; 15687 } 15688 15689 // Diagnose the s/=/==/ and s/\|=/!=/ typos. Note that adding parentheses 15690 // will prevent this condition from triggering, which is what we want. 15691 void Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(Expr *E) { 15692 SourceLocation Loc; 15693 15694 unsigned diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_assignment; 15695 bool IsOrAssign = false; 15696 15697 if (BinaryOperator *Op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E)) { 15698 if (Op->getOpcode() != BO_Assign && Op->getOpcode() != BO_OrAssign) 15699 return; 15700 15701 IsOrAssign = Op->getOpcode() == BO_OrAssign; 15702 15703 // Greylist some idioms by putting them into a warning subcategory. 15704 if (ObjCMessageExpr *ME 15705 = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Op->getRHS()->IgnoreParenCasts())) { 15706 Selector Sel = ME->getSelector(); 15707 15708 // self = [<foo> init...] 15709 if (isSelfExpr(Op->getLHS()) && ME->getMethodFamily() == OMF_init) 15710 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment; 15711 15712 // <foo> = [<bar> nextObject] 15713 else if (Sel.isUnarySelector() && Sel.getNameForSlot(0) == "nextObject") 15714 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment; 15715 } 15716 15717 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc(); 15718 } else if (CXXOperatorCallExpr *Op = dyn_cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) { 15719 if (Op->getOperator() != OO_Equal && Op->getOperator() != OO_PipeEqual) 15720 return; 15721 15722 IsOrAssign = Op->getOperator() == OO_PipeEqual; 15723 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc(); 15724 } else if (PseudoObjectExpr *POE = dyn_cast<PseudoObjectExpr>(E)) 15725 return DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(POE->getSyntacticForm()); 15726 else { 15727 // Not an assignment. 15728 return; 15729 } 15730 15731 Diag(Loc, diagnostic) << E->getSourceRange(); 15732 15733 SourceLocation Open = E->getLocStart(); 15734 SourceLocation Close = getLocForEndOfToken(E->getSourceRange().getEnd()); 15735 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_silence) 15736 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Open, "(") 15737 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Close, ")"); 15738 15739 if (IsOrAssign) 15740 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_or_assign_to_comparison) 15741 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "!="); 15742 else 15743 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_to_comparison) 15744 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "=="); 15745 } 15746 15747 /// Redundant parentheses over an equality comparison can indicate 15748 /// that the user intended an assignment used as condition. 15749 void Sema::DiagnoseEqualityWithExtraParens(ParenExpr *ParenE) { 15750 // Don't warn if the parens came from a macro. 15751 SourceLocation parenLoc = ParenE->getLocStart(); 15752 if (parenLoc.isInvalid() || parenLoc.isMacroID()) 15753 return; 15754 // Don't warn for dependent expressions. 15755 if (ParenE->isTypeDependent()) 15756 return; 15757 15758 Expr *E = ParenE->IgnoreParens(); 15759 15760 if (BinaryOperator *opE = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E)) 15761 if (opE->getOpcode() == BO_EQ && 15762 opE->getLHS()->IgnoreParenImpCasts()->isModifiableLvalue(Context) 15763 == Expr::MLV_Valid) { 15764 SourceLocation Loc = opE->getOperatorLoc(); 15765 15766 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_equality_with_extra_parens) << E->getSourceRange(); 15767 SourceRange ParenERange = ParenE->getSourceRange(); 15768 Diag(Loc, diag::note_equality_comparison_silence) 15769 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(ParenERange.getBegin()) 15770 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(ParenERange.getEnd()); 15771 Diag(Loc, diag::note_equality_comparison_to_assign) 15772 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "="); 15773 } 15774 } 15775 15776 ExprResult Sema::CheckBooleanCondition(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *E, 15777 bool IsConstexpr) { 15778 DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(E); 15779 if (ParenExpr *parenE = dyn_cast<ParenExpr>(E)) 15780 DiagnoseEqualityWithExtraParens(parenE); 15781 15782 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E); 15783 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 15784 E = result.get(); 15785 15786 if (!E->isTypeDependent()) { 15787 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 15788 return CheckCXXBooleanCondition(E, IsConstexpr); // C++ 6.4p4 15789 15790 ExprResult ERes = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E); 15791 if (ERes.isInvalid()) 15792 return ExprError(); 15793 E = ERes.get(); 15794 15795 QualType T = E->getType(); 15796 if (!T->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.8.4.1p1 15797 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_statement_requires_scalar) 15798 << T << E->getSourceRange(); 15799 return ExprError(); 15800 } 15801 CheckBoolLikeConversion(E, Loc); 15802 } 15803 15804 return E; 15805 } 15806 15807 Sema::ConditionResult Sema::ActOnCondition(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc, 15808 Expr *SubExpr, ConditionKind CK) { 15809 // Empty conditions are valid in for-statements. 15810 if (!SubExpr) 15811 return ConditionResult(); 15812 15813 ExprResult Cond; 15814 switch (CK) { 15815 case ConditionKind::Boolean: 15816 Cond = CheckBooleanCondition(Loc, SubExpr); 15817 break; 15818 15819 case ConditionKind::ConstexprIf: 15820 Cond = CheckBooleanCondition(Loc, SubExpr, true); 15821 break; 15822 15823 case ConditionKind::Switch: 15824 Cond = CheckSwitchCondition(Loc, SubExpr); 15825 break; 15826 } 15827 if (Cond.isInvalid()) 15828 return ConditionError(); 15829 15830 // FIXME: FullExprArg doesn't have an invalid bit, so check nullness instead. 15831 FullExprArg FullExpr = MakeFullExpr(Cond.get(), Loc); 15832 if (!FullExpr.get()) 15833 return ConditionError(); 15834 15835 return ConditionResult(*this, nullptr, FullExpr, 15836 CK == ConditionKind::ConstexprIf); 15837 } 15838 15839 namespace { 15840 /// A visitor for rebuilding a call to an __unknown_any expression 15841 /// to have an appropriate type. 15842 struct RebuildUnknownAnyFunction 15843 : StmtVisitor<RebuildUnknownAnyFunction, ExprResult> { 15844 15845 Sema &S; 15846 15847 RebuildUnknownAnyFunction(Sema &S) : S(S) {} 15848 15849 ExprResult VisitStmt(Stmt *S) { 15850 llvm_unreachable("unexpected statement!"); 15851 } 15852 15853 ExprResult VisitExpr(Expr *E) { 15854 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unsupported_unknown_any_call) 15855 << E->getSourceRange(); 15856 return ExprError(); 15857 } 15858 15859 /// Rebuild an expression which simply semantically wraps another 15860 /// expression which it shares the type and value kind of. 15861 template <class T> ExprResult rebuildSugarExpr(T *E) { 15862 ExprResult SubResult = Visit(E->getSubExpr()); 15863 if (SubResult.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 15864 15865 Expr *SubExpr = SubResult.get(); 15866 E->setSubExpr(SubExpr); 15867 E->setType(SubExpr->getType()); 15868 E->setValueKind(SubExpr->getValueKind()); 15869 assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary); 15870 return E; 15871 } 15872 15873 ExprResult VisitParenExpr(ParenExpr *E) { 15874 return rebuildSugarExpr(E); 15875 } 15876 15877 ExprResult VisitUnaryExtension(UnaryOperator *E) { 15878 return rebuildSugarExpr(E); 15879 } 15880 15881 ExprResult VisitUnaryAddrOf(UnaryOperator *E) { 15882 ExprResult SubResult = Visit(E->getSubExpr()); 15883 if (SubResult.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 15884 15885 Expr *SubExpr = SubResult.get(); 15886 E->setSubExpr(SubExpr); 15887 E->setType(S.Context.getPointerType(SubExpr->getType())); 15888 assert(E->getValueKind() == VK_RValue); 15889 assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary); 15890 return E; 15891 } 15892 15893 ExprResult resolveDecl(Expr *E, ValueDecl *VD) { 15894 if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(VD)) return VisitExpr(E); 15895 15896 E->setType(VD->getType()); 15897 15898 assert(E->getValueKind() == VK_RValue); 15899 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 15900 !(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(VD) && 15901 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(VD)->isInstance())) 15902 E->setValueKind(VK_LValue); 15903 15904 return E; 15905 } 15906 15907 ExprResult VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) { 15908 return resolveDecl(E, E->getMemberDecl()); 15909 } 15910 15911 ExprResult VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) { 15912 return resolveDecl(E, E->getDecl()); 15913 } 15914 }; 15915 } 15916 15917 /// Given a function expression of unknown-any type, try to rebuild it 15918 /// to have a function type. 15919 static ExprResult rebuildUnknownAnyFunction(Sema &S, Expr *FunctionExpr) { 15920 ExprResult Result = RebuildUnknownAnyFunction(S).Visit(FunctionExpr); 15921 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 15922 return S.DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Result.get()); 15923 } 15924 15925 namespace { 15926 /// A visitor for rebuilding an expression of type __unknown_anytype 15927 /// into one which resolves the type directly on the referring 15928 /// expression. Strict preservation of the original source 15929 /// structure is not a goal. 15930 struct RebuildUnknownAnyExpr 15931 : StmtVisitor<RebuildUnknownAnyExpr, ExprResult> { 15932 15933 Sema &S; 15934 15935 /// The current destination type. 15936 QualType DestType; 15937 15938 RebuildUnknownAnyExpr(Sema &S, QualType CastType) 15939 : S(S), DestType(CastType) {} 15940 15941 ExprResult VisitStmt(Stmt *S) { 15942 llvm_unreachable("unexpected statement!"); 15943 } 15944 15945 ExprResult VisitExpr(Expr *E) { 15946 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unsupported_unknown_any_expr) 15947 << E->getSourceRange(); 15948 return ExprError(); 15949 } 15950 15951 ExprResult VisitCallExpr(CallExpr *E); 15952 ExprResult VisitObjCMessageExpr(ObjCMessageExpr *E); 15953 15954 /// Rebuild an expression which simply semantically wraps another 15955 /// expression which it shares the type and value kind of. 15956 template <class T> ExprResult rebuildSugarExpr(T *E) { 15957 ExprResult SubResult = Visit(E->getSubExpr()); 15958 if (SubResult.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 15959 Expr *SubExpr = SubResult.get(); 15960 E->setSubExpr(SubExpr); 15961 E->setType(SubExpr->getType()); 15962 E->setValueKind(SubExpr->getValueKind()); 15963 assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary); 15964 return E; 15965 } 15966 15967 ExprResult VisitParenExpr(ParenExpr *E) { 15968 return rebuildSugarExpr(E); 15969 } 15970 15971 ExprResult VisitUnaryExtension(UnaryOperator *E) { 15972 return rebuildSugarExpr(E); 15973 } 15974 15975 ExprResult VisitUnaryAddrOf(UnaryOperator *E) { 15976 const PointerType *Ptr = DestType->getAs<PointerType>(); 15977 if (!Ptr) { 15978 S.Diag(E->getOperatorLoc(), diag::err_unknown_any_addrof) 15979 << E->getSourceRange(); 15980 return ExprError(); 15981 } 15982 15983 if (isa<CallExpr>(E->getSubExpr())) { 15984 S.Diag(E->getOperatorLoc(), diag::err_unknown_any_addrof_call) 15985 << E->getSourceRange(); 15986 return ExprError(); 15987 } 15988 15989 assert(E->getValueKind() == VK_RValue); 15990 assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary); 15991 E->setType(DestType); 15992 15993 // Build the sub-expression as if it were an object of the pointee type. 15994 DestType = Ptr->getPointeeType(); 15995 ExprResult SubResult = Visit(E->getSubExpr()); 15996 if (SubResult.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 15997 E->setSubExpr(SubResult.get()); 15998 return E; 15999 } 16000 16001 ExprResult VisitImplicitCastExpr(ImplicitCastExpr *E); 16002 16003 ExprResult resolveDecl(Expr *E, ValueDecl *VD); 16004 16005 ExprResult VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) { 16006 return resolveDecl(E, E->getMemberDecl()); 16007 } 16008 16009 ExprResult VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) { 16010 return resolveDecl(E, E->getDecl()); 16011 } 16012 }; 16013 } 16014 16015 /// Rebuilds a call expression which yielded __unknown_anytype. 16016 ExprResult RebuildUnknownAnyExpr::VisitCallExpr(CallExpr *E) { 16017 Expr *CalleeExpr = E->getCallee(); 16018 16019 enum FnKind { 16020 FK_MemberFunction, 16021 FK_FunctionPointer, 16022 FK_BlockPointer 16023 }; 16024 16025 FnKind Kind; 16026 QualType CalleeType = CalleeExpr->getType(); 16027 if (CalleeType == S.Context.BoundMemberTy) { 16028 assert(isa<CXXMemberCallExpr>(E) || isa<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)); 16029 Kind = FK_MemberFunction; 16030 CalleeType = Expr::findBoundMemberType(CalleeExpr); 16031 } else if (const PointerType *Ptr = CalleeType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 16032 CalleeType = Ptr->getPointeeType(); 16033 Kind = FK_FunctionPointer; 16034 } else { 16035 CalleeType = CalleeType->castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 16036 Kind = FK_BlockPointer; 16037 } 16038 const FunctionType *FnType = CalleeType->castAs<FunctionType>(); 16039 16040 // Verify that this is a legal result type of a function. 16041 if (DestType->isArrayType() || DestType->isFunctionType()) { 16042 unsigned diagID = diag::err_func_returning_array_function; 16043 if (Kind == FK_BlockPointer) 16044 diagID = diag::err_block_returning_array_function; 16045 16046 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diagID) 16047 << DestType->isFunctionType() << DestType; 16048 return ExprError(); 16049 } 16050 16051 // Otherwise, go ahead and set DestType as the call's result. 16052 E->setType(DestType.getNonLValueExprType(S.Context)); 16053 E->setValueKind(Expr::getValueKindForType(DestType)); 16054 assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary); 16055 16056 // Rebuild the function type, replacing the result type with DestType. 16057 const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FnType); 16058 if (Proto) { 16059 // __unknown_anytype(...) is a special case used by the debugger when 16060 // it has no idea what a function's signature is. 16061 // 16062 // We want to build this call essentially under the K&R 16063 // unprototyped rules, but making a FunctionNoProtoType in C++ 16064 // would foul up all sorts of assumptions. However, we cannot 16065 // simply pass all arguments as variadic arguments, nor can we 16066 // portably just call the function under a non-variadic type; see 16067 // the comment on IR-gen's TargetInfo::isNoProtoCallVariadic. 16068 // However, it turns out that in practice it is generally safe to 16069 // call a function declared as "A foo(B,C,D);" under the prototype 16070 // "A foo(B,C,D,...);". The only known exception is with the 16071 // Windows ABI, where any variadic function is implicitly cdecl 16072 // regardless of its normal CC. Therefore we change the parameter 16073 // types to match the types of the arguments. 16074 // 16075 // This is a hack, but it is far superior to moving the 16076 // corresponding target-specific code from IR-gen to Sema/AST. 16077 16078 ArrayRef<QualType> ParamTypes = Proto->getParamTypes(); 16079 SmallVector<QualType, 8> ArgTypes; 16080 if (ParamTypes.empty() && Proto->isVariadic()) { // the special case 16081 ArgTypes.reserve(E->getNumArgs()); 16082 for (unsigned i = 0, e = E->getNumArgs(); i != e; ++i) { 16083 Expr *Arg = E->getArg(i); 16084 QualType ArgType = Arg->getType(); 16085 if (E->isLValue()) { 16086 ArgType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ArgType); 16087 } else if (E->isXValue()) { 16088 ArgType = S.Context.getRValueReferenceType(ArgType); 16089 } 16090 ArgTypes.push_back(ArgType); 16091 } 16092 ParamTypes = ArgTypes; 16093 } 16094 DestType = S.Context.getFunctionType(DestType, ParamTypes, 16095 Proto->getExtProtoInfo()); 16096 } else { 16097 DestType = S.Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(DestType, 16098 FnType->getExtInfo()); 16099 } 16100 16101 // Rebuild the appropriate pointer-to-function type. 16102 switch (Kind) { 16103 case FK_MemberFunction: 16104 // Nothing to do. 16105 break; 16106 16107 case FK_FunctionPointer: 16108 DestType = S.Context.getPointerType(DestType); 16109 break; 16110 16111 case FK_BlockPointer: 16112 DestType = S.Context.getBlockPointerType(DestType); 16113 break; 16114 } 16115 16116 // Finally, we can recurse. 16117 ExprResult CalleeResult = Visit(CalleeExpr); 16118 if (!CalleeResult.isUsable()) return ExprError(); 16119 E->setCallee(CalleeResult.get()); 16120 16121 // Bind a temporary if necessary. 16122 return S.MaybeBindToTemporary(E); 16123 } 16124 16125 ExprResult RebuildUnknownAnyExpr::VisitObjCMessageExpr(ObjCMessageExpr *E) { 16126 // Verify that this is a legal result type of a call. 16127 if (DestType->isArrayType() || DestType->isFunctionType()) { 16128 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_func_returning_array_function) 16129 << DestType->isFunctionType() << DestType; 16130 return ExprError(); 16131 } 16132 16133 // Rewrite the method result type if available. 16134 if (ObjCMethodDecl *Method = E->getMethodDecl()) { 16135 assert(Method->getReturnType() == S.Context.UnknownAnyTy); 16136 Method->setReturnType(DestType); 16137 } 16138 16139 // Change the type of the message. 16140 E->setType(DestType.getNonReferenceType()); 16141 E->setValueKind(Expr::getValueKindForType(DestType)); 16142 16143 return S.MaybeBindToTemporary(E); 16144 } 16145 16146 ExprResult RebuildUnknownAnyExpr::VisitImplicitCastExpr(ImplicitCastExpr *E) { 16147 // The only case we should ever see here is a function-to-pointer decay. 16148 if (E->getCastKind() == CK_FunctionToPointerDecay) { 16149 assert(E->getValueKind() == VK_RValue); 16150 assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary); 16151 16152 E->setType(DestType); 16153 16154 // Rebuild the sub-expression as the pointee (function) type. 16155 DestType = DestType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 16156 16157 ExprResult Result = Visit(E->getSubExpr()); 16158 if (!Result.isUsable()) return ExprError(); 16159 16160 E->setSubExpr(Result.get()); 16161 return E; 16162 } else if (E->getCastKind() == CK_LValueToRValue) { 16163 assert(E->getValueKind() == VK_RValue); 16164 assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary); 16165 16166 assert(isa<BlockPointerType>(E->getType())); 16167 16168 E->setType(DestType); 16169 16170 // The sub-expression has to be a lvalue reference, so rebuild it as such. 16171 DestType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(DestType); 16172 16173 ExprResult Result = Visit(E->getSubExpr()); 16174 if (!Result.isUsable()) return ExprError(); 16175 16176 E->setSubExpr(Result.get()); 16177 return E; 16178 } else { 16179 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled cast type!"); 16180 } 16181 } 16182 16183 ExprResult RebuildUnknownAnyExpr::resolveDecl(Expr *E, ValueDecl *VD) { 16184 ExprValueKind ValueKind = VK_LValue; 16185 QualType Type = DestType; 16186 16187 // We know how to make this work for certain kinds of decls: 16188 16189 // - functions 16190 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(VD)) { 16191 if (const PointerType *Ptr = Type->getAs<PointerType>()) { 16192 DestType = Ptr->getPointeeType(); 16193 ExprResult Result = resolveDecl(E, VD); 16194 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 16195 return S.ImpCastExprToType(Result.get(), Type, 16196 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay, VK_RValue); 16197 } 16198 16199 if (!Type->isFunctionType()) { 16200 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unknown_any_function) 16201 << VD << E->getSourceRange(); 16202 return ExprError(); 16203 } 16204 if (const FunctionProtoType *FT = Type->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) { 16205 // We must match the FunctionDecl's type to the hack introduced in 16206 // RebuildUnknownAnyExpr::VisitCallExpr to vararg functions of unknown 16207 // type. See the lengthy commentary in that routine. 16208 QualType FDT = FD->getType(); 16209 const FunctionType *FnType = FDT->castAs<FunctionType>(); 16210 const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionProtoType>(FnType); 16211 DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E); 16212 if (DRE && Proto && Proto->getParamTypes().empty() && Proto->isVariadic()) { 16213 SourceLocation Loc = FD->getLocation(); 16214 FunctionDecl *NewFD = FunctionDecl::Create(FD->getASTContext(), 16215 FD->getDeclContext(), 16216 Loc, Loc, FD->getNameInfo().getName(), 16217 DestType, FD->getTypeSourceInfo(), 16218 SC_None, false/*isInlineSpecified*/, 16219 FD->hasPrototype(), 16220 false/*isConstexprSpecified*/); 16221 16222 if (FD->getQualifier()) 16223 NewFD->setQualifierInfo(FD->getQualifierLoc()); 16224 16225 SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 16> Params; 16226 for (const auto &AI : FT->param_types()) { 16227 ParmVarDecl *Param = 16228 S.BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(FD, Loc, AI); 16229 Param->setScopeInfo(0, Params.size()); 16230 Params.push_back(Param); 16231 } 16232 NewFD->setParams(Params); 16233 DRE->setDecl(NewFD); 16234 VD = DRE->getDecl(); 16235 } 16236 } 16237 16238 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) 16239 if (MD->isInstance()) { 16240 ValueKind = VK_RValue; 16241 Type = S.Context.BoundMemberTy; 16242 } 16243 16244 // Function references aren't l-values in C. 16245 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 16246 ValueKind = VK_RValue; 16247 16248 // - variables 16249 } else if (isa<VarDecl>(VD)) { 16250 if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = Type->getAs<ReferenceType>()) { 16251 Type = RefTy->getPointeeType(); 16252 } else if (Type->isFunctionType()) { 16253 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unknown_any_var_function_type) 16254 << VD << E->getSourceRange(); 16255 return ExprError(); 16256 } 16257 16258 // - nothing else 16259 } else { 16260 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unsupported_unknown_any_decl) 16261 << VD << E->getSourceRange(); 16262 return ExprError(); 16263 } 16264 16265 // Modifying the declaration like this is friendly to IR-gen but 16266 // also really dangerous. 16267 VD->setType(DestType); 16268 E->setType(Type); 16269 E->setValueKind(ValueKind); 16270 return E; 16271 } 16272 16273 /// Check a cast of an unknown-any type. We intentionally only 16274 /// trigger this for C-style casts. 16275 ExprResult Sema::checkUnknownAnyCast(SourceRange TypeRange, QualType CastType, 16276 Expr *CastExpr, CastKind &CastKind, 16277 ExprValueKind &VK, CXXCastPath &Path) { 16278 // The type we're casting to must be either void or complete. 16279 if (!CastType->isVoidType() && 16280 RequireCompleteType(TypeRange.getBegin(), CastType, 16281 diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_incomplete)) 16282 return ExprError(); 16283 16284 // Rewrite the casted expression from scratch. 16285 ExprResult result = RebuildUnknownAnyExpr(*this, CastType).Visit(CastExpr); 16286 if (!result.isUsable()) return ExprError(); 16287 16288 CastExpr = result.get(); 16289 VK = CastExpr->getValueKind(); 16290 CastKind = CK_NoOp; 16291 16292 return CastExpr; 16293 } 16294 16295 ExprResult Sema::forceUnknownAnyToType(Expr *E, QualType ToType) { 16296 return RebuildUnknownAnyExpr(*this, ToType).Visit(E); 16297 } 16298 16299 ExprResult Sema::checkUnknownAnyArg(SourceLocation callLoc, 16300 Expr *arg, QualType ¶mType) { 16301 // If the syntactic form of the argument is not an explicit cast of 16302 // any sort, just do default argument promotion. 16303 ExplicitCastExpr *castArg = dyn_cast<ExplicitCastExpr>(arg->IgnoreParens()); 16304 if (!castArg) { 16305 ExprResult result = DefaultArgumentPromotion(arg); 16306 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 16307 paramType = result.get()->getType(); 16308 return result; 16309 } 16310 16311 // Otherwise, use the type that was written in the explicit cast. 16312 assert(!arg->hasPlaceholderType()); 16313 paramType = castArg->getTypeAsWritten(); 16314 16315 // Copy-initialize a parameter of that type. 16316 InitializedEntity entity = 16317 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, paramType, 16318 /*consumed*/ false); 16319 return PerformCopyInitialization(entity, callLoc, arg); 16320 } 16321 16322 static ExprResult diagnoseUnknownAnyExpr(Sema &S, Expr *E) { 16323 Expr *orig = E; 16324 unsigned diagID = diag::err_uncasted_use_of_unknown_any; 16325 while (true) { 16326 E = E->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 16327 if (CallExpr *call = dyn_cast<CallExpr>(E)) { 16328 E = call->getCallee(); 16329 diagID = diag::err_uncasted_call_of_unknown_any; 16330 } else { 16331 break; 16332 } 16333 } 16334 16335 SourceLocation loc; 16336 NamedDecl *d; 16337 if (DeclRefExpr *ref = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) { 16338 loc = ref->getLocation(); 16339 d = ref->getDecl(); 16340 } else if (MemberExpr *mem = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E)) { 16341 loc = mem->getMemberLoc(); 16342 d = mem->getMemberDecl(); 16343 } else if (ObjCMessageExpr *msg = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(E)) { 16344 diagID = diag::err_uncasted_call_of_unknown_any; 16345 loc = msg->getSelectorStartLoc(); 16346 d = msg->getMethodDecl(); 16347 if (!d) { 16348 S.Diag(loc, diag::err_uncasted_send_to_unknown_any_method) 16349 << static_cast<unsigned>(msg->isClassMessage()) << msg->getSelector() 16350 << orig->getSourceRange(); 16351 return ExprError(); 16352 } 16353 } else { 16354 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unsupported_unknown_any_expr) 16355 << E->getSourceRange(); 16356 return ExprError(); 16357 } 16358 16359 S.Diag(loc, diagID) << d << orig->getSourceRange(); 16360 16361 // Never recoverable. 16362 return ExprError(); 16363 } 16364 16365 /// Check for operands with placeholder types and complain if found. 16366 /// Returns ExprError() if there was an error and no recovery was possible. 16367 ExprResult Sema::CheckPlaceholderExpr(Expr *E) { 16368 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 16369 // C cannot handle TypoExpr nodes on either side of a binop because it 16370 // doesn't handle dependent types properly, so make sure any TypoExprs have 16371 // been dealt with before checking the operands. 16372 ExprResult Result = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(E); 16373 if (!Result.isUsable()) return ExprError(); 16374 E = Result.get(); 16375 } 16376 16377 const BuiltinType *placeholderType = E->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType(); 16378 if (!placeholderType) return E; 16379 16380 switch (placeholderType->getKind()) { 16381 16382 // Overloaded expressions. 16383 case BuiltinType::Overload: { 16384 // Try to resolve a single function template specialization. 16385 // This is obligatory. 16386 ExprResult Result = E; 16387 if (ResolveAndFixSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(Result, false)) 16388 return Result; 16389 16390 // No guarantees that ResolveAndFixSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization 16391 // leaves Result unchanged on failure. 16392 Result = E; 16393 if (resolveAndFixAddressOfOnlyViableOverloadCandidate(Result)) 16394 return Result; 16395 16396 // If that failed, try to recover with a call. 16397 tryToRecoverWithCall(Result, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_unresolvable), 16398 /*complain*/ true); 16399 return Result; 16400 } 16401 16402 // Bound member functions. 16403 case BuiltinType::BoundMember: { 16404 ExprResult result = E; 16405 const Expr *BME = E->IgnoreParens(); 16406 PartialDiagnostic PD = PDiag(diag::err_bound_member_function); 16407 // Try to give a nicer diagnostic if it is a bound member that we recognize. 16408 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(BME)) { 16409 PD = PDiag(diag::err_dtor_expr_without_call) << /*pseudo-destructor*/ 1; 16410 } else if (const auto *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(BME)) { 16411 if (ME->getMemberNameInfo().getName().getNameKind() == 16412 DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) 16413 PD = PDiag(diag::err_dtor_expr_without_call) << /*destructor*/ 0; 16414 } 16415 tryToRecoverWithCall(result, PD, 16416 /*complain*/ true); 16417 return result; 16418 } 16419 16420 // ARC unbridged casts. 16421 case BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast: { 16422 Expr *realCast = stripARCUnbridgedCast(E); 16423 diagnoseARCUnbridgedCast(realCast); 16424 return realCast; 16425 } 16426 16427 // Expressions of unknown type. 16428 case BuiltinType::UnknownAny: 16429 return diagnoseUnknownAnyExpr(*this, E); 16430 16431 // Pseudo-objects. 16432 case BuiltinType::PseudoObject: 16433 return checkPseudoObjectRValue(E); 16434 16435 case BuiltinType::BuiltinFn: { 16436 // Accept __noop without parens by implicitly converting it to a call expr. 16437 auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParenImpCasts()); 16438 if (DRE) { 16439 auto *FD = cast<FunctionDecl>(DRE->getDecl()); 16440 if (FD->getBuiltinID() == Builtin::BI__noop) { 16441 E = ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(FD->getType()), 16442 CK_BuiltinFnToFnPtr).get(); 16443 return new (Context) CallExpr(Context, E, None, Context.IntTy, 16444 VK_RValue, SourceLocation()); 16445 } 16446 } 16447 16448 Diag(E->getLocStart(), diag::err_builtin_fn_use); 16449 return ExprError(); 16450 } 16451 16452 // Expressions of unknown type. 16453 case BuiltinType::OMPArraySection: 16454 Diag(E->getLocStart(), diag::err_omp_array_section_use); 16455 return ExprError(); 16456 16457 // Everything else should be impossible. 16458 #define IMAGE_TYPE(ImgType, Id, SingletonId, Access, Suffix) \ 16459 case BuiltinType::Id: 16460 #include "clang/Basic/OpenCLImageTypes.def" 16461 #define BUILTIN_TYPE(Id, SingletonId) case BuiltinType::Id: 16462 #define PLACEHOLDER_TYPE(Id, SingletonId) 16463 #include "clang/AST/BuiltinTypes.def" 16464 break; 16465 } 16466 16467 llvm_unreachable("invalid placeholder type!"); 16468 } 16469 16470 bool Sema::CheckCaseExpression(Expr *E) { 16471 if (E->isTypeDependent()) 16472 return true; 16473 if (E->isValueDependent() || E->isIntegerConstantExpr(Context)) 16474 return E->getType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType(); 16475 return false; 16476 } 16477 16478 /// ActOnObjCBoolLiteral - Parse {__objc_yes,__objc_no} literals. 16479 ExprResult 16480 Sema::ActOnObjCBoolLiteral(SourceLocation OpLoc, tok::TokenKind Kind) { 16481 assert((Kind == tok::kw___objc_yes || Kind == tok::kw___objc_no) && 16482 "Unknown Objective-C Boolean value!"); 16483 QualType BoolT = Context.ObjCBuiltinBoolTy; 16484 if (!Context.getBOOLDecl()) { 16485 LookupResult Result(*this, &Context.Idents.get("BOOL"), OpLoc, 16486 Sema::LookupOrdinaryName); 16487 if (LookupName(Result, getCurScope()) && Result.isSingleResult()) { 16488 NamedDecl *ND = Result.getFoundDecl(); 16489 if (TypedefDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TypedefDecl>(ND)) 16490 Context.setBOOLDecl(TD); 16491 } 16492 } 16493 if (Context.getBOOLDecl()) 16494 BoolT = Context.getBOOLType(); 16495 return new (Context) 16496 ObjCBoolLiteralExpr(Kind == tok::kw___objc_yes, BoolT, OpLoc); 16497 } 16498 16499 ExprResult Sema::ActOnObjCAvailabilityCheckExpr( 16500 llvm::ArrayRef<AvailabilitySpec> AvailSpecs, SourceLocation AtLoc, 16501 SourceLocation RParen) { 16502 16503 StringRef Platform = getASTContext().getTargetInfo().getPlatformName(); 16504 16505 auto Spec = std::find_if(AvailSpecs.begin(), AvailSpecs.end(), 16506 [&](const AvailabilitySpec &Spec) { 16507 return Spec.getPlatform() == Platform; 16508 }); 16509 16510 VersionTuple Version; 16511 if (Spec != AvailSpecs.end()) 16512 Version = Spec->getVersion(); 16513 16514 // The use of `@available` in the enclosing function should be analyzed to 16515 // warn when it's used inappropriately (i.e. not if(@available)). 16516 if (getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl()) 16517 getEnclosingFunction()->HasPotentialAvailabilityViolations = true; 16518 else if (getCurBlock() || getCurLambda()) 16519 getCurFunction()->HasPotentialAvailabilityViolations = true; 16520 16521 return new (Context) 16522 ObjCAvailabilityCheckExpr(Version, AtLoc, RParen, Context.BoolTy); 16523 } 16524